HADCO CORP
S-3, 1997-02-18
PRINTED CIRCUIT BOARDS
Previous: FIDELITY ADVISOR SERIES VIII, 497, 1997-02-18
Next: DEFINED ASSET FUNDS MUNICIPAL INVT TR FD MON PYMT SER 302, 24F-2NT, 1997-02-18



<PAGE>   1
 
   AS FILED WITH THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION ON FEBRUARY 18, 1997
                                                     REGISTRATION NO. 333-
================================================================================
 
                       SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
                             WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549
                            ------------------------
 
                                    FORM S-3
                             REGISTRATION STATEMENT
                                     UNDER
                           THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933
                            ------------------------
 
                               HADCO CORPORATION
             (EXACT NAME OF REGISTRANT AS SPECIFIED IN ITS CHARTER)
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                                               <C>
                          MASSACHUSETTS                                                       04-2393279
  (STATE OR OTHER JURISDICTION OF INCORPORATION OR ORGANIZATION)                 (I.R.S. EMPLOYER IDENTIFICATION NO.)
</TABLE>
 
                               12A MANOR PARKWAY
                           SALEM, NEW HAMPSHIRE 03079
                                 (603) 898-8000
  (ADDRESS, INCLUDING ZIP CODE, AND TELEPHONE NUMBER, INCLUDING AREA CODE, OF
                   REGISTRANT'S PRINCIPAL EXECUTIVE OFFICES)
 
                                ANDREW E. LIETZ
                            CHIEF EXECUTIVE OFFICER
                               HADCO CORPORATION
                               12A MANOR PARKWAY
                           SALEM, NEW HAMPSHIRE 03079
                                 (603) 898-8000
 (NAME, ADDRESS, INCLUDING ZIP CODE, AND TELEPHONE NUMBER, INCLUDING AREA CODE,
                             OF AGENT FOR SERVICE)
 
                                   COPIES TO
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                                               <C>
                     STEPHEN A. HURWITZ, ESQ.                                            PETER B. TARR, ESQ.
                 TESTA, HURWITZ & THIBEAULT, LLP                                          HALE AND DORR, LLP
                        HIGH STREET TOWER                                                  60 STATE STREET
                         125 HIGH STREET                                                   BOSTON, MA 02109
                         BOSTON, MA 02110                                                   (617) 526-6000
                          (617) 248-7000
</TABLE>
 
                            ------------------------
 
    APPROXIMATE DATE OF COMMENCEMENT OF PROPOSED SALE TO THE PUBLIC:  As soon as
practicable following the effective date of this Registration Statement.
 
    If the only securities being registered on this Form are being offered
pursuant to dividend or interest reinvestment plans, check the following box. [
]
 
    If any of the securities being registered on this Form are to be offered on
a delayed or continuous basis pursuant to Rule 415 of the Securities Act of
1933, check the following box. [ ]
 
    If this Form is filed to register additional securities for an offering
pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act, please check the following box
and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier
effective registration statement for the same offering. [ ]
 
    If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(c)
under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act
registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement
for the same offering. [ ]
 
    If delivery of the prospectus is expected to be made pursuant to Rule 434,
please check the following box. [X]
                            ------------------------
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                         <C>             <C>               <C>               <C>
                        CALCULATION OF REGISTRATION FEE
================================================================================
</TABLE>
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                             PROPOSED MAXIMUM  PROPOSED MAXIMUM
           TITLE OF EACH CLASS OF             AMOUNT TO BE    OFFERING PRICE      AGGREGATE        AMOUNT OF
        SECURITIES TO BE REGISTERED          REGISTERED(1)     PER SHARE(2)   OFFERING PRICE(1) REGISTRATION FEE
<S>                                         <C>             <C>               <C>               <C>
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Common Stock, par value $.05 per share......    2,300,000        $54.625       $125,637,500(2)      $38,072
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
    % Convertible Subordinated Notes due
  2004......................................   $115,000,000        100%          $115,000,000       $34,849
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Common Stock, par value $.05 per share......       (3)             (3)               (3)              (3)
====================================================================================================================================
</TABLE>
 
(1) Includes 300,000 shares of Common Stock and an additional $15,000,000
    principal amount of Notes which the Underwriters may purchase to cover
    over-allotments, if any.
 
(2) Estimated solely for the purpose of calculating the registration fee
    pursuant to Rule 457(c) and based on the average of the high and low sales
    prices on February 13, 1997, as reported on the Nasdaq National Market.
 
(3) An indeterminate number of shares of Common Stock issuable upon conversion
    of the   % Convertible Subordinated Notes due 2004, including shares
    issuable pursuant to the anti-dilution provisions of such Notes. No separate
    consideration will be received for any such shares so issued upon such
    conversion.
                            ------------------------
 
    THE REGISTRANT HEREBY AMENDS THIS REGISTRATION STATEMENT ON SUCH DATE OR
DATES AS MAY BE NECESSARY TO DELAY ITS EFFECTIVE DATE UNTIL THE REGISTRANT SHALL
FILE A FURTHER AMENDMENT WHICH SPECIFICALLY STATES THAT THIS REGISTRATION
STATEMENT SHALL THEREAFTER BECOME EFFECTIVE IN ACCORDANCE WITH SECTION 8(A) OF
THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933, AS AMENDED, OR UNTIL THIS REGISTRATION STATEMENT
SHALL BECOME EFFECTIVE ON SUCH DATE AS THE COMMISSION, ACTING PURSUANT TO SAID
SECTION 8(A), MAY DETERMINE.
================================================================================
<PAGE>   2
 
                 SUBJECT TO COMPLETION, DATED FEBRUARY 18, 1997
                                      LOGO
                                2,000,000 SHARES
 
                                  COMMON STOCK
 
                                  $100,000,000
                   % CONVERTIBLE SUBORDINATED NOTES DUE 2004
 
    Hadco Corporation ("Hadco" or the "Company") hereby offers 2,000,000 shares
of Common Stock (the "Common Stock Offering"), and $100,000,000 aggregate
principal amount of     % Convertible Subordinated Notes due 2004 (the "Note
Offering"). The     % Convertible Subordinated Notes due 2004 (the "Notes") are
convertible into shares of Common Stock at any time through maturity, unless
previously redeemed or repurchased, at a conversion price of $         per
share, subject to adjustment in certain events. Prior to the Note Offering,
there has been no public trading market for the Notes. The Notes are expected to
be traded on the over-the-counter market. The Company's Common Stock is traded
on the Nasdaq National Market under the symbol "HDCO." On February 13, 1997, the
last reported sale price for the Common Stock on the Nasdaq National Market was
$53.6875 per share.
 
    Interest on the Notes is payable on          and          , commencing
             , 1997. Prior to              , 2000, the Notes are not redeemable
at the option of the Company. At any time on or after that date, the Notes are
redeemable at the option of the Company, in whole, or in part from time to time,
at the declining redemption prices set forth herein, together with accrued and
unpaid interest. See "Description of Notes -- Optional Redemption by the
Company." In the event of a Designated Event (as defined), each holder may
require the Company to repurchase all or a portion of such holder's Notes at
100% of the principal amount thereof, plus accrued and unpaid interest. The
Notes are unsecured and are subordinated to all existing and future Senior
Indebtedness (as defined) of the Company and effectively subordinated with
respect to the assets and earnings of the Company's subsidiaries to all
indebtedness and other liabilities of such subsidiaries. As of January 25, 1997,
the Company had approximately $218 million of outstanding indebtedness that
would have constituted Senior Indebtedness and the Company's subsidiaries had
outstanding indebtedness and other liabilities of approximately $57 million to
which the Notes would have been effectively subordinated. See "Description of
Notes."
 
    The Common Stock Offering and the Note Offering are referred to collectively
as the "Offerings." Neither the closing of the Common Stock Offering nor the
closing of the Note Offering is conditioned on the closing of the other
offering. Adams, Harkness & Hill, Inc. will be a Representative of the Common
Stock Underwriters in the Common Stock Offering only. See "Underwriting."
                            ------------------------
 
    THE COMMON STOCK AND NOTES OFFERED HEREBY INVOLVE A HIGH DEGREE OF RISK.
                    SEE "RISK FACTORS" COMMENCING ON PAGE 8.
                            ------------------------
 
  THESE SECURITIES HAVE NOT BEEN APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED BY THE SECURITIES AND
 EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION NOR HAS THE COMMISSION
   OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION PASSED UPON THE ACCURACY OR ADEQUACY OF
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                             <C>                    <C>                    <C>
   THIS PROSPECTUS. ANY REPRESENTATION TO THE CONTRARY IS A CRIMINAL OFFENSE.
=====================================================================================================================
                                                                            UNDERWRITING
                                                       PRICE TO             DISCOUNTS AND           PROCEEDS TO
                                                        PUBLIC               COMMISSIONS            COMPANY(1)
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Per Share......................................            $                      $                      $
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Per Note.......................................            %                      %                      %
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Total Shares...................................            $                      $                      $
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Total Notes....................................            $                      $                      $
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Total(2).......................................            $                      $                      $
=====================================================================================================================
</TABLE>
 
(1) Before deducting expenses payable by the Company, estimated at $1,200,000.
 
(2) The Company and the Selling Stockholders have granted the Underwriters a
    30-day option to purchase up to an additional 300,000 shares of Common
    Stock, and the Company has granted the Underwriters a 30-day option to
    purchase up to an additional $15,000,000 principal amount of Notes, solely
    to cover over-allotments, if any. See "Underwriting." If such options are
    exercised in full, the total Price to Public, Underwriting Discounts and
    Commissions, and Proceeds to Company will be $         , $         and
    $         , respectively, and the total proceeds to the Selling Stockholders
    will be $         .
                            ------------------------
 
    The Common Stock is offered by the Common Stock Underwriters as stated
herein, and the Notes are offered by the Note Underwriters as stated herein,
subject in each case to receipt and acceptance by them and subject to their
right to reject any order in whole or in part. It is expected that delivery of
such securities will be made through the offices of Robertson, Stephens &
Company LLC ("Robertson, Stephens & Company"), San Francisco, California on or
about              , 1997.
ROBERTSON, STEPHENS & COMPANY
                              MERRILL LYNCH & CO.
                                                    ADAMS, HARKNESS & HILL, INC.
 
              The date of this Prospectus is              , 1997.
 
     INFORMATION CONTAINED HEREIN IS SUBJECT TO COMPLETION OR AMENDMENT. A
     REGISTRATION STATEMENT RELATING TO THESE SECURITIES HAS BEEN FILED WITH THE
     SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION. THESE SECURITIES MAY NOT BE SOLD NOR
     MAY OFFERS TO BUY BE ACCEPTED PRIOR TO THE TIME THE REGISTRATION STATEMENT
     BECOMES EFFECTIVE. THIS PROSPECTUS SHALL NOT CONSTITUTE AN OFFER TO SELL OR
     THE SOLICITATION OF AN OFFER TO BUY NOR SHALL THERE BE ANY SALE OF THESE
     SECURITIES IN ANY STATE IN WHICH SUCH OFFER, SOLICITATION OR SALE WOULD BE
     UNLAWFUL PRIOR TO REGISTRATION OR QUALIFICATION UNDER THE SECURITIES LAWS
     OF ANY SUCH STATE.
<PAGE>   3

HADCO

Where Technology and Time To Market Connect(TM)


Tech Centers                                  Volume Manufacturing

- - Hadco provides development,                 - Hadco can transition production
  design and quick-turn prototype               from prototype to full-scale
  services to customers.                        commercial production.
                                    
- - Tech Center developments                    - Hadco volume capabilities
  include:                                      include:

  - Multilayer printed circuits                 - Multilayer printed circuits of
    of 38+ layers                                 18+ layers

  - Embedded discrete components                - BGA and TAB

  - Multichip modules (MCM)                     - MCM and SCC
                                    
  - Single chip carriers (SCC)                - Volume manufacturing facilities
                                                are located in California,
  - Planar Magnetics                            New Hampshire, New York
                                                and Malaysia.
  - Advanced surface finishes

  - Substrates for high-frequency
    markets
                                                        
- - Tech Centers are located in
  California, Massachusetts and
  New Hampshire.



  Includes pictures of various printed circuits.



CERTAIN PERSONS PARTICIPATING IN THESE OFFERINGS MAY ENGAGE IN TRANSACTIONS
THAT STABILIZE, MAINTAIN, OR OTHERWISE AFFECT THE PRICE OF THE COMMON STOCK AND
THE NOTES, INCLUDING SYNDICATE COVERING TRANSACTIONS OR THE IMPOSITION OF
PENALTY BIDS. FOR A DISCUSSION OF THESE ACTIVITIES, SEE "UNDERWRITING."


<PAGE>   4
 
     NO DEALER, SALES REPRESENTATIVE OR OTHER PERSON HAS BEEN AUTHORIZED TO GIVE
ANY INFORMATION OR MAKE ANY REPRESENTATION IN CONNECTION WITH THE OFFERINGS
OTHER THAN THOSE CONTAINED IN THIS PROSPECTUS, AND, IF GIVEN OR MADE, SUCH
INFORMATION OR REPRESENTATIONS MUST NOT BE RELIED UPON AS HAVING BEEN AUTHORIZED
BY THE COMPANY OR ANY UNDERWRITER. THIS PROSPECTUS DOES NOT CONSTITUTE AN OFFER
TO SELL, OR A SOLICITATION OF AN OFFER TO BUY, ANY SECURITIES OTHER THAN THE
REGISTERED SECURITIES TO WHICH IT RELATES OR AN OFFER TO, OR A SOLICITATION OF,
ANY PERSON IN ANY JURISDICTION WHERE SUCH AN OFFER OR SOLICITATION WOULD BE
UNLAWFUL. NEITHER THE DELIVERY OF THIS PROSPECTUS NOR ANY OFFER OR SALE MADE
HEREUNDER SHALL, UNDER ANY CIRCUMSTANCES, CREATE ANY IMPLICATION THAT THERE HAS
BEEN NO CHANGE IN THE AFFAIRS OF THE COMPANY SINCE THE DATE HEREOF OR THAT THE
INFORMATION CONTAINED HEREIN IS CORRECT AS OF ANY DATE SUBSEQUENT TO THE DATE
HEREOF.
                            ------------------------
 
                               TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                        PAGE
                                                                                        ----
<S>                                                                                     <C>
Incorporation of Certain Information by Reference.....................................    3
Summary...............................................................................    4
Risk Factors..........................................................................    8
Use of Proceeds.......................................................................   16
Dividend Policy.......................................................................   16
Price Range of Common Stock...........................................................   17
Capitalization........................................................................   18
Selected Consolidated Financial Data..................................................   19
Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of
  Operations..........................................................................   21
Business..............................................................................   28
Management............................................................................   41
Principal Shareholders................................................................   43
Description of Capital Stock..........................................................   46
Description of Notes..................................................................   48
Certain Federal Income Tax Considerations.............................................   60
Underwriting..........................................................................   62
Legal Matters.........................................................................   64
Experts...............................................................................   64
Additional Information................................................................   65
Available Information.................................................................   65
Index to Consolidated Financial Statements............................................  F-1
</TABLE>
 
               INCORPORATION OF CERTAIN INFORMATION BY REFERENCE
 
     The following documents filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission
(the "Commission") under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the
"Exchange Act") are hereby incorporated by reference into this Prospectus:
(1) Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended October 26, 1996;
(2) Current Report on Form 8-K dated December 5, 1996; and (3) Current Report on
Form 8-K dated January 24, 1997, as amended by Form 8-K/A dated February 14,
1997.
 
     All documents subsequently filed by Hadco pursuant to Sections 13(a),
13(c), 14 and 15(d) of the Exchange Act after the date of this Prospectus and
prior to the termination of the Offerings shall be deemed to be incorporated by
reference herein and to be a part hereof from the date of filing such documents.
Any statement contained herein or in a document incorporated by reference or
deemed to be incorporated by reference herein shall be deemed to be modified or
superseded for purposes of this Prospectus to the extent that such statement is
modified or superseded by any other subsequently filed document which is
incorporated or is deemed to be incorporated by reference herein. Any such
statement so modified or superseded shall not be deemed, except as so modified
or superseded, to constitute a part of this Prospectus.
 
     This Prospectus incorporates documents by reference which are not presented
herein or delivered herewith. Hadco hereby undertakes to provide without charge
to each person, including any beneficial owner, to whom this Prospectus has been
delivered, on the written or oral request of such person, a copy of any or all
of the documents referred to above which have been or may be incorporated into
this Prospectus and deemed to be part hereof, other than exhibits to such
documents, unless such exhibits are specifically incorporated by reference in
such documents. These documents are available upon request from Timothy P.
Losik, Vice President, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer, Hadco Corporation,
12A Manor Parkway, Salem, New Hampshire 03079, (603) 898-8000.
 
                                        3
<PAGE>   5
 
                                    SUMMARY
 
     This Prospectus contains forward-looking statements which involve risks and
uncertainties. The Company's actual results could differ materially from those
anticipated in these forward-looking statements as a result of certain factors,
including, without limitation, those set forth under "Risk Factors" and
elsewhere in this Prospectus. The following summary is qualified in its entirety
by, and should be read in conjunction with, the more detailed information,
including "Risk Factors," and Consolidated Financial Statements and Notes
thereto, appearing elsewhere in this Prospectus or incorporated by reference
herein. Unless otherwise indicated, all information in this Prospectus assumes
no exercise of the Underwriters' over-allotment options.
 
     As used herein, the terms "Company" and "Hadco," unless otherwise indicated
or the context otherwise requires, refer to Hadco Corporation and its
subsidiaries, including Zycon Corporation ("Zycon"). However, all financial
information for periods ended prior to January 10, 1997, unless otherwise
indicated or the context otherwise requires, is for Hadco Corporation alone and
does not include Zycon.
 
                                  THE COMPANY
 
     Hadco is the largest manufacturer of advanced electronic interconnect
products in North America. The Company offers a wide array of sophisticated
manufacturing, engineering and systems integration services to meet its
customers' electronic interconnect needs. The Company's principal products are
complex multilayer rigid printed circuits and backplane assemblies. Hadco's
largest customers include many of the leading and fastest growing companies in
the electronics industry, such as Cabletron Systems, Cisco Systems, Intel,
Solectron, Sun Microsystems and U.S. Robotics.
 
     Hadco's advanced manufacturing and assembly facilities are designed to meet
the accelerated time-to-market and time-to-volume requirements of its customers
whose markets and products are characterized by high growth rates, rapid
technological advances and short product life-cycles. To this end, Hadco
(including Zycon) has invested approximately $235 million in state-of-the-art
production facilities and new technologies during the past five fiscal years.
Hadco provides customers with a range of products and services that includes
development, design, quick-turn prototype, pre-production, volume production,
and backplane assembly. Hadco is one of a small number of printed circuit
manufacturers with the technology and advanced production facilities necessary
to offer all of these services. The Company believes its combination of a broad
product offering and advanced technology facilitates long-term relationships
with existing customers, attracts new customers, helps customers meet their
time-to-market and time-to-volume needs, and satisfies a larger share of
customers' electronic interconnect requirements.
 
     Hadco's customers are a diverse group of electronics original equipment
manufacturers ("OEMs") and contract manufacturers in the computing (mainly
workstations, servers, mainframes, storage and notebooks), data
communications/telecommunications and industrial automation industries,
including process controls, automotive, medical and instrumentation. Hadco
(including Zycon) supplied its products and services to a diverse base of
approximately 500 customers in fiscal 1996, including 77 customers with
purchases in excess of $1 million. The Company's ten largest customers accounted
for approximately 43% of net sales in fiscal 1996 on a pro forma basis including
Zycon.
 
     Industry sources estimate that the number of U.S. interconnect
manufacturers has decreased from over 2,100 in 1978 to approximately 700 in 1995
during a period when the market size increased to $8.3 billion for rigid printed
circuits and backplane assemblies. In large part, this decrease in manufacturers
resulted from the increasingly advanced technology and services required by
sophisticated electronics OEMs to meet their needs for complex products and
shorter time-to-market cycles in their industries. As OEMs have narrowed their
supply base, the increased investment necessary for state-of-the-art production
facilities and advanced technologies has accelerated consolidation in the
printed circuit industry and the exit of smaller companies.
 
                                        4
<PAGE>   6
 
     To capitalize on this consolidation trend and to gain increased economies
of scale, Hadco acquired Zycon on January 10, 1997. This acquisition increased
Hadco's net sales significantly, added approximately 600,000 square feet of
manufacturing space (approximately a 100% increase) and substantially expanded
the Company's manufacturing capabilities and geographic reach. The new
manufacturing capabilities consist of state-of-the-art West Coast facilities for
volume production of complex printed circuits and backplane assemblies, a
quick-turn prototype and design facility on the East Coast, and a newly
constructed facility for volume production in Malaysia. The acquisition of Zycon
has also broadened the Company's customer base, expanded its involvement in many
fast growing industry sectors, added new proprietary technologies, and increased
its sales force.
 
     The Company's strategy takes advantage of other major industry trends such
as the increased customer demand for a single source of integrated services,
accelerating time-to-market and time-to-volume product requirements, and the
increased demand for complex electronic products and new interconnect
technologies. The principal components of Hadco's strategy are size, financial
strength, investment in state-of-the-art facilities and technologies, and a
broad and integrated offering (from development and design through volume
production and backplane assembly). The Company believes this strategy is
responsible for its emergence as the largest manufacturer of advanced electronic
interconnect products in North America.
 
     The Company was incorporated in Massachusetts in 1966. The Company's
principal executive offices are located at 12A Manor Parkway, Salem, New
Hampshire 03079, and its telephone number is (603) 898-8000.
 
     Hadco(TM), ResistAIR(TM) and MicroPath(TM) are trademarks of the Company.
This Prospectus also includes the trademarks of other companies.
 
                           THE COMMON STOCK OFFERING
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                                                     <C>
Common Stock Offered by the Company.................................    2,000,000 shares
Common Stock to be Outstanding after the Common Stock Offering......    12,444,188 shares(1)
Nasdaq National Market Symbol.......................................    HDCO
</TABLE>
 
- ------------
 
(1) Based on shares outstanding on January 25, 1997. Excludes options
    outstanding as of January 25, 1997 to acquire 1,219,829 shares of Common
    Stock at a weighted average exercise price of $15.06 per share and an
    additional 843,000 shares of Common Stock reserved for issuance under the
    Company's stock option plans. See Note 10 of Notes to the Company's
    Consolidated Financial Statements. Also excludes shares of Common Stock
    issuable upon conversion of the Notes.
 
                                        5
<PAGE>   7
 
                               THE NOTE OFFERING
 
Securities Offered.........  $100 million principal amount of   % Convertible
                             Subordinated Notes due 2004 (the "Notes") ($115
                             million principal amount of Notes if the
                             over-allotment option is exercised in full).
 
Interest Payment Dates.....            and           , commencing           ,
                             1997.
 
Maturity...................            , 2004.
 
Conversion.................  Convertible into Common Stock, $.05 par value, of
                             the Company at any time through maturity, unless
                             previously redeemed or repurchased, at a conversion
                             price of $          per share, subject to
                             adjustment in certain events. See "Description of
                             Notes -- Conversion."
 
Optional Redemption........  The Notes are not redeemable at the option of the
                             Company prior to           , 2000. At any time on
                             or after that date, the Notes are redeemable at the
                             option of the Company, in whole or in part from
                             time to time, at the declining redemption prices
                             set forth herein, plus accrued and unpaid interest
                             to the redemption date. See "Description of
                             Notes -- Optional Redemption by the Company."
 
Repurchase at Option of
Holders   upon a Designated
Event......................  In the event of a Designated Event (as defined),
                             each holder may require the Company to repurchase
                             all or a portion of such holder's Notes at 100% of
                             the principal amount thereof plus accrued and
                             unpaid interest. See "Description of Notes
                              -- Repurchase at Option of Holders Upon a
                             Designated Event."
 
Subordination..............  Subordinate to all existing and future Senior
                             Indebtedness (as defined) of the Company and will
                             be effectively subordinated with respect to the
                             assets and earnings of the Company's subsidiaries
                             to all indebtedness and other liabilities of such
                             subsidiaries. As of January 25, 1997, the Company
                             had approximately $218 million of outstanding
                             indebtedness that would have constituted Senior
                             Indebtedness, and subsidiaries of the Company had
                             outstanding indebtedness and other liabilities of
                             approximately $57 million (excluding intracompany
                             liabilities and liabilities of a type not required
                             to be reflected as liabilities on the balance
                             sheets of such subsidiaries in accordance with
                             generally accepted accounting principles) to which
                             the Notes would have been effectively subordinated.
                             The Indenture will not limit the amount of
                             additional indebtedness, including Senior
                             Indebtedness, which the Company or any of its
                             subsidiaries can create, incur, assume or
                             guarantee. See "Description of
                             Notes -- Subordination."
 
Trading....................  The Notes are expected to trade on the
                             over-the-counter market.
 
                                USE OF PROCEEDS
 
     The Company intends to use a majority of the net proceeds from the sale of
the 2,000,000 shares of Common Stock and the $100 million principal amount of
the Notes to repay a portion of the outstanding indebtedness incurred in
connection with the acquisition of Zycon, and the remainder for general
corporate purposes, which may include additional acquisitions. See "Use of
Proceeds."
 
                                        6
<PAGE>   8
 
                      SUMMARY CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL DATA
                (In thousands, except ratio and per share data)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                             FISCAL YEAR ENDED,                             THREE MONTHS ENDED,
                             ---------------------------------------------------   --------------------------------------
                             OCTOBER 29,  OCTOBER 28,  OCTOBER 26,                 JANUARY 27,  JANUARY 25,
                                1994         1995         1996      OCTOBER 26,       1996        1997(1)    JANUARY 25,
                             -----------  -----------  -----------      1996       -----------  -----------      1997
                                                                    ------------                             ------------
                                                                    PRO FORMA(2)                             PRO FORMA(2)
<S>                          <C>          <C>          <C>          <C>            <C>          <C>          <C>
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF
  OPERATIONS:
Net sales...................  $ 221,570    $ 265,168    $ 350,685     $570,345       $76,481     $ 111,536     $172,547
Gross profit................     43,973       64,495       86,148      119,494        19,482        24,855       32,941
Write-off of acquired in-            --           --           --           --            --        78,000           --
  process research and
  development...............
Income (loss) from               16,482       33,906       51,532       64,968        11,534       (62,443)      18,637
  operations................
Net income (loss)...........  $   9,943    $  21,374    $  32,014     $ 28,700       $ 7,191     $ (69,161)    $  8,275
Net income (loss) per         $     .93    $    1.98    $    2.89     $   2.59       $   .65     $   (6.64)    $    .76
  share(3)..................
Weighted average shares          10,720       10,806       11,084       11,084        11,104        10,413       10,944
  outstanding(3)............
OTHER DATA:
Ratio of earnings to fixed         19.4x        66.2x       156.3x         4.1x        125.1x           --          4.1x
  charges(4)................
EBITDA(5)...................     30,704       48,812       70,375       91,906        15,582        21,818       26,002
Capital expenditures........     19,510       28,865       54,998      107,154        13,713        11,011       17,939
Interest expense............        891          537          338       16,197            95           933        4,669
</TABLE>
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                           JANUARY 25, 1997
                                                                                --------------------------------------
                                                                                  ACTUAL          AS ADJUSTED(6)
                                                                                -----------  -------------------------
<S>                                                                             <C>          <C>          <C>
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET DATA:
Working capital...............................................................   $  22,072                    $ 22,072
Total assets..................................................................     448,554                     452,154
Long-term debt and capital lease obligations, net of current portion..........     228,168                     130,362
Stockholders' investment......................................................      71,057                     172,463
</TABLE>
 
- ------------
 
(1) Net loss for the three months ended January 25, 1997 includes a
    non-recurring write-off relating to the acquisition of Zycon for in-process
    research and development. Before deducting the non-recurring write-off,
    income from operations was $15,557,000, net income was $8,839,000, net
    income per share was $.81 (based on weighted average shares outstanding of
    approximately 10,944,000), and the ratio of earnings to fixed shares was
    17.6x.
(2) Gives effect to the acquisition of Zycon assuming such transaction had
    occurred on October 29, 1995. See the Company's unaudited Pro Forma
    Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements beginning on page F-23 and
    "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of
    Operations."
(3) See Note 1 of Notes to the Company's Consolidated Financial Statements for
    an explanation of the basis used to calculate net income (loss) per share.
(4) Computed by dividing the sum of net income (loss), before deducting
    provisions for income taxes and fixed charges, by total fixed charges. Fixed
    charges consist of interest on debt and amortization of debt issuance costs
    and a portion of capital lease costs that is intended to represent interest
    expense.
(5) EBITDA represents net income before interest, income taxes, depreciation and
    amortization, and write-off of acquired in-process research and development.
    EBITDA should not be considered an alternative measure of the Company's net
    income, operating performance, cash flow or liquidity. It is included herein
    to provide additional information related to the Company's ability to
    service debt.
(6) Adjusted to reflect (i) the sale by the Company of 2,000,000 shares of
    Common Stock (at an assumed public offering price of $53.6875 per share) in
    the Common Stock Offering and the sale of $100 million of principal amount
    of Notes in the Note Offering, in each case less estimated underwriting
    discounts and commissions and offering expenses payable by the Company, and
    (ii) the application of the net proceeds from the Common Stock Offering and
    the Note Offering. See "Use of Proceeds."
 
                                        7
<PAGE>   9
 
                                  RISK FACTORS
 
     This Prospectus contains forward-looking statements which involve risks and
uncertainties. The Company's actual results could differ materially from those
anticipated in these forward-looking statements as a result of certain factors,
including, without limitation, those set forth in the following risk factors and
elsewhere in this Prospectus. In addition to the other information included or
incorporated by reference in this Prospectus, the following risk factors should
be considered carefully in evaluating the Company and its business before
purchasing shares of Common Stock or the Notes offered hereby.
 
DEPENDENCE ON ELECTRONICS INDUSTRY
 
     The Company's principal customers are electronics OEMs and contract
manufacturers in the computing (mainly workstations, servers, mainframes,
storage and notebooks), data communications/telecommunications and industrial
automation industries, including process controls, automotive, medical and
instrumentation. These industry segments, and the electronics industry as a
whole, are characterized by intense competition, relatively short product
life-cycles and significant fluctuations in product demand. In addition, the
electronics industry is generally subject to rapid technological change and
product obsolescence. Discontinuance or modifications of products containing
components manufactured by the Company could have a material adverse effect on
the Company's business, financial condition and results of operations. Further,
the electronics industry is subject to economic cycles and has in the past
experienced, and is likely in the future to experience, recessionary periods. A
recession or any other event leading to excess capacity or a downturn in the
electronics industry would likely result in intensified price competition,
reduced gross margins and a decrease in unit volume, all of which would have a
material adverse effect on the Company's business, financial condition and
results of operations. See "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial
Condition and Results of Operations," "Business -- Industry Overview and Trends"
and "-- Markets and Customers."
 
FLUCTUATIONS IN QUARTERLY OPERATING RESULTS
 
     The Company's quarterly operating results have varied and may continue to
fluctuate significantly. At times in the past, the Company's net sales and net
income have decreased from the prior quarter. Operating results are affected by
a number of factors, including the timing and volume of orders from and
shipments to customers relative to the Company's manufacturing capacity, level
of product and price competition, product mix, the number of working days in a
particular quarter, trends in the electronics industry and general economic
factors. In recent years, the Company's gross margins have varied primarily as a
result of capacity utilization, product mix, lead times, volume levels and
complexity of customer orders. There can be no assurance that the Company will
be able to manage the utilization of manufacturing capacity or product mix in a
manner that would maintain or improve gross margins or the Company's business,
financial condition and results of operations. The timing and volume of orders
placed by the Company's customers vary due to customer attempts to manage
inventory, changes in customers' manufacturing strategies and variation in
demand for customer products. An interruption in manufacturing resulting from
shortages of parts or equipment, fire, earthquake or other natural disaster,
equipment failure or otherwise would have a material adverse effect on the
Company's business, financial condition and results of operations. The Company's
expense levels are relatively fixed and are based, in part, on expectations of
future revenues. Consequently, if revenue levels are below expectations, this
occurrence is likely to materially adversely affect the Company's business,
financial condition and results of operations. Results of operations in any
period are not necessarily indicative of the results to be expected for any
future period. Due to all of the foregoing factors, it is possible that in some
future quarter the Company's operating results may be below the expectations of
public market analysts and investors. Such an event could have a material
adverse effect on the price of the Company's Common Stock and the Notes. See
"Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of
Operations."
 
                                        8
<PAGE>   10
 
VARIABILITY OF ORDERS
 
     The level and timing of orders placed by the Company's customers vary due
to a number of factors, including customer attempts to manage inventory, changes
in the customers' manufacturing strategies and variation in demand for customer
products due to, among other things, technological change, new product
introductions, product life-cycles, competitive conditions or general economic
conditions. Since the Company generally does not obtain long-term purchase
orders or commitments from its customers, it must anticipate the future volume
of orders based on discussions with its customers. A substantial portion of
sales in a given quarter may depend on obtaining orders for products to be
manufactured and shipped in the same quarter in which those orders are received.
The Company relies on its estimate of anticipated future volumes when making
commitments regarding the level of business that it will seek and accept, the
mix of products that it intends to manufacture, the timing of production
schedules and the levels and utilization of personnel and other resources. A
variety of conditions, both specific to the individual customer and generally
affecting the customer's industry, may cause customers to cancel, reduce or
delay orders that were previously made or anticipated. A significant portion of
the Company's released backlog at any time may be subject to cancellation or
postponement without penalty. The Company cannot assure the timely replacement
of canceled, delayed or reduced orders. Significant or numerous cancellations,
reductions or delays in orders by a customer or group of customers could
materially adversely affect the Company's business, financial condition and
results of operations. See "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial
Condition and Results of Operations" and "Business -- Released Backlog."
 
ACQUISITIONS
 
     The Company acquired 100% of the capital stock of Zycon, a manufacturer of
electronic interconnect products, on January 10, 1997 (the "Zycon acquisition").
Zycon currently operates as a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company. The
Company has limited experience in integrating acquired companies or technologies
into its operations. Therefore, there can be no assurance that the Company will
operate the acquired business profitably during the next year or in the future.
Contemporaneous with the Zycon acquisition, nine senior management personnel of
Zycon were terminated. There can be no assurance that the Company will not be
materially adversely affected by such terminations or that the Company will be
able to retain key personnel at Zycon. Accordingly, operating expenses
associated with the acquired business may have a material adverse effect on the
Company's business, financial condition and results of operations in the future.
See "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of
Operations" and "Business -- General."
 
     The Company may from time to time pursue the acquisition of other
companies, assets, products or technologies. The Company may incur additional
indebtedness in connection with a future business acquisition, and the
incurrence of substantial amounts of debt in connection with future acquisitions
could increase the risk of the Company's operations. If the Company's cash flow
and existing working capital are not sufficient to fund its general working
capital requirements or to service its indebtedness, the Company would have to
raise additional funds through the sale of its equity securities, the
refinancing of all or part of its indebtedness or the sale of assets or
subsidiaries. There can be no assurance that any of these sources of funds would
be available in amounts sufficient for the Company to meet its obligations. The
cost of debt financing may also impair the ability of the Company to maintain
adequate working capital or to make future acquisitions. In addition, the
issuance of additional shares of Common Stock in connection with future
acquisitions could be dilutive to existing investors. Acquisitions involve a
number of operating risks that could materially adversely affect the Company's
operating results, including the diversion of management's attention to
assimilate the operations, products and personnel of the acquired companies, the
amortization of acquired intangible assets, and the potential loss of key
employees of the acquired companies. Furthermore, acquisitions may involve
businesses in which the Company lacks experience. There can be no assurance that
the Company will be able to manage one or more acquisitions successfully, or
that the Company will be able to integrate the operations, products or personnel
gained through any such acquisitions without a
 
                                        9
<PAGE>   11
 
material adverse effect on the Company's business, financial condition and
results of operations. See "Business -- The Hadco Strategy."
 
COMPETITION
 
     The electronic interconnect industry is highly fragmented and characterized
by intense competition. The Company believes that its major competitors are the
large U.S. and international independent and captive producers that also
manufacture multilayer printed circuits and provide backplane and other
electronic assemblies. Some of these competitors have significantly greater
financial, technical and marketing resources, greater name recognition and a
larger installed customer base than the Company. In addition, these competitors
may have the ability to respond more quickly to new or emerging technologies,
may adapt more quickly to changes in customer requirements and may devote
greater resources to the development, promotion and sale of their products than
the Company.
 
     During periods of recession or economic slowdown in the electronics
industry and other periods when excess capacity exists, electronics OEMs become
more price sensitive, which could have a material adverse effect on interconnect
pricing. In addition, the Company believes that price competition from printed
circuit manufacturers in Asia and other locations with lower production costs
may play an increasing role in the printed circuit markets in which the Company
competes. The Company's basic interconnect technology is generally not subject
to significant proprietary protection, and companies with significant resources
or international operations may enter the market. Increased competition could
result in price reductions, reduced margins or loss of market share, any of
which could materially adversely affect the Company's business, financial
condition and results of operations.
 
     The demand for printed circuits has continued to be affected by the
development of smaller, more powerful electronic components requiring less
printed circuit area. Expansion of the Company's existing products or services
could expose the Company to new competition. Moreover, new developments in the
electronics industry could render existing technology obsolete or less
competitive and could potentially introduce new competition into the industry.
There can be no assurance that the Company will continue to compete successfully
against present and future competitors or that competitive pressures faced by
the Company will not have a material adverse effect on the Company's business,
financial condition and results of operations. See "Business -- Industry
Overview and Trends."
 
TECHNOLOGICAL CHANGE, PROCESS DEVELOPMENT AND PROCESS DISRUPTION
 
     The market for the Company's products and services is characterized by
rapidly changing technology and continuing process development. The future
success of the Company's business will depend in large part upon its ability to
maintain and enhance its technological capabilities, develop and market products
and services that meet changing customer needs and successfully anticipate or
respond to technological changes, on a cost-effective and timely basis. In
addition, the electronic interconnect industry could in the future encounter
competition from new technologies that render existing electronic interconnect
technology less competitive or obsolete, including technologies that may reduce
the number of printed circuits required in electronic components. There can be
no assurance that the Company will effectively respond to the technological
requirements of the changing market. To the extent the Company determines that
new technologies and equipment are required to remain competitive, the
development, acquisition and implementation of such technologies and equipment
are likely to continue to require significant capital investment by the Company.
There can be no assurance that capital will be available for this purpose in the
future or that investments in new technologies will result in commercially
viable technological processes or that there will be commercial applications for
these technologies. Moreover, the Company's business involves highly complex
manufacturing processes that have in the past and could in the future be subject
to periodic failure or disruption. Process disruptions can result in delays in
certain product shipments. There can be no assurance that failures or
disruptions will not occur in the future. The loss of revenue and earnings to
the Company from such a technological change, process development or process
disruption, as well as any disruption of the Company's operations resulting from
a natural disaster such as an earthquake, fire
 
                                       10
<PAGE>   12
 
or flood, could have a material adverse effect on the Company's business,
financial condition and results of operations. See "Business -- Industry
Overview and Trends," "-- The Hadco Strategy" and "-- Products and Services."
 
MALAYSIA FACILITY
 
     Zycon recently completed construction of a volume manufacturing facility
for printed circuits in Malaysia. Hadco's management has no experience in
operating foreign manufacturing facilities, and there can be no assurance that
the Company will be able to operate the new facility on a profitable basis. The
Company expects that the Malaysia facility will incur operating losses during
future quarters of operations as a result of various factors, including, without
limitation, initial operating inefficiencies, other start-up costs, and price
competition for the products which the Company intends to produce at the new
facility. Losses incurred in its Malaysia operations will not be deductible for
United States income tax purposes. International operations are also subject to
a number of risks, including unforeseen changes in regulatory requirements,
exchange rates, tariffs and other trade barriers, misappropriation of
intellectual property, currency fluctuations, and political and economic
instability.
 
CUSTOMER CONCENTRATION
 
     During the past several years, the Company's sales to a small number of its
customers have accounted for a significant percentage of the Company's annual
net sales. During fiscal 1994, 1995 and 1996, the Company's ten largest
customers accounted for approximately 48%, 46% and 48% of net sales,
respectively, and 43% in fiscal 1996 on a pro forma basis including Zycon. In
fiscal 1996, Sun Microsystems accounted for approximately 10% of the net sales
of the Company (including Zycon). Given the Company's strategy of developing
long-term relationships with high growth companies, the Company's dependence on
a number of its most significant customers may increase. There can be no
assurance that the Company will be able to identify, attract and retain
customers with high growth rates or that the customers that it does attract and
retain will continue to grow. Although there can be no assurance that the
Company's principal customers will continue to purchase products and services
from the Company at current levels, the Company expects to continue to depend
upon its principal customers for a significant portion of its net sales. The
loss of or decrease in orders from one or more major customers could have a
material adverse effect on the Company's business, financial condition and
results of operations. See "Business -- Markets and Customers."
 
MANUFACTURING CAPACITY
 
     The Company believes its long-term competitive position depends in part on
its ability to increase manufacturing capacity. The Company may obtain such
additional capacity through acquisitions or expansion of its current facilities.
Either approach would require substantial additional capital, and there can be
no assurance that such capital will be available from cash generated by current
operations. Further, there can be no assurance that the Company will be able to
acquire sufficient capacity or successfully integrate and manage such additional
facilities. In addition, the Company's expansion of its manufacturing capacity
has significantly increased and will continue to significantly increase its
fixed costs, and the future profitability of the Company will depend on its
ability to utilize its manufacturing capacity in an effective manner. The
failure to obtain sufficient capacity or to successfully integrate and manage
additional manufacturing facilities could adversely impact the Company's
relationships with its customers and materially adversely affect the Company's
business, financial condition and results of operations. The Company has a large
manufacturing facility in Santa Clara, California, and an earthquake or other
natural disaster in that area that results in an interruption of manufacturing
at such facility would have a material adverse effect on the Company's business,
financial condition and results of operations. See "Business -- Manufacturing
and Facilities."
 
                                       11
<PAGE>   13
 
MANAGEMENT OF GROWTH
 
     The Company has initiated significant expansion, including geographic
expansion, of its operations, which has placed, and will continue to place,
significant demands on the Company's management, operational, technical and
financial resources. These demands are compounded by the Zycon acquisition. See
"-- Acquisitions." The Company expects that expansion will require additional
management personnel and the development of further expertise by existing
management personnel. The Company's ability to manage growth effectively,
particularly given the increasing scope of its operations, will require it to
continue to implement and improve its operational, financial and management
information systems as well as to further develop the management skills of its
managers and supervisors and to train, motivate and manage its employees. The
Company's failure to effectively manage future growth, if any, could have a
material adverse effect on the Company's business, financial condition and
results of operations. Competition for personnel is intense, and there can be no
assurance that the Company will be able to attract, assimilate or retain
additional highly qualified employees in the future, especially engineering
personnel. The failure to hire and retain such personnel could have a material
adverse effect on the Company's business, financial condition and results of
operations.
 
ENVIRONMENTAL MATTERS
 
     The Company is subject to a variety of local, state and federal
environmental laws and regulations relating to the storage, use, discharge and
disposal of chemicals, solid waste and other hazardous materials used during its
manufacturing process, as well as air quality regulations and restrictions on
water use. When violations of environmental laws occur, the Company can be held
liable for damages and the costs of remedial actions and can also be subject to
revocation of permits necessary to conduct its business. Any such revocations
could require the Company to cease or limit production at one or more of its
facilities, which could have a material adverse effect on the Company's
business, financial condition and results of operations. Moreover, the Company's
failure to comply with present and future regulations could restrict the
Company's ability to expand its facilities or could require the Company to
acquire costly equipment or to incur other significant expenses to comply with
environmental regulations.
 
     Environmental laws could become more stringent over time, imposing greater
compliance costs and increasing risks and penalties associated with violation.
The Company operates in several environmentally sensitive locations and is
subject to potentially conflicting and changing regulatory agendas of political,
business and environmental groups. Changes or restrictions on discharge limits,
emissions levels, or material storage or handling might require a high level of
unplanned capital investment and/or relocation. There can be no assurance that
compliance with new or existing regulations will not have a material adverse
effect on the Company's business, financial condition and results of operations.
See "Business -- Environmental Matters," "-- Legal Proceedings" and Note 9 of
Notes to the Company's Consolidated Financial Statements.
 
AVAILABILITY OF RAW MATERIALS AND COMPONENTS
 
     While the Company has not entered into any supply agreements and does not
have any guaranteed sources of raw materials or components, it routinely
purchases raw materials and components from several key material suppliers.
Although alternative material suppliers are currently available, a significant
unplanned event at a major supplier could have a material adverse effect on the
Company's operations. Zycon has experienced shortages of certain types of raw
materials in the past. The potential exists for shortages of certain types of
raw materials or components and any such future shortages or price fluctuations
in raw materials could have a material adverse effect on the Company's
manufacturing operations and future unit costs, thereby materially adversely
affecting the Company's business, financial condition and results of operations.
Product changes and the overall demand for electronic interconnect products
could increase the industry's use of new laminate materials, standard laminate
materials, multilayer blanks, electronic components and other materials, and
therefore such
 
                                       12
<PAGE>   14
 
materials may not be readily available to the Company in the future. Electronic
components used by the Company in producing backplane assemblies are purchased
by the Company and, in certain circumstances, the Company may bear the risk of
component price fluctuations. There can be no assurance that shortages of
certain types of electronic components will not occur in the future. Component
shortages or price fluctuations could have a material adverse effect on the
Company's backplane assembly business, thereby materially adversely affecting
the Company's business, financial condition and results of operations. To the
extent that the Company's backplane assembly business expands as a percentage of
the Company's net sales, component shortages and price fluctuations could, to a
greater extent, materially adversely affect the Company's business, financial
condition and results of operations. See "Business -- Supplier Relationships."
 
DEPENDENCE ON KEY PERSONNEL
 
     The Company's future success depends to a large extent upon the continued
services of key managerial and technical employees, none of whom, except for the
President/Chief Executive Officer, is bound by an employment agreement or a
non-competition agreement. The President/Chief Executive Officer's
non-competition agreement is for one year after the termination of his
employment with the Company. The loss of the services of any of the Company's
key employees could have a material adverse effect on the Company. The Company
believes that its future success depends on its continuing ability to attract
and retain highly qualified technical, managerial and marketing personnel.
Competition for such personnel is intense, especially for engineering personnel,
and there can be no assurance that the Company will be able to attract,
assimilate or retain such personnel. If the Company is unable to hire and retain
key personnel, the Company's business, financial condition and results of
operations may be materially adversely affected. See "Management."
 
INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY
 
     The Company's success depends in part on its proprietary techniques and
manufacturing expertise, particularly in the area of complex multilayer printed
circuits. The Company has few patents and relies primarily on trade secret
protection of its intellectual property. There can be no assurance that the
Company will be able to protect its trade secrets or that others will not
independently develop substantially equivalent proprietary information and
techniques or otherwise gain access to the Company's trade secrets. In addition,
litigation may be necessary to protect the Company's trade secrets, to determine
the validity and scope of the proprietary rights of others or to defend against
claims of patent infringement. If any infringement claim is asserted against the
Company, the Company may seek to obtain a license of the other party's
intellectual property rights. There is no assurance that a license would be
available on reasonable terms or at all. Litigation with respect to patents or
other intellectual property matters could result in substantial costs and
diversion of management and other resources and could have a material adverse
effect on the Company's business, financial condition and results of operations.
 
SUBORDINATION OF NOTES AND ABSENCE OF FINANCIAL COVENANTS
 
     The Notes will be unsecured and subordinated in right of payment in full to
all existing and future Senior Indebtedness (as defined) of the Company and will
be effectively subordinated with respect to the assets and earnings of the
Company's subsidiaries to all indebtedness and other liabilities of such
subsidiaries. As of January 25, 1997, the Company had approximately $218 million
of outstanding indebtedness that would have constituted Senior Indebtedness, and
subsidiaries of the Company had outstanding indebtedness and other liabilities
aggregating approximately $57 million (excluding intracompany liabilities and
liabilities of a type not required to be reflected as liabilities on the balance
sheet of such subsidiaries in accordance with generally accepted accounting
principles) to which the Notes would have been effectively subordinated. The
Indenture will not limit the amount of additional indebtedness, including Senior
Indebtedness, which the Company or any of its subsidiaries can create, incur,
assume or guarantee. During the continuance beyond any applicable grace period
of any default
 
                                       13
<PAGE>   15
 
of the payment of principal, premium, if any, interest or any other payment due
on any Senior Indebtedness and upon notice by holders of Designated Senior
Indebtedness (as defined) to the Trustee of a covenant default on Designated
Senior Indebtedness, no payment of principal, or premium, if any, or interest on
the Notes (including, but not limited to the redemption price or repurchase
price with respect to the Notes) may be made by the Company. In addition, upon
any distribution of assets of the Company pursuant to any dissolution, winding
up, liquidation or reorganization, or acceleration of the maturity of the Notes
as a result of an Event of Default (as defined), the payment of the principal
of, or premium, if any, and interest on the Notes is subordinated to the extent
provided in the Indenture to the prior payment in full of all Senior
Indebtedness. By reason of the subordination, in the event of the Company's
liquidation or dissolution, holders of Senior Indebtedness may receive more,
ratably, and holders of the Notes may receive less, ratably, than the other
creditors of the Company.
 
     The Notes are obligations exclusively of the Company. As a significant
portion of the Company's consolidated operations is conducted through
subsidiaries, the cash flow and the consequent ability to service debt,
including the Notes, of the Company is partially dependent upon the earnings of
such subsidiaries and the distribution of those earnings, or upon loans or other
payments of funds by those subsidiaries, to the Company. Such subsidiaries are
separate and distinct legal entities, and have no obligation, contingent or
otherwise, to pay any amounts due pursuant to the Notes or to make any funds
available therefor, whether by dividends, distributions, loans or other
payments. In addition, the payment of dividends or distributions and the making
of loans and advances to the Company by any such subsidiaries may be subject to
statutory or contractual restrictions, and may be contingent upon the earnings
of those subsidiaries and subject to various business considerations. Any right
of the Company to receive assets of subsidiaries upon their liquidation or
reorganization (and the consequent right of the holders of the Notes to
participate in these assets) would be effectively subordinated to the claims of
that subsidiary's creditors (including trade creditors), except to the extent
that the Company is itself recognized as a creditor of such subsidiary, in which
case the claims of the Company would be subordinate to any security interests in
the assets of such subsidiary and any indebtedness of such subsidiary senior to
that held by the Company. See "Description of Notes -- Subordination."
 
     The Indenture does not contain any financial performance covenants.
Consequently, the Company is not required under the Indenture to meet any
financial tests such as those that measure the Company's working capital,
interest coverage, fixed charge coverage or net worth in order to maintain
compliance with the terms of the Indenture. No sinking fund is provided for the
Notes.
 
LIMITATIONS ON REPURCHASE OF NOTES UPON A DESIGNATED EVENT
 
     In the event of a Designated Event, each holder may require the Company to
repurchase all or a portion of such holder's Notes at 100% of the principal
amount thereof plus accrued and unpaid interest to the repurchase date. If a
Designated Event were to occur, there can be no assurance that the Company would
have sufficient funds to pay the repurchase price for all Notes tendered by the
holders thereof. The Company's repurchase of Notes, absent a waiver, would
constitute a default under the terms of the Company's senior revolving credit
loan facility with The First National Bank of Boston. In addition, the Company's
repurchase of Notes as a result of the occurrence of a Designated Event may be
prohibited or limited by the subordination provisions applicable to the Notes,
or be prohibited or limited by, or create an event of default under, the terms
of other agreements relating to borrowings which constitute Senior Indebtedness
as may be entered into, amended, supplemented or replaced from time to time.
Failure of the Company to repurchase Notes at the option of the holder upon a
Designated Event would result in an Event of Default under the Indenture. The
Notes may not be repurchased at the option of holders following a Designated
Event if there has occurred and is continuing an Event of Default (other than a
default in the payment of the repurchase price with respect to such Notes on the
repurchase date). See "Description of Notes -- Repurchase at Option of Holders
Upon a Designated Event."
 
                                       14
<PAGE>   16
 
ABSENCE OF PUBLIC MARKET FOR THE NOTES; VOLATILITY OF THE NOTES
 
     Prior to the Note Offering, there has been no trading market for the Notes.
The Company expects that the Notes will trade on the over-the-counter market.
However, there can be no assurance that an active trading market for the Notes
will develop or, if such market develops, as to the liquidity or sustainability
of such market. Robertson, Stephens & Company LLC and Merrill Lynch, Pierce,
Fenner & Smith Incorporated have advised the Company that they currently intend
to make a market in the Notes, but they are not obligated to do so and may
discontinue such market making at any time. There can be no assurance that an
active market for the Notes will develop and continue upon completion of the
Note Offering or that the market price of the Notes will not decline. Various
factors such as changes in prevailing interest rates or changes in perceptions
of the Company's creditworthiness could cause the market price of the Notes to
fluctuate significantly. The trading price of the Notes could also be
significantly affected by the market price of the Common Stock, which could be
subject to wide fluctuations in response to a variety of factors, including
quarterly variations in operating results, announcements of technological
innovations or new products by the Company, its customers or its competitors,
developments in patents or other intellectual property rights, general
conditions in the electronics industry and general economic and market
conditions. Factors creating volatility in the trading prices of the Common
Stock could have a significant impact on the trading price of the Notes.
 
VOLATILITY OF STOCK PRICE
 
     The Company's Common Stock has experienced significant price volatility
historically, and such volatility may continue to occur in the future. Factors
such as announcements of large customer orders, order cancellations, new product
introductions by the Company or competitors or general conditions in the
electronics industry, as well as quarterly variations in the Company's actual or
anticipated results of operations, may cause the market price of the Company's
Common Stock to fluctuate significantly. Furthermore, the stock market has
experienced extreme price and volume fluctuations in recent years, which has had
a substantial effect on the market price for securities issued by many
technology companies, often for reasons unrelated to the operating performance
of the specific companies. These broad market fluctuations may materially
adversely affect the price of the Company's Common Stock. There can be no
assurance that the market price of the Company's Common Stock will not
experience significant fluctuations in the future, including fluctuations that
are unrelated to the Company's performance.
 
ANTI-TAKEOVER PROVISIONS
 
     The Company's Stockholder Rights Plan and certain provisions of the
Company's Restated Articles of Organization and By-Laws and of Massachusetts
Law, including Massachusetts General Laws Chapter 110D, entitled "Regulation of
Control Share Acquisitions" and Chapter 110F, the so-called Business Combination
Statute, could discourage potential acquisition proposals and could delay or
prevent a change in control or sale of the Company. The rights of holders of
Notes to require the Company to repurchase Notes under certain circumstances
could also have the same effect. Each and all of the above provisions, statutes
and rights could diminish the opportunities for a stockholder to participate in
tender offers, including tender offers at a price above the then current market
value of Common Stock and may render more difficult or discourage a merger,
consolidation or tender offer (even if such transaction is supported by the
Company's Board of Directors or is favorable to the stockholders), the
assumption of control by a holder of a large block of the Company's shares, and
the removal of incumbent management. See "Description of Capital Stock" and
"Description of Notes -- Repurchase at Option of Holders Upon a Designated
Event."
 
                                       15
<PAGE>   17
 
                                USE OF PROCEEDS
 
     The net proceeds to the Company from the sale of 2,000,000 shares of Common
Stock (at an assumed public offering price of $53.6875 per share) and $100
million principal amount of the Notes, in each case less estimated underwriting
discounts and commissions and offering expenses payable by the Company, are
estimated to be approximately $101.4 million and $96.4 million, respectively,
for an aggregate of approximately $197.8 million ($106.4 million and $111.0
million, respectively, for an aggregate of approximately $217.4 million, if the
Underwriters' over-allotment options are exercised in full). Neither the closing
of the Common Stock Offering nor the closing of the Note Offering is conditioned
on the closing of the other offering.
 
     The Company expects to use a majority of the net proceeds to repay a
portion of the outstanding balance on its senior revolving credit loan facility
with The First National Bank of Boston (the "Credit Facility"). The Company
obtained the Credit Facility (i) primarily to finance the purchase of the shares
of Common Stock of Zycon pursuant to the tender offer completed by the Company
on January 10, 1997, (ii) to refinance Zycon's existing bank credit agreements,
and (iii) for working capital and other general corporate purposes. Pursuant to
the terms of the Credit Facility, the Company may be required to use $50 million
from the net proceeds of the Note Offering to repay a portion of the outstanding
balance thereunder. As of January 25, 1997, the amount outstanding under the
Credit Facility was $215 million. Interest on loans outstanding under the Credit
Facility is, at the Company's election, payable at either (i) the higher of the
lender's base rate, or a floating rate equal to 1.5% over the prevailing U.S.
federal funds rate, or (ii) a Eurodollar Rate, which is a fixed rate equal to an
applicable Eurodollar rate margin plus the prevailing Eurodollar rate for
interest periods of one, two, three or six months. As of January 25, 1997, the
weighted average interest rate on loans outstanding under the Credit Facility
was 6.68%. The Credit Facility matures in January 2002. The remaining net
proceeds will be used for general corporate purposes, including working capital,
product development and capital expenditures. A portion of the net proceeds may
also be used for the acquisition of companies, assets, products or technologies.
As of the date of this Prospectus, the Company has no commitments or agreements
with respect to any significant acquisitions, and no portion of the net proceeds
has been allocated for any specific acquisition.
 
                                DIVIDEND POLICY
 
     The Company has never declared or paid a cash dividend on its Common Stock,
and it is currently anticipated that the Company will continue to retain its
earnings for use in its business and not pay cash dividends. The Company's
Credit Facility currently contains a covenant prohibiting the Company from
paying a cash dividend.
 
                                       16
<PAGE>   18
 
                          PRICE RANGE OF COMMON STOCK
 
     The Company's Common Stock is traded on the Nasdaq National Market under
the symbol "HDCO." The following table sets forth, for the periods indicated,
the range of high and low sale prices for the Company's Common Stock on the
Nasdaq National Market.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                            HIGH     LOW
                                                                            ----     ---
    <S>                                                                     <C>      <C>
    Fiscal 1995
      First Quarter.......................................................  $ 9 5/8  $8
      Second Quarter......................................................   18 1/8   8 7/8
      Third Quarter.......................................................   32 1/8  15 3/8
      Fourth Quarter......................................................   33 1/4  22 1/2
    Fiscal 1996
      First Quarter.......................................................   34 15/16 21 1/4
      Second Quarter......................................................   35 3/4  23 3/4
      Third Quarter.......................................................   30 3/4  18 1/4
      Fourth Quarter......................................................   34 1/8  18 1/2
    Fiscal 1997
      First Quarter.......................................................   59 1/8  27 3/8
      Second Quarter (through February 13, 1997)..........................   57 1/8  49
</TABLE>
 
     As of February 13, 1997, there were approximately 331 holders of record of
the Common Stock. On February 13, 1997, the last sale price reported on the
Nasdaq National Market for the Company's Common Stock was $53.6875 per share.
 
                                       17
<PAGE>   19
 
                                 CAPITALIZATION
 
     The following table sets forth the actual capitalization of the Company as
of January 25, 1997, and as adjusted to reflect (i) the sale by the Company of
2,000,000 shares of Common Stock (at an assumed public offering price of
$53.6875 per share) in the Common Stock Offering and the sale of $100 million
aggregate principal amount of Notes in the Note Offering, in each case less
estimated underwriting discounts and commissions and offering expenses payable
by the Company, and (ii) the application of the net proceeds from the Common
Stock Offering and the Note Offering:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                           JANUARY 25, 1997
                                                                       ------------------------
                                                                        ACTUAL      AS ADJUSTED
                                                                       --------     -----------
                                                                            (In thousands)
<S>                                                                    <C>          <C>
Short-term debt and current portion of long-term debt and capital
  lease obligations..................................................  $  8,116      $   8,116
                                                                       ========       ========
Long-term debt:
  Long term debt and capital lease obligations, net of current
     portion.........................................................   228,168         30,362
    % Convertible Subordinated Notes due 2004........................        --        100,000
Stockholders' investment:
  Common Stock, $0.05 par value, 25,000,000 shares authorized;
     10,444,188 shares issued; 12,444,188 shares issued, as
     adjusted(1).....................................................       523            623
  Paid-in capital....................................................    32,283        133,589
  Deferred compensation..............................................      (209)          (209)
  Retained earnings..................................................    38,460         38,460
                                                                       --------       --------
       Total stockholders' investment................................    71,057        172,463
                                                                       --------       --------
          Total capitalization.......................................  $299,225      $ 302,825
                                                                       ========       ========
</TABLE>
 
- ------------
(1) Excludes options outstanding as of January 25, 1997 to acquire 1,219,829
    shares of Common Stock at a weighted average exercise price of $15.06 per
    share and an additional 843,000 shares of Common Stock reserved for issuance
    under the Company's stock option plans. See Note 10 of Notes to the
    Company's Consolidated Financial Statements. Also excludes shares of Common
    Stock issuable upon conversion of the Notes.
 
                                       18
<PAGE>   20
 
                      SELECTED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL DATA
 
     The following table presents selected consolidated financial data for Hadco
and subsidiaries. The selected consolidated financial data for each of the years
ended October 31, 1992, October 30, 1993, October 29, 1994, October 28, 1995 and
October 26, 1996 have been derived from the Company's Consolidated Financial
Statements, which have been audited by Arthur Andersen LLP, independent public
accountants. The selected consolidated financial data for the three months ended
January 27, 1996 and January 25, 1997 have been derived from the Company's
unaudited Consolidated Financial Statements, which reflect in the opinion of
management, all adjustments, consisting only of normal recurring adjustments,
necessary for a fair presentation of the results for such periods. The results
for the three months ended January 25, 1997 are not necessarily indicative of
results for any future period. The pro forma statements of operations data for
the year ended October 26, 1996 and the three months ended January 25, 1997 have
been derived from the Pro Forma Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements
included elsewhere in this Prospectus. The pro forma statements of operations
data are not necessarily indicative of the actual results that would have been
achieved had the Zycon acquisition occurred at the beginning of the respective
periods nor do they purport to indicate the results of future operations of the
Company. The selected consolidated financial data should be read in conjunction
with the Company's and Zycon's Consolidated Financial Statements and the Notes
thereto appearing elsewhere in this Prospectus and "Management's Discussion and
Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations."
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                              FISCAL YEAR ENDED,                                     THREE MONTHS ENDED,
                     ---------------------------------------------------------------------   ------------------------------------
                     OCT. 31,   OCT. 30,   OCT. 29,   OCT. 28,   OCT. 26,      OCT. 26,      JAN. 27,   JAN. 25,      JAN. 25,
                       1992       1993       1994       1995       1996          1996          1996     1997(1)         1997
                     --------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------------   --------   --------   --------------
                                                                             PRO FORMA(2)                           PRO FORMA(2)
<S>                  <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>              <C>        <C>        <C>
                                                   (In thousands, except ratio and per share data)
CONSOLIDATED
  STATEMENT OF
  OPERATIONS:
Net sales..........  $183,408   $189,494   $221,570   $265,168   $350,685      $570,345      $76,481    $111,536      $172,547
Gross profit.......    34,160     35,393     43,973     64,495     86,148       119,494       19,482      24,855        32,941
Write-off of
  acquired
  in-process
  research and
  development......        --         --         --         --         --            --           --      78,000            --
Income (loss) from
  operations.......    13,404     13,710     16,482     33,906     51,532        64,968       11,534     (62,443)       18,637
Net income
  (loss)...........  $  8,075   $  8,227   $  9,943   $ 21,374   $ 32,014      $ 28,700      $ 7,191    $(69,161)     $  8,275
Net income (loss)
  per share(3).....  $    .75   $    .76   $    .93   $   1.98   $   2.89      $   2.59      $   .65    $  (6.64)     $    .76
Weighted average
  shares
  outstanding(3)...    10,808     10,819     10,720     10,806     11,084        11,084       11,104      10,413        10,944
OTHER DATA:
Ratio of earnings
  to fixed
  charges(4).......       6.9x      10.2x      19.4x      66.2x     156.3x          4.1x       125.1 x        --           4.1x
EBITDA(5)..........    26,974     25,378     30,704     48,812     70,375        91,906       15,582      21,818        26,002
Capital
  expenditures.....    10,854     10,978     19,510     28,865     54,998       107,154       13,713      11,011        17,939
Interest expense...     2,045      1,402        891        537        338        16,197           95         933         4,669
</TABLE>
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                            JANUARY 25, 1997
                                                 OCT. 31,   OCT. 30,   OCT. 29,   OCT. 28,   OCT. 26,   -------------------------
                                                   1992       1993       1994       1995       1996      ACTUAL    AS ADJUSTED(6)
                                                 --------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------------
<S>                                              <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET DATA:
Working capital................................  $ 25,215   $ 30,593   $ 31,829   $ 41,043   $ 43,561   $ 22,072      $ 22,072
Total assets...................................   104,035    110,782    126,326    162,991    219,501    448,554       452,154
Long-term debt and capital lease obligations,
  net of current portion.......................    11,046      9,382      4,526      2,387      1,515    228,168       130,362
Stockholders' investment.......................    59,363     68,431     77,440    100,774    138,841     71,057       172,463
</TABLE>
 
                                       19
<PAGE>   21
 
- ------------
 
(1) Net loss for the three months ended January 25, 1997 includes a
    non-recurring write-off relating to the acquisition of Zycon for in-process
    research and development. Before deducting the non-recurring write-off,
    income from operations was $15,557,000, net income was $8,839,000, net
    income per share was $.81 (based on weighted average shares outstanding of
    approximately 10,944,000), and the ratio of earnings to fixed charges was
    17.6x.
 
(2) Gives effect to the acquisition of Zycon assuming such transaction had
    occurred on October 29, 1995. See the Company's unaudited Pro Forma
    Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements beginning on page F-23 and
    "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of
    Operations."
 
(3) See Note 1 of Notes to the Company's Consolidated Financial Statements for
    an explanation of the basis used to calculate net income (loss) per share.
 
(4) Computed by dividing the sum of net income (loss), before deducting
    provisions for income taxes and fixed charges, by total fixed charges. Fixed
    charges consist of interest on debt and amortization of debt issuance costs
    and a portion of capital lease costs that is intended to represent interest
    expense.
 
(5) EBITDA represents net income before interest, income taxes, depreciation and
    amortization, and write-off of acquired in-process research and development.
    EBITDA should not be considered an alternative measure of the Company's net
    income, operating performance, cash flow or liquidity. It is included herein
    to provide additional information related to the Company's ability to
    service debt.
 
(6) Adjusted to reflect (i) the sale by the Company of 2,000,000 shares of
    Common Stock (at an assumed public offering price of $53.6875 per share) in
    the Common Stock Offering and the sale of $100 million of principal amount
    of Notes in the Note Offering, in each case less estimated underwriting
    discounts and commissions and offering expenses payable by the Company, and
    (ii) the application of the net proceeds from the Common Stock Offering and
    the Note Offering. See "Use of Proceeds."
 
                                       20
<PAGE>   22
 
                      MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS
                OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
 
     The following discussion contains forward-looking statements which involve
risks and uncertainties. The Company's actual results could differ materially
from those anticipated in these forward-looking statements as a result of
certain factors, including, without limitation, those set forth under "Risk
Factors" and elsewhere in this Prospectus.
 
     As used herein, the terms "Company" and "Hadco," unless otherwise indicated
or the context otherwise requires, refer to Hadco Corporation and its
subsidiaries, including Zycon. However, all financial information for periods
ended prior to January 10, 1997, unless otherwise indicated or the context
otherwise requires, is for Hadco Corporation alone and does not include Zycon.
 
OVERVIEW
 
     Hadco is the largest manufacturer of advanced electronic interconnect
products in North America. The Company offers a wide array of sophisticated
manufacturing, engineering and systems integration services to meet its
customers' electronic interconnect needs. The Company's principal products are
complex multilayer printed circuits and backplane assemblies. Hadco's customers
are a diverse group of electronics OEMs and contract manufacturers in the
computing (mainly workstations, servers, mainframes, storage and notebooks),
data communications/telecommunications and industrial automation industries,
including process controls, automotive, medical and instrumentation.
 
     The Company was incorporated in 1966 and began operations in Cambridge,
Massachusetts as a manufacturer of single and double-sided printed circuits. A
16,000 square foot printed circuit facility was constructed in 1969 in Derry,
New Hampshire, and the Company added multilayer printed circuits to its product
offering in 1975. In 1979, the Company acquired a 33,000 square foot printed
circuit facility in Owego, New York. In 1981, the Company added to its
double-sided and multilayer printed circuit product offerings with the
construction of Tech Center One in Salem, New Hampshire, a quick-turn prototype
operation to serve the prototype printed circuit needs of OEMs. In 1982, the
Company began backplane assembly operations in Salem, New Hampshire. In 1983,
the Company expanded further by adding a second Tech Center in the Silicon
Valley area. In 1984, the Company completed an initial public offering of its
Common Stock.
 
     By fiscal 1991, net sales of the Company were $153 million and grew to $351
million in fiscal 1996, $570 million on a pro forma basis including Zycon.
During this period, the printed circuit industry experienced an increasing
demand for complex products that required a significant investment in
facilities. The Company (including Zycon) has invested approximately $235
million in state-of-the-art production facilities and new technologies during
the past five fiscal years.
 
ZYCON ACQUISITION
 
     On January 10, 1997, the Company purchased Zycon. The acquisition added
state-of-the-art facilities for volume production of complex printed circuits
and backplane assemblies in the Silicon Valley area, a quick-turn prototype and
design facility in Massachusetts, and a newly constructed facility for volume
production of printed circuits in Malaysia. With this acquisition, Hadco became
the largest manufacturer of advanced electronic interconnect products in North
America. Hadco acquired Zycon for $212 million and recorded the acquisition
under the purchase method of accounting. As a result, a purchase price premium
of $187 million was recorded on the transaction. Approximately $78 million of
the premium was written off as acquired in-process research and development with
no alternative future use as a non-recurring write-off to net income for the
three months ended January 25, 1997. The remaining premium of $109 million was
allocated to identifiable intangibles and goodwill, and will be written off over
12 to 30 years, with an average amortization period of 17 years. The acquisition
was financed from a $250 million senior revolving credit facility, plus existing
cash and short-term investments.
 
                                       21
<PAGE>   23
 
     The gross profit margin for Hadco for the fiscal year ended October 26,
1996 was 24.6%. The gross profit margin for Zycon for the fiscal year ended
December 31, 1996 was 15.2%. As a result of the Zycon acquisition, the Company
expects that its gross profit margin will be lower in future quarters than has
historically been the case for Hadco.
 
RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
 
     The following table sets forth certain Consolidated Statements of
Operations data and other data as a percentage of net sales. The table and the
discussion below should be read in conjunction with the Company's and Zycon's
Consolidated Financial Statements and Notes thereto, that appear elsewhere in
this Prospectus.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                      FISCAL YEAR ENDED,                           THREE MONTHS ENDED,
                       ------------------------------------------------    ------------------------------------
                       OCT. 29,    OCT. 28,    OCT. 26,      OCT. 26,      JAN. 27,    JAN. 25,      JAN. 25,
                         1994        1995        1996          1996          1996      1997(1)         1997
                       --------    --------    --------    ------------    --------    --------    ------------
                                                           PRO FORMA(2)                            PRO FORMA(2)
<S>                    <C>         <C>         <C>         <C>             <C>         <C>         <C>
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT
  OF OPERATIONS:
Net sales.............   100.0%      100.0%      100.0%        100.0%        100.0%      100.0%        100.0%
Cost of sales.........    80.2        75.7        75.4          79.0          74.5        77.7          80.9
                       --------    --------    --------       ------       --------    --------       ------
Gross profit..........    19.8        24.3        24.6          21.0          25.5        22.3          19.1
Selling, general and
  administrative
  expenses............    12.4        11.5         9.9           8.5          10.4         8.4           7.4
Write-off of acquired
  in-process research
  and development.....      --          --          --            --            --        69.9            --
Amortization of
  acquired intangible
  assets..............      --          --          --           1.1            --          --            .9
                       --------    --------    --------       ------       --------    --------       ------
Income (loss) from
  operations..........     7.4        12.8        14.7          11.4          15.1       (56.0)         10.8
Interest income
  (expense), net......      --          .4          .3          (2.6)           .3          --          (2.4)
                       --------    --------    --------       ------       --------    --------       ------
Income (loss) before
  provision for income
  taxes...............     7.4        13.2        15.0           8.8          15.4       (56.0)          8.4
Provision for income
  taxes...............     2.9         5.2         5.8           3.8           6.0         6.0           3.6
                       --------    --------    --------       ------       --------    --------       ------
Net income (loss).....     4.5%        8.1%        9.1%          5.0%          9.4%      (62.0)%         4.8%
                       =======     =======     =======     ============     ======      ======     ============
OTHER DATA:
EBITDA(3).............    13.9%       18.4%       20.1%         16.1%         20.4%       19.6%         15.1%
Capital
  expenditures........     8.8        10.9        15.7          18.8          17.9         9.9          10.4
Interest expense......      .4          .2          .1           2.8            .1          .8           2.7
</TABLE>
 
- ---------------
(1) Net loss for the three months ended January 25, 1997 includes a
    non-recurring write-off relating to the acquisition of Zycon for in-process
    research and development. As a percentage of net sales, income from
    operations was 13.9%, income before provision for income taxes was 13.9%,
    and net income was 7.9%, all before deducting the non-recurring write-off.
 
(2) Gives effect to the acquisition of Zycon assuming such transaction had
    occurred on October 29, 1995. See the Company's unaudited Pro Forma
    Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements beginning on page F-23 and
    "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of
    Operations."
 
                                       22
<PAGE>   24
 
(3) EBITDA represents net income before interest, income taxes, depreciation and
    amortization, and write-off of acquired in-process research and development.
    EBITDA should not be considered an alternative measure of the Company's net
    income, operating performance, cash flow or liquidity. It is included herein
    to provide additional information related to the Company's ability to
    service debt.
 
THREE MONTHS ENDED JANUARY 25, 1997 AND JANUARY 27, 1996
 
     Net sales for the three months ended January 25, 1997 increased 45.8% over
net sales for the three months ended January 27, 1996. The increase resulted
from several factors including the acquisition of Zycon, which added $11.6
million in printed circuit net sales after January 10, 1997, and an increase in
both backplane assembly and printed circuit net sales excluding Zycon. Backplane
assembly net sales increased due to higher product volume and shipments. Printed
circuit net sales increased due to higher production volume and shipments and a
shift towards products with more layers and greater densities. The increase in
printed circuit net sales was partially offset by a decrease in average pricing
of 3.2%. Net sales from backplane assemblies increased to 16.3% of total net
sales, from 10.5% in the first three months of fiscal 1996.
 
     The gross profit margin decreased to 22.3% in the three months ended
January 25, 1997 from 25.5% in the comparable period in fiscal 1996. The
decrease resulted from increased investment in new capacity at certain
facilities, lower overall gross margins from the Zycon operations (including
ongoing start-up expenses associated with the volume production facility in
Malaysia) and the change in product mix related to the increase in backplane
assembly operations.
 
     Selling, general and administrative (SG&A) expenses, as a percent of net
sales, decreased to 8.3% in the three months ended January 25, 1997 from 10.4%
in the comparable period in fiscal 1996, due to increased net sales and the
fixed nature of the Company's SG&A expenses.
 
     Income from operations for the three months ended January 25, 1997 was
reduced by $78 million due to a non-recurring write-off relating to acquired
in-process research and development recorded in connection with the Zycon
acquisition. The remaining goodwill and purchased intangibles will be amortized
over 12 to 30 years, with an average amortization period of 17 years, which will
reduce income from operations by approximately $1.6 million per fiscal quarter.
For the three months ended January 25, 1997, income from operations was reduced
by goodwill and purchased intangibles amortization of $270,000, which
represented the amortization for the 15 day period following the Zycon
acquisition.
 
     Excluding the non-recurring write-off of $78 million for acquired
in-process research and development, operating margins decreased slightly to
13.9% for the three months ended January 25, 1997 from 15.1% in the comparable
period in fiscal 1996, primarily as a result of the same factors affecting gross
profit margins, and of goodwill amortization from the Zycon acquisition.
 
     Interest income increased in the three months ended January 25, 1997 as
compared to the three months ended January 27, 1996, due to higher daily average
cash balances available for investing. Interest expense increased in the three
months ended January 25, 1997 as compared to the three months ended January 27,
1996, due to an increase in outstanding debt as a result of the Zycon
acquisition.
 
     In accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, the Company
provides for income taxes on an interim basis, using its effective annual income
tax rate. Although the Company has incurred a loss before income taxes during
the three months ended January 25, 1997, the Company has recorded an income tax
provision because the write-off of acquired in-process research and development
is not deductible for income tax purposes. Without taking into consideration the
write-off of acquired in-process research and development, the Company
anticipates an effective annual income tax rate for fiscal 1997 of 43%, which is
more than the expected combined federal and state statutory rates. This
difference is caused primarily by anticipated losses incurred by the Company's
Malaysian
 
                                       23
<PAGE>   25
 
volume production facility which are not tax deductible. These items are
partially offset by tax advantaged investment income, the tax benefit of the
Company's foreign sales corporation and various state investment tax credits.
The effective tax rate for fiscal 1997 is based on current tax laws.
 
     The Company includes in SG&A expenses charges for actual expenditures and
accruals, based on estimates, for environmental matters. To the extent and in
amounts Hadco believes circumstances warrant, it will continue to accrue and
charge to SG&A expenses cost estimates relating to environmental matters. The
Company believes the ultimate disposition of known environmental matters will
not have a material adverse effect upon the liquidity, capital resources,
business or consolidated financial position of the Company. However, one or more
of such environmental matters could have a significant negative impact on the
Company's consolidated financial results for a particular reporting period. See
"Business -- Environmental Matters," "-- Legal Proceedings" and Note 9 of Notes
to the Company's Consolidated Financial Statements.
 
     The Company believes that excess capacity may exist in the printed circuit
and electronic assembly industries, as well as fluctuating growth rates in the
electronics industry as a whole. Both factors could have a material adverse
effect on future orders and pricing. The Company also believes that the
potential exists for a shortage of materials in such industries, which could
have a material adverse effect on future unit costs.
 
FISCAL YEARS ENDED OCTOBER 26, 1996 AND OCTOBER 28, 1995
 
     Net sales during 1996 increased 32.3% over 1995. The change was due to a
15.1% increase in the volume of production and shipments and a shift in product
mix to higher layer, higher density products, as compared to 1995. Average
pricing per unit increased 6.1% compared to 1995. Sales of backplane and other
electronic assemblies increased to 17% of the Company's net sales in 1996,
versus 7% for 1995.
 
     The gross profit margin increased to 24.6% in 1996 from 24.3% in 1995. The
increase was a direct result of higher volume of shipments, an increase in the
technology level of product mix, and improved pricing. These increases have been
partially offset by increased costs relating to the implementation of new
production lines and materials and the shift in mix to a higher level of
value-added products.
 
     SG&A expenses, as a percent of net sales, decreased to 9.9% during 1996
from 11.5% during 1995, due to increased revenue. SG&A expenses increased to
$34.6 million in 1996 from $30.6 million in 1995, primarily as a result of
increased variable costs directly attributable to increased net sales. Included
in SG&A expenses are charges for actual expenditures and accruals, based on
estimates, for environmental matters. During 1996 and 1995, the Company made,
and charged to SG&A expenses, actual payments of approximately $680,000 and
$1,111,000 respectively, for environmental matters. In 1996 and 1995, the
Company also accrued and charged to SG&A expenses of approximately $1,825,000
and $2,740,000, respectively, as cost estimates relating to known environmental
matters.
 
     In 1996, interest income decreased as a result of lower cash balances
available for investment. Interest expense decreased in 1996 from 1995 due to
decreased average debt balances during the year.
 
     The annual effective tax rate for 1996 and 1995 was 39.0%, which was less
than the then current combined federal and state statutory rates. This
difference was caused primarily by tax advantaged investments and the tax
benefits of a foreign sales corporation.
 
FISCAL YEARS ENDED OCTOBER 28, 1995 AND OCTOBER 29, 1994
 
     Net sales during 1995 increased 19.7% over the same period in 1994. The
change was due to an 8.2% increase in the volume of production and shipments and
a shift in product mix to higher layer, higher density products, as compared to
fiscal 1994. Average pricing per unit increased 3.1% compared to the prior year.
 
                                       24
<PAGE>   26
 
     The gross profit margin increased to 24.3% in 1995 from 19.8% in 1994. The
increase was a direct result of higher volume of shipments, an increase in the
technology level of product mix, improved pricing and improvements in operating
efficiencies. Continued productivity improvements led to increased unit volume
and lower unit costs.
 
     SG&A expenses, as a percent of net sales, decreased to 11.5% during 1995
from 12.4% during 1994, due to increased revenue. SG&A expenses increased to
$30.6 million in 1995 from $27.5 million in 1994, as a result of increased
variable costs directly attributable to increased net sales and charges for
environmental related matters. Included in SG&A expenses are charges for actual
expenditures and accruals, based on estimates, for environmental matters. During
1995 and 1994, the Company made, and charged to SG&A expenses, actual payments
of approximately $1,111,000 and $1,040,000, respectively, for environmental
matters. In 1995 and 1994, the Company also accrued and charged to SG&A expenses
of approximately $2,740,000 and $2,100,000, respectively, as cost estimates
relating to known environmental matters.
 
     In 1995, interest income increased as a result of higher rates of return
earned on investments, and higher cash balances available for investment.
Interest expense decreased in 1995 from 1994 due to decreased average debt
balances during the year.
 
     The annual effective tax rate was 39.0% and 39.5% in 1995 and 1994,
respectively, which was less than the then current combined federal and state
statutory rates. This difference was caused primarily by tax advantaged
investments and the tax benefits of a foreign sales corporation.
 
QUARTERLY RESULTS
 
     The following table presents certain unaudited consolidated financial
information for each of the Company's nine fiscal quarters for the period ended
January 25, 1997, as well as certain of such information expressed as a
percentage of net sales for the same period. Information for the three months
ended January 25, 1997 includes the results of operations for Zycon from January
10, 1997, the date of the Zycon acquisition. In the opinion of management, this
information has been prepared on the same basis as the audited Consolidated
Financial Statements of the Company appearing elsewhere in this Prospectus and
includes all adjustments, consisting only of normal recurring adjustments,
necessary to present fairly the quarterly results when read in conjunction with
the Company's
 
                                       25
<PAGE>   27
 
Consolidated Financial Statements. The Company's operating results have been
subject to fluctuations, and thus results for any quarter are not necessarily
indicative of results for any future period.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                             THREE MONTHS ENDED
                      ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                       JAN.       APRIL      JULY       OCT.       JAN.       APRIL      JULY       OCT.
                        28,        29,        29,        28,        27,        27,        27,        26,      JAN. 25,
                       1995       1995       1995       1995       1996       1996       1996       1996      1997(1)
                      -------    -------    -------    -------    -------    -------    -------    -------    --------
                      (In thousands, except percentages and per share data)
<S>                   <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>
CONSOLIDATED
  STATEMENT OF
  OPERATIONS:
Net sales..........   $56,825    $67,637    $67,752    $72,954    $76,481    $88,096    $88,225    $97,883    $111,536
Gross profit.......    11,292     16,261     17,540     19,402     19,482     21,893     21,451     23,322      24,855
Income (loss) from
  operations.......     4,770      8,342      9,821     10,973     11,534     12,703     12,910     14,385     (62,443)
Net income
  (loss)...........     3,003      5,193      6,152      7,026      7,191      7,895      7,994      8,934     (69,161)
Net income (loss)
  per share........      $.29       $.49       $.56       $.63       $.65       $.71       $.72       $.81     $(6.64)
AS A PERCENTAGE OF
  NET SALES:
Gross profit.......      19.9%      24.0%      25.9%      26.6%      25.5%      24.9%      24.3%      23.8%       22.3%
Income (loss) from
  operations.......       8.4       12.3       14.5       15.0       15.1       14.4       14.6       14.7       (56.0)
Net income
  (loss)...........       5.3        7.7        9.1        9.6        9.4        9.0        9.1        9.1       (62.0)
</TABLE>
 
- ------------
(1) Net loss for the three months ended January 25, 1997 includes a
    non-recurring write-off relating to the acquisition of Zycon for in-process
    research and development. Income from operations was $15,557,000, net income
    was $8,839,000, net income per share was $.81 (based on weighted average
    shares outstanding of approximately 10,944,000), and, as a percentage of net
    sales, income from operations was 13.9% and net income was 7.9%, all before
    deducting the non-recurring write-off.
 
     The Company's results of operations have fluctuated and may continue to
fluctuate from period to period, including on a quarterly basis. Variations in
quick-turn prototype and volume production orders, in the average number of
layers per printed circuit, and in the mix of products sold by the Company have
significantly affected both net sales and gross profit. Gross profit declined to
22.3% in the three months ended January 25, 1997 from 26.6% in the three months
ended October 28, 1995 primarily as a result of (i) costs related to increases
in manufacturing capacity, (ii) an increase in backplane assembly net sales as a
percentage of net sales, and (iii) factors related to the Zycon acquisition.
Operating results generally may also be affected by other factors, including the
receipt and shipment of large orders, plant utilization, product mix,
manufacturing process yields, the timing of expenditures in anticipation of
future sales, raw material availability, product and price competition, the
length of sales cycles and economic conditions in the electronics industry. Many
of these factors are outside the control of the Company.
 
     The Company does not obtain long term purchase orders or commitments from
its customers, and a substantial portion of sales in a given quarter may depend
on obtaining orders for products to be manufactured and shipped in the same
quarter in which those orders are received. Sales for future quarters may not be
predictable. The Company relies on its estimate of anticipated future volumes
when making commitments regarding the level of business that it will seek and
accept, the mix of products that it intends to manufacture, the timing of
production schedules and the levels and utilization of personnel and other
resources. A variety of conditions, both specific to the individual customer and
generally affecting the customer's industry, may cause customers to cancel,
reduce or delay orders that were previously made or anticipated. A significant
portion of the Company's released backlog at any time may be subject to
cancellation or postponement without penalty. The Company cannot assure the
timely replacement of canceled, delayed or reduced orders. Significant or
numerous cancellations, reductions or delays in orders by a customer or group of
customers could materially adversely affect the Company's business, financial
condition and results of operations. The Company's expense levels are relatively
fixed and are based, in part, on expectations of future revenues.
 
                                       26
<PAGE>   28
 
Consequently, if revenue levels are below expectations, the Company's business,
financial condition and results of operations are likely to be materially
adversely affected. Due to all of the foregoing factors, it is likely that in
some future quarter or quarters the Company's operating results may be below the
expectations of securities analysts and investors. In such event, the price of
the Company's Common Stock could likely be materially adversely affected. See
"Risk Factors -- Fluctuations in Quarterly Operating Results."
 
LIQUIDITY AND CAPITAL RESOURCES
 
     In fiscal 1996, the Company's financing requirements were satisfied
principally from cash flows from operations. Cash provided by operating
activities was approximately $55.6 million in fiscal 1996. These funds were
sufficient to meet increased working capital needs, capital expenditures of
approximately $54.0 million, and debt and lease payments of approximately $2.1
million in fiscal 1996. Cash provided by operating activities was approximately
$8.3 million in the three months ended January 25, 1997.
 
     At January 25, 1997, the Company had working capital of approximately $22.1
million and a current ratio of 1.20, compared to working capital of
approximately $41.7 million and a current ratio of 1.79 at January 27, 1996.
Cash, cash equivalents and short-term investments at January 25, 1997 were
approximately $12.1 million, a decrease of $22.6 million from approximately
$34.7 million at January 27, 1996.
 
     The Company currently anticipates that its capital expenditures for fiscal
1997 will be in excess of $70 million, of which approximately $17.2 million
represents commitments to purchase manufacturing equipment and leasehold
improvements. The majority of these capital expenditures is expected to be
completed by the end of fiscal 1997. The amount of these anticipated capital
expenditures will frequently change based on future changes in business plans
and conditions of the Company and changes in economic conditions.
 
     In January 1997, the Company obtained a senior revolving credit loan
facility for up to $250 million from The First National Bank of Boston (the
"Credit Facility") (i) primarily to finance the purchase of the shares of Common
Stock of Zycon pursuant to the tender offer commenced by the Company on December
11, 1996, (ii) to refinance Zycon's existing bank credit agreements, and (iii)
for working capital and other general corporate purposes. Interest on loans
outstanding under the Credit Facility is, at the Company's election, payable at
either (1) the higher of the lender's base rate or a floating rate equal to 1.5%
over the prevailing U.S. federal funds rate, or (2) a Eurodollar Rate, which is
a fixed rate equal to an applicable Eurodollar rate margin plus the prevailing
Eurodollar rate for interest periods of one, two, three or six months. At
January 25, 1997, $215 million was outstanding under the Credit Facility. The
Credit Facility will terminate in five years. The Company currently expects that
a majority of the net proceeds of the Common Stock Offering and the Note
Offering will be used to repay a portion of the outstanding balance on the
Credit Facility.
 
     The Company believes its existing working capital and borrowing capacity,
coupled with the funds generated from the Company's operations, and the net
proceeds from the Offerings, will be sufficient to fund its anticipated working
capital, capital expenditure and debt payment requirements through fiscal 1997.
Because the Company's capital requirements cannot be predicted with certainty,
however, there is no assurance that the Company will not require additional
financing during this period. There is no assurance that any additional
financing will be available on terms satisfactory to the Company or not
disadvantageous to the Company's securityholders, including those purchasing
securities in the Offerings.
 
                                       27
<PAGE>   29
 
                                    BUSINESS
 
     The following Business section contains forward-looking statements which
involve risks and uncertainties. The Company's actual results could differ
materially from those anticipated in these forward-looking statements as a
result of certain factors, including, without limitation, those set forth under
"Risk Factors" and elsewhere in this Prospectus.
 
GENERAL
 
     Hadco is the largest manufacturer of advanced electronic interconnect
products in North America. The Company offers a wide array of sophisticated
manufacturing, engineering and systems integration services to meet its
customers' electronic interconnect needs. The Company's principal products are
complex multilayer rigid printed circuits and backplane assemblies. Hadco's
largest customers include many of the leading and fastest growing companies in
the electronics industry, such as Cabletron Systems, Cisco Systems, Intel,
Solectron, Sun Microsystems and U.S. Robotics.
 
     Hadco's advanced manufacturing and assembly facilities are designed to meet
the accelerated time-to-market and time-to-volume requirements of its customers
whose markets and products are characterized by high growth rates, rapid
technological advances and short product life-cycles. To this end, Hadco
(including Zycon) has invested approximately $235 million in state-of-the-art
production facilities and new technologies during the past five fiscal years.
Hadco provides customers with a range of products and services that includes
development, design, quick-turn prototype, pre-production, volume production and
backplane assembly. Hadco is one of a small number of printed circuit
manufacturers with the technology and advanced production facilities necessary
to offer all of these services. The Company believes its combination of a broad
product offering and advanced technology facilitates long-term relationships
with existing customers, attracts new customers, helps customers meet their
time-to-market and time-to-volume needs, and satisfies a larger share of
customers' electronic interconnect requirements.
 
     Hadco's customers are a diverse group of electronics OEMs and contract
manufacturers in the computing (mainly workstations, servers, mainframes,
storage and notebooks), data communications/telecommunications and industrial
automation industries, including process controls, automotive, medical and
instrumentation. Hadco (including Zycon) supplied its products and services to a
diverse base of approximately 500 customers in fiscal 1996, including 77
customers with purchases in excess of $1 million. The Company's ten largest
customers accounted for approximately 43% of net sales in fiscal 1996 on a pro
forma basis including Zycon.
 
     Hadco acquired Zycon on January 10, 1997. This acquisition increased
Hadco's net sales significantly, added approximately 600,000 square feet of
manufacturing space (approximately a 100% increase) and substantially expanded
the Company's manufacturing capabilities and geographic reach. The new
manufacturing capabilities include state-of-the-art West Coast facilities for
volume production of complex printed circuits and backplane assemblies, a
quick-turn prototype and design facility on the East Coast, and a newly
constructed facility for volume production in Malaysia. The acquisition of Zycon
has also broadened the Company's customer base, expanded its involvement in many
fast growing industry sectors, added new proprietary technologies, and increased
its sales force.
 
INDUSTRY OVERVIEW AND TRENDS
 
     Printed circuits are the basic platforms used to interconnect
microprocessors, integrated circuits and other components essential to the
functioning of electronic products. Printed circuits consist of a pattern of
electrical traces etched from copper laminated on an insulated base that is
typically composed of rigid fiberglass or thin flexible circuits. To meet the
increasing requirements of OEMs and contract manufacturers, printed circuit
manufacturers have developed more complex multilayer designs with surface mount
and other attachment technologies, narrower widths and separations of copper
traces, advanced materials, and smaller diameters of vias and through-holes to
connect internal circuitry. Backplane assemblies are generally larger and
thicker printed circuits on which connectors
 
                                       28
<PAGE>   30
 
are mounted to receive and interconnect printed circuits, integrated circuits
and other electronic components.
 
     Electronic interconnect products are customized for specific electronic
applications and are sold to OEMs and contract manufacturers in volumes that
range from several units for prototypes and small quantities for pre-production
to large quantities for volume production. In the 1980s, the electronic
interconnect market was largely comprised of military and personal computer
applications. However, the proliferation of electronics and the emergence of new
technologies have significantly broadened this market and reduced the amplitude
of interconnect industry cycles in the 1990s. Electronic interconnects such as
rigid printed circuits, flexible circuits and backplane assemblies are now used
in a wide variety of industries and products, including data
communications/telecommunications, workstations, servers, personal computers,
peripherals, industrial automation, instrumentation, medical, transportation and
defense.
 
     As electronic products have become smaller and more complex, the
manufacture of interconnect products has required increasingly sophisticated
engineering and manufacturing expertise and substantial capital investment.
These advanced manufacturing process and technology requirements have caused
OEMs to rely more heavily on independent manufacturers and to reduce dependence
on their internal captive facilities. Industry sources estimate that 85% of the
domestic printed circuit market was served by independent manufacturers in 1996
(compared to 66% in 1991). Captive manufacturing facilities serve the remaining
15% of the market. Historically, electronics OEMs used independent printed
circuit manufacturers as offload capacity for their captive facilities. During
economic downturns, independent facilities lost production orders as captives
produced a greater percentage of demand internally. However, as a result of
outsourcing of OEM printed circuit production, the Company believes independents
are less affected by unused captive capacity during market downturns than was
previously the case.
 
     Industry sources estimate that in 1996 the world-wide market for rigid
printed circuits was approximately $28.2 billion, and the domestic market for
rigid printed circuits was approximately $7.1 billion. In addition, industry
sources estimate that the market for more complex multilayer printed circuits
(six layers and above) comprised approximately 45% of the total market in 1996,
and has increased an average of 16% per year over the past two years. Despite
its large size, the market for printed circuits remains highly fragmented. The
Company believes that 9 North American rigid printed circuit manufacturers had
annual sales in excess of $100 million in 1996, which together would represent
approximately 32% of the rigid printed circuit market.
 
     According to industry sources, the domestic market for backplane assemblies
was approximately $1.1 billion in 1995. This market is less fragmented than that
of printed circuits. The Company estimates that the ten largest producers of
backplane assemblies accounted for a majority of the backplane assembly
production in 1996. As in the printed circuit market, OEMs have increasingly
come to rely on independent producers of backplane assemblies, allowing OEMs to
reduce their capital investments, improve inventory management and purchasing
power and take advantage of the process technology expertise of manufacturing
specialists.
 
     The Company considers the following trends important in understanding the
electronic interconnect industry:
 
     Industry Consolidation.  The Company believes the industry will continue to
consolidate as a result of the substantial capital investment for advanced
production facilities, engineering and manufacturing expertise and technology
required to make increasingly sophisticated electronic interconnect products.
The increased investment requirement for state-of-the-art production facilities
has accelerated consolidation in the electronic interconnect industry and the
exit of smaller companies. In addition, OEMs and contract manufacturers
increasingly recognize that only a few suppliers of interconnect products can
consistently provide timely delivery of required volumes of highly sophisticated
electronic interconnect products. As a result, Hadco believes that companies
with lesser
 
                                       29
<PAGE>   31
 
financial and technical resources are likely to exit the industry and larger
interconnect companies with sufficient resources will continue to gain market
share.
 
     Increasing Demand for Single Sourcing.  To avoid delays and costs during
the product life-cycle, OEMs are increasingly turning to suppliers capable of
producing electronic interconnect products from development, design, quick-turn
prototype and pre-production through volume production and backplane assembly.
The accelerated time-to-market and time-to-volume needs of OEMs have resulted in
increased collaboration with qualified suppliers capable of providing a broad
and integrated offering. To meet their rapidly changing electronic interconnect
requirements, many OEMs have moved to limit their vendor base to a smaller
number of technically qualified suppliers capable of providing both quick-turn
prototype and pre-production quantities as well as cost-competitive volume
production quantities.
 
     New and Emerging Markets.  The markets for electronic products are growing
as a result of new product introductions, technological change, demands for a
wider variety of electronic product features, and increasingly powerful and less
expensive electronic components. New markets have emerged in computing, data
communications/telecommunications and multimedia. Moreover, existing industries
have significantly expanded applications in areas such as computer networking
and peripherals, digital and mobile communications, video-on-demand, the
Internet/World Wide Web, instrumentation and industrial controls. The Company
believes these new and emerging electronic product markets and applications have
also contributed to the reduction in the amplitude of the electronic
interconnect industry cycles.
 
     Greater Demand for Complex Electronic Products.  Advanced communication
equipment, as well as next-generation computer chips and microprocessors,
require interconnect systems that operate at greater speeds and higher
frequencies with minimal signal loss and distortion. Further, electronics OEMs
are designing more compact and portable high performance products. The
complexity of these new products requires higher performance, smaller size,
greater circuit and component density, and increased reliability. These
requirements necessitate greater sophistication in printed circuit manufacturing
and process technologies, including advanced materials, more layers, narrower
line widths and spacing, smaller vias to connect internal circuitry, and more
precise positioning of traces and pads to accommodate a greater density of
surface mount components. These products require increasingly advanced packaging
technologies, such as Multichip Module (MCM), Tape Automated Bonding (TAB),
Direct Chip Attach (DCA) and Ball Grid Array (BGA), and high frequency
materials. The trend toward increasingly sophisticated products also requires
greater engineering support and investment in manufacturing and process
technology for suppliers to produce high-quality electronic interconnect
products on-time, in volume, and at acceptable cost.
 
     Shorter Product Life-Cycles for Electronic Products.  Rapid changes in
technology have significantly shortened the life-cycle of complex electronic
products and placed increased pressure on OEMs to develop new products as
quickly as possible. The time-to-market considerations of OEMs have increased
emphasis on the engineering and quick-turn production of small unit volumes of
electronic interconnects in the prototype development stage. In addition, the
success of first-to-market products has heightened the emphasis on volume
manufacturing expertise and technologically advanced manufacturing
infrastructure.
 
THE HADCO STRATEGY
 
     The Company's strategy is to increase sales and profitability by providing
a wide range of electronic interconnect solutions and services to a broad and
diversified customer base. Hadco assists customers in meeting their
time-to-market and time-to-volume requirements by providing a broad and
integrated offering (from development, design, quick-turn prototype and
pre-production through volume production and backplane assembly). The Company
believes this integrated offering gives it an important competitive advantage.
 
                                       30
<PAGE>   32
 
     The Company's strategy is to capitalize on major industry trends as
follows:
 
     Serve Diversified Customer Base in High Growth Segments.  The Company
concentrates its marketing efforts on OEMs and contract manufacturers in
segments of the electronics market characterized by high growth, rapid
technological advances, short product development cycles and accelerated
time-to-market and time-to-volume requirements, such as the computing (mainly
workstations, servers, mainframes, storage and notebooks), data
communications/telecommunications and industrial automation industries,
including process controls, automotive, medical and instrumentation. Hadco
(including Zycon) supplied its products and services to a diverse base of
approximately 500 customers in fiscal 1996, including 77 customers with
purchases in excess of $1 million. The Company's ten largest customers accounted
for approximately 43% of net sales in fiscal 1996 on a pro forma basis including
Zycon.
 
     Provide a Broad and Integrated Offering.  Hadco develops and maintains
long-term customer relationships by providing a full range of integrated
services, from development, design, quick-turn prototype and pre-production
through volume production and backplane assembly. The Company believes its broad
range of integrated services adds significant value to its customers by
shortening their new product development cycles, helping them to meet their
time-to-market and time-to-volume requirements, lowering manufacturing costs,
and providing concentrated expertise. By offering development and design
services, the Company also gains early access to volume production sales
opportunities, and its relationships with volume production customers create
additional quick-turn and development and design sales opportunities.
 
     Expand Backplane Assembly Operations.  To extend its integrated offering,
the Company expanded backplane assembly operations. The Company believes this
investment will facilitate a broader range of manufacturing services, reduce
customer costs and improve product quality. With this backplane assembly
expansion, the Company intends to position itself to capture an increasing share
of the interconnect requirements of its customers.
 
     Maintain High Levels of Investment.  Hadco believes its financial strength
allows it to maintain leadership positions in advanced materials, process
technologies and packaging through both its development activities and
acquisitions. The Company (including Zycon) has invested approximately $235
million in state-of-the-art production facilities and new technologies during
the past five fiscal years. These investments have increased capacity and
operating efficiencies, improved management control and provided more consistent
product quality. As a result, the Company believes it has become one of the few
interconnect manufacturers capable of satisfying volume production,
time-to-market, time-to-volume, and technology requirements of customers in the
electronic interconnect industry.
 
     Develop Advanced Manufacturing and Process Technologies.  The Company is
committed to being a leader in the manufacture of advanced materials and the
development of sophisticated process technologies in the electronic interconnect
industry. The Company has invested in leading process technologies that enable
it to cost-effectively produce high quality and technologically advanced
products, thereby attracting fast growing technology customers. The Company
believes its manufacturing and process capabilities provide a competitive
advantage in the manufacture of complex interconnect products.
 
     Increase Geographic Reach.  Hadco believes it is the only independent North
American printed circuit manufacturer with a full service offering of quick-turn
and volume printed circuit manufacturing and backplane assembly on both the East
and West Coasts. In addition, its volume production facility in Malaysia, which
recently commenced operations, is intended to provide the Company with access to
U.S. customers expanding into Asian markets. The Company also intends to broaden
its European and other international sales.
 
     Pursue Strategic Acquisitions.  The January 1997 acquisition of Zycon
provided Hadco with state-of-the-art volume printed circuit manufacturing and
backplane assembly facilities on the West Coast, a new volume production
facility in Malaysia, a quick-turn prototype and design facility on the East
 
                                       31
<PAGE>   33
 
Coast, a broader customer base, new proprietary technologies, and additional
sales personnel. The Company will consider other strategic acquisitions of
companies and technologies that enhance its competitive position.
 
PRODUCTS AND SERVICES
 
     The Company's products and services are designed to meet its customers'
interconnect needs for complex multilayer printed circuits and backplane
assemblies. Hadco offers complementary processes and capabilities that span the
period from product conception through delivery of volume products. The
Company's offering includes the following:
 
     Development.  Through development groups located at various facilities,
Hadco identifies, develops and markets new technologies that benefit its
customers. These development groups work closely with customers during all
stages of product life-cycles. For instance, process design changes and
refinements required for volume production are identified and implemented prior
to production. The development groups also focus on the special requirements of
the Company's customers, including increasing printed circuit densities,
electronic packaging and advanced materials and products. When appropriate, the
development groups have coordinated the acquisition of technology licenses,
filed patent disclosures and applications, and registered trademarks on behalf
of the Company.
 
     Design.  The Company provides design and engineering assistance in the
early stages of product development which assures both mechanical and electrical
considerations are integrated to achieve a high quality and cost effective
product. The Company also evaluates customer designs for manufacturability and,
when appropriate, recommends design changes to reduce manufacturing costs or
lead times or to increase manufacturing yields or the quality of finished
printed circuits. The Company believes that this long-term view of manufacturing
and customer relationships distinguishes the Company from many manufacturers
which compete primarily in the quick-turn market. By working closely with its
customers, the Company also gains a better understanding of the future
requirements of OEMs. This cooperative process shortens the time in transition
from the development of the prototype design to volume manufacturing and
facilitates the delivery of high quality products to customer premises in a
timely fashion.
 
     Quick-Turn Prototype.  Prototypes typically require lead times of three to
seven days, and as short as 24 hours. The Company provides quick-turn prototype
services to the product development groups of customers that require small test
quantities. Hadco offers these services through its Tech Centers in
Massachusetts, New Hampshire and California. Prototype development at these
Centers has included multilayer printed circuits of up to 38 layers, embedded
discrete components, Multichip Modules (MCM), Single Chip Carriers (SCC), planar
magnetics, advanced surface finishes, and various high performance substrates
for the high frequency microwave market. The Tech Centers also support advanced
attachment technologies such as Tape Automated Bonding (TAB) and Direct Chip
Attach (DCA). In combining the design of a printed circuit with the manufacture
of the prototype, Hadco can reduce the length of the design/manufacture cycle.
By working closely with customers at the design and prototype stage, the Company
believes it strengthens long-term relationships with its customers and gains an
advantage in securing a preferred vendor status when customers begin volume
production.
 
     Pre-Production.  Pre-production is the manufacture of limited quantities of
electronic interconnects during the transition period from prototype to volume
production. Pre-production generally requires quick-turn delivery to accommodate
time-to-volume pressures or as a temporary solution for unforeseen customer
demands. Pre-production is done in the Tech Centers and in volume production
facilities.
 
     Volume Production.  Volume production is characterized by longer lead times
and increased emphasis on lower cost as the product moves to full-scale
commercial production. As customers increasingly demand a quick transition from
prototype to volume production, few independent manufacturers can provide
complex printed circuits of 18 or more layers in the volume provided by
 
                                       32
<PAGE>   34
 
Hadco's larger facilities. During 1996, the Tech Centers transitioned chip
attachment technologies such as Ball Grid Array (BGA), Tape Automated Bonding
(TAB) and Direct Chip Attach (DCA), and other technologies including Multichip
Module (MCM) and Single Chip Carriers (SCC) to volume production. The Company
operates five facilities located in California, New York, New Hampshire and
Malaysia for medium and high-volume printed circuit production.
 
     Backplane Assembly.  Backplane assemblies are generally larger and thicker
printed circuits on which connectors are mounted to interconnect printed
circuits, integrated circuits and other electronic components. Hadco
incorporates its own printed circuits in backplane assemblies to provide
customers with a high level of printed circuit technology on a quick-turn and
volume basis. Net sales of backplane assemblies accounted for 6%, 7% and 17% of
total Company net sales during fiscal 1994, 1995 and 1996, respectively, and for
10% on a pro forma basis including Zycon during fiscal 1996. With its backplane
assembly operations, Hadco is one of a few companies that provides its customers
with the strategic advantage of an integrated offering to meet their needs from
development and design through volume production and backplane assembly.
 
     The Company's advanced process capabilities enhance each of the above
services and include:
 
     Manufacture of High Performance Printed Circuits.  The Company produces
technologically advanced printed circuits primarily for the high performance
market at the Tech Centers and its volume production facilities. These printed
circuits, used principally in the data communications and telecommunications
industries, are designed to function in high temperature environments and at
higher frequencies. Materials used by the Company for these products include
Teflon(R), cyanate ester, GETEK(R), liquid crystal polymers, polymides, and
bismaleimide triazine epoxies.
 
     Development of Emerging Technologies.  The Company undertakes projects to
develop advanced or improved processes, materials and product lines. Buried
capacitance and buried resistance are advanced materials developed by the
Company to provide improved electrical performance and greater interconnect
densities. Sales of buried capacitance products by the Company (including Zycon)
in fiscal 1996 totaled $24.0 million, and the Company believes that buried
resistance materials (ResistAIR(TM)) may generate additional future revenue. In
addition, the Company is developing the MicroPath(TM) family of micro via
processes, which include liquid imaging, dry film imaging, plasma etching, and
laser drilling. Micro vias provide a significant increase in printed circuit
density. During fiscal 1996, the Company also began to produce rigid flex
printed circuit products utilizing licensed HVRFlex(TM) technology. These
products enable customers to fold a printed circuit and reduce the need for
cable connectors in the portable computer and telecommunications markets. See
"-- Manufacturing and Facilities."
 
MARKETS AND CUSTOMERS
 
     Hadco's customers are a diverse group of OEMs and contract manufacturers in
the computing (mainly workstations, servers, mainframes, storage and notebooks),
data communications/telecommunications and industrial automation industries,
including process controls, automotive, medical and instrumentation. The
following table shows, for the periods indicated, the Company's net sales and
percentage of its net sales to the principal end-user markets it serves. Except
for the information under
 
                                       33
<PAGE>   35
 
the column "Fiscal Year Ended October 26, 1996 (Pro Forma)," the information
reflected in the table does not include Zycon.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                        OCTOBER 26,
                                                                                            1996
                                                                                       --------------
                                                       FISCAL YEAR ENDED,
                            -------------------------------------------------------------------------
                             OCTOBER 29,         OCTOBER 28,         OCTOBER 26,
         MARKETS                 1994                1995                1996            Pro Forma
- --------------------------  --------------     ----------------     --------------
                            (Dollars in millions)
<S>                         <C>        <C>     <C>          <C>     <C>        <C>     <C>        <C>
Computing.................  $ 79.8      36%    $ 84.9        32%    $119.2      34%    $148.3      26%
Contract Assembly.........    46.5      21       69.0        26      112.2      32      193.9      34
Data Communications/
  Telecommunications......    82.0      37       90.2        34       94.7      27      193.9      34
Industrial Automation.....    11.1       5       15.9         6       17.5       5       28.5       5
Other.....................     2.2       1        5.2         2        7.1       2        5.8       1
                            ------     ---     ------       ---     ------     ---     ------     ---
Total Net Sales...........  $221.6     100%    $265.2       100%    $350.7     100%    $570.4     100%
                            ======     ===     ======       ===     ======     ===     ======     ===
</TABLE>
 
     The Company (including Zycon) supplied its products and services to a
diverse base of approximately 500 customers in fiscal 1996, including 77
customers with purchases in excess of $1 million. The Company attempts to market
its products to customers who currently have, or have the potential to achieve,
significant market share in their respective industries. The following list sets
forth the Company's largest customers during fiscal 1996:
 
<TABLE>
<S>                  <C>
Bay Networks         SCI Systems
Cabletron Systems    Solectron
Cisco Systems        Storage Technology
Compaq Computer      Sun Microsystems
Jabil Circuits       U.S. Robotics
</TABLE>
 
     During fiscal 1994, 1995 and 1996, no customer accounted for more than 7%,
7% and 15%, respectively, of Hadco's net sales and the Company's ten largest
customers together accounted for approximately 48%, 46% and 48%, respectively,
during the same periods, and 43% in fiscal 1996 on a pro forma basis including
Zycon. In fiscal 1996, one customer, Sun Microsystems, accounted for
approximately 10% of the net sales of the Company (including Zycon).
 
SALES AND MARKETING
 
     The Company markets its products through its own sales and marketing
organization and independent manufacturers' representatives. As of January 25,
1997, the Company employed 112 sales and marketing employees, of which 55 are
direct sales representatives at eight locations. The Company is also represented
by 17 independent manufacturers' representatives at 28 locations in North
America, Europe, Mexico, Asia, Australia and the Middle East. Regional direct
sales offices are located in the states of Arizona, California, Colorado,
Georgia, Minnesota, New Hampshire, North Carolina, Pennsylvania, Texas and the
Province of Ontario, Canada. The Company's sales organization is divided into
four territories, and each direct sales representative and each manufacturer's
representative works within one of the four territories. Each territory also has
a support staff of sales engineers and technical service personnel responsible
for technical liaison and problem solving, development of product and market
opportunities, market research and marketing communications.
 
     The Company focuses on developing close relationships with customers
beginning at the earliest development and design phases and continuing
throughout all stages of product production. The Company's Advanced Packaging
Development Group identifies, develops and markets new technologies that benefit
its customers and is intended to position the Company as an important source for
these solutions. This group also assists marketing efforts by hosting the
Regional Technology Symposiums at which the Company's technical capabilities are
presented to, and industry technical trends are discussed with, customers of the
Company. These Symposiums attract engineers and designers from
 
                                       34
<PAGE>   36
 
electronics OEMs and facilitate an interactive discussion of the latest
technologies in the manufacture of complex printed circuits.
 
MANUFACTURING AND FACILITIES
 
     The need for high volume production of dense multilayer printed circuits
has transformed the electronic interconnect industry into one that increasingly
requires complex manufacturing processes and necessitates high levels of
investment in facilities, advanced materials, production processes and product
design capabilities. The Company has invested in production technology to
manufacture large volumes of dense multilayer printed circuits utilizing
advanced attachment strategies such as Surface Mount Technology (SMT), Tape
Automated Bonding (TAB) and Ball Grid Array (BGA). The Company employs numerous
advanced manufacturing techniques and systems, including Computer Aided
Manufacturing (CAM) systems, Computer Integrated Manufacturing (CIM) systems,
computer controlled drilling and routing, dry-film imaging, multi-purpose metals
plating, high volume surface coating, dual-access electrical testing, automated
optical inspection, high-volume photoimageable solder mask processing, and
computer controlled high-volume lamination systems. These techniques enable
Hadco to manufacture complex printed circuits of consistent quality, in high
volume and on a timely basis. All of the Company's North American production
facilities are ISO9002 certified. See "-- Products and Services."
 
     Hadco is able to provide a broad and integrated offering through a focused
manufacturing strategy for each facility. The Company manufactures its products
in ten facilities, consisting of five volume production facilities (in
California, New Hampshire, New York and Malaysia), two backplane assembly
facilities (in California and New Hampshire) and three quick-turn prototype
facilities (in Massachusetts, New Hampshire and California). The production
expertise of some facilities overlap, enabling Hadco to allocate production
based on product type and available capacity. Each facility can focus on
particular product types and respond quickly to customers' specific
requirements.
 
     Hadco has pursued a strategy of expanding the capacity and geographic scope
of its manufacturing facilities to better serve high growth segments of the
electronics industry in key geographic markets. With the acquisition of Zycon,
the Company added a 310,000 square foot volume production facility in
California, a 180,000 square foot volume production facility in Malaysia, a
71,000 square foot quick-turn prototype facility in Massachusetts, and a 29,000
square foot backplane assembly facility in California expected to begin
operations in the first half of calendar 1997. During fiscal 1996, the Company
also expanded its backplane assembly facility from 40,000 to 60,000 square feet,
and added two additional SMT lines, in-circuit testing capability, and numerous
pieces of assembly equipment.
 
     In total, the Company leases or owns approximately 1.2 million square feet
of manufacturing space. The Company's significant facilities are as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                          FUNCTION                                 LOCATION       SQUARE FEET
- ------------------------------------------------------------  ------------------  -----------
<S>                                                           <C>                 <C>
Volume Production...........................................  Santa Clara and
                                                              San Jose, CA          310,000
                                                              Owego, NY             282,000*
                                                              Derry, NH             199,000
                                                              Kuching, Malaysia     180,000
                                                              Hudson, NH             52,000
Quick-Turn Prototype........................................  Haverhill, MA          71,000
                                                              Watsonville, CA        35,000
                                                              Salem, NH              27,000
Backplane Assembly..........................................  Salem, NH              60,000
                                                              Santa Clara, CA        29,000**
Administrative..............................................  Salem, NH              35,000
                                                              Santa Clara, CA        29,000**
</TABLE>
 
- ------------
 * 27,200 feet of which is under renovation
 
** Under construction
 
                                       35
<PAGE>   37
 
     The Company owns its volume production facilities in Owego, New York and
Derry, New Hampshire. The Company leases its volume production and backplane
assembly facilities in Santa Clara and San Jose, California, which are located
in four adjacent buildings; the leases for these four buildings expire in March
2009 and contain options to extend for up to two additional periods of five
years each. The Company completed construction in calendar 1996 of its volume
production facility in Kuching, Malaysia and leases the land on which this
facility is located for a period of 60 years, expiring in November 2055. The
Hudson, New Hampshire operations are located in two separate buildings, and
their leases expire in December 1997 with options to extend until December 2000.
 
     Leases for the Company's quick-turn prototype facility in Haverhill,
Massachusetts expire in December 2003, with options on two of the leases to
extend for an additional five years and options on the third lease to extend for
an additional ten years. The lease for the Watsonville, California quick-turn
prototype facility expires in December 1999. The lease for the quick-turn
prototype facility in Salem, New Hampshire expires in May 1999, with an option
to extend until May 2004.
 
     The lease for the backplane assembly facility in Salem, New Hampshire
expires in March 2000, with options to extend until March 2006. The leases for
the Santa Clara, California buildings include the 29,000 square feet of
backplane assembly operations.
 
     The administrative and corporate offices in Salem, New Hampshire are
located in two separate buildings, which are covered by leases that expire in
October 2000, with options to extend until October 2006. The leases for the
Santa Clara, California buildings include the 29,000 square feet of
administrative space.
 
     The Company also owns approximately six acres of land in Salem, New
Hampshire, approximately five acres of land in Derry, New Hampshire, and
approximately ten acres of land in Owego, New York.
 
     In fiscal 1996, the Company's capital expenditures relating to its
environmental control facilities and equipment totaled approximately $1 million.
The Company estimates that it will make capital expenditures with respect to its
environmental control facilities and equipment of approximately $1.8 million and
$700,000 in fiscal 1997 and 1998, respectively.
 
SUPPLIER RELATIONSHIPS
 
     Historically, the majority of raw materials used in the Company's
manufacture of printed circuits and components used in backplane assemblies have
been readily available. However, product changes and the overall demand for
electronic interconnect products could increase the industry's use of new
laminate materials, standard laminate materials, multilayer blanks, electronic
components and other materials, and therefore such materials may not be readily
available to the Company in the future. Zycon has experienced shortages of
certain types of raw materials in the past. There can be no assurance that
shortages of certain types of raw materials or components will not occur in the
future. To date, material shortages or price fluctuations have not had a
materially adverse effect on the Company, but there can be no assurance that
material shortages or price fluctuations will not have a material adverse effect
on the Company in the future.
 
     The Company works with its suppliers to develop just-in-time supply systems
which reduce inventory carrying costs. The Company also maintains a Supplier
Certification Program which evaluates potential vendors on the basis of such
factors as quality, on-time delivery, cost, technical capability, and potential
technical advancement. Certification is based on both actual performance and
audits of vendors' manufacturing sites. Key suppliers are reviewed quarterly to
preserve strong relationships with these suppliers and maintain regular dialogue
on quality, cost and technical advancement issues. Many suppliers attend the
Company's Supplier Symposium, where the Company's goals and objectives are
discussed with vendors.
 
                                       36
<PAGE>   38
 
COMPETITION
 
     The electronic interconnect industry is highly fragmented and characterized
by intense competition. The Company believes that its major competitors are the
large U.S. and international independent and captive producers that also
manufacture multilayer printed circuits and provide backplane and other
electronic assemblies. Some of these competitors have significantly greater
financial, technical and marketing resources, greater name recognition and a
larger installed customer base than the Company. In addition, these competitors
may have the ability to respond more quickly to new or emerging technologies,
may adapt more quickly to changes in customer requirements and may devote
greater resources to the development, promotion and sale of their products than
the Company.
 
     During periods of recession or economic slowdown in the electronics
industry and other periods when excess capacity exists, electronics OEMs become
more price sensitive, which could have a material adverse effect on interconnect
pricing. In addition, the Company believes that price competition from printed
circuit manufacturers in Asia and other locations with lower production costs
may play an increasing role in the printed circuit markets in which the Company
competes. The Company's basic interconnect technology is generally not subject
to significant proprietary protection, and companies with significant resources
or international operations may enter the market. Increased competition could
result in price reductions, reduced margins or loss of market share, any of
which could materially adversely affect the Company's business, financial
condition and results of operations.
 
     The demand for printed circuits has continued to be affected by the
development of smaller, more powerful electronic components requiring less
printed circuit area. Expansion of the Company's existing products or services
could expose the Company to new competition. Moreover, new developments in the
electronics industry could render existing technology obsolete or less
competitive and could potentially introduce new competition into the industry.
There can be no assurance that the Company will continue to compete successfully
against present and future competitors or that competitive pressures faced by
the Company will not have a material adverse effect on the Company's business,
financial condition and results of operations.
 
     Hadco competes on the basis of product quality, timeliness of delivery,
price, customer technical support and its integrated offering, from development
and design through volume production and backplane assembly.
 
PRODUCT PROTECTION
 
     The Company has obtained four United States and one foreign patent with
respect to its buried capacitance technology. Although Hadco seeks to protect
certain proprietary technology and other intangible assets through patents and
trademark filings, it has relatively few patents and relies primarily on trade
secret protection. There can be no assurance that the Company will be able to
protect its trade secrets or that others will not independently develop
substantially equivalent proprietary information and techniques or otherwise
gain access to the Company's trade secrets. The future success of the Company
will depend on the continued development of processes and capabilities. The
Company believes that its accumulated experience with respect to materials and
process technology is also important to its operations.
 
RELEASED BACKLOG
 
     The Company's released backlog as of January 25, 1997 was $129.1 million
(including Zycon), compared with $96.9 million (excluding Zycon) as of January
27, 1996. The Company anticipates delivering approximately 90% of its released
backlog during its second quarter of fiscal 1997. Released backlog consists of
orders for which artwork has been received, a delivery date has been scheduled
and the Company anticipates it will manufacture and deliver the order.
Cancellation and postponement charges, to the extent they exist with respect to
released backlog, generally vary depending upon the time of cancellation or
postponement, and a significant portion of the Company's released backlog at any
time may be subject to cancellation or postponement without penalty. Variations
in the size,
 
                                       37
<PAGE>   39
 
timing and delivery schedules of purchase orders received by the Company, as
well as changes in customers' delivery requirements, may result in substantial
fluctuations in released backlog from period to period. Accordingly, the Company
believes that released backlog is not a meaningful indicator of future quarterly
or annual financial results.
 
EMPLOYEES
 
     As of January 25, 1997, the Company had 5,410 employees, compared to 2,487
employees as of January 27, 1996. The employees are not represented by a union,
and the Company has never experienced any labor problems resulting in a work
stoppage.
 
ENVIRONMENTAL MATTERS
 
     The Company is required to comply with all federal, state, county and
municipal regulations regarding protection of the environment. There can be no
assurance that more stringent environmental laws will not be adopted in the
future and, if adopted, the costs of compliance with more stringent
environmental laws could be substantial. Waste treatment and disposal are major
considerations for printed circuit manufacturers. The Company uses chemicals in
the manufacture of its products that are classified by the Environmental
Protection Agency (EPA) as hazardous substances. The Company is aware of certain
chemicals that exist in the ground at certain of its facilities. The Company has
notified various governmental agencies and continues to work with them to
monitor and resolve these matters. During March 1995, the Company received a
Record Of Decision (ROD) from the New York State Department of Environmental
Conservation (NYSDEC), regarding soil and groundwater contamination at its
Owego, New York facility. Based on a Remedial Investigation and Feasibility
Study (RIFS) for apparent on-site contamination at that facility and a Focused
Feasibility Study (FFS), each prepared by environmental consultants of the
Company, the NYSDEC has approved a remediation program of groundwater withdrawal
and treatment and iterative soil flushing. The Company recently executed a
Modification of the Order on Consent to implement the approved ROD. The cost,
based upon the FFS, to implement this remediation is estimated to be $4.6
million, and is expected to be expended as follows: $260,000 for capital
equipment and $4.3 million for operation and maintenance costs which will be
incurred and expended over the estimated life of the program of 30 years. NYSDEC
has requested that the Company consider taking additional samples from a wetland
area near the Company's Owego facility. Analytical reports of earlier sediment
samples indicated the presence of certain inorganics. There can be no assurance
that the Company and/or other third parties will not be required to conduct
additional investigations and remediation at that location, the costs of which
are currently indeterminable due to the numerous variables described in the
fifth paragraph of this "-- Environmental Matters" section.
 
     From 1974 to 1980, the Company operated a printed circuit manufacturing
facility in Florida as a lessee of property that is now the subject of a pending
lawsuit ("the Florida Lawsuit") and investigation by the Florida Department of
Environmental Protection (FDEP). On June 9, 1992, the Company entered into a
Cooperating Parties Agreement in which it and Gould, Inc., another prior lessee
of the site have agreed to fund certain assessment and feasibility study
activities at the site, and an environmental consultant has been retained to
perform such activities. The cost of such activities is not expected to be
material to the Company. In addition to the Cooperating Parties Agreement, Hadco
and others are participating in alternative dispute resolution regarding the
site with an independent mediator. In connection with the mediation, in February
1992 the FDEP presented computer-generated estimates of remedial costs, for
activities expected to be spread over a number of years, that ranged from
approximately $3.3 million to $9.7 million. Mediation sessions were conducted in
March 1992 but have been suspended during the ongoing assessment and feasibility
activities. Management believes it is likely that it will participate in
implementing a continuing remedial program for the site, the costs of which are
currently unknown. In June 1995, Hadco was named a third-party defendant in the
Florida Lawsuit. See "-- Legal Proceedings."
 
                                       38
<PAGE>   40
 
     The Company has commenced the operation of a groundwater extraction system
at its Derry, New Hampshire facility to address certain groundwater
contamination and groundwater migration control issues. Because of the
uncertainty regarding both the quantity of contaminants beneath the building at
the site and the long-term effectiveness of the groundwater migration control
system the Company has installed, it is not possible to make a reliable estimate
of the length of time remedial activity will have to be performed. However, it
is anticipated that the groundwater extraction system will be operated for at
least 30 years. There can be no assurance that the Company will not be required
to conduct additional investigations and remediation relating to the Derry
facility. The total costs of such groundwater extraction system and of
conducting any additional investigations and remediation relating to the Derry
facility are not fully determinable due to the numerous variables described in
the fifth paragraph of this "-- Environmental Matters" section.
 
     The City of Santa Clara has adopted an ordinance that, as of April 1, 1997,
significantly reduces the amount of waste, including copper and nickel, that
companies such as the Company may discharge into the city sanitary sewer. The
new ordinance provides for substantial penalties for intentional or negligent
violations. These penalties include fines ranging from $10,000 to $50,000 per
day, revocation of required business permits, the issuance of a cease and desist
order and, under certain circumstances, up to nine months imprisonment. Under
the new ordinance, the Company is subject to stringent requirements on the
amount of water it can discharge and is required to substantially reduce the
concentrations of certain chemicals, including copper and nickel, which it
currently discharges. Under the new ordinance, the concentration limit for
Hadco's copper discharge is reduced from 2.70 milligrams per liter to 1.02
milligrams per liter, and the concentration limit for Hadco's nickel discharge
is reduced from 2.60 milligrams per liter to 0.02 milligrams per liter. The
Company believes that by using a combination of existing and developing
technologies, including established methods for the chemical removal of copper,
it will be able to meet the concentration standards by April 1, 1997, the
required date of compliance. However, there can be no assurances that the
Company will be able to comply with the reduced discharge levels mandated by the
ordinance or that the costs of complying with the new ordinance will not exceed
the Company's current estimate.
 
     The Company accrues estimated costs associated with known environmental
matters, when such costs can be reasonably estimated. The cost estimates
relating to future environmental clean-up are subject to numerous variables, the
effects of which can be difficult to measure, including the stage of the
environmental investigations, the nature of potential remedies, possible joint
and several liability, the magnitude of possible contamination, the difficulty
of determining future liability, the time over which remediation might occur,
and the possible effects of changing laws and regulations.
 
     Management believes the ultimate disposition of above known environmental
matters described in this "-- Environmental Matters" section will not have a
material adverse effect upon the liquidity, capital resources, business or
consolidated financial position of the Company. However, one or more of such
environmental matters could have a significant negative impact on the Company's
consolidated financial results for a particular reporting period. See
"Management's Discussion and Analysis of Results of Operations and Financial
Condition" and Note 9 of Notes to the Company's Consolidated Financial
Statements.
 
     The Company plans additional capital expenditures during fiscal 1997 to
further reduce air emissions and reduce waste generation. See discussion under
"-- Manufacturing and Facilities" concerning the Company's capital expenditures
relating to environmental control facilities and equipment, and under "-- Legal
Proceedings" relating to lawsuits regarding environmental matters.
 
LEGAL PROCEEDINGS
 
     The Company is one of 33 entities which have been named as potentially
responsible parties in a lawsuit pending in the federal district court of New
Hampshire concerning environmental conditions at the Auburn Road, Londonderry,
New Hampshire landfill site. Local, state and federal entities and certain other
parties to the litigation seek contribution for past costs, totaling
approximately $20
 
                                       39
<PAGE>   41
 
million, allegedly incurred to assess and remediate the Auburn Road site. In
December 1996, following publication and comment period, the EPA amended the ROD
to change the remedy at the Auburn Road site from active groundwater remediation
to future monitoring. Other parties to the lawsuit also allege that future
monitoring will be required. The Company is contesting liability, but is
participating in mediation with 27 other parties in an effort to resolve the
lawsuit.
 
     In connection with the Florida Lawsuit pending in the Circuit Court for
Broward County, Florida, Hadco and Gould, Inc., another prior lessee of the site
of the printed circuit manufacturing facility in Florida, was each served with a
third-party complaint in June 1995, as third-party defendants in such pending
Florida Lawsuit by a party who had previously been named as a defendant when the
Florida Lawsuit was commenced in 1993 by the FDEP. The Florida Lawsuit seeks
damages relating to environmental pollution and FDEP costs and expenses, civil
penalties, and declaratory and injunctive relief to require the parties to
complete assessment and remediation of soil and groundwater contamination. The
other parties include alleged owners of the property. "See
Business -- Environmental Matters."
 
     In March 1993, the EPA notified Zycon of its potential liability for
maintenance and remediation costs in connection with a hazardous waste disposal
facility operated by Casmalia Resources, a California Limited Partnership, in
Santa Barbara County, California. The EPA identified Zycon as one of the 65
generators which had disposed the greatest amounts of materials at the site.
Based on the total tonnage contributed by all generators, Zycon's share is
estimated at approximately 0.2% of the total weight.
 
     The Casmalia site was regulated by the EPA during the period when the
material was accepted. There is no allegation that Zycon violated any law in the
disposal of material at the site, rather the EPA's actions stemmed from the fact
that Casmalia Resources may not have the financial means to implement a closure
plan for the site and because of Zycon's status as a generator of hazardous
waste.
 
     In September 1996, a Consent Decree among the EPA and 48 entities
(including Zycon) acting through the Casmalia Steering Committee (CSC) was
lodged with the United States District Court in Los Angeles, California, which
must approve the agreement. Although this approval is pending, work has started
under the Consent Decree. The Consent Decree sets forth the terms and conditions
under which the CSC will carry out work aimed at final closure of the site.
Certain closure activities will be performed by the CSC. Later work will be
performed by the CSC, if funded by other parties. Under the Consent Decree, the
settling parties will work with the EPA to pursue the non-settling parties to
ensure they participate in contributing to the closure and long-term operation
and maintenance of the facility.
 
     The EPA will continue as the lead regulatory agency during the final
closure work. Because long-term maintenance plans for the site will not be
determined for a number of years, it has not yet been decided which regulatory
agency will oversee this phase of the work plan or how the long-term costs will
be funded. However, the agreement provides a mechanism for ensuring that an
appropriate federal, state or local agency will assume regulatory responsibility
for long-term maintenance.
 
     The future costs in connection with the lawsuits described in the preceding
paragraphs are currently indeterminable due to such factors as the unknown
timing and extent of any future remedial actions which may be required, the
extent of any liability of the Company and of other potentially responsible
parties, and the financial resources of the other potentially responsible
parties.
 
                                       40
<PAGE>   42
 
                                   MANAGEMENT
 
EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND DIRECTORS
 
     The executive officers and directors of the Company are as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                NAME                  AGE                          POSITION
- ------------------------------------  ---   ------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                   <C>   <C>
Horace H. Irvine II(3)..............  59    Chairman of the Board of Directors
Andrew E. Lietz(3)..................  58    President, Chief Executive Officer and Director
Timothy P. Losik....................  38    Vice President, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer
James R. Griffin....................  46    Vice President
Richard P. Saporito.................  43    Vice President
James C. Hamilton...................  59    Clerk
Lawrence Coolidge(2)(3).............  60    Director
J. Stanley Hill(1)(2)(4)............  82    Director
John O. Irvine(2)(4)................  55    Director
Mikael Salovaara....................  42    Director
John F. Smith(1)(4).................  61    Director
Oliver O. Ward(1)(2)................  61    Director
Patrick Sweeney.....................  61    Director
John E. Pomeroy.....................  55    Director
James C. Taylor.....................  58    Director
</TABLE>
 
- ------------
 
(1) Member of Audit Committee.
 
(2) Member of Compensation Committee.
 
(3) Member of Nominating Committee.
 
(4) Member of Stock Option Committee.
 
     Mr. Horace H. Irvine II is a founder of the Company and has been its
Chairman of the Board since the Company was incorporated in 1966, and its Chief
Executive Officer from 1966 until 1986. He was President of the Company from
1966 until 1980 and Treasurer of the Company from 1966 until 1984. He is
Chairman of the Nominating Committee of the Board of Directors.
 
     Mr. Lietz joined the Company in 1984 and has been President and Chief
Executive Officer of the Company since October 1995. From July 1991 to October
1995 Mr. Lietz was the Chief Operating Officer and a Vice President of the
Company. He has been a director of the Company since February 1993. Prior to
joining the Company, Mr. Lietz spent 20 years employed by IBM where he held
various sales, marketing and management positions.
 
     Mr. Losik joined the Company in 1986 and has been the Chief Financial
Officer, Vice President and Treasurer of the Company since March 1994. He was
the Controller of the Company from June 1992 to March 1994 and a Corporate
Accounting Manager from March 1988 to June 1992. Mr. Losik is a certified public
accountant. From 1979 to 1986, Mr. Losik held various positions, including
partner, in public accounting firms.
 
     Mr. Griffin joined the Company in 1979 and has been a Vice President of the
Company since August 1991. He was the Director of Marketing Programs of the
Company from 1989 to 1991.
 
     Mr. Saporito joined the Company in 1987 and has been a Vice President of
the Company since December 1991. He was the Director of Human Resources of the
Company from 1989 to 1991.
 
     Mr. Hamilton has been the Clerk of the Company since 1966. He is a partner
in the law firm of Berlin, Hamilton & Dahmen, LLP, general counsel to the
Company.
 
                                       41
<PAGE>   43
 
     Mr. Coolidge has been a director of the Company since 1995. He is Chairman
of the Long-Term Planning and Strategy Committee of the Board of Directors. He
has been the president and a private trustee of Loring, Wolcott & Coolidge
Office, a fiduciary services provider, since 1962. On August 1, 1994, Mr.
Coolidge became an associate of Loring, Wolcott & Coolidge Fiduciary Advisors, a
registered investment advisor.
 
     Mr. Hill has been a director of the Company since 1981. He is Chairman of
the Audit and Stock Option Committees of the Board of Directors. During the past
27 years, he has been president of Digiplan Inc., a private consultant to the
computer users' industry.
 
     Mr. John O. Irvine has been a director of the Company since 1973. During
the past six years, he has been president of Little Mountain Bancshares Inc. of
Monticello, Minnesota, a bank holding company. Mr. Irvine is the brother of
Horace H. Irvine II.
 
     Mr. Salovaara has been a director of the Company since 1995. He has been a
founding partner of Greycliff Partners, an investment advisor, since December
1991. He was a partner of Goldman Sachs & Co., an investment banking firm, from
1988 to 1991. Mr. Salovaara is also a director of Granite Broadcasting
Corporation and Circuit City Stores, Inc.
 
     Mr. Smith has been a director of the Company since 1995. He has been the
president of MYCOS International, Inc., a property development corporation,
since April 1993, and president of PerSeptive Biosystems, Inc., a biotechnology
company, since July 1996. In April 1993, Mr. Smith retired as Senior Vice
President and Chief Operating Officer of Digital Equipment Corporation, a
computer company, in which capacities he had served since 1991. He began his
career at Digital Equipment Corporation in 1958 and served in various other
senior management positions from 1976 to 1991. Mr. Smith is also a director of
Ansys Corporation, Instron Corporation, PerSeptive Biosystems, Inc. and Sequoia
Systems, Inc.
 
     Mr. Ward has been a director of the Company since 1987. He is Chairman of
the Compensation, Executive and Finance Committees of the Board of Directors. He
was a founder and has served as chairman of the board, chief executive officer
and president of Germanium Power Devices Corp., a manufacturer and marketer of
germanium semiconductors, since 1973.
 
     Mr. Sweeney has been a director of the Company since 1991. He was President
and Chief Executive Officer of the Company from 1991 until October 1995, and
Chief Operating Officer from July 1990 to July 1991. He is currently a
consultant to the Company.
 
     Mr. Pomeroy has been a director of the Company since September 1996. He has
been president and chief executive officer of Dover Technologies, a group of
manufacturing companies and a subsidiary of Dover Corporation, since 1987. Mr.
Pomeroy is also a director of Adept Technologies, Inc.
 
     Mr. Taylor has been a director of the Company since December 1996. He has
been an advisory director at Downer and Company, an investment banking firm,
since 1995. He was a managing director of Burns Fry Limited, an investment
banking firm, from 1988 to 1994.
 
     Mr. John O. Irvine and Mr. Salovaara are not standing for re-election as
directors of the Company at the Annual Meeting of Stockholders to be held on
February 26, 1997, and thus will no longer be directors of the Company effective
as of that date.
 
     Directors are elected annually and hold office until the next annual
meeting of stockholders and until their successors are duly elected and
qualified, or until their earlier removal or resignation. Executive officers are
elected to serve at the pleasure of the Board of Directors. Horace H. Irvine II
and John O. Irvine are brothers. There are no other family relationships among
any of the directors and executive officers of the Company.
 
                                       42
<PAGE>   44
 
                             PRINCIPAL SHAREHOLDERS
 
     The following table sets forth certain information with respect to
beneficial ownership of the Company's outstanding Common Stock as of January 24,
1997, and as adjusted to reflect the sale of the Common Stock offered hereby, by
(i) each person who is known by the Company to beneficially own more than 5% of
the Company's Common Stock, (ii) each director and executive officer of the
Company, (iii) the Chief Executive Officer, and (iv) all the directors and
executive officers of the Company as a group. Except as otherwise provided
below, the address of each person listed below is c/o Hadco Corporation, 12A
Manor Parkway, Salem, New Hampshire 03079.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                         PERCENT OF SHARES
                                                                        BENEFICIALLY OWNED
                                                NUMBER OF SHARES     -------------------------
                                                  BENEFICIALLY       PRIOR TO        AFTER
                NAMES OR GROUP                      OWNED(1)         OFFERING     OFFERING(16)
- ----------------------------------------------  ----------------     --------     ------------
<S>                                             <C>                  <C>          <C>
Horace H. Irvine II...........................        923,512(2)        8.8%           7.4%
J&W Seligman & Co. Incorporated...............        702,100+          6.7            5.6
  100 Park Avenue
  New York, NY 10017
FMR Corp......................................        675,800(3)        6.5            5.4
  82 Devonshire Street
  Boston, MA 02109
Nicholas Applegate Capital Management.........        528,200+          5.1            4.2
  600 West Broadway, 29th Floor
  San Diego, CA 03079
Andrew E. Lietz...............................        165,146(4)        1.6            1.3
Patrick Sweeney...............................         27,000             *              *
Timothy P. Losik..............................         26,775(5)          *              *
James R. Griffin..............................         39,746(6)          *              *
Richard P. Saporito...........................         23,650(7)          *              *
John O. Irvine(8).............................        115,000(9)        1.1              *
J. Stanley Hill...............................         41,000(10)         *              *
Oliver O. Ward................................          3,000(11)         *              *
Lawrence Coolidge.............................        240,158(12)       2.3            1.9
Mikael Salovaara..............................          3,100             *              *
John F. Smith.................................          9,000(13)         *              *
John E. Pomeroy...............................          3,000(14)         *              *
James C. Taylor...............................          3,000(14)         *              *
James C. Hamilton.............................        241,408(12)       2.3            1.9
All directors and executive officers as a
  group (15 persons)..........................      1,635,337(15)      15.3%          12.9%
                                                =================    ========     ============
</TABLE>
 
- ------------
 *  Represents less than 1% of the outstanding shares of the Company's Common
    Stock.
 
 +  Information obtained from a Schedule 13G filed February 4, 1997.
 
 (1) Except as indicated in footnotes to this table, the persons named in this
     table have sole voting and investment power with respect to all shares of
     Common Stock owned.
 
 (2) Includes 124,855 shares held in a voting trust for the benefit of Andrea P.
     Irvine. Horace H. Irvine II, who is the sole trustee of such trust and
     retains sole voting power with respect to the shares held in such trust,
     disclaims beneficial ownership of such shares. Does not include 229,158
     shares held in irrevocable trusts for the benefit of members of Horace H.
     Irvine II's family. Horace H. Irvine II, who is not a trustee of such
     trusts, disclaims beneficial ownership of such
 
                                       43
<PAGE>   45
 
     229,158 shares. James C. Hamilton, Clerk and a partner in Berlin, Hamilton
     & Dahmen, LLP, which is general counsel to the Company, Lawrence Coolidge,
     a Director of the Company, and Gilbert M. Roddy, Jr. are co-trustees of
     these irrevocable trusts. Horace H. Irvine II retains no voting or
     dispositive power with respect to these shares. All voting rights under
     these trusts reside in Messrs. Hamilton, Coolidge and Roddy, who have the
     right to dispose of such shares. Messrs. Coolidge and Hamilton own 11,000
     and 12,250 shares, respectively, as individuals, in addition to the shares
     they hold as co-trustees. Mr. Coolidge's 11,000 shares include 6,000 shares
     issuable upon the exercise of stock options that will become exercisable
     within 60 days after January 24, 1997.
 
 (3) According to information provided to the Company by FMR Corp., as of
     January 24, 1997, FMR Corp. beneficially owned 675,800 shares of the Common
     Stock of the Company. Includes 608,200 shares beneficially owned by
     Fidelity Management & Research Company, as a result of its serving as an
     investment adviser to various investment companies registered under Section
     8 of the Investment Company Act of 1940 and as an investment adviser to
     certain other funds which are generally offered to limited groups of
     investors. Also includes 67,600 shares beneficially owned by Fidelity
     Management Trust Company as a result of its serving as trustee or managing
     agent for various private investment accounts, primarily employee benefit
     plans, and as an investment adviser to certain other funds which are
     generally offered to limited groups of investors. FMR Corp. has sole voting
     power with respect to 11,600 shares and sole dispositive power with respect
     to 675,800 shares.
 
 (4) Includes 134,746 shares issuable upon the exercise of stock options granted
     to Mr. Lietz that are currently exercisable or will become exercisable
     within 60 days after January 24, 1997 and 30,000 shares held by a trust of
     which Mr. Lietz is the sole trustee and sole beneficiary.
 
 (5) Includes 22,775 shares issuable upon the exercise of stock options granted
     to Mr. Losik that are currently exercisable or will become exercisable
     within 60 days after January 24, 1997 and 4,000 shares held jointly with
     Mr. Losik's spouse.
 
 (6) Includes 37,300 shares issuable upon the exercise of stock options granted
     to Mr. Griffin that are currently exercisable or will become exercisable
     within 60 days after January 24, 1997.
 
 (7) Includes 23,450 shares issuable upon the exercise of stock options granted
     to Mr. Saporito that are currently exercisable or will become exercisable
     within 60 days after January 24, 1997.
 
 (8) Horace H. Irvine II and John O. Irvine are brothers.
 
 (9) Includes 15,000 shares issuable upon the exercise of stock options granted
     to John O. Irvine that are currently exercisable or will become exercisable
     within 60 days after January 24, 1997.
 
(10) Includes 10,000 shares issuable upon the exercise of stock options granted
     to Mr. Hill that are currently exercisable or will become exercisable
     within 60 days after January 24, 1997. Does not include 20,000 shares owned
     by Mr. Hill's wife, as to which Mr. Hill disclaims beneficial ownership.
 
(11) Consists of 3,000 shares issuable upon the exercise of stock options
     granted to Mr. Ward that are currently exercisable or will become
     exercisable within 60 days after January 24, 1997.
 
(12) See footnote (2) above.
 
(13) Consists of 9,000 shares issuable upon the exercise of stock options
     granted to Mr. Smith that are currently exercisable or will become
     exercisable within 60 days after January 24, 1997.
 
(14) Consists of 3,000 shares issuable upon the exercise of stock options
     granted to each of Messrs. Pomeroy and Taylor that are currently
     exercisable or will become exercisable within 60 days after January 24,
     1997.
 
                                       44
<PAGE>   46
 
(15) Includes 229,158 shares held by Mr. Coolidge, Mr. Hamilton, and Gilbert M.
     Roddy, Jr., as co-trustees and 124,855 shares held by Horace H. Irvine II
     as trustee. Includes 6,000 shares issuable upon the exercise of stock
     options granted to Mr. Coolidge that are currently exercisable or will
     become exercisable within 60 days after January 24, 1997. See footnote (2)
     above. Includes 134,746 shares issuable upon the exercise of stock options
     granted to Andrew E. Lietz, that are currently exercisable or will become
     exercisable within 60 days after January 24, 1997. See footnote (4) above.
     Includes 22,775 shares issuable upon the exercise of stock options granted
     to Mr. Losik that are currently exercisable or will become exercisable
     within 60 days after January 24, 1997. See footnote (5) above. Includes
     37,300 shares issuable upon the exercise of stock options granted to Mr.
     Griffin that are currently exercisable or will become exercisable within 60
     days after January 24, 1997. See footnote (6) above. Includes 23,450 shares
     issuable upon the exercise of stock options granted to Mr. Saporito that
     are currently exercisable or will become exercisable within 60 days after
     January 24, 1997. See footnote (7) above. Includes 15,000 shares issuable
     upon the exercise of currently exercisable stock options granted to Mr.
     John O. Irvine. See footnote (9) above. Includes 10,000 shares issuable
     upon the exercise of stock options granted to Mr. Hill. See footnote (10)
     above. Includes 3,000 shares issuable upon the exercise of stock options
     granted to Mr. Ward. See footnote (11) above. Includes 9,000 shares
     issuable upon the exercise of stock options granted to Mr. Smith that are
     currently exercisable or will become exercisable within 60 days after
     January 24, 1997. See footnote (13) above. Includes an aggregate of 6,000
     shares issuable upon the exercise of currently exercisable stock options
     granted to each of Messrs. Pomeroy and Taylor. See footnote (14) above.
 
(16) The above table assumes no exercise of the over-allotment options. If the
     Common Stock Underwriters exercise their over-allotment options in full,
     the number of shares offered, the number of shares beneficially owned after
     the Common Stock Offering, and the percent of shares beneficially owned
     after the offering for each of the Selling Stockholders would be: (a)
     Horace H. Irvine II -- 100,000, 823,515, 6.6%; (b) certain trusts for the
     benefit of members of Horace H. Irvine II's family -- 35,000, 194,158,
     1.5%; (c) Andrew E. Lietz -- 40,000, 125,146, 1.0%; (d) J. Stanley
     Hill -- 10,000, 31,000,*%; (e) James C. Hamilton -- 3,000, 203,408, 1.6%;
     and (f) Kenneth Ogle -- 14,600,16,400,*%; and the percent of shares
     beneficially owned after the Common Stock Offering by all directors and
     executive officers as a group will be 11.3% if the Common Stock
     Underwriters exercise their over-allotment options in full.
 
                                       45
<PAGE>   47
 
                          DESCRIPTION OF CAPITAL STOCK
 
     The Company's authorized capital stock consists of 25,000,000 shares of
Common Stock, $.05 par value. As of January 24, 1997, there were 10,444,188
shares of Common Stock of the Company outstanding held by approximately 345
holders of record.
 
COMMON STOCK
 
     Each outstanding share of Common Stock is entitled to one vote on all
matters submitted to a vote of stockholders. Voting rights are not cumulative,
so that the holders of a majority of the voting power of the Company could elect
all the Directors standing for election at any annual or special meeting of
stockholders, and the holders of the remaining shares may not be able to elect
any Director. Dividends may be paid to the holders of Common Stock only when and
if declared by the Board of Directors out of funds legally available therefor.
No cash dividends have ever been paid by the Company on its Common Stock. See
"Dividend Policy." Holders of Common Stock have no preemptive, conversion or
other rights to subscribe for additional shares of stock or other securities of
the Company. Shares of Common Stock are not subject to any redemption
provisions. No share of Common Stock outstanding on the date hereof, sold in the
Common Stock Offering or issuable on conversion of any Note is or will be
subject to any call or assessment. In the event of any liquidation, dissolution
or winding up of the affairs of the Company, the holders of Common Stock will be
entitled to share ratably in all assets remaining after provision for payment of
creditors.
 
MASSACHUSETTS LAW
 
     The Company is subject to the provisions of Chapter 110F of the
Massachusetts General Laws, the so-called Business Combination Statute. Under
Chapter 110F, a Massachusetts corporation with over 200 stockholders, such as
the Company, may not engage in a "business combination" with an "interested
stockholder" for a period of three years after the date of the transaction in
which the person becomes an interested stockholder, unless (i) the interested
stockholder obtains the approval of the Board of Directors prior to becoming an
interested stockholder, (ii) the interested stockholder acquires 90% of the
outstanding voting stock of the corporation (excluding shares held by certain
affiliates of the corporation) at the time it becomes an interested stockholder,
or (iii) the business combination is approved by both the Board of Directors and
the holders of two-thirds of the outstanding voting stock of the corporation
(excluding shares held by the interested stockholder). An "interested
stockholder" is a person who, together with affiliates and associates, owns (or
at any time within the prior three years did own) 5% or more of the outstanding
voting stock of the corporation. A "business combination" includes a merger, a
stock or assets sale, and other transactions resulting in a financial benefit to
the stockholder.
 
     The Company is subject to the provisions of Chapter 110D of the
Massachusetts General Laws, entitled "Regulation of Control Share Acquisitions."
In general, this statute provides that any stockholder of a corporation subject
to this statute who acquires 20% or more of the outstanding voting stock of a
corporation (except in certain transactions) may not vote such stock unless the
stockholders of the corporation so authorize. The Board of Directors may amend
the Company's By-laws at any time to exclude the Company from this statute
prospectively.
 
     On April 18, 1990, Massachusetts enacted Chapter 156B sec.50A of the
Massachusetts General Laws which, in general, requires that publicly held
Massachusetts corporations have a classified board of directors consisting of
three classes as nearly equal in size as possible. Once the corporation is
subject to the classified board provisions of this statute, directors may be
removed by a majority vote of the stockholders only for cause. This statute
provides that a corporation may elect to be exempt from the classified board
provisions by a vote of its directors. By vote of the Board of Directors, the
Company has elected to be exempt from the classified board provisions of this
statute.
 
                                       46
<PAGE>   48
 
STOCKHOLDER RIGHTS PLAN
 
     On August 22, 1995, the Company's Board of Directors adopted a Stockholder
Rights Plan (the "Rights Plan"), the adoption of which did not require
stockholder approval, under which Common Stock Purchase Rights (the "Rights")
were distributed as a Rights dividend on September 11, 1995 at the rate of one
Right for each share of Common Stock held as of the close of business on that
date.
 
     The Rights Plan is designed to prevent an acquirer from gaining control of
the Company without offering a fair price to all of the Company's stockholders.
The Rights Plan was not adopted by the Board in response to any specific offer
or threat, but rather is intended to protect the interests of stockholders in
the event the Company is confronted in the future with takeover tactics.
 
     Each Right will entitle holders of Common Stock to buy one share of Common
Stock of the Company at an exercise price of $130. The Rights will be
exercisable only after 10 days following a public announcement that a person or
group has acquired more than 20% (exempting the stock ownership of Horace H.
Irvine II, the founder and Chairman of the Board of the Company, and certain
related persons and entities) of the Common Stock (the "Stock Acquisition
Date"), or 10 business days after such person or group announces a tender or
exchange offer which would result in its ownership of 25% or more of the Common
Stock, or 10 business days after a person owning 10% or more of the Common Stock
is determined by the Board to be an "Adverse Person," as defined in the Rights
Plan.
 
     If any person or group becomes the beneficial owner of 25% or more of the
Company's Common Stock except pursuant to a tender offer for all shares at a
price that a majority of the independent directors determines to be fair; if a
more-than-20% stockholder engages in a merger with the Company in which the
Company survives and its Common Stock remains outstanding and unchanged; if
certain other events involving the Company and a more-than-20% stockholder
occur; or, if under certain circumstances, the Board determines a 10% or more
stockholder to be an Adverse Person, then each Right not owned by such person or
related parties will entitle its holder to purchase, at the then current
exercise price of the Right, Common Stock of the Company (or, in certain
circumstances as determined by the Board, including the failure of the
stockholders to increase the authorized Common Stock as proposed herein, a
combination of cash, property, Common Stock or other securities or a reduction
in the exercise price) having a value of twice the Right's exercise price. In
such circumstances, the Company may also exchange one share of Common Stock for
each Right outstanding. In addition, if the Company is involved in a merger or
other business combination transaction with another person in which its Common
Stock is changed or converted, or sells or transfers more than 50% of its assets
or earning power to another person, each Right that has not previously been
exercised will entitle its holder to purchase, at the then current exercise
price of the Right, shares of Common Stock of such other person having a value
of twice the Right's exercise price.
 
     In general, the Company can redeem the Rights at $0.01 per Right at any
time prior to ten days following the Stock Acquisition Date. The Rights will
expire on September 11, 2005, unless earlier redeemed or exchanged.
 
     The Rights have certain anti-takeover effects, in that they can cause
substantial dilution to a person or group that attempts to acquire a significant
interest in the Company on terms not approved by the Board of Directors.
 
TRANSFER AGENT AND REGISTRAR
 
     The Transfer Agent and Registrar for the Company's Common Stock is The
First National Bank of Boston.
 
                                       47
<PAGE>   49
 
                              DESCRIPTION OF NOTES
 
     The Notes are to be issued under an indenture to be dated as of           ,
1997 (the "Indenture"), between the Company and State Street Bank and Trust
Company, as trustee (the "Trustee"), a copy of which has been filed as an
exhibit to the Registration Statement of which this Prospectus forms a part. The
terms of the Notes will include those stated in the Indenture and those made a
part of the Indenture by reference to the Trust Indenture Act of 1939, as
amended (the "TIA"), as in effect on the date of the Indenture. The Notes will
be subject to all such terms, and holders of the Notes are referred to the
Indenture and the TIA for a statement of such terms. The following is a summary
of important terms of the Notes and does not purport to be complete and is
qualified in its entirety by reference to the Indenture and the TIA. Reference
should be made to all provisions of the Indenture, including the definitions
therein of certain terms and all terms made a part of the Indenture by reference
to the TIA. As used in this "Description of Notes," the term "Company," unless
otherwise indicated or the context otherwise requires, refers only to Hadco
Corporation and does not include any of its subsidiaries including Zycon.
 
GENERAL
 
     The Notes will be general unsecured obligations of the Company subordinate
in right of payment to certain other obligations of the Company as described
under "-- Subordination," and convertible into Common Stock as described under
"-- Conversion." The Notes will be limited to $100,000,000 aggregate principal
amount ($115,000,000 if the over-allotment option is exercised in full), will be
issued in fully registered form only in denominations of $1,000 or any integral
multiple thereof and will mature on           , 2004, unless earlier redeemed at
the option of the Company or repurchased by the Company at the option of the
holder upon a Designated Event (as defined).
 
     The Notes will bear interest from           , 1997 at the annual rate set
forth on the cover page hereof, payable semiannually on           and
          , commencing on           , 1997, to holders of record at the close of
business on the preceding           and           , respectively (subject to
certain exceptions in the case of conversion, redemption or repurchase of such
Notes prior to the applicable interest payment date). Interest will be computed
on the basis of a 360-day year comprised of twelve 30-day months.
 
     Principal of and premium, if any, and interest on the Notes will be
payable, and the transfer of Notes will be registrable, and the Notes may be
presented for conversion, at the office or agency of the Company maintained for
such purposes in the Borough of Manhattan, State of New York, which shall
initially be an office or agency of the Trustee. In addition, payment of
interest may, at the option of the Company, be made by check mailed to the
address of the person entitled thereto as it appears in the Note register,
provided that the holder of Notes with an aggregate principal amount in excess
of $2,000,000 shall, at the election of such holder, be paid by wire transfer in
immediately available funds.
 
     No service charge will be made for any registration or transfer or exchange
of Notes, but the Company may require payment of a sum sufficient to cover any
tax or other governmental charge payable in connection therewith. The Company is
not required to exchange or register the transfer of (i) any Note for a period
of 15 days next preceding any selection of Notes to be redeemed, (ii) any Note
or portion thereof selected for redemption, (iii) any Note or portion thereof
surrendered for conversion, or (iv) any Note or portion thereof surrendered for
repurchase (and not withdrawn) in connection with a Designated Event.
 
     The Indenture does not contain any financial covenants or any restrictions
on the payment of dividends, the repurchase of securities of the Company or the
incurrence of Senior Indebtedness. The Indenture contains no covenants or other
provisions to afford protection to holders of Notes in the event of a highly
leveraged transaction or a change in control of the Company except to the
limited extent described under "-- Repurchase at Option of Holders Upon a
Designated Event" below.
 
                                       48
<PAGE>   50
 
CONVERSION
 
     The holders of Notes will be entitled at any time through the close of
business on the final maturity date of the Notes, subject to prior redemption or
repurchase, to convert any Notes or portions thereof (in denominations of $1,000
or multiples thereof) into Common Stock of the Company, at the conversion price
set forth on the cover page of this Prospectus, subject to adjustment as
described below. Except as described below, no adjustment will be made on
conversion of any Notes for interest accrued thereon or for dividends on any
Common Stock issued. If Notes are converted after a record date for the payment
of interest and on or prior to the close of business on the business day prior
to the next succeeding interest payment date, such Notes, other than Notes
called for redemption during such period, when submitted for conversion by the
holder, must be accompanied by funds equal to the interest payable on such
succeeding interest payment date on the principal amount so converted. No such
payment will be required with respect to interest payable on           , 2000.
The Company is not required to issue fractional shares of Common Stock upon
conversion of Notes and, in lieu thereof, will pay a cash adjustment based upon
the market price of the Common Stock on the last business day prior to the date
of conversion. In the case of Notes called for redemption, conversion rights
will expire at the close of business on the business day preceding the date
fixed for redemption, unless the Company defaults in payment of the redemption
price in which case the conversion right shall terminate on the date such
default is cured and such Note is redeemed. A Note for which a holder has
delivered a Designated Event purchase notice exercising the option of such
holder to require the Company to repurchase such Note may be converted only if
such notice is withdrawn by a written notice of withdrawal delivered by the
holder to the Company prior to the close of business on the business day
preceding the date fixed for repurchase.
 
     The right of conversion attaching to any Note may be exercised by the
holder by delivering the Note at the specified office of a conversion agent,
accompanied by a duly signed and completed notice of conversion, together with
any funds that may be required as described in the preceding paragraph. The
conversion date shall be the date on which the Note, the duly signed and
completed notice of conversion and any funds that may be required as described
in the preceding paragraph shall have been so delivered. A holder delivering a
Note for conversion will not be required to pay any taxes or duties payable in
respect of the issue or delivery of Common Stock on conversion, but will be
required to pay any tax or duty which may be payable in respect of any transfer
involved in the issue or delivery of the Common Stock in a name other than the
holder of the Note. Certificates representing shares of Common Stock will not be
issued or delivered unless all taxes and duties, if any, payable by the holder
have been paid.
 
     The initial conversion price of $          per share of Common Stock is
subject to adjustment (under formulae set forth in the Indenture) in certain
events, including: (i) the issuance of Common Stock as a dividend or
distribution on Common Stock of the Company; (ii) certain subdivisions and
combinations of the Common Stock; (iii) the issuance to all holders of Common
Stock of certain rights or warrants to purchase Common Stock at less than the
current market price of the Common Stock; (iv) the dividend or other
distribution to all holders of Common Stock of shares of capital stock of the
Company (other than Common Stock) or evidence of indebtedness of the Company or
assets (including securities, but excluding those rights, warrants, dividends
and distributions referred to above or paid exclusively in cash); (v) dividends
or other distributions consisting exclusively of cash (excluding any cash
portion of distributions referred to in clause (iv)) to all holders of Common
Stock to the extent that such distributions, combined together with (A) all
other such all-cash distributions made within the preceding 12 months in respect
of which no adjustment has been made plus (B) any cash and the fair market value
of other consideration payable in respect of any tender offers by the Company or
any of its subsidiaries for Common Stock concluded within the preceding 12
months in respect of which no adjustment has been made, exceeds 10% of the
Company's market capitalization (being the product of the then current market
price of the Common Stock times the number of shares of Common Stock then
outstanding) on the record date for such distribution; (vi) the purchase of
Common Stock pursuant to a tender offer made by the Company or any of its
subsidiaries to the extent
 
                                       49
<PAGE>   51
 
that the same involves an aggregate consideration that, together with (X) any
cash and the fair market value of any other consideration payable in any other
tender offer by the Company or any of its subsidiaries for Common Stock expiring
within the 12 months preceding such tender offer in respect of which no
adjustment has been made plus (Y) the aggregate amount of any such all-cash
distributions referred to in clause (v) above to all holders of Common Stock
within the 12 months preceding the expiration of such tender offer in respect of
which no adjustments have been made, exceeds 10% of the Company's market
capitalization on the expiration of such tender offer; and (vii) payment in
respect of a tender offer or exchange offer by a person other than the Company
or any subsidiary of the Company in which, as of the closing of the offer, the
Board of Directors is not recommending rejection of the offer. The adjustment
referred to in clause (vii) above will only be made if the tender offer or
exchange offer is for an amount which increases that person's ownership of
Common Stock to more than 25% of the total shares of Common Stock outstanding,
and only if the cash and value of any other consideration included in such
payment per share of Common Stock exceeds the current market price per share of
Common Stock on the business day next succeeding the last date on which tenders
or exchanges may be made pursuant to such tender or exchange. The adjustment
referred to in clause (vii) above will not be made, however, if, as of the
closing of the offer, the offering documents with respect to such offer disclose
a plan or an intention to cause the Company to engage in a consolidation or
merger of the Company or a sale of all or substantially all of the Company's
assets.
 
     Under the terms of the Rights Plan, upon conversion of any Notes prior to
the redemption or expiration of the Rights, the holders of such Notes will
receive, subject to certain limited conditions, an appropriate number of Rights
with respect to the shares of Common Stock issued upon such conversion. In
addition, the Indenture will provide that if the Company amends the Rights Plan
or implements a replacement or successor stockholders' rights plan, such rights
plan must provide that upon conversion of the Notes the holders will receive, in
addition to the Common Stock issuable upon such conversion, such rights whether
or not such rights have separated from the Common Stock at the time of such
conversion.
 
     In the case of (i) any reclassification or change of the Common Stock
(other than changes in par value or resulting from a subdivision or combination)
or (ii) a consolidation, merger or combination involving the Company or a sale
or conveyance to another corporation of the property and assets of the Company
as an entirety or substantially as an entirety, in each case as a result of
which holders of Common Stock shall be entitled to receive stock, other
securities, other property or assets (including cash) with respect to or in
exchange for such Common Stock, the holders of the Notes then outstanding will
be entitled thereafter to convert such Notes into the kind and amount of shares
of stock, other securities or other property or assets which they would have
owned or been entitled to receive upon such reclassification, change,
consolidation, merger, combination, sale or conveyance had such Notes been
converted into Common Stock immediately prior to such reclassification, change,
consolidation, merger, combination, sale or conveyance (assuming, in a case in
which the Company's stockholders may exercise rights of election, that a holder
of Notes would not have exercised any rights of election as to the stock, other
securities or other property or assets receivable in connection therewith and
received per share the kind and amount received per share by a plurality of
nonelecting shares).
 
     In the event of a taxable distribution to holders of Common Stock (or other
transaction) which results in any adjustment of the conversion price, the
holders of Notes may, in certain circumstances, be deemed to have received a
distribution subject to United States income tax as a dividend; in certain other
circumstances, the absence of such an adjustment may result in a taxable
dividend to the holders of Common Stock. See "Certain Federal Income Tax
Considerations."
 
     The Company from time to time may, to the extent permitted by law, reduce
the conversion price of the Notes by any amount for any period of at least 20
days, in which case the Company shall give at least 15 days' notice of such
decrease, if the Board of Directors has made a determination that such decrease
would be in the best interests of the Company, which determination shall be
conclusive. The Company may at its option, make such reductions in the
conversion price, in addition to those set forth
 
                                       50
<PAGE>   52
 
above, as the Board of Directors deems advisable to avoid or diminish any income
tax to holders of Common Stock resulting from any dividend or distribution of
stock (or rights to acquire stock) or from any event treated as such for income
tax purposes. See "Certain Federal Income Tax Considerations."
 
     No adjustment in the conversion price will be required unless such
adjustment would require a change of at least 1% in the conversion price then in
effect; provided that any adjustment that would otherwise be required to be made
shall be carried forward and taken into account in any subsequent adjustment.
Except as stated above, the conversion price will not be adjusted for the
issuance of Common Stock or any securities convertible into or exchangeable for
Common Stock or carrying the right to purchase any of the foregoing.
 
OPTIONAL REDEMPTION BY THE COMPANY
 
     The Notes are not redeemable at the option of the Company prior to
          , 2000. At any time on or after that date the Notes may be redeemed at
the Company's option on at least 20 but not more than 60 days' notice, as a
whole or, from time to time in part, at the following prices (expressed in
percentages of the principal amount), together with accrued interest to, but
excluding, the date fixed for redemption; provided that if a redemption date is
an interest payment date, the semi-annual payment of interest becoming due on
such date shall be payable to the holder of record as of the relevant record
date.
 
     If redeemed during the 12-month period beginning           , 2000
(beginning           , 2000 and ending           , 2001 in the case of the first
such period):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                        REDEMPTION
                                    YEAR                                   PRICE
                                    ----                               -------------
        <S>                                                            <C>
        2000.........................................................               %
        2001.........................................................
        2002.........................................................
        2003.........................................................
</TABLE>
 
and 100% at          , 2004.
 
     If fewer than all the Notes are to be redeemed, the Trustee will select the
Notes to be redeemed in principal amounts of $1,000 or multiples thereof by lot
or, in its sole discretion, on a pro rata basis. If any Note is to be redeemed
in part only, a new Note or Notes in principal amount equal to the unredeemed
principal portion thereof will be issued. If a portion of a holder's Notes is
selected for partial redemption and such holder converts a portion of such
Notes, such converted portion shall be deemed to be taken from the portion
selected for redemption.
 
     No sinking fund is provided for the Notes.
 
REPURCHASE AT OPTION OF HOLDERS UPON A DESIGNATED EVENT
 
     The Indenture provides that if a Designated Event (as defined) occurs, each
holder of Notes shall have the right, at the holder's option, to require the
Company to repurchase all of such holder's Notes, or any portion thereof that is
an integral multiple of $1,000, on the date (the "repurchase date") that is 40
calendar days after the date of the Company Notice (as defined below), for cash
at a price equal to 100% of the principal amount of the Notes, together with
accrued interest, if any, to (but excluding) the repurchase date (the
"repurchase price"), provided, however, that if a repurchase date is an interest
payment date, the semi-annual payment of interest becoming due on such date
shall be payable to the holder of record as of the relevant record date.
 
     Within 15 days after the occurrence of a Designated Event, the Company is
obligated to mail to all holders of record of the Notes a notice (the "Company
Notice") of the occurrence of such Designated Event and of the repurchase right
arising as a result thereof. The Company must deliver a copy of the Company
Notice to the Trustee and cause a copy or a summary of such notice to be
published in a
 
                                       51
<PAGE>   53
 
newspaper of general circulation in The City of New York. To exercise the
repurchase right, a holder of such Notes must deliver, on or before the 40th day
after the Company Notice, written notice to the Company (or an agent designated
by the Company for such purpose) of the holder's exercise of such right,
together with the Notes with respect to which the right is being exercised, duly
endorsed for transfer. Such notice of exercise may be withdrawn by the holder by
a written notice of withdrawal delivered to the Company at any time prior to the
close of business on the last business day preceding the repurchase date.
 
     "Designated Event" means a Change in Control (as defined) or a Termination
of Trading (as defined).
 
     "Change in Control" means an event or series of events after the original
issuance of the Notes as a result of which (i) any "person" or "group" (as such
terms are used in Sections 13(d) and 14(d) of the Exchange Act) is or becomes
the "beneficial owner" (as defined in Rules 13d-3 and 13d-5 under the Exchange
Act) of shares representing more than 50% of the combined voting power of the
then outstanding securities entitled to vote generally in elections of directors
of the Company ("Voting Stock"); (ii) the stockholders of the Company approve
any plan or proposal for the liquidation, dissolution or winding up of the
Company, (iii) the Company consolidates with or merges into any other
corporation, or conveys, transfers or leases all or substantially all of its
assets to any person, or any other corporation merges into the Company, and in
the case of any such transaction, the outstanding Common Stock of the Company is
changed or exchanged into or for other assets or securities as a result, unless
the stockholders of the Company immediately before such transaction own,
directly or indirectly immediately following such transaction, at least 51% of
the combined voting power of the outstanding voting securities of the
corporation resulting from such transaction in substantially the same proportion
as their ownership of the Voting Stock immediately before such transaction; or
(iv) any time Continuing Directors (as defined) do not constitute a majority of
the Board of Directors of the Company (or, if applicable, a successor
corporation to the Company); provided that a Change in Control shall not be
deemed to have occurred if either (x) the last sale price of the Common Stock
for any five trading days during the ten trading days immediately preceding the
Change in Control is at least equal to 105% of the conversion price in effect on
such day or (y) in the case of a merger or consolidation, at least 95% of the
consideration (excluding cash payments for fractional shares or for dissenters'
appraisal rights) in such merger or consolidation otherwise constituting the
Designated Event consists of common stock traded on a United States national
securities exchange or quoted on the Nasdaq National Market (or which will be so
traded or quoted when issued or exchanged in connection with such Change in
Control) and as a result of such transaction or transactions such Notes become
convertible solely into such common stock.
 
     "Continuing Director" means at any date a member of the Company's Board of
Directors (i) who was a member of such board on           , 1997 or (ii) who was
nominated or elected by at least a majority of the directors who were Continuing
Directors at the time of such nomination or election or whose election to the
Company's Board of Directors was recommended or endorsed by at least a majority
of the directors who were Continuing Directors at the time of such nomination or
election or such lesser number comprising a majority of a nominating committee
if authority for such nominations or elections has been delegated to a
nominating committee whose authority and composition has been approved by at
least a majority of the directors who were Continuing Directors at the time such
committee was formed. (Under this definition, if the current Board of Directors
of the Company were to approve a new director or directors and then resign, no
Change in Control would occur even though the current Board of Directors would
thereafter cease to be in office.)
 
     A "Termination of Trading" shall have occurred if the Common Stock (or
other common stock into which the Notes are then convertible) is neither listed
for trading on a United States national securities exchange nor approved for
trading on an established automated over-the-counter trading market in the
United States.
 
                                       52
<PAGE>   54
 
     No quantitative or other established meaning has been given to the phrase
"all or substantially all" (which appears in the definition of Change in
Control) by courts which have interpreted this phrase in various contexts. In
interpreting this phrase, courts, among other things, make a subjective
determination as to the portion of assets conveyed, considering such factors as
the value of assets conveyed, the proportion of an entity's income derived from
the assets conveyed and the significance of those assets to the ongoing business
of the entity. To the extent the meaning of such phrase is uncertain,
uncertainty will exist as to whether or not a Change in Control may have
occurred (and, accordingly, as to whether or not the holders of Notes will have
the right to require the Company to repurchase their Notes).
 
     If a Designated Event were to occur, there can be no assurance that the
Company would have sufficient financial resources, or would be able to arrange
financing, to pay the repurchase price for all Notes tendered by holders
thereof. In addition, the terms of certain of the Company's existing debt
agreements prohibit the Company from repurchasing any Notes and also identify
certain events that would constitute Designated Events, as well as certain other
change in control events with respect to the Company or certain of its
subsidiaries, which would constitute an event of default under such debt
agreements. Any future credit agreements or other agreements relating to other
indebtedness (including other Senior Indebtedness) to which the Company becomes
a party may contain similar restrictions and provisions. In the event a
Designated Event occurs at a time when the Company is prohibited from
repurchasing Notes, the Company could seek the consent of its lenders to the
repurchase of the Notes or could attempt to refinance the borrowings that
contain such prohibition. If the Company does not obtain such a consent or repay
such borrowings, the Company would remain prohibited from repurchasing Notes.
Any failure by the Company to repurchase the Notes when required following a
Designated Event would result in an Event of Default under the Indenture whether
or not such repurchase is permitted by the subordination provisions of the
Indenture. Any such default may, in turn, cause a default under Senior
Indebtedness of the Company. Moreover, the occurrence of a Designated Event may
cause an event of default under Senior Indebtedness of the Company. As a result,
in each case, any repurchase of the Notes would, absent a waiver, be prohibited
under the subordination provisions of the Indenture until the Senior
Indebtedness is paid in full. See "-- Subordination" below and "Risk
Factors -- Subordination of Notes and Absence of Financial Covenants." No Notes
may be repurchased at the option of holders upon a Designated Event if there has
occurred and is continuing an Event of Default described under "-- Events of
Default and Remedies" below (other than a default in the payment of the
repurchase price with respect to such Notes on the repurchase date).
 
     The foregoing provisions would not necessarily afford holders of the Notes
protection in the event of a highly leveraged transaction, a change in control
of the Company or other transactions involving the Company that may adversely
affect holders. The Company could, in the future, enter into certain
transactions, including certain recapitalizations of the Company, that would
increase the amount of Senior Indebtedness (or other indebtedness) outstanding
at such time or result in an actual change in control of the Company but that
would not constitute a Change in Control giving rise to the right of the holders
to cause the Company to repurchase the Notes. There are no restrictions in the
Indenture or the Notes on the creation of additional Senior Indebtedness (or any
other indebtedness) of the Company or any of its subsidiaries and the incurrence
of significant amounts of additional indebtedness could have an adverse impact
on the Company's ability to service its debt, including the Notes. The Notes are
subordinate in right of payment to all existing and future Senior Indebtedness
as described under "-- Subordination" below.
 
     Certain leveraged transactions and transactions involving a change in
control of the Company sponsored by the Company's management or an affiliate of
the Company could constitute a Change in Control that would give rise to the
repurchase right. The Indenture does not provide the Company's Board of
Directors with the right to limit or waive the repurchase right in the event of
any such leveraged transaction or change in control. In addition, the right to
require the Company to repurchase Notes as a result of a Change in Control could
have the effect of delaying, deferring or
 
                                       53
<PAGE>   55
 
preventing a change of control or other attempts to acquire control of the
Company unless arrangements have been made to enable the Company to repurchase
all of the Notes at the repurchase date. Consequently, the right may render more
difficult or discourage a merger, consolidation or tender offer (even if such
transaction is supported by the Company's Board of Directors or is favorable to
the stockholders), the assumption of control by a holder of a large block of the
Company's shares and the removal of incumbent management. The Designated Event
repurchase right, however, is not the result of management's knowledge of any
specific effort to accumulate shares of Common Stock or to obtain control of the
Company by means of a merger, tender offer, solicitation or otherwise. Instead,
the Designated Event repurchase right has resulted from negotiations between the
Company and the Note Underwriters.
 
     No modification of the Indenture regarding the provisions on repurchase at
the option of any holder of a Note is permissible without the consent of the
holder of the Note so affected.
 
     The Company will comply with the provisions of Rule 13e-4, Rule 14e-1 and
any other tender offer rules under the Exchange Act to the extent then
applicable, and otherwise comply with all federal and state securities laws in
connection with any offer by the Company to purchase Notes at the option of the
holders upon a Designated Event. Rule 13e-4 under the Exchange Act requires,
among other things, the dissemination of certain information to security holders
in the event of an issuer tender offer and may apply in the event that the
repurchase option becomes available to holders of the Notes.
 
SUBORDINATION
 
     The indebtedness evidenced by the Notes is, to the extent provided in the
Indenture, subordinate to the prior payment in full of all Senior Indebtedness
(as defined) whether presently outstanding or hereafter incurred or created.
Upon any distribution of assets of the Company upon any dissolution, winding up,
liquidation or reorganization of the Company, the payment of the principal of,
or premium, if any, and interest on the Notes is to be subordinated to the
extent provided in the Indenture in right of payment to the prior payment in
full, in cash or in such other form of payment as may be acceptable to the
holders thereof, of all Senior Indebtedness. Moreover, in the event of any
acceleration of the Notes because of an Event of Default, the holders of any
Senior Indebtedness then outstanding would be entitled to payment in full in
cash or such other form of payment as may be acceptable to the holders thereof
of all such Senior Indebtedness before the holders of the Notes are entitled to
receive any payment or distribution in respect thereof.
 
     The Company also may not make any payment upon or in respect of the Notes
if (i) a default in the payment of principal of, premium, if any, interest, or
other payment due on Senior Indebtedness occurs and is continuing beyond any
applicable period of grace or (ii) any other default occurs and is continuing
with respect to Designated Senior Indebtedness (as defined below) that permits
holders of the Designated Senior Indebtedness as to which such default related
to accelerate its maturity and the Trustee and the Company receive a notice of
such default (a "Payment Blockage Notice") from a holder of Designated Senior
Indebtedness or its representative or agent. Payments on the Notes may and shall
be resumed (a) in case of payment default, on the date on which such default is
cured or waived and (b) in case of a nonpayment default, on the earlier of the
date on which such nonpayment default is cured or waived or 179 days after the
date on which the applicable Payment Blockage Notice is received. No new period
of payment blockage may be commenced pursuant to a Payment Blockage Notice
unless (i) 365 days have elapsed since the first day of the effectiveness of the
immediately prior Payment Blockage Notice and (ii) all scheduled payments of
principal, premium, if any, and interest on the Notes that have become due have
been paid in full in cash or the Trustee or the Noteholders shall not have
instituted proceedings to enforce the Noteholders' right to receive such
payments. No default (whether or not such event of default is on the same issue
of Designated Senior Indebtedness) that existed or was continuing on the date of
delivery of any Payment Blockage Notice shall be, or be made, the basis for a
subsequent Payment Blockage Notice.
 
                                       54
<PAGE>   56
 
     The term "Senior Indebtedness" means the principal of, premium, if any,
interest on (including any interest accruing after the filing of a petition by
or against the Company under any bankruptcy law, whether or not allowed as a
claim after such filing in any proceeding under such bankruptcy law), and any
other payment due pursuant to, any of the following, whether outstanding on the
date of the Indenture or thereafter incurred or created: (a) all indebtedness of
the Company for money borrowed or evidenced by notes, debentures, bonds, similar
instruments or other debt securities (including, but not limited to, purchase
money mortgages and any such indebtedness which is convertible or exchangeable
for securities of the Company); (b) all indebtedness of the Company due and
owing with respect to letters of credit, bankers' acceptances or similar credit
transactions (including, but not limited to, reimbursement obligations with
respect thereto); (c) all indebtedness or other obligations of the Company due
and owing with respect to interest rate and currency swap agreements, cap,
floor, collar and option agreements, currency spot and forward contracts and
other similar agreements and arrangements; (d) all indebtedness consisting of
commitment or standby fees due and payable to lending institutions with respect
to credit facilities or letters of credit, bankers' acceptances or similar
credit transactions; (e) all obligations of the Company for payment of money
under leases required or permitted to be capitalized under generally accepted
accounting principles; (f) all indebtedness or obligations of others of the
kinds described in any of the preceding clauses (a), (b), (c), (d) or (e)
assumed by or guaranteed in any manner by the Company or in effect guaranteed
(directly or indirectly) by the Company through an agreement to purchase,
contingent or otherwise, and all obligations of the Company under any such
guarantee or other arrangements; and (g) all renewals, extensions, refundings,
deferrals, amendments or modifications of indebtedness or obligations of the
kinds described in any of the preceding clauses (a), (b), (c), (d), (e) or (f),
unless in the case of any particular indebtedness, obligation, renewal,
extension, refunding, amendment, modification or supplement, the instrument or
other document creating or evidencing the same or the assumption or guarantee of
the same expressly provides that such indebtedness, obligation, renewal,
extension, refunding, amendment, modification or supplement is subordinate to,
or is not superior to, or is pari passu with, the Notes; provided that Senior
Indebtedness shall not include (i) any indebtedness of any kind of the Company
to any subsidiary of the Company, a majority of the voting stock of which is
owned, directly or indirectly, by the Company, (ii) indebtedness for trade
payables or constituting the deferred purchase price of inventory, material or
services incurred in the ordinary course of business or (iii) the Notes.
 
     The term "Designated Senior Indebtedness" means all Senior Indebtedness
under the Credit Facility and all other Senior Indebtedness if the instrument
creating or evidencing the same or the assumption or guarantee thereof (or
related agreements or documents to which the Company is a party) expressly
provides that such indebtedness shall be "Designated Senior Indebtedness" for
purposes of the Indenture (provided that such instrument, agreement or other
document may place limitations and conditions on the right of holders of such
Senior Indebtedness to exercise the rights of Designated Senior Indebtedness).
 
     In the event that, notwithstanding the foregoing, the Trustee or any holder
of Notes receives any payment or distribution of assets of the Company of any
kind in contravention of any of the terms of the Indenture, whether in cash,
property or securities, including, without limitation, by way of set-off or
otherwise, in respect of the Notes before all Senior Indebtedness is paid in
full in cash or such other form of payment acceptable to the holders of such
Senior Indebtedness, then such payment or distribution will be held by the
recipient in trust for the benefit of the holders of Senior Indebtedness of the
Company, and will be immediately paid over or delivered to the holders of Senior
Indebtedness of the Company or their representative or representatives to the
extent necessary to make payment in full in cash or such other form of payment
acceptable to the holders of such Senior Indebtedness of all Senior Indebtedness
of the Company remaining unpaid, after giving effect to any concurrent payment
or distribution, or provision therefor, to or for the holders of Senior
Indebtedness of the Company.
 
     The Notes are obligations exclusively of the Company. As a significant
portion of the Company's consolidated operations is conducted through
subsidiaries, the cash flow and the consequent ability to
 
                                       55
<PAGE>   57
 
service debt, including the Notes, of the Company is partially dependent upon
the earnings of such subsidiaries and the distribution of those earnings, or
upon loans or other payments of funds by those subsidiaries, to the Company.
Such subsidiaries are separate and distinct legal entities, and have no
obligation, contingent or otherwise, to pay any amounts due pursuant to the
Notes or to make any funds available therefor, whether by dividends,
distributions, loans or other payments. In addition, the payment of dividends or
distributions and the making of loans and advances to the Company by any such
subsidiaries may be subject to statutory or contractual restrictions, and may be
contingent upon the earnings of those subsidiaries and subject to various
business considerations. Any right of the Company to receive assets of
subsidiaries upon their liquidation or reorganization (and the consequent right
of the holders of the Notes to participate in these assets) would be effectively
subordinated to the claims of that subsidiary's creditors (including trade
creditors), except to the extent that the Company is itself recognized as a
creditor of such subsidiary, in which case the claims of the Company would still
be subordinate to any security interests in the assets of such subsidiary and
any indebtedness of such subsidiary senior to that held by the Company.
 
     As of January 25, 1997, the Company had approximately $218 million of
indebtedness outstanding that would have constituted Senior Indebtedness and the
Company's subsidiaries had outstanding indebtedness and other liabilities of
approximately $57 million (excluding intercompany liabilities and liabilities of
a type not required to be reflected as liabilities on the balance sheets of such
subsidiaries in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles) to
which the Notes would have been effectively subordinated. The Indenture will not
limit the amount of additional indebtedness, including Senior Indebtedness,
which the Company can create, incur, assume or guarantee, nor will the Indenture
limit the amount of indebtedness which any subsidiary of the Company can create,
incur, assume or guarantee.
 
     No provision contained in the Indenture or the Notes will affect the
obligation of the Company, which is absolute and unconditional, to pay, when
due, principal of, premium, if any, and interest on, the Notes. The
subordination provisions of the Indenture and the Notes will not prevent the
occurrence of any default or Event of Default or limit the rights of any holder
of Notes to pursue any other rights or remedies with respect to the Notes.
 
     As a result of these subordination provisions, in the event of the
liquidation, bankruptcy, reorganization, insolvency, receivership or similar
proceeding or an assignment for the benefit of the creditors of the Company or a
marshaling of assets or liabilities of the Company and its subsidiaries, holders
of the Notes may receive ratably less than other creditors.
 
EVENTS OF DEFAULT AND REMEDIES
 
     An Event of Default is defined in the Indenture as being: (i) a default in
payment of the principal of, or premium, if any, on the Notes (whether or not
such payment is prohibited by the subordination provisions of the Indenture);
(ii) default for 30 days in payment of any installment of interest on the Notes
(whether or not such payment is prohibited by the subordination provisions of
the Indenture); (iii) default by the Company for 45 days after notice given in
accordance with the Indenture in the observance or performance of any other
covenants in the Indenture; (iv) default in the payment of the repurchase price
in respect of the Note on the repurchase date therefor (whether or not such
payment is prohibited by the subordination provisions of the Indenture); (v)
failure to provide timely notice of a Designated Event; (vi) failure of the
Company or any Significant Subsidiary (as defined) to make any payment at
maturity, including any applicable grace period, in respect of Indebtedness
(which term as used in the Indenture means obligations (other than non-recourse
obligations) of, or guaranteed or assumed by, the Company or any Significant
Subsidiary for borrowed money or evidenced by bonds, notes or similar
instruments) in an amount in excess of $10 million and continuance of such
failure for 30 days after notice given in accordance with the Indenture; (vii)
default by the Company or any Significant Subsidiary with respect to any
Indebtedness, which default results in the acceleration of Indebtedness in an
amount in excess of $10 million without such Indebtedness having been discharged
or such acceleration having been rescinded or annulled for 30 days after notice
given in accordance
 
                                       56
<PAGE>   58
 
with the Indenture; or (viii) certain events involving bankruptcy, insolvency or
reorganization of the Company or any Significant Subsidiary.
 
     The Indenture provides that the Trustee shall, within 90 days after the
occurrence of a default, give to the registered holders of the Notes notice of
all uncured defaults known to it, but the Trustee shall be protected in
withholding such notice if it in good faith determines that the withholding of
such notice is in the best interest of such registered holders, except in the
case of a default in the payment of the principal of, or premium, if any, or
interest on, any of the Notes when due or in the payment of any redemption or
repurchase obligation.
 
     The Indenture provides that if any Event of Default shall have occurred and
be continuing, the Trustee or the holders of not less than 25% in principal
amount of the Notes then outstanding by notice to the Company and the Trustee
may declare the principal of and premium, if any, on the Notes to be due and
payable immediately, but if the Company shall cure all defaults (except the
nonpayment of interest on, premium, if any, and principal of any Notes which
shall have become due by acceleration) and certain other conditions are met,
such declaration may be canceled and past defaults may be waived by the holders
of a majority in principal amount of Notes then outstanding. If an Event of
Default resulting from certain events of bankruptcy, insolvency or
reorganization were to occur, all unpaid principal of and accrued interest on
the outstanding Notes will become due and payable immediately without any
declaration or other act on the part of the Trustee or any holders of Notes,
subject to certain limitations.
 
     The Indenture provides that the holders of a majority in principal amount
of the outstanding Notes may direct the time, method and place of conducting any
proceeding for any remedy available to the Trustee or exercising any trust or
power conferred on the Trustee, subject to certain limitations specified in the
Indenture. Before proceeding to exercise any right or power under the Indenture
at the direction of such holders, the Trustee shall be entitled to receive from
such holders reasonable security or indemnity against the costs, expenses and
liabilities which might be incurred by it in complying with any such direction.
The right of a holder to institute a proceeding with respect to the Indenture is
subject to certain conditions precedent, including the written notice by such
holder of an Event of Default and an offer to indemnify the Trustee, along with
the written request by the holders of not less than 25% in principal amount of
the outstanding Notes that such a proceeding be instituted, but the holder has
an absolute right to institute suit for the enforcement of payment of the
principal of, and premium, if any, and interest on, such holder's Notes when due
and to enforce such holder's right to convert such Notes.
 
     The holders of not less than a majority in principal amount of the
outstanding Notes may on behalf of the holders of all Notes waive any past
defaults, except (i) a default in payment of the principal of, or premium, if
any, or interest on, any Note when due, (ii) a failure by the Company to convert
any Notes into Common Stock or (iii) in respect of certain provisions of the
Indenture which cannot be modified or amended without the consent of the holder
of each outstanding Note affected thereby.
 
     The Company is required to furnish to the Trustee annually within 120 days
of the end of the fiscal year a statement of certain officers of the Company
stating whether or not to the best of their knowledge the Company is in default
in the performance and observation of certain terms of the Indenture and, if
they have knowledge that the Company is in default, specifying such default and
its status. The Company is also required, upon becoming aware of any default or
Event of Default, to deliver to the Trustee a statement specifying such default
or Event of Default and the action the Company has taken, is taking or proposes
to take with respect thereto.
 
LIMITATION ON MERGER, SALE OR CONSOLIDATION
 
     The Indenture provides that the Company may not, directly or indirectly,
consolidate with or merge with or into another person or sell, lease, convey or
transfer all or substantially all of its assets (computed on a consolidated
basis), whether in a single transaction or a series of related transactions, to
another person or group of affiliated persons, unless (i) either (a) the Company
is the surviving
 
                                       57
<PAGE>   59
 
entity or (b) the resulting, surviving or transferee entity is a corporation
organized under the laws of the United States, any state thereof or the District
of Columbia and expressly assumes by written agreement all of the obligations of
the Company in connection with the Notes and the Indenture; (ii) no default or
Event of Default shall exist or shall occur immediately after giving effect on a
pro forma basis to such transaction; and (iii) certain other conditions are
satisfied.
 
     Upon any consolidation or merger or any transfer of all or substantially
all of the assets of the Company in accordance with the foregoing, the successor
corporation formed by such consolidation or into which the Company is merged or
to which such transfer is made, shall succeed to, and be substituted for, and
may exercise every right and power of, the Company under the Indenture with the
same effect as if such successor corporation had been named therein as the
Company, and the Company will be released from its obligations under the
Indenture and the Notes, except as to any obligations that arise from or as a
result of such transaction.
 
MODIFICATIONS OF THE INDENTURE
 
     The Indenture contains provisions permitting the Company and the Trustee,
with the consent of the holders of not less than a majority in principal amount
of the Notes at the time outstanding, to modify the Indenture or any
supplemental indenture or the rights of the holders of the Notes, except that no
such modification shall (i) extend the fixed maturity of any Note, reduce the
rate or extend the time for payment of interest thereon, reduce the principal
amount thereof or premium, if any, thereon, reduce any amount payable upon
redemption or repurchase thereof, impair or change in any respect adverse to the
holders of Notes the obligation of the Company to make repurchase of any Note
upon the happening of a Designated Event, impair or adversely affect the right
of a holder to institute suit for the payment thereof, change the currency in
which the Notes are payable, or impair or change in any respect adverse to the
holder of the Notes, the right to convert the Notes into Common Stock subject to
the terms set forth in the Indenture or modify the provisions of the Indenture
with respect to the subordination of the Notes in a manner adverse to the
holders of the Notes, without the consent of the holder of each Note so
affected, or (ii) reduce the aforesaid percentage of Notes, without the consent
of the holders of all of the Notes then outstanding.
 
TAXATION OF NOTES
 
     See "Certain Federal Income Tax Considerations" for a discussion of certain
federal tax aspects which will apply to holders of Notes.
 
SATISFACTION AND DISCHARGE
 
     The Company may discharge its obligations under the Indenture while Notes
remain outstanding if (i) all outstanding Notes will become due and payable at
their scheduled maturity within one year or (ii) all outstanding Notes are
scheduled for redemption within one year and, in either case, the Company has
deposited with the Trustee an amount sufficient to pay and discharge all
outstanding Notes on the date of their scheduled maturity or the scheduled date
of redemption.
 
GOVERNING LAW
 
     The Indenture and Notes will be governed by and construed in accordance
with the laws of the State of New York.
 
CONCERNING THE TRUSTEE
 
     State Street Bank and Trust Company, the Trustee under the Indenture, has
been appointed by the Company as the initial paying agent, conversion agent,
registrar and custodian with regard to the Notes. The Company may maintain
deposit accounts and conduct other banking transactions with the Trustee or its
affiliates in the ordinary course of business, and the Trustee and its
affiliates may from
 
                                       58
<PAGE>   60
 
time to time in the future provide banking and other services to the Company in
the ordinary course of their business.
 
     During the existence of an Event of Default, the Trustee will exercise such
rights and powers vested in it under the Indenture and use the same degree of
care and skill in its exercise as a prudent person would exercise under the
circumstances in the conduct of such person's own affairs. The Indenture and the
TIA will contain certain limitations on the rights of the Trustee, should it
become a creditor of the Company, to obtain payment of claims in certain cases
or to realize on certain property received in respect of any such claim as
security or otherwise. Subject to the TIA, the Trustee will be permitted to
engage in other transactions, provided, however, that if it acquires any
conflicting interest (as described in the TIA), it must eliminate such conflict
or resign.
 
                                       59
<PAGE>   61
 
                   CERTAIN FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSIDERATIONS
 
     The following is a general discussion of certain United States federal
income tax considerations relevant to holders of the Notes. This discussion is
based upon the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the "Code"), Treasury
Regulations, Internal Revenue Service ("IRS") rulings and judicial decisions now
in effect, all of which are subject to change (possibly with retroactive effect)
or different interpretations. This discussion does not purport to deal with all
aspects of federal income taxation that may be relevant to a particular
investor's decision to purchase the Notes, and it is not intended to be wholly
applicable to all categories of investors, some of which, such as dealers in
securities, banks, insurance companies, tax-exempt organizations and non-United
States persons, may be subject to special rules. In addition, this discussion is
limited to persons that purchase the Notes in the Note Offering and hold the
Notes as a "capital asset" within the meaning of Section 1221 of the Code.
 
     ALL PROSPECTIVE PURCHASERS OF THE NOTES ARE ADVISED TO CONSULT THEIR OWN
TAX ADVISORS REGARDING THE FEDERAL, STATE, LOCAL AND FOREIGN TAX CONSEQUENCES OF
THE PURCHASE, OWNERSHIP AND DISPOSITION OF THE NOTES AND THE COMMON STOCK.
 
CONVERSION OF NOTES INTO COMMON STOCK
 
     In general, no gain or loss will be recognized for federal income tax
purposes on a conversion of the Notes into shares of Common Stock. However, cash
paid in lieu of a fractional share of Common Stock will result in taxable gain
(or loss), which will be capital gain or loss, to the extent that the amount of
such cash exceeds (or is exceeded by) the portion of the adjusted basis of the
Note allocable to such fractional share. The adjusted basis of shares of Common
Stock received on conversion will equal the adjusted basis of the Note
converted, reduced by the portion of adjusted basis allocated to any fractional
share of Common Stock exchanged for cash. The holding period of an investor in
the Common Stock received on conversion will include the period during which the
converted Notes were held.
 
     The conversion price of the Notes is subject to adjustment under certain
circumstances. See "Description of Notes -- Conversion." Section 305 of the Code
and the Treasury Regulations issued thereunder may treat the holders of the
Notes as having received a constructive distribution, resulting in ordinary
income (subject to a possible dividends received deduction in the case of
corporate holders) to the extent of the Company's then current and/or
accumulated earnings and profits, if and to the extent that certain adjustments
in the conversion price that may occur in limited circumstances (particularly an
adjustment to reflect a taxable dividend to holders of Common Stock) increase
the proportionate interest of a holder of Notes in the fully diluted Common
Stock, whether or not such holder ever exercises its conversion privilege.
Moreover, if there is not a full adjustment to the conversion price of the Notes
to reflect a stock dividend or other event increasing the proportionate interest
of the holders of outstanding Common Stock in the assets or earnings and profits
of the Company, then such increase in the proportionate interest of the holders
of the Common Stock generally will be treated as a distribution to such Common
Stock holders, taxable as ordinary income (subject to a possible dividends
received deduction in the case of corporate holders) to the extent of the
Company's then current and/or accumulated earnings.
 
MARKET DISCOUNT
 
     Investors acquiring Notes pursuant to this Prospectus should note that the
resale of those Notes may be adversely affected by the market discount
provisions of sections 1276 through 1278 of the Code. Under the market discount
rules, if a holder of a Note purchases it at a market discount (i.e., at a price
below its stated redemption price at maturity) in excess of a
statutorily-defined de minimis amount and thereafter recognizes gain upon a
disposition or retirement of the Note, then the lesser of the gain recognized or
the portion of the market discount that accrued on a ratable basis (or, if
 
                                       60
<PAGE>   62
 
elected, on a constant interest rate basis) generally will be treated as
ordinary income at the time of the disposition. Moreover, any market discount on
a Note may be taxable to an investor to the extent of appreciation at the time
of certain otherwise non-taxable transactions (e.g., gifts). Any accrued market
discount not previously taken into income prior to a conversion of a Note,
however, may (pursuant to Committee Report) carry over to the Common Stock
received on conversion and be treated as ordinary income upon a subsequent
disposition of such Common Stock to the extent of any gain recognized on such
disposition. In addition, absent an election to include market discount in
income as it accrues, a holder of a market discount debt instrument may be
required to defer a portion of any interest expense that otherwise may be
deductible on any indebtedness incurred or maintained to purchase or carry such
debt instrument until the holder disposes of the debt instrument in a taxable
transaction.
 
SALE, EXCHANGE OR RETIREMENT OF NOTES
 
     Each holder of Notes generally will recognize gain or loss upon the sale,
exchange, redemption, repurchase, retirement or other disposition of those Notes
measured by the difference (if any) between (i) the amount of cash and the fair
market value of any property received (except to the extent that such cash or
other property is attributable to the payment of accrued interest not previously
included in income, which amount will be taxable as ordinary income), and (ii)
the holder's adjusted tax basis in those Notes (including any market discount
previously included in income by the holder). Each holder of Common Stock into
which the Notes are converted, in general, will recognize gain or loss upon the
sale, exchange, redemption, or other disposition of the Common Stock measured
under rules similar to those described in the preceding sentence for the Notes.
Special rules may apply to redemptions of Common Stock which may result in
different treatment. Any such gain or loss recognized on the sale, exchange,
redemption, repurchase, retirement or other disposition of a Note or share of
Common Stock should be capital gain or loss (except as discussed under
"-- Market Discount" above), and would be long-term capital gain or loss if the
Note or the Common Stock had been held for more than one year at the time of the
sale or exchange. An investor's initial basis in a Note will be the cash price
paid therefor.
 
BACK-UP WITHHOLDING
 
     Certain "reportable payments," including interest payments, and, under
certain circumstances, principal payments on the Notes, as well as dividend
payments on the Common Stock, may be subject to "back-up withholding" at a rate
of 31%. These back-up withholding rules apply if the holder, among other things,
(i) fails to furnish a social security number or other taxpayer identification
number ("TIN") certified under penalties of perjury within a reasonable time
after the request therefor, (ii) furnishes an incorrect TIN, (iii) fails to
report properly interest or dividends, or (iv) under certain circumstances,
fails to provide a certified statement, signed under penalties of perjury, that
the TIN furnished is the correct number and that the holder is not subject to
back-up withholding. A holder who does not provide the Company with its correct
TIN also may be subject to penalties imposed by the IRS. Any amount withheld
from a payment to a holder under the back-up withholding rules is creditable
against the holder's federal income tax liability, provided the required
information is furnished to the IRS. Back-up withholding will not apply,
however, with respect to payments made to certain holders, including
corporations, tax-exempt organizations and certain foreign persons, provided
their exemption from back-up withholding is properly established.
 
     The Company will report to the holders of Notes and Common Stock and to the
IRS the amount of any "reportable payments" for each calendar year and the
amount of tax withheld, if any, with respect to such payments.
 
                                       61
<PAGE>   63
 
                                  UNDERWRITING
 
     The Underwriters named below (the "Common Stock Underwriters"), acting
through their representatives, Robertson, Stephens & Company LLC, Merrill Lynch,
Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated, and Adams, Harkness & Hill, Inc. (the
"Common Stock Representatives"), have severally agreed with the Company, subject
to the terms and conditions of the applicable Underwriting Agreement, to
purchase from the Company the number of shares of Common Stock set forth
opposite their respective names below. The Common Stock Underwriters are
committed to purchase and pay for all such shares if any shares are purchased.
The closing of the Common Stock Offering is not conditioned upon the closing of
the Note Offering.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                   COMMON STOCK                                  NUMBER
                                   UNDERWRITER                                  OF SHARES
                                   ------------                                 ---------
    <S>                                                                         <C>
    Robertson, Stephens & Company LLC.........................................
    Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith
                  Incorporated................................................
    Adams, Harkness & Hill, Inc...............................................
 
                                                                                ---------
         Total................................................................  2,000,000
                                                                                =========
</TABLE>
 
     The Underwriters named below (the "Note Underwriters"), acting through
their representatives, Robertson, Stephens & Company LLC and Merrill Lynch,
Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated (the "Note Representatives"), have severally
agreed with the Company, subject to the terms and conditions of the applicable
Underwriting Agreement, to purchase from the Company the principal amount of
Notes set forth opposite their respective names below. The Note Underwriters are
committed to purchase and pay for all such Notes if any Notes are purchased. The
closing of the Note Offering is not conditioned upon the closing of the Common
Stock Offering.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                              PRINCIPAL
                                                                                AMOUNT
                                NOTE UNDERWRITER                               OF NOTES
                                ----------------                             ------------
    <S>                                                                      <C>
    Robertson, Stephens & Company LLC......................................  $
    Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith
                  Incorporated.............................................
 
                                                                                ---------
         Total.............................................................  $100,000,000
                                                                                =========
</TABLE>
 
     The Common Stock Representatives and the Note Representatives are sometimes
referred to collectively as the "Representatives." The Common Stock Underwriters
and the Note Underwriters are sometimes referred to collectively as the
"Underwriters."
 
     The respective Representatives have advised the Company that the respective
Underwriters propose to offer the shares of Common Stock and the Notes to the
public at the public offering price set forth on the cover page of this
Prospectus and to certain dealers at such price less a concession of,
respectively, not in excess of $          per share, of which $          may be
reallowed to other dealers, and of not more than   % of the principal amount of
the Notes. After the consummation of each Offering, the public offering price,
concession and reallowance to dealers for such Offering may
 
                                       62
<PAGE>   64
 
be reduced by the respective Representatives. No such reduction shall change the
amount of proceeds to be received by the Company with respect to such Offering
as set forth on the cover page of this Prospectus.
 
     The Company and the Selling Stockholders have granted to the Common Stock
Underwriters an option, exercisable during the 30-day period after the date of
this Prospectus, to purchase up to 97,400 and 202,600 shares of Common Stock,
respectively, to cover over-allotments, if any, at the same price per share as
the Company receives for the 2,000,000 shares of Common Stock that the Common
Stock Underwriters have agreed to purchase from the Company. The first 202,600
shares of Common Stock purchased by the Common Stock Underwriters pursuant to
this option will be sold by the Selling Stockholders and the subsequent 97,400
shares, if any, purchased by the Common Stock Underwriters pursuant to this
option will be sold by the Company. The Company also has granted to the Note
Underwriters an option, exercisable during the 30-day period after the date of
this Prospectus, to purchase up to $15 million principal amount of Notes to
cover over-allotments, if any, at the same price per Note as the Company
receives for the first $100 million principal amount of Notes that the Note
Underwriters have agreed to purchase from the Company. To the extent that the
Common Stock Underwriters exercise such option for shares of Common Stock, each
of the Common Stock Underwriters will have a firm commitment to purchase
approximately the same percentage of such additional shares of Common Stock as
the number of shares of Common Stock to be purchased by it shown in the above
table represents as a percentage of the 2,000,000 shares offered hereby. If
purchased, such additional shares will be sold by the Common Stock Underwriters
on the same terms as those on which the 2,000,000 shares of Common Stock are
being sold. To the extent that the Note Underwriters exercise such option for
Notes, each of the Note Underwriters will have a firm commitment to purchase
approximately the same percentage of such additional Notes as the principal
amount of Notes to be purchased by it shown in the above table represents as a
percentage of the $100 million principal amount of Notes offered hereby. If
purchased, such additional Notes will be sold by the Note Underwriters on the
same terms as those on which the $100 million principal amount of Notes are
being sold.
 
     The respective Underwriting Agreements contain covenants of indemnity among
the respective Underwriters, the Company and, in the case of the Underwriting
Agreement for the Common Stock Offering, the Selling Stockholders, against
certain civil liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act of
1933, as amended (the "Securities Act").
 
     Pursuant to the terms of Lockup Agreements, all executive officers and
Selling Stockholders, and certain directors, of the Company have agreed with the
respective Representatives that, for a period 90 days after the date of the
Offerings (the "Lock-Up Period"), they will not offer to sell, contract to sell
or otherwise sell, dispose of or grant any rights with respect to any shares of
Common Stock, any options or warrants to purchase shares of Common Stock or any
securities convertible into or exchangeable for shares of Common Stock now owned
or hereafter acquired directly by such holders or with respect to which they
have the power of disposition, otherwise than with the prior written consent of
Robertson Stephens & Company LLC which may, in its sole discretion and at any
time, without notice, release all or any portion of the securities subject to
Lockup Agreements. The Company has also agreed not to offer, sell, contract to
sell or otherwise dispose of any shares of Common Stock or any securities
convertible into or exercisable or exchangeable for Common Stock or any options
or warrants to purchase Common Stock other than shares or options issued under
the Company's stock option plans and stock issued upon the exercise of
outstanding options and warrants during the Lock-Up Period except with the prior
written consent of Robertson, Stephens & Company LLC.
 
     The respective Representatives have advised the Company that the respective
Underwriters do not intend to confirm any sales to accounts over which they
exercise discretionary authority.
 
     The offering price of the Common Stock will be determined by negotiations
among the Company and the Common Stock Representatives, based largely upon the
market price for the Common Stock as reported on the Nasdaq National Market.
 
                                       63
<PAGE>   65
 
     Certain persons participating in these Offerings may engage in
transactions, including syndicate covering transactions or the imposition of
penalty bids, which may involve the purchase of Common Stock and Notes on the
Nasdaq National Market, the over-the-counter market or otherwise. Such
transactions may stabilize or maintain the market price of the Common Stock and
the Notes at levels above that which might otherwise prevail in the open market
and, if commenced, may be discontinued at any time.
 
     Prior to the Note Offering, there has been no trading market for the Notes.
The Company expects that the Notes will trade on the over-the-counter market.
However, there can be no assurance that an active trading market for the Notes
will develop or, if such market develops, as to the liquidity or sustainability
of such market. Robertson, Stephens & Company LLC and Merrill Lynch, Pierce,
Fenner & Smith Incorporated have advised the Company that they currently intend
to make a market in the Notes, but they are not obligated to do so and may
discontinue such market making at any time. There can be no assurance that an
active market for the Notes will develop and continue upon completion of the
Note Offering or that the market price of the Notes will not decline. Various
factors such as changes in prevailing interest rates or changes in perceptions
of the Company's creditworthiness could cause the market price of the Notes to
fluctuate significantly. The trading price of the Notes could also be
significantly affected by the market price of the Common Stock, which could be
subject to wide fluctuations in response to a variety of factors, including
quarterly variations in operating results, announcements of technological
innovations or new products by the Company, its customers or its competitors,
developments in patents or other intellectual property rights, general
conditions in the electronics industry and general economic and market
conditions. Factors creating volatility in the trading price of the Common Stock
could have a significant impact on the trading price of the Notes.
 
                                 LEGAL MATTERS
 
     The validity of the shares of Common Stock offered hereby and the validity
of the Notes offered hereby and the shares of Common Stock issuable upon
conversion thereof will be passed upon for the Company by Testa, Hurwitz &
Thibeault, LLP, Boston, Massachusetts, special counsel to the Company. The
validity of the shares of Common Stock offered hereby by the Selling
Stockholders will be passed upon for the Selling Stockholders by Berlin,
Hamilton & Dahmen, LLP, Boston, Massachusetts. A member of Testa, Hurwitz &
Thibeault, LLP is the beneficial owner of 100 shares of Common Stock of the
Company. James C. Hamilton, a partner at Berlin, Hamilton & Dahmen, LLP, which
is general counsel to the Company, is the Company's Clerk. He is the beneficial
owner of 12,250 shares of Common Stock of the Company. He is also the co-trustee
of certain irrevocable trusts for the benefit of members of the family of Horace
H. Irvine II, Chairman of the Board of the Company. See "Principal
Shareholders."
 
     Certain legal matters relating to the Common Stock Offering and the Note
Offering will be passed upon for the respective Underwriters by Hale and Dorr,
LLP, Boston, Massachusetts, and the validity of the Notes offered hereby and the
shares of Common Stock issuable upon conversion thereof will be passed upon for
the Note Underwriters by Wilson Sonsini Goodrich & Rosati, Professional
Corporation, Palo Alto, California.
 
                                    EXPERTS
 
     The Company's audited consolidated financial statements and schedule
included in this Prospectus and elsewhere in the Registration Statement have
been audited by Arthur Andersen LLP, independent public accountants, as
indicated in its reports with respect thereto, and are included herein in
reliance upon the authority of said firm as experts in giving said reports.
 
     The consolidated financial statements of Zycon Corporation included in this
Prospectus have been audited by Arthur Andersen LLP, independent public
accountants, as of December 31, 1996 and for the one-year period ended December
31, 1996 to the extent indicated in its report, and are included
 
                                       64
<PAGE>   66
 
herein in reliance upon the authority of such firm as experts in giving said
report. The consolidated financial statements of Zycon Corporation as of
December 31, 1995 and for each of the years in the two-year period ended
December 31, 1995, have been included herein and in the Registration Statement
in reliance upon the report of KPMG Peat Marwick LLP, independent certified
public accountants, appearing elsewhere herein, and upon the authority of said
firm as experts in accounting and auditing.
 
                             ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
 
     The Company has filed with the Commission a Registration Statement on Form
S-3 under the Securities Act with respect to the securities offered hereby (the
"Registration Statement"). This Prospectus, which constitutes part of the
Registration Statement, does not contain all the information set forth in the
Registration Statement and the exhibits and schedules thereto, certain parts of
which are omitted in accordance with the rules and regulations of the
Commission. Statements contained in this Prospectus as to the contents of any
contract or any other document referred to are not necessarily complete.
Reference is made to such contract or other document filed, or incorporated by
reference, as an exhibit to the Registration Statement, and each such statement
is qualified in all respects by such reference. For further information
pertaining to the Company and the Common Stock and Notes, reference is made to
the Registration Statement and the exhibits and schedules thereto, which may be
inspected without charge at the office of the Commission at 450 Fifth Street,
N.W., Washington, D.C. 20549; and at the following Regional Offices of the
Commission: Seven World Trade Center, New York, New York, 10048; and 500 West
Madison Avenue, Suite 1400, Chicago, Illinois 60621.
 
                             AVAILABLE INFORMATION
 
     The Company is subject to the informational requirements of the Exchange
Act, and in accordance therewith files reports, proxy statements and other
information with the Commission. All such reports, proxy statements and other
information can be inspected and copied at the public reference facilities
maintained by the Commission at Room 1024, Judiciary Plaza, 450 Fifth Street,
N.W., Washington, D.C. 20549, and at the following regional offices of the
Commission: 90 Devonshire Street, Suite 700, Boston, Massachusetts 02109; 7
World Trade Center, 13th Floor, New York, New York 10048; and Northwestern
Atrium Center, 500 West Madison Street, Suite 1400, Chicago, Illinois
60661-2511. Copies of such material may also be obtained from the Public
Reference Section of the Commission at Room 1024, Judiciary Plaza, 450 Fifth
Street, N.W., Washington, D.C. 20549, and at its public reference facilities at
Boston, Massachusetts, New York, New York and Chicago, Illinois at prescribed
rates. In addition, the aforementioned materials may also be inspected at the
offices of the Nasdaq National Market at 1735 K Street, N.W., Washington, D.C.
20006. The Commission maintains a World-Wide Web site that contains reports,
proxy and information statements and other information regarding registrants
that file electronically with the Commission. The address of the Commission's
Web site is http.//www.sec.gov.
 
                                       65
<PAGE>   67
 
                   INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                       PAGE
                                                                                       -----
<S>                                                                                    <C>
HADCO CORPORATION:
  Report of Independent Public Accountants...........................................  F-2
  Consolidated Balance Sheets at October 28, 1995, October 26, 1996 and January 25,
     1997 (Unaudited)................................................................  F-3
  Consolidated Statements of Operations for the Years Ended October 29, 1994, October
     28, 1995 and October 26, 1996 and for the Three Months Ended January 27, 1996
     (Unaudited) and January 25, 1997 (Unaudited)....................................  F-4
  Consolidated Statements of Stockholders' Investment for the Years Ended October 29,
     1994, October 28, 1995 and October 26, 1996 and for the Three Months Ended
     January 25, 1997 (Unaudited)....................................................  F-5
  Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the Years Ended October 29, 1994, October
     28, 1995 and October 26, 1996 and for the Three Months Ended January 27, 1996
     (Unaudited) and January 25, 1997 (Unaudited)....................................  F-6
  Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.........................................  F-7
PRO FORMA FINANCIAL STATEMENTS:
  Pro Forma Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements..............................  F-23
  Pro Forma Condensed Consolidated Statement of Operations for the Fiscal Year Ended
     October 26, 1996 (Unaudited)....................................................  F-24
  Pro Forma Condensed Consolidated Statement of Operations for the Quarter Ended
     January 25, 1997 (Unaudited)....................................................  F-25
ZYCON CORPORATION:
  Report of Independent Public Accountants (Arthur Andersen LLP).....................  F-26
  Independent Auditors' Report (KPMG Peat Marwick LLP)...............................  F-27
  Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 1995 and 1996.......................  F-28
  Consolidated Statements of Income for the Years Ended December 31, 1994, 1995 and
     1996............................................................................  F-29
  Consolidated Statements of Stockholders' Equity for the Years Ended December 31,
     1994, 1995 and 1996.............................................................  F-30
  Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the Years Ended December 31, 1994, 1995
     and 1996........................................................................  F-31
  Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.........................................  F-32
</TABLE>
 
                                       F-1
<PAGE>   68
 
                    REPORT OF INDEPENDENT PUBLIC ACCOUNTANTS
 
To Hadco Corporation:
 
     We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Hadco
Corporation (a Massachusetts corporation) and subsidiaries as of October 28,
1995 and October 26, 1996, and the related consolidated statements of
operations, stockholders' investment and cash flows for each of the three years
in the period ended October 26, 1996. These financial statements are the
responsibility of the Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an
opinion on these financial statements based on our audits.
 
     We conducted our audits in accordance with generally accepted auditing
standards. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain
reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material
misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting
the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes
assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by
management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation.
We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.
 
     In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present fairly,
in all material respects, the financial position of Hadco Corporation as of
October 28, 1995 and October 26, 1996, and the results of their operations and
their cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended October 26,
1996, in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles.
 
                                                  ARTHUR ANDERSEN LLP
 
Boston, Massachusetts
November 15, 1996 (except for the
  matter discussed in Note 2, as to
  which the date is January 10, 1997)
 
                                       F-2
<PAGE>   69
 
                       HADCO CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
                          CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
                  (In thousands, except per share information)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                        OCTOBER 28,     OCTOBER 26,     JANUARY 25,
                                                           1995            1996            1997
                                                        -----------     -----------     -----------
                                                                                        (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                                     <C>             <C>             <C>
ASSETS
CURRENT ASSETS:
  Cash and cash equivalents...........................   $  21,307       $  32,786       $   8,825
  Short-term investments..............................      15,167           9,401           3,264
  Accounts receivable, net of allowance of $850 in
     1995, $1,100 in 1996 and $1,830 in 1997..........      35,797          40,622          72,616
  Inventories.........................................      13,304          21,786          34,107
  Deferred tax asset..................................       6,288           7,483           7,483
  Prepaid and other expenses..........................       1,696           1,483           5,607
                                                          --------        --------        --------
          Total current assets........................      93,559         113,561         131,902
PROPERTY, PLANT AND EQUIPMENT, NET....................      67,692         103,735         203,639
DEFERRED TAX ASSET....................................       1,646           2,117              --
ACQUIRED INTANGIBLE ASSETS, NET.......................          --              --         108,699
OTHER ASSETS..........................................          94              88           4,314
                                                          --------        --------        --------
                                                         $ 162,991       $ 219,501       $ 448,554
                                                          ========        ========        ========
LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' INVESTMENT
CURRENT LIABILITIES:
  Short-term debt, current portion of long-term debt
     and capital lease obligations....................   $   2,143       $   1,907       $   8,116
  Accounts payable....................................      27,002          42,265          69,709
  Accrued payroll and other employee benefits.........      16,030          17,592          19,771
  Other accrued expenses..............................       7,341           8,236          12,234
                                                          --------        --------        --------
          Total current liabilities...................      52,516          70,000         109,830
                                                          --------        --------        --------
LONG-TERM DEBT AND CAPITAL LEASE OBLIGATIONS, NET OF
  CURRENT PORTION.....................................       2,387           1,515         228,168
                                                          --------        --------        --------
DEFERRED TAX LIABILITY................................          --              --          30,285
                                                          --------        --------        --------
OTHER LONG-TERM LIABILITIES...........................       7,314           9,145           9,214
                                                          --------        --------        --------
COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES (Note 9)
STOCKHOLDERS' INVESTMENT:
  Common stock, $.05 par value;
  Authorized -- 25,000 shares
  Issued and outstanding -- 9,939 shares in 1995,
     10,382 in 1996 and 10,444 shares in 1997.........         497             521             523
  Paid-in capital.....................................      25,077          30,939          32,283
  Deferred compensation...............................        (407)           (240)           (209)
  Retained earnings...................................      75,607         107,621          38,460
                                                          --------        --------        --------
          Total stockholders' investment..............     100,774         138,841          71,057
                                                          --------        --------        --------
                                                         $ 162,991       $ 219,501       $ 448,554
                                                          ========        ========        ========
</TABLE>
 
  The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial
                                  statements.
 
                                       F-3
<PAGE>   70
 
                       HADCO CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
                     CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS
                     (In thousands, except per share data)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                    FOR THE YEARS ENDED,             THREE MONTHS ENDED,
                                                            -------------------------------------  ------------------------
                                                            OCTOBER 29,  OCTOBER 28,  OCTOBER 26,  JANUARY 27,  JANUARY 25,
                                                               1994         1995         1996         1996         1997
                                                            -----------  -----------  -----------  -----------  -----------
                                                                                                         (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                                         <C>          <C>          <C>          <C>          <C>
Net Sales..................................................  $ 221,570    $ 265,168    $ 350,685     $76,481     $ 111,536
Cost of Sales..............................................    177,597      200,673      264,537      56,999        86,681
                                                              --------     --------     --------     -------      --------
Gross Profit...............................................     43,973       64,495       86,148      19,482        24,855
Selling, General and Administrative Expenses...............     27,491       30,589       34,616       7,948         9,298
Write-off of Acquired in-Process Research and
  Development..............................................         --           --           --          --        78,000
                                                              --------     --------     --------     -------      --------
Income (Loss) From Operations..............................     16,482       33,906       51,532      11,534       (62,443)
Interest and Other Income..................................        843        1,669        1,287         355           880
Interest Expense...........................................       (891)        (537)        (338)        (95)         (933)
                                                              --------     --------     --------     -------      --------
Income (Loss) Before Provision for Income Taxes............     16,434       35,038       52,481      11,794       (62,496)
Provision for Income Taxes.................................      6,491       13,664       20,467       4,603         6,665
                                                              --------     --------     --------     -------      --------
Net Income (Loss)..........................................  $   9,943    $  21,374    $  32,014     $ 7,191     $ (69,161)
                                                              ========     ========     ========     =======      ========
Net Income (Loss) Per Share................................  $     .93    $    1.98    $    2.89     $   .65     $   (6.64)
                                                              ========     ========     ========     =======      ========
Weighted Average Shares Outstanding........................     10,720       10,806       11,084      11,104        10,413
                                                              ========     ========     ========     =======      ========
</TABLE>
 
  The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial
                                  statements.
 
                                       F-4
<PAGE>   71
 
                       HADCO CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
              CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF STOCKHOLDERS' INVESTMENT
                                 (In thousands)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                   COMMON STOCK
                                               --------------------
                                                NUMBER     $.05 PAR   PAID-IN     DEFERRED     RETAINED
                                               OF SHARES    VALUE     CAPITAL   COMPENSATION   EARNINGS
                                               ---------   --------   -------   ------------   --------
<S>                                            <C>         <C>        <C>       <C>            <C>
BALANCE, OCTOBER 30, 1993....................     9,734      $487     $21,953     $ (1,316)    $ 47,307
  Terminated stock options...................        --        --        (225)         225           --
  Exercise of stock options..................       332        16         837           --           --
  Tax benefit of exercise of nonqualified
     stock options...........................        --        --         319           --           --
  Compensation expense associated with
     granting nonqualified stock options.....        --        --          --          360           --
  Purchase and retirement of common stock....      (328)      (16)       (121)          --       (2,329)
  Net income.................................        --        --          --           --        9,943
                                                 ------      ----     -------      -------     --------
BALANCE, OCTOBER 29, 1994....................     9,738       487      22,763         (731)      54,921
  Terminated stock options...................        --        --         (37)          37           --
  Exercise of stock options..................       529        16       1,079           --           --
  Tax benefit of exercise of nonqualified
     stock options...........................        --        --       1,597           --           --
  Compensation expense associated with
     granting nonqualified stock options.....        --        --          --          287           --
  Purchase and retirement of common stock....      (328)       (6)       (325)          --         (688)
  Net income.................................        --        --          --           --       21,374
                                                 ------      ----     -------      -------     --------
BALANCE, OCTOBER 28, 1995....................     9,939       497      25,077         (407)      75,607
  Terminated stock options...................        --        --         (13)          13           --
  Exercise of stock options..................       443        24       1,714           --           --
  Tax benefit of exercise of nonqualified
     stock options...........................        --        --       4,161           --           --
  Compensation expense associated with
     granting nonqualified stock options.....        --        --          --          154           --
  Net income.................................        --        --          --           --       32,014
                                                 ------      ----     -------      -------     --------
BALANCE, OCTOBER 26, 1996....................    10,382       521      30,939         (240)     107,621
  Exercise of stock options (unaudited)......        62         2         326           --           --
  Tax benefit of exercise of nonqualified
     stock options (unaudited)...............        --        --       1,018           --           --
  Compensation expense associated with
     granting nonqualified stock options
     (unaudited).............................        --        --          --           31           --
  Net loss (unaudited).......................        --        --          --           --      (69,161)
                                                 ------      ----     -------      -------     --------
BALANCE, JANUARY 25, 1997 (Unaudited)........    10,444      $523     $32,283     $   (209)    $ 38,460
                                                 ======      ====     =======      =======     ========
</TABLE>
 
  The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial
                                  statements.
 
                                       F-5
<PAGE>   72
 
                       HADCO CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
                     CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
                                 (In thousands)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                     FOR THE YEARS ENDED,                 THREE MONTHS ENDED,
                                                            ---------------------------------------   ---------------------------
                                                            OCTOBER 29,   OCTOBER 28,   OCTOBER 26,   JANUARY 27,     JANUARY 25,
                                                               1994          1995          1996          1996            1997
                                                            -----------   -----------   -----------   -----------     -----------
                                                                                                              (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                                         <C>           <C>           <C>           <C>             <C>
CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES:
  Net income (loss).......................................   $   9,943     $  21,374     $  32,014     $   7,191       $ (69,161)
  Adjustments to reconcile net income (loss) to net cash
    provided by operating activities--
    Write-off of acquired in-process research and
      development.........................................          --            --            --            --          78,000
    Depreciation, amortization, deferred compensation and
      deferred taxes......................................      12,708        11,218        17,330         3,840           6,531
    Gain on sale of fixed assets..........................         (81)         (415)         (205)         (194)             --
    Changes in assets and liabilities, net of acquisition
      of Zycon Corporation--
        Increase in accounts receivable...................      (2,739)      (10,485)       (4,825)         (465)         (7,158)
        Increase in inventories...........................        (288)       (3,009)       (8,482)       (1,166)           (931)
        (Increase) decrease in prepaid taxes and other
          expenses........................................        (685)         (364)          213          (775)         (1,053)
        Decrease (increase) in other assets...............          55            25            33            15            (628)
        Increase in accounts payable and accrued
          expenses........................................       8,661        15,291        17,720           304           2,661
        Increase in long-term liabilities.................       1,710         2,714         1,831           700              70
                                                              --------      --------      --------      --------       ---------
          Net cash provided by operating activities.......      29,284        36,349        55,629         9,450           8,331
                                                              --------      --------      --------      --------       ---------
CASH FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES:
  Net (purchases) sales of short-term investments.........      (4,095)       (2,668)        5,766         1,933           6,137
  Purchases of property, plant and equipment..............     (19,510)      (28,865)      (53,966)      (13,713)        (11,011)
  Proceeds from sale of property, plant and equipment.....         177           429           290           194              --
  Acquisition of Zycon Corporation, net of cash acquired
    of $2,824.............................................          --            --            --            --        (209,661)
                                                              --------      --------      --------      --------       ---------
          Net cash used in investing activities...........     (23,428)      (31,104)      (47,910)      (11,586)       (214,535)
                                                              --------      --------      --------      --------       ---------
CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES:
  Principal payments under capital lease obligations......      (4,447)       (2,584)       (2,047)         (630)           (413)
  Principal payments of long-term debt....................         (92)       (2,091)          (92)          (22)        (33,690)
  Proceeds from issuance of long-term debt................          --            --            --            --         215,000
  Proceeds from exercise of stock options.................         853         1,095         1,738         2,952             328
  Tax benefit from exercise of options....................         319         1,597         4,161            --           1,018
  Purchase and retirement of common stock.................      (2,466)       (1,019)           --            --              --
                                                              --------      --------      --------      --------       ---------
          Net cash (used in) provided by financing
            activities....................................      (5,833)       (3,002)        3,760         2,300         182,243
                                                              --------      --------      --------      --------       ---------
NET INCREASE (DECREASE) IN CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS......          23         2,243        11,479           164         (23,961)
CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS, BEGINNING OF PERIOD............      19,041        19,064        21,307        21,307          32,786
                                                              --------      --------      --------      --------       ---------
CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS, END OF PERIOD..................   $  19,064     $  21,307     $  32,786     $  21,471       $   8,825
                                                              ========      ========      ========      ========       =========
SUPPLEMENTAL SCHEDULE OF NONCASH INVESTING AND FINANCING
  ACTIVITIES:
  Machinery and equipment acquired under capital
    lease obligations.....................................   $      --     $      --     $   1,032     $      --       $      --
                                                              ========      ========      ========      ========       =========
SUPPLEMENTAL DISCLOSURE OF CASH FLOW INFORMATION:
  Cash paid during the period for--
    Interest..............................................   $     859     $     576     $     279     $      --       $     311
                                                              ========      ========      ========      ========       =========
    Income taxes (net of refunds).........................   $   8,939     $  13,609     $  16,794     $   3,101       $     405
                                                              ========      ========      ========      ========       =========
ACQUISITION OF ZYCON CORPORATION--
  Fair value of assets acquired...........................                                                             $ 212,509
  Liabilities assumed.....................................                                                              (114,993)
  Cash paid...............................................                                                              (204,885)
  Acquisition costs incurred..............................                                                                (7,600)
  Write-off of acquired in-process research and
    development...........................................                                                                78,000
                                                                                                                       ---------
  Goodwill................................................                                                             $ (36,969)
                                                                                                                       =========
</TABLE>
 
  The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial
                                  statements.
 
                                       F-6
<PAGE>   73
 
                       HADCO CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
                   NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                (INCLUDING DATA APPLICABLE TO UNAUDITED PERIODS)
 
(1)  SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES
 
     Hadco Corporation's (the "Company") principal products are complex
multilayer rigid printed circuits and backplane assemblies. The consolidated
financial statements reflect the application of certain accounting policies as
described in this note and elsewhere in the accompanying notes to consolidated
financial statements.
 
  Principles of Consolidation
 
     The accompanying consolidated financial statements include the accounts of
the Company and its wholly owned subsidiaries. All significant intercompany
balances and transactions have been eliminated in consolidation.
 
  Management Estimates
 
     The preparation of financial statements in conformity with generally
accepted accounting principles requires management to make estimates and
assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and
disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial
statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the
reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates.
 
  Cash Equivalents and Short-Term Investments
 
     The Company considers all highly liquid investment instruments purchased
with a maturity of three months or less to be cash equivalents. Short-term
investments are carried at cost, which approximates market, and have maturities
of less than one year.
 
     The Company classifies its investments in corporate and government debt
securities as held-to-maturity given the Company's intent and ability to hold
the securities to maturity. In accordance with the statement, held-to-maturity
securities are carried at amortized cost.
 
     The Company's investments in held-to-maturity securities are as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                     1995               1996              1997
                               -----------------   ---------------   ---------------
                                          FAIR               FAIR              FAIR
                                         MARKET             MARKET            MARKET
                                COST      VALUE     COST    VALUE     COST    VALUE      MATURITY
                               -------   -------   ------   ------   ------   ------   -------------
                                                  (IN THOUSANDS)
<S>                            <C>       <C>       <C>      <C>      <C>      <C>      <C>
US Government Securities.....  $ 6,039   $ 6,058   $1,000   $ 999    $1,000   $ 999    within 1 year
State and Local Securities...    1,000     1,000    5,270   5,271     2,264   2,264    within 1 year
Corporate Debt Securities....    8,128     8,064    3,131   3,069        --      --    within 1 year
                               -------   -------   ------   ------   ------   ------
                               $15,167   $15,122   $9,401   $9,339   $3,264   $3,263
                               =======   =======   ======   ======   ======   ======
</TABLE>
 
     The Company has no financial instruments requiring disclosure under
Financial Accounting Standards Board issued Statement of Financial Accounting
Standard (SFAS) No. 119, Disclosure About Derivative Financial Instruments and
Fair Value of the Financial Instruments.
 
  Concentration of Credit Risk
 
     SFAS No. 105, Disclosure of Information About Financial Instruments with
Off-Balance-Sheet Risk and Financial Instruments with Concentrations of Credit
Risk, requires disclosure of any significant off-balance-sheet and credit risk
concentration. The Company has no significant off-balance-sheet
 
                                       F-7
<PAGE>   74
 
                       HADCO CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
             NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)
                (INCLUDING DATA APPLICABLE TO UNAUDITED PERIODS)
 
concentrations of credit risk such as foreign currency exchange contracts or
other hedging arrangements. Financial instruments that subject the Company to
credit risk consist of cash and cash equivalents, short-term investments and
trade accounts receivable. The Company maintains the majority of its cash and
investment balances with financial institutions. The Company has not experienced
any losses on these investments to date. Substantially all of the Company's
accounts receivable are concentrated in the high technology and electronics
industry. The Company has not experienced significant losses related to
receivables from individual customers or groups of customers in the high
technology and electronics industry or by geographic region. Due to these
factors, no additional credit risk beyond amounts provided for collection losses
is believed by management to be inherent in the Company's accounts receivable.
 
  Depreciation and Amortization of Property, Plant and Equipment
 
     The Company provides for depreciation and amortization by charges to
operations in amounts that allocate the cost of property, plant and equipment on
a straight-line basis over the following estimated useful lives:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                              ESTIMATED
                             ASSET CLASSIFICATION                            USEFUL LIFE
                             --------------------                            -----------
    <S>                                                                      <C>
    Land betterments.......................................................  10-18 Years
    Buildings and improvements.............................................  10-40 Years
    Machinery and equipment................................................    3-9 Years
    Furniture and fixtures.................................................    5-7 Years
    Computer software......................................................      3 Years
    Vehicles...............................................................      3 Years
    Capital leases.........................................................   Lease term
</TABLE>
 
  Net Income (Loss) per Share
 
     Net income (loss) per share was computed based on the weighted average
number of common and common equivalent shares outstanding during each period.
Common equivalent shares include outstanding stock options and are included when
dilutive. Fully diluted net income (loss) per share has not been separately
presented as it would not be materially different from net income (loss) per
share as presented.
 
  Revenue Recognition
 
     The Company recognizes revenue at the time products are shipped.
 
  New Accounting Standard
 
     The Company accounts for its stock-based compensation plans under
Accounting Principles Board (APB) Opinion No. 25, Accounting for Stock Issued to
Employees. The Company is required to adopt SFAS No. 123, Accounting for
Stock-Based Compensation, in fiscal 1997. SFAS No. 123 defines a fair-
value-based method of accounting for employee stock options and other
stock-based compensation. The compensation expense arising from this method of
accounting can be reflected in the financial statements or, alternatively, the
pro forma net income and earnings per share effect of the fair-value-based
accounting can be disclosed in the financial footnotes. The Company will adopt
the disclosure-only alternative.
 
                                       F-8
<PAGE>   75
 
                       HADCO CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
             NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)
                (INCLUDING DATA APPLICABLE TO UNAUDITED PERIODS)
 
  Foreign Currency Translation
 
     The functional currency of the Company's Malaysian subsidiary is the United
States dollar. Accordingly, all translation gains and losses resulting from
transactions denominated in currencies other than United States dollars are
included in the consolidated statements of operations. To date, the resulting
gains and losses have not been material.
 
  Reclassification
 
     The Company has reclassified certain prior year information to conform with
the current year's presentation.
 
  Interim Financial Statements
 
     The accompanying consolidated balance sheet as of January 25, 1997, the
consolidated statements of operations and cash flows for the three-month periods
ended January 27, 1996 and January 25, 1997 and the statement of stockholders'
investment for the three-month period ended January 25, 1997 are unaudited but,
in the opinion of management, include all adjustments (consisting of normal,
recurring adjustments) necessary for a fair presentation of results for these
interim periods. The results of operations for the three months ended January
25, 1997 are not necessarily indicative of results to be expected for the entire
year.
 
(2)  ACQUISITION OF ZYCON
 
     On January 10, 1997, the Company acquired substantially all of the
outstanding common stock of Zycon Corporation ("Zycon"). The acquisition was
financed by a new bank credit facility of up to $250,000,000, of which the
Company borrowed approximately $215,000,000, upon consummation of the
acquisition (see Note 7). The acquisition is being accounted for as a purchase
in accordance with APB Opinion No. 16, and accordingly, Zycon's operating
results since January 10, 1997 are included in the accompanying consolidated
financial statements.
 
     In accordance with APB Opinion No. 16, the Company has allocated the
purchase price based on the fair value of assets acquired and liabilities
assumed. A significant portion of the purchase price, as described below, has
been identified in an independent appraisal as intangible assets using proven
valuation procedures and techniques, including approximately $78,000,000 of
in-process research and development ("in-process R&D"). Acquired intangibles
include developed technology, customer relationships, assembled workforce and
trade names/trademarks. These intangibles are being amortized over their
estimated useful lives of 12 to 30 years. The portion of the purchase price
allocated to the in-process R&D projects that did not have a future alternative
use totaled $78,000,000 and was charged to expense as of the acquisition date.
Due to a difference in the bases of certain assets for financial statement and
income tax purposes, deferred income taxes of $28,800,000 have been provided as
part of the purchase price allocation in accordance with SFAS No. 109.
 
                                       F-9
<PAGE>   76
 
                       HADCO CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
             NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)
                (INCLUDING DATA APPLICABLE TO UNAUDITED PERIODS)
 
     The aggregate purchase price of $212,485,000, including acquisition costs,
was allocated as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                            (IN THOUSANDS)
                                                                            --------------
    <S>                                                                     <C>
    Current assets........................................................    $   41,790
    Property, plant and equipment.........................................        95,193
    Acquired intangibles..................................................        72,000
    In-process R&D........................................................        78,000
    Other assets..........................................................         3,526
    Goodwill..............................................................        36,969
    Liabilities assumed...................................................      (114,993)
                                                                               ---------
                                                                              $  212,485
                                                                               =========
</TABLE>
 
     Unaudited pro forma operating results for the Company, assuming the
acquisition of Zycon occurred on October 29, 1995 are as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                       THREE MONTHS ENDED
                                                    YEAR ENDED     ---------------------------
                                                     OCTOBER       JANUARY 27,     JANUARY 25,
                                                     26, 1996         1996            1997
                                                    ----------     -----------     -----------
                                                    (IN THOUSANDS)
    <S>                                             <C>            <C>             <C>
    Net sales.....................................   $570,345       $ 129,901       $ 172,547
    Net income....................................     28,700           8,167           8,275
    Net income per share..........................   $   2.59       $     .74       $     .76
</TABLE>
 
     For purposes of these pro forma operating results, the in-process R&D was
assumed to have been written off prior to October 29, 1995, so that the
operating results presented include only recurring costs.
 
(3)  INVENTORIES
 
     Inventories are stated at the lower of cost, first-in, first-out (FIFO), or
market and consist of the following:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                             1995        1996        1997
                                                            -------     -------     -------
                                                                    (IN THOUSANDS)
    <S>                                                     <C>         <C>         <C>
    Raw materials.........................................  $ 6,318     $ 8,008     $12,668
    Work-in-process.......................................    6,986      13,778      21,439
                                                            -------     -------     -------
                                                            $13,304     $21,786     $34,107
                                                            =======     =======     =======
</TABLE>
 
     The work-in-process consists of materials, labor and manufacturing
overhead.
 
                                      F-10
<PAGE>   77
 
                       HADCO CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
             NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)
                (INCLUDING DATA APPLICABLE TO UNAUDITED PERIODS)
 
(4)  PROPERTY, PLANT AND EQUIPMENT
 
     Property, plant and equipment consist of the following:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                        1995          1996          1997
                                                      ---------     ---------     ---------
                                                                 (IN THOUSANDS)
    <S>                                               <C>           <C>           <C>
    Land betterments................................  $   1,838     $   1,991     $   2,174
    Buildings and improvements......................     42,885        52,961        97,895
    Construction-in-progress........................     15,173        22,543        23,841
    Machinery and equipment.........................     94,611       126,878       228,099
    Furniture and fixtures..........................     11,721        14,082        15,500
    Computer software...............................      2,343         2,662         3,581
    Vehicles........................................        141           159           584
    Capital leases..................................     15,048        14,972        16,620
                                                      ---------     ---------     ---------
                                                        183,760       236,248       388,294
    Accumulated depreciation and amortization.......   (116,068)     (132,513)     (184,655)
                                                      ---------     ---------     ---------
                                                      $  67,692     $ 103,735     $ 203,639
                                                      =========     =========     =========
</TABLE>
 
(5)  INTANGIBLE ASSETS
 
     The Company assesses the realizability of intangible assets in accordance
with SFAS No. 121, Accounting for the Impairment of Long-Lived Assets and for
Long-Lived Assets to be Disposed of. Under SFAS No. 121, the Company is required
to assess the valuation of its long-lived assets, including intangible assets,
based on the estimated cash flows to be generated by such assets. Intangible
assets are amortized on a straight-line basis, based on their estimated lives,
as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                               ESTIMATED      JANUARY 25,
                                                                  LIFE            1997
                                                               ----------    --------------
                                                                             (IN THOUSANDS)
    <S>                                                        <C>           <C>
    Developed technology.....................................   12 years        $ 30,000
    Customer relationships...................................   25 years          19,000
    Assembled workforce......................................   12 years          10,000
    Trade names/trademarks...................................   30 years          13,000
    Goodwill.................................................   20 years          36,969
                                                                                --------
                                                                                 108,969
    Less -- Accumulated amortization.........................                       (270)
                                                                                --------
                                                                                $108,699
                                                                                ========
</TABLE>
 
(6)  INCOME TAXES
 
     The Company accounts for income taxes in accordance with SFAS No. 109,
Accounting for Income Taxes.
 
                                      F-11
<PAGE>   78
 
                       HADCO CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
             NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)
                (INCLUDING DATA APPLICABLE TO UNAUDITED PERIODS)
 
     The provision for income taxes shown in the accompanying consolidated
statements of operations is comprised of the following:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                     YEARS ENDED OCTOBER
                                                                 ---------------------------
                                                                  1994      1995      1996
                                                                 -------   -------   -------
                                                                 (IN THOUSANDS)
    <S>                                                          <C>       <C>       <C>
    Federal --
      Current.................................................   $ 6,566   $14,331   $18,341
      Deferred................................................    (1,224)   (2,954)   (1,206)
                                                                 -------   -------   -------
                                                                   5,342    11,377    17,135
                                                                 -------   -------   -------
    State --
      Current.................................................     1,440     2,928     3,611
      Deferred................................................      (291)     (641)     (279)
                                                                 -------   -------   -------
                                                                   1,149     2,287     3,332
                                                                 -------   -------   -------
                                                                 $ 6,491   $13,664   $20,467
                                                                 =======   =======   =======
</TABLE>
 
     The tax rate used in the computation of the provision for federal and state
income taxes differs from the statutory federal and state rates due to the
following:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                     1994     1995     1996
                                                                     ----     ----     ----
    <S>                                                              <C>      <C>      <C>
    Provision for statutory rate.................................    34.0%    34.0%    34.0%
    Increase (decrease) in tax resulting from --
      State income taxes, net of federal tax benefit.............     4.6      4.5      4.4
      Tax-exempt interest income.................................    (0.4)    (0.5)    (0.4)
      Other, net.................................................     1.3      1.0      1.0
                                                                     ----     ----     ----
         Provision for income taxes..............................    39.5%    39.0%    39.0%
                                                                     ====     ====     ====
</TABLE>
 
     In accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, the Company
provides for income taxes on an interim basis, using its effective annual income
tax rate. Although the Company has incurred a loss before income taxes during
the three months ended January 25, 1997, the Company has recorded an income tax
provision because the write-off of in-process R&D is not deductible for income
tax purposes. Without taking into consideration the write-off of in-process R&D,
the Company anticipates that the effective annual income tax rate for fiscal
1997 will be 43%, which is more than the expected combined federal and state
statutory rates. This difference is caused primarily by anticipated losses
incurred by the Company's Malaysian subsidiary for which the Company cannot
record any tax benefit, and by amortization of goodwill and acquired intangibles
which is not tax deductible. These items are partially offset by tax advantaged
investment income, the tax benefit of the Company's Foreign Sales Corporation
and various state investment tax credits.
 
                                      F-12
<PAGE>   79
 
                       HADCO CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
             NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)
                (INCLUDING DATA APPLICABLE TO UNAUDITED PERIODS)
 
     The deferred provision for income taxes results from the following:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                             1994        1995        1996
                                                            -------     -------     -------
                                                            (IN THOUSANDS)
    <S>                                                     <C>         <C>         <C>
    Difference between book and tax depreciation........    $  (352)    $  (144)    $   (46)
    Deferred compensation...............................        143          73         266
    Reserves and expenses recognized in different
      periods for book and tax purposes.................     (1,288)     (3,506)     (1,658)
      Other, net........................................        (18)        (18)        (47)
                                                            -------     -------     -------
                                                            $(1,515)    $(3,595)    $(1,485)
                                                            =======     =======     =======
</TABLE>
 
     The tax effects of temporary differences that give rise to significant
portions of the current and long-term deferred tax assets and liabilities at
October 28, 1995 and October 26, 1996 are as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                        1995        1996
                                                                       -------     -------
                                                                       (IN THOUSANDS)
    <S>                                                                <C>         <C>
    Deferred Tax Assets --
      Nondeductible reserves.......................................    $ 6,184     $ 7,475
      Nondeductible environmental accruals.........................      3,197       3,907
      Deferred compensation from issuance of nonqualified stock
         options...................................................        579         275
                                                                       -------     -------
              Total gross deferred tax assets......................      9,960      11,657
      Less -- valuation allowance..................................        290         137
                                                                       -------     -------
                                                                         9,670      11,520
    Deferred Tax Liability --
      Property, plant and equipment, principally due to differences
         in depreciation...........................................     (1,736)     (1,920)
                                                                       -------     -------
              Net deferred tax asset...............................    $ 7,934     $ 9,600
                                                                       =======     =======
</TABLE>
 
     Due to the uncertainty relating to the actual value of the favorable tax
benefits of deferred compensation from stock options, the Company has recorded a
valuation allowance of approximately $290,000 and $137,000 as of October 28,
1995 and October 26, 1996, respectively. The reduction of this allowance for the
year ended October 26, 1996 is a result of the decrease in the deferred tax
asset relating to deferred compensation.
 
(7)  LINES OF CREDIT
 
     Prior to the acquisition of Zycon discussed in Note 2, the Company had an
unsecured Revolving Credit and Term Loan Agreement with a bank. The agreement
provided for up to $15,000,000 in revolving credit until June 30, 1997. The
Company could designate the rate of interest at either the Eurodollar Rate plus
0.6%, or the bank's base rate. As of October 26, 1996, no amounts were
outstanding under this line of credit.
 
     In connection with the Zycon acquisition discussed in Note 2, the Company
entered into a $250,000,000 unsecured Revolving Credit Agreement (the
"Agreement") with a bank, replacing the previous $15,000,000 agreement described
above. The Agreement provides for direct borrowings or letters of credit and
expires January 8, 2002. Borrowings under the Agreement bear interest, at the
Company's option, at either; (i) the Eurodollar rate plus a margin ranging
between .5% and 1.125%, based on a certain financial ratio of the Company, or
(ii) the Base Rate, as defined. The Company is
 
                                      F-13
<PAGE>   80
 
                       HADCO CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
             NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)
                (INCLUDING DATA APPLICABLE TO UNAUDITED PERIODS)
 
required to pay a quarterly commitment fee ranging from .2% to .375%, based on a
certain financial ratio of the Company, of the unused commitment under the
Agreement. If the Company obtains certain debt financing, as defined, the bank
may require the Company to repay up to $150,000,000 of amounts outstanding under
the Agreement. At January 25, 1997, borrowings of $215,000,000 were outstanding
under the Agreement at a weighted average interest rate of 6.68%.
 
     The Agreement places several restrictions on the Company, including
limitations on mergers, acquisitions and sales of a substantial portion of its
assets, as well as certain limitations on liens, guarantees, additional
borrowings, changes in the Company's capitalization, as defined, and
investments. The Agreement also requires the Company to maintain certain
financial covenants, including minimum levels of consolidated net worth, a
maximum ratio of funded debt to EBITDA, maximum capital expenditures and
interest coverage, as defined, during the term of the Agreement. At January 25,
1997, the Company was in compliance with all loan covenants.
 
     The Company has a line of credit arrangement with a Malaysian bank
denominated in Malaysian ringgits and U.S. dollars for aggregate borrowings of
approximately $4.4 million for the purpose of acquiring land, facilities and
equipment for the Company's Malaysian subsidiary. The arrangement is renewable
annually. At January 25, 1997, there was $2,929,000 outstanding under this
arrangement at a weighted average interest rate of approximately 10%.
 
(8)  LONG-TERM DEBT
 
     Long-term debt consists of the following:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                OCTOBER
                                                                           -----------------     JANUARY
                                                                            1995       1996        1997
                                                                           ------     ------     --------
                                                                                   (IN THOUSANDS)
<S>                                                                        <C>        <C>        <C>
Loan agreements in connection with the expansion of a building. The
  loans bear interest at rates from 1% to 7% through March 2011 and are
  collateralized by property and an irrevocable letter of credit.
  Payments of principal and interest are due quarterly.................    $1,008     $  916     $    893
Revolving credit agreement (Note 7)....................................        --         --      215,000
Loan agreements in connection with the purchase of manufacturing
  equipment. The loans bear interest at 7.17% to 11.37%, are payable in
  monthly installments of principal and interest through June 2001, and
  are collateralized by machinery and equipment........................        --         --       15,331
Line of credit arrangement with a Malaysia bank (Note 7)...............        --         --        2,929
Obligations under capital leases.......................................     3,522      2,506        2,131
                                                                           ------     ------     --------
                                                                            4,530      3,422      236,284
Less -- Current portion................................................     2,143      1,907        8,116
                                                                           ------     ------     --------
                                                                           $2,387     $1,515     $228,168
                                                                           ======     ======     ========
</TABLE>
 
                                      F-14
<PAGE>   81
 
                       HADCO CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
             NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)
                (INCLUDING DATA APPLICABLE TO UNAUDITED PERIODS)
 
     Maturities of long-term debt and capital lease obligations are as follows
as of October 26, 1996:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                             AMOUNT
                                                                             ------
        <S>                                                                  <C>
        Year Ending October--
          1997.............................................................  $1,907
          1998.............................................................    401
          1999.............................................................    474
          2000.............................................................     92
          2001.............................................................     92
          2002 and thereafter..............................................    456
                                                                             ------
                                                                             $3,422
                                                                             ======
</TABLE>
 
(9)  COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES
 
  Operating Leases
 
     The Company leases manufacturing equipment and space under noncancelable
operating leases with terms expiring through 2009. Future minimum lease payments
under these leases as of January 25, 1997 (in thousands) are as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                         REAL
                                                          EQUIPMENT     ESTATE       TOTAL
                                                          ---------     -------     -------
                                                          (IN THOUSANDS)
    <S>                                                   <C>           <C>         <C>
    Year Ending October --
      1997 (nine months)................................     $48        $ 4,804     $ 4,852
      1998..............................................      15          4,728       4,743
      1999..............................................       5          4,641       4,646
      2000..............................................      --          4,395       4,395
      2001..............................................      --          4,088       4,088
      Thereafter........................................      --         26,175      26,175
                                                             ---        -------     -------
           Future minimum lease payments................     $68        $48,831     $48,895
                                                             ===        =======     =======
</TABLE>
 
     Total rental expense of approximately $1,317,000, $1,447,000, $1,434,000
and $516,000 was incurred for the fiscal years ended October 1994, 1995, 1996
and for the three months ended January 25, 1997, respectively.
 
     These operating leases include office and manufacturing space leased from a
partnership in which the Chairman of the Board has an interest. Two of the
leases are for terms of five years, and expire in October 2000 with options to
extend until October 2006. The remaining lease expires in March 2000 with
options to extend until 2006. For the fiscal years ended October 1994, 1995 and
1996 and the quarter ended January 25, 1997, the related rental expense was
approximately $571,000, $479,000 $529,000 and $140,000, respectively.
 
  Environmental Matters
 
     During March 1995, the Company received a Record of Decision ("ROD") from
the New York State Department of Environmental Conservation ("NYSDEC"),
regarding soil and groundwater contamination at its Owego, New York facility.
Based on a Remedial Investigation and Feasibility Study ("RIFS") for apparent
on-site contamination at that facility and a Focused Feasibility Study ("FFS"),
each prepared by environmental consultants of the Company, the NYSDEC has
approved a
 
                                      F-15
<PAGE>   82
 
                       HADCO CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
             NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)
                (INCLUDING DATA APPLICABLE TO UNAUDITED PERIODS)
 
remediation program of groundwater withdrawal and treatment and interactive soil
flushing. The Company recently executed a Modification of the Order on Consent
to implement the approved ROD. The cost, based upon the FFS, to implement this
remediation is estimated to be $4.6 million, and is expected to be expended as
follows: $260,000 for capital equipment and $4.3 million for operation and
maintenance costs which will be incurred and expended over the estimated life of
the program of 30 years. NYSDEC has requested that the Company consider taking
additional samples from a wetland area near the Company's Owego facility.
Analytical reports of earlier sediment samples indicated the presence of certain
inorganics. There can be no assurance that the Company and/or other third
parties will not be required to conduct additional investigations and
remediation at that location, the costs of which are currently indeterminable
due to the numerous variables described in the fifth paragraph of this
Environmental Matters note.
 
     From 1974 to 1980, the Company operated a printed circuit manufacturing
facility in Florida as a lessee of property that is now the subject of a pending
lawsuit (the "Florida Lawsuit") and investigation by the Florida Department of
Environmental Protection ("FDEP"). On June 9, 1992, the Company entered into a
Cooperating Parties Agreement in which it and Gould, Inc., another prior lessee
of the site, have agreed to fund certain assessment and feasibility study
activities at the site, and an environmental consultant has been retained to
perform such activities. The cost of such activities is not expected to be
material to the Company. In addition to the Cooperating Parties Agreement, Hadco
and others are participating in alternative dispute resolution regarding the
site with an independent mediator. In connection with the mediation, in February
1997 the FDEP presented computer-generated estimates of remedial costs, for
activities expected to be spread over a number of years, that ranged from
approximately $3.3 million to $9.7 million. Mediation sessions were conducted in
March 1992 but have been suspended during the ongoing assessment and feasibility
activities. Management believes it is likely that it will participate in
implementing a continuing remedial program for the site, the costs of which are
currently unknown. Also see the seventh paragraph of this Environmental Matters
note relating to the Company's having been named as a third-party defendant in
the Florida Lawsuit.
 
     The Company has commenced the operation of a groundwater extraction system
at its Derry, New Hampshire facility to address certain groundwater
contamination and migration control issues. Because of the uncertainty regarding
both the quantity of contaminants beneath the building at the site and the
long-term effectiveness of the groundwater migration control system the Company
has installed, it is not possible to make a reliable estimate of the length of
time remedial activity will have to be performed. However, it is anticipated
that the groundwater extraction system will be operated for at least 30 years.
There can be no assurance that the Company will not be required to conduct
additional investigations and remediation relating to the Derry facility. The
total costs of such groundwater extraction system and of conducting any
additional investigations and remediation relating to the Derry facility are not
fully determinable due to the numerous variables described in the fifth
paragraph of this Environmental Matters note.
 
     Included in selling, general and administrative (SG&A) expenses are charges
for actual expenditures and accruals, based on estimates, for environmental
matters. During fiscal 1994, 1995, 1996 and for the three months ended January
25, 1997, the Company made, and charged to SG&A expenses, actual payments of
approximately $1,040,000, $1,111,000, $680,000 and $70,000, respectively, for
environmental matters. In 1994, 1995 and 1996, the Company also accrued and
charged to SG&A expenses approximately $2,100,000, $2,740,000 and $1,825,000,
respectively, as cost estimates for environmental matters.
 
                                      F-16
<PAGE>   83
 
                       HADCO CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
             NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)
                (INCLUDING DATA APPLICABLE TO UNAUDITED PERIODS)
 
     The Company accrues estimated costs associated with known environmental
matters, when such costs can be reasonably estimated. The cost estimates
relating to future environmental clean-up are subject to numerous variables, the
effects of which can be difficult to measure, including the stage of the
environmental investigations, the nature of potential remedies, possible joint
and several liability, the magnitude of possible contamination, the difficulty
of determining future liability, the time over which remediation might occur,
and the possible effects of changing laws and regulations. The total reserve for
environmental matters currently identified by the Company amounted to $8.2
million at October 28, 1995 and $10.0 million at October 26, 1996 and January
25, 1997. The current portion of these costs as of October 26, 1995, October 28,
1996 and January 25, 1997, amounted to approximately $900,000 in each period,
and is included in Other accrued expenses. The long-term portion of these costs
amounted to approximately $7.3 million, $9.1 million and $9.2 million as of
October 28, 1995, October 26, 1996 and January 25, 1997, respectively, and is
reported under the caption Other Long-Term Liabilities. Based on its assessment
at the current time, management estimates the cost of ultimate disposition of
the above known environmental matters to range from approximately $7.0 million
to $12.0 million, and is expected to be spread over a number of years.
Management believes the ultimate disposition of the above known environmental
matters will not have a material adverse effect on the liquidity, capital
resources, business or consolidated financial position of the Company. However,
one or more of such environmental matters could have a significant negative
impact on the Company's consolidated financial results for a particular
reporting period.
 
     The Company is one of 33 entities which have been named as potentially
responsible parties in a lawsuit pending in the federal district court of New
Hampshire concerning environmental conditions at the Auburn Road, Londonderry,
New Hampshire landfill site. Local, state and federal entities and certain other
parties to the litigation seek contribution for past costs, totaling
approximately $20 million, allegedly incurred to assess and remedy the Auburn
Road site. In December 1996, following publication and comment period, the U.S.
Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) amended the ROD to change the remedy at
the Auburn Road site from active groundwater remediation to future monitoring.
Other parties to the lawsuit also allege that future monitoring will be
required. The Company is contesting liability, but is participating in mediation
with 27 other parties in an effort to resolve the lawsuit.
 
     In connection with the Florida Lawsuit (as described in the second
paragraph of this Environmental Matters section), pending in the Circuit Court
of Broward County, Florida, Hadco and Gould, Inc., another prior lessee of the
site of the printed circuit manufacturing facility in Florida, was each served
with a third-party complaint in June 1995, as third-party defendants in such
pending Florida Lawsuit by a party who had previously been named as a defendant
when the Florida Lawsuit was commenced in 1993 by the FDEP. The Florida Lawsuit
seeks damages relating to environmental pollution and FDEP costs and expenses,
civil penalties, and declaratory and injunctive relief to require the parties to
complete assessment and remediation of soil and groundwater contamination. The
other parties include alleged owners of the property.
 
     In March 1993, the EPA notified Zycon of its potential liability for
maintenance and remediation costs in connection with a hazardous waste disposal
facility operated by Casmalia Resources, a California Limited Partnership, in
Santa Barbara County, California. The EPA identified Zycon as one of the 65
generators which had disposed the greatest amounts of materials at the site.
Based on the total tonnage contributed by all generators, Zycon's share is
estimated at approximately 0.2% of the total weight.
 
     The Casmalia site was regulated by the EPA during the period when the
material was accepted. There is no allegation that Zycon violated any law in the
disposal of material at the site, rather the
 
                                      F-17
<PAGE>   84
 
                       HADCO CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
             NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)
                (INCLUDING DATA APPLICABLE TO UNAUDITED PERIODS)
 
EPA's actions stemmed from the fact that Casmalia Resources may not have the
financial means to implement a closure plan for the site and because of Zycon's
status as a generator of hazardous waste.
 
     In September 1996, a Consent Decree among the EPA and 48 entities
(including Zycon) acting through the Casmalia Steering Committee ("CSC") was
lodged with the United States District Court in Los Angeles, California, which
must approve the agreement. Although this approval is pending, work has started
under the Consent Decree. The Consent Decree sets forth the terms and conditions
under which the CSC will carry out work aimed at final closure of the site.
Certain closure activities will be performed by the CSC. Later work will be
performed by the CSC, if funded by other parties. Under the Consent Decree, the
settling parties will work with the EPA to pursue the non-settling parties to
ensure they participate in contributing to the closure and long-term operation
and maintenance of the facility.
 
     The future costs in connection with the lawsuits described in the above
paragraphs are currently indeterminable due to such factors as the unknown
timing and extent of any future remedial actions which may be required, the
extent of any liability of the Company and of other potentially responsible
parties, and the financial resources of the other potentially responsible
parties. Management currently believes, based on the facts currently known to
it, that it is probable that the ultimate dispositions of the above lawsuits
will not have a material adverse effect on the Company's business and financial
condition; however, there can be no assurance that this will be the case.
 
  Purchase Commitments
 
     The Company had commitments to purchase approximately $15,668,000 of
manufacturing equipment and approximately $1,520,000 of leasehold improvements
as of January 25, 1997. The majority of these commitments is expected to be
completed by the end of fiscal 1997.
 
                                      F-18
<PAGE>   85
 
                       HADCO CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
             NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)
                (INCLUDING DATA APPLICABLE TO UNAUDITED PERIODS)
 
(10) STOCKHOLDERS' INVESTMENT
 
  Stock Options
 
     The following table summarizes stock option activity with respect to the
nonqualified stock options:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                 EXERCISE
                                                                                PRICE RANGE
                                                                 NUMBER       ---------------
                                                               OF SHARES
                                                             --------------
                                                             (IN THOUSANDS)
    <S>                                                      <C>              <C>      <C>
    Outstanding, October 30, 1993..........................       1,921       $2.00 -  $ 9.00
      Options granted......................................         340        8.00 -    8.81
      Options exercised....................................        (332)       2.00 -    4.94
      Options canceled.....................................        (239)       2.00 -    9.00
                                                                  -----       ---------------
    Outstanding, October 29, 1994..........................       1,690        2.00 -    9.00
      Options granted......................................         223        8.50 -   25.69
      Options exercised....................................        (320)       2.00 -   11.06
      Options canceled.....................................        (147)       2.10 -    8.81
                                                                  -----       ---------------
    Outstanding, October 28, 1995..........................       1,446        2.00 -   25.69
      Options granted......................................         150       27.00 -   31.50
      Options exercised....................................        (443)       2.00 -   11.06
      Options canceled.....................................         (45)       2.00 -   31.50
                                                                  -----       ---------------
    Outstanding, October 26, 1996..........................       1,108        2.00 -   31.50
      Options granted......................................         174                 47.44
      Options exercised....................................         (62)       2.00 -   31.50
                                                                  -----       ---------------
    Outstanding, January 25, 1997..........................       1,220       $2.00 -  $47.44
                                                                  =====       ===============
</TABLE>
 
     The Company has the following nonqualified stock option plans:
 
     DECEMBER 1985 PLAN AND DECEMBER 1986 PLAN
 
     The options under these plans are exercisable immediately, and have various
vesting periods up to 10 years according to each individual option agreement
with an expiration date no later than 10 years and 90 days from the date of
grant. Upon termination of employment under certain circumstances, the Company
may, at its option, repurchase the exercised but unvested shares at the original
purchase price.
 
     DECEMBER 1987 PLAN
 
     The options under this plan become exercisable according to each option
agreement and expire no later than June 30, 1997.
 
     SEPTEMBER 1990 PLAN
 
     This plan provides for the granting of options at a price equal to the fair
market value at the date of grant. The options vest over periods of up to seven
years and become exercisable according to each option agreement, and they expire
no later than 10 years from the date of grant.
 
                                      F-19
<PAGE>   86
 
                       HADCO CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
             NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)
                (INCLUDING DATA APPLICABLE TO UNAUDITED PERIODS)
 
     DECEMBER 1991 DIRECTOR PLAN
 
     This plan provides for the granting of options to purchase up to 150,000
shares of common stock at a price equal to the fair market value at the date of
grant. These options are exercisable ratably over a five-year period and expire
no later than seven years from the date of grant. The Board of Directors has
amended this plan, subject to the approval of the shareholders in February 1997,
(i) to increase the number of shares available to 300,000, (ii) provide that any
current non-employee director who will have five years of service in such
capacity on February 26, 1997 be automatically granted, on such date and on each
anniversary of service thereafter, a vested option to purchase 3,000 shares and
(iii) provide that any current non-employee director who does not have five
years of service in such capacity on March 15, 1997 and any future non-employee
director each be automatically granted, on the date such non-employee director
achieves five years of service in such capacity and on each anniversary of
service thereafter, a vested option to purchase 3,000 shares.
 
     NOVEMBER 1995 PLAN
 
     This plan provides for the granting of options to purchase up to 1,000,000
shares of common stock at a price equal to fair market value at the date of
grant. The options vest according to each option agreement and they expire no
later than 10 years from the date of grant.
 
     The status of the stock option plans at January 25, 1997 is as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                      AVERAGE
                                                        OPTIONS         OPTIONS       EXERCISE
                          PLAN                        OUTSTANDING     EXERCISABLE      PRICE
    ------------------------------------------------  -----------     -----------     --------
                                                      (IN THOUSANDS)
    <S>                                               <C>             <C>             <C>
    *December 1985 and 1986 Plans...................       203            203          $ 2.92
    *December 1987 Plan.............................        75             75            3.00
    *September 1990 Plan............................       691            263           11.99
     December 1991 Director Plan....................        88             37           18.49
     November 1995 Plan.............................       163             --           46.93
                                                         -----            ---          ------
                                                         1,220            578          $15.06
                                                         =====            ===          ======
</TABLE>
 
- ------------
* The Board of Directors has determined to make no further grants under the
  December 1985 Plan, December 1986 Plan, December 1987 Plan and September 1990
  Plan.
 
     The Company had reserved as of January 25, 1997, a total of 2,062,829
shares of common stock for issuance under the nonqualified stock option plans
listed in the above chart. During fiscal 1994, 1995 and 1996 and the quarter
ended January 25, 1997, approximately $360,000, $287,000, $154,000 and $32,000,
respectively, were charged against income as compensation expense associated
with the granting of these options.
 
     The Company adopted a Stockholder Rights Plan in August 1995 pursuant to
which the Company declared the distribution of one Common Stock Purchase Right
("Right") for each share of outstanding common stock. Under certain conditions,
each Right may be exercised for one share of common stock at an exercise price
of $130, subject to adjustment. Under circumstances defined in the Stockholder
Rights Plan, the Rights entitle holders to purchase stock having a value of
twice the exercise price of the Rights. Until they become exercisable, the
Rights are not transferable apart from the common stock. The Rights may be
redeemed by the Company at any time prior to the occurrence of certain events at
$.01 per Right. The Stockholder Rights Plan will expire on September 11, 2005,
unless the Rights are earlier redeemed by the Company.
 
                                      F-20
<PAGE>   87
 
                       HADCO CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
             NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)
                (INCLUDING DATA APPLICABLE TO UNAUDITED PERIODS)
 
(11)  RETIREMENT PLAN
 
     The Hadco Corporation Retirement Plan (the "Plan"), as amended, covers all
employees with at least six months of continuous service, as defined. Annual
profit sharing contributions are determined at the discretion of the Board of
Directors but cannot exceed the amount allowable for federal income tax
purposes. The Company made profit sharing contributions of $1,074,000,
$2,285,000 and $3,335,000 to the Plan for the years ended October 1994, 1995 and
1996, respectively. The Company has provided $1,100,000 for the three months
ended January 25, 1997 for profit sharing contributions.
 
     The Plan permits participants to elect to have contributions made to the
Plan in the form of reductions in salary under Section 401(k) of the Internal
Revenue Code subject to limitations set out in the Plan. Under the Plan, the
Company will match employee contributions up to a set percentage. Employee
contributions become vested when made, and Company contributions become vested
at the rate of 33 1/3 for each year of service with the Company. The Company
matched employee contributions in the amount of approximately $500,000, $600,000
and $736,000 during fiscal 1994, 1995 and 1996, respectively. The Company has
provided $178,000 for matching contributions during the quarter ended January
25, 1997.
 
(12)  QUARTERLY RESULTS (UNAUDITED)
 
     The following summarized unaudited results of operations for the fiscal
quarters in the years ended October 1995 and 1996 have been accounted for using
generally accepted principles for interim reporting purposes and include
adjustments (consisting of normal recurring adjustments) that the Company
considers necessary for the fair presentation of results for these interim
periods.
 
                                      F-21
<PAGE>   88
 
                       HADCO CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
             NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)
                (INCLUDING DATA APPLICABLE TO UNAUDITED PERIODS)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                         1995           1996
                                                                        -------        -------
                                                                        (IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT
                                                                           PER SHARE DATA)
<S>                                                                     <C>            <C>
First Fiscal Quarter --
  Net sales...........................................................  $56,825        $76,481
  Gross profit........................................................   11,292         19,482
  Net income..........................................................    3,003          7,191
  Net income per share................................................      .29            .65
  Weighted average shares outstanding.................................   10,446         11,104
Second Fiscal Quarter --
  Net sales...........................................................  $67,637        $88,096
  Gross profit........................................................   16,261         21,893
  Net income..........................................................    5,193          7,895
  Net income per share................................................      .49            .71
  Weighted average shares outstanding.................................   10,626         11,135
Third Fiscal Quarter --
  Net sales...........................................................  $67,752        $88,225
  Gross profit........................................................   17,540         21,451
  Net income..........................................................    6,152          7,994
  Net income per share................................................      .56            .72
  Weighted average shares outstanding.................................   11,034         11,100
Fourth Fiscal Quarter --
  Net sales...........................................................  $72,954        $97,883
  Gross profit........................................................   19,402         23,322
  Net income..........................................................    7,026          8,934
  Net income per share................................................      .63            .81
  Weighted average shares outstanding.................................   11,124         11,008
</TABLE>
 
(13)  CUSTOMERS
 
     During fiscal years 1994, 1995 and 1996 and the quarter ended January 25,
1997, no customer accounted for more than 7%, 7%, 15% and 14% of consolidated
net sales, respectively. The Company's five largest customers accounted for 28%,
28%, 34% and 33% of consolidated net sales during fiscal 1994, 1995 and 1996 and
the quarter ended January 25, 1997, respectively. For the first quarter of
fiscal 1997 and the 1996 fiscal year, one customer accounted for more than 10%
of consolidated net sales.
 
                                      F-22
<PAGE>   89
 
             PRO FORMA CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
 
     In January 1997, Hadco purchased substantially all of Zycon's common stock
for approximately $205 million in cash. The Company also incurred approximately
$7.5 million in acquisition related costs resulting in a total purchase price of
approximately $212.5 million. The acquisition was financed by a new Credit
Facility of up to $250 million. The Company borrowed approximately $215 million
under the new Credit Facility, upon consummation of the transaction.
 
     This acquisition is being accounted for as a purchase, and due to the
different bases in certain assets for book and tax purposes, deferred taxes have
been provided for as part of the purchase price allocation in accordance with
Statement of Financial Accounting Standards (SFAS) No. 109. A significant
portion of the purchase price, as outlined in the attached notes to these pro
forma financial statements, has been identified in an appraisal as intangible
assets, including approximately $78 million of in-process R&D (see discussion in
Note 1 to October 26, 1996 Pro Forma Condensed Consolidated Statement of
Operations).
 
     The accompanying Pro Forma Condensed Consolidated Statements of Operations
for the year ended October 26, 1996 and the three months ended January 25, 1997
assume that the acquisition of Zycon took place on October 29, 1995, the
beginning of Hadco's fiscal year ended October 26, 1996. The Pro Forma Condensed
Consolidated Statements of Operations do not include the effect of any
non-recurring write-offs directly attributable to the acquisition.
 
     The accompanying pro forma information is presented for illustrative
purposes only and is not necessarily indicative of the financial position or
results of operations which would actually have been reported had the
acquisition been in effect during the periods presented, or which may be
reported in the future.
 
     The accompanying Pro Forma Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements
should be read in conjunction with the historical financial statements and
related notes thereto for Hadco and Zycon.
 
                                      F-23
<PAGE>   90
 
                               HADCO CORPORATION
 
            PRO FORMA CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS
                      FOR THE YEAR ENDED OCTOBER 26, 1996
                                  (Unaudited)
                     (In thousands, except per share data)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                 HISTORICAL
                                    ------------------------------------
                                         HADCO               ZYCON
                                       YEAR ENDED         YEAR ENDED        PRO FORMA      PRO FORMA
                                    OCTOBER 26, 1996   DECEMBER 31, 1996   ADJUSTMENTS     COMBINED
                                    ----------------   -----------------   -----------     ---------
<S>                                 <C>                <C>                 <C>             <C>
Net Sales.........................      $350,685           $ 219,660                       $570,345
Cost of Sales.....................       264,537             186,314                        450,851
                                        --------            --------                       --------
Gross Profit......................        86,148              33,346                        119,494
Selling, General and
  Administrative Expenses.........        34,616              16,079           (2,637)(2)    48,058
Amortization of Acquired
  Intangible Assets...............            --                  --            6,468 (3)     6,468
                                        --------            --------         --------      --------
Income from Operations............        51,532              17,267           (3,831)       64,968
Interest and Other Income.........         1,287                 726             (805)(4)     1,208
Interest Expense..................          (338)             (2,567)         (13,292)(5)   (16,197) 
Other Expense.....................            --              (6,019)           6,019 (1)        --
                                        --------            --------         --------      --------
Income Before Provisions for
  Income Taxes....................        52,481               9,407          (11,909)       49,979
Provision for Income Taxes........        20,467               6,518           (5,706)(6)    21,279
                                        --------            --------         --------      --------
Net Income (Loss).................      $ 32,014           $   2,889        $  (6,203)     $ 28,700
                                        ========            ========         ========      ========
Net Income per Share..............      $   2.89                                           $   2.59
                                        ========                                           ========
Weighted Average Shares
  Outstanding.....................        11,084                                             11,084
                                        ========                                           ========
</TABLE>
 
NOTE 1:
 
     For purpose of this Pro Forma Condensed Consolidated Statement of
Operations, the acquired in-process R&D was assumed to have been written off
prior to the period presented herein, so that the statement of operations
includes only recurring costs.
 
NOTE 2: PRO FORMA ADJUSTMENTS
 
     The following is a description of each of the pro forma adjustments.
 
     (1) Eliminate non-recurring acquisition costs incurred by Zycon.
 
     (2) Eliminate non-recurring Zycon management salaries and certain bonuses.
 
     (3) Amortization of acquired intangible assets over lives ranging from 12
         to 30 years.
 
     (4) Reduce interest income as a result of utilizing cash for acquisition.
 
     (5) Interest expense on debt issued to finance acquisition.
 
     (6) Related tax effect of adjustments (1) through (5).
 
                                      F-24
<PAGE>   91
 
                               HADCO CORPORATION
 
            PRO FORMA CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS
                     FOR THE QUARTER ENDED JANUARY 25, 1997
                                  (Unaudited)
                     (In thousands, except per share data)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                HISTORICAL
                                   -------------------------------------
                                        HADCO                ZYCON
                                    QUARTER ENDED        QUARTER ENDED       PRO FORMA     PRO FORMA
                                   JANUARY 25, 1997    DECEMBER 31, 1996    ADJUSTMENTS    COMBINED
                                   ----------------    -----------------    -----------    ---------
<S>                                <C>                 <C>                  <C>            <C>
Net Sales.........................     $111,536             $61,011                        $172,547
Cost of Sales.....................       86,681              52,925                         139,606
                                       --------             -------                        --------
Gross Profit......................       24,855               8,086                          32,941
Selling, General and
  Administrative Expenses.........        9,028               4,342               (659)(3)   12,711
Amortization of Acquired
  Intangible Assets...............          270                 136              1,188 (4)    1,594
Write-off of In-process Research
  and Development.................       78,000                  --            (78,000)(1)       --
                                       --------             -------           --------     --------
Income (Loss) From Operations.....      (62,443)              3,608             77,472       18,637
Interest and Other Income.........          880                 167               (496)(5)      551
Interest Expense..................         (933)             (1,033)            (2,703)(6)   (4,669) 
Other Expense.....................           --              (6,019)             6,019 (2)       --
                                       --------             -------           --------     --------
Income (Loss) Before Provision for
  Income Taxes....................      (62,496)             (3,277)            80,291       14,518
Provision for Income Taxes........        6,665               1,247             (1,669)(7)    6,243
                                       --------             -------           --------     --------
Net Income (Loss).................     $(69,161)            $(4,524)         $  81,960     $  8,275
                                       ========             =======           ========     ========
Net Income (Loss) per Share.......     $  (6.64)                                           $   0.76
                                       ========                                            ========
Weighted Average Shares
  Outstanding.....................       10,413                                              10,944
                                       ========                                            ========
</TABLE>
 
NOTE 1: PRO FORMA ADJUSTMENTS
 
     The following is a description of each of the pro forma adjustments:
 
     (1) Eliminate non-recurring write-off of in-process R&D.
 
     (2) Eliminate non-recurring acquisition costs incurred by Zycon.
 
     (3) Eliminate non-recurring Zycon management salaries and certain bonuses.
 
     (4) Amortization of acquired intangible assets over lives ranging from 12
         to 30 years.
 
     (5) Reduce interest income as a result of utilizing cash for acquisition.
 
     (6) Interest expense on debt issued to finance acquisition.
 
     (7) Related tax effect of adjustments (1) through (6).
 
                                      F-25
<PAGE>   92
 
                    REPORT OF INDEPENDENT PUBLIC ACCOUNTANTS
 
To Zycon Corporation:
 
     We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheet of Zycon
Corporation (a Delaware corporation) and subsidiaries as of December 31, 1996,
and the related consolidated statements of income, stockholders' equity and cash
flows for the year then ended. These financial statements are the responsibility
of the Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on
these financial statements based on our audit.
 
     We conducted our audit in accordance with generally accepted auditing
standards. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain
reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material
misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting
the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes
assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by
management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation.
We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.
 
     In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present fairly,
in all material respects, the financial position of Zycon Corporation and
subsidiaries as of December 31, 1996, and the results of their operations and
their cash flows for the year then ended in conformity with generally accepted
accounting principles.
 
                                          ARTHUR ANDERSEN LLP
 
San Jose, California
January 17, 1997
 
                                      F-26
<PAGE>   93
 
                          INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' REPORT
 
To the Board of Directors and Stockholders
  of Zycon Corporation:
 
     We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheet of Zycon
Corporation and subsidiary as of December 31, 1995 and the related consolidated
statements of income, stockholders' equity and cash flows for each of the years
in the two-year period ended December 31, 1995. These consolidated financial
statements are the responsibility of the Company's management. Our
responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on
our audits.
 
     We conducted our audits in accordance with generally accepted auditing
standards. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain
reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material
misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting
the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes
assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by
management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation.
We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.
 
     In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above
present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Zycon
Corporation and subsidiary as of December 31, 1995 and the results of their
operations and their cash flows for each of the years in the two-year period
ended December 31, 1995 in conformity with generally accepted accounting
principles.
 
                                          KPMG PEAT MARWICK LLP
 
January 19, 1996
 
                                      F-27
<PAGE>   94
 
                               ZYCON CORPORATION
 
                          CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
                           DECEMBER 31, 1995 AND 1996
                (IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT SHARE AND PER SHARE DATA)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                           1995         1996
                                                                          -------     --------
<S>                                                                       <C>         <C>
ASSETS
CURRENT ASSETS:
  Cash and cash equivalents.............................................  $11,264     $  7,549
  Receivables, net of allowances of $250 in 1995 and $255 in 1996.......   20,886       28,430
  Inventories...........................................................    6,131       11,343
  Prepaid expenses and other current assets.............................    1,734        2,569
                                                                          --------     -------
          Current assets................................................   40,015       49,891
PLANT AND EQUIPMENT, net................................................   52,130       95,297
DEPOSITS AND OTHER ASSETS...............................................    2,830        3,304
EXCESS OF COST OVER NET ASSETS ACQUIRED, net of accumulated amortization
  of $272 in 1996.......................................................       --        5,396
                                                                          --------     -------
                                                                          $94,975     $153,888
                                                                          ========     =======
LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
CURRENT LIABILITIES:
  Current portion of long-term debt and bank borrowings.................  $ 2,567     $  9,122
  Accounts payable......................................................   17,624       26,192
  Accrued liabilities...................................................    5,021        7,479
  Income taxes payable..................................................    1,770          870
                                                                          --------     -------
          Current liabilities...........................................   26,982       43,663
LONG-TERM DEBT AND LIABILITIES, net of current portion..................    5,458       43,777
DEFERRED INCOME TAXES...................................................    6,634        7,003
                                                                          --------     -------
          Total liabilities.............................................   39,074       94,443
                                                                          --------     -------
COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES (see Note 7)
STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY:
  Preferred stock; $0.001 par value; 20,000,000 shares authorized; none
     outstanding........................................................       --           --
  Common stock; $0.001 par value; 25,000,000 shares authorized;
     11,000,000 and 11,056,600 shares issued and outstanding in 1995 and
     1996, respectively.................................................       11           11
  Additional paid-in capital............................................   32,369       33,024
  Retained earnings.....................................................   23,521       26,410
                                                                          --------     -------
          Total stockholders' equity....................................   55,901       59,445
                                                                          --------     -------
                                                                          $94,975     $153,888
                                                                          ========     =======
</TABLE>
 
  The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial
                                  statements.
 
                                      F-28
<PAGE>   95
 
                               ZYCON CORPORATION
 
                       CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF INCOME
              FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1994, 1995 AND 1996
                                 (IN THOUSANDS)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                               1994         1995         1996
                                                             --------     --------     --------
<S>                                                          <C>          <C>          <C>
Net Sales..................................................  $149,151     $180,944     $219,660
Cost of Sales..............................................   133,043      153,109      186,314
                                                             --------     --------     --------
Gross Profit...............................................    16,108       27,835       33,346
Selling, General and Administrative Expenses...............     8,350       11,233       16,079
                                                             --------     --------     --------
Income from Operations.....................................     7,758       16,602       17,267
                                                             --------     --------     --------
Other Income (Expense):
Interest Income............................................       264          711          726
Interest Expense...........................................    (2,250)      (2,427)      (2,567)
Other Expense..............................................        --           --       (6,019)
                                                             --------     --------     --------
Other Income (Expense).....................................    (1,986)      (1,716)      (7,860)
                                                             --------     --------     --------
Income Before Income Taxes.................................     5,772       14,886        9,407
Provision For Income Taxes.................................        97        7,409        6,518
                                                             --------     --------     --------
Net Income.................................................  $  5,675     $  7,477     $  2,889
                                                             ========     ========     ========
Pro Forma Net Income Data (Unaudited):
Income Before Income Taxes, as reported....................  $  5,772     $ 14,886
Pro Forma Provision for Income Taxes.......................     2,333        5,925
                                                                          --------
Pro Forma Net Income.......................................  $  3,439     $  8,961
                                                                          ========
</TABLE>
 
  The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial
                                  statements.
 
                                      F-29
<PAGE>   96
 
                               ZYCON CORPORATION
 
                CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
              FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1994, 1995 AND 1996
                                 (IN THOUSANDS)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                            NOTES
                                           COMMON STOCK     ADDITIONAL    RECEIVABLE                   TOTAL
                                          ---------------    PAID-IN         FROM       RETAINED   STOCKHOLDERS'
                                          SHARES   AMOUNT    CAPITAL     STOCKHOLDERS   EARNINGS      EQUITY
                                          ------   ------   ----------   ------------   --------   -------------
<S>                                       <C>      <C>      <C>          <C>            <C>        <C>
BALANCES AS OF DECEMBER 31, 1993........   8,000    $  8     $     22       $   --      $23,483       $23,513
  Stockholder distributions.............      --      --           --           --       (3,859)       (3,859)
  Issuance of stockholder notes.........      --      --           --         (575)          --          (575)
  Collections on stockholder notes......      --      --           --           45           --            45
  Net income............................      --      --           --           --        5,675         5,675
                                          ------     ---      -------        -----      -------       -------
BALANCES AS OF DECEMBER 31, 1994........   8,000       8           22         (530)      25,299        24,799
  Sale of common stock, net of $3,650
     issuance costs.....................   3,000       3       32,347           --           --        32,350
  Stockholder distributions.............      --      --           --           --       (9,255)       (9,255)
  Collections on stockholder notes......      --      --           --          530           --           530
  Net income............................      --      --           --           --        7,477         7,477
                                          ------     ---      -------        -----      -------       -------
BALANCES AS OF DECEMBER 31, 1995........  11,000      11       32,369           --       23,521        55,901
  Issuance of common stock in connection
     with Alternate Circuit Technology,
     Inc. (ACT) acquisition.............      50      --          600           --           --           600
  Issuance of common stock pursuant to
     the stock option plan..............       7      --           55           --           --            55
  Net income............................      --      --           --           --        2,889         2,889
                                          ------     ---      -------        -----      -------       -------
BALANCES AS OF DECEMBER 31, 1996........  11,057    $ 11     $ 33,024       $   --      $26,410       $59,445
                                          ======     ===      =======        =====      =======       =======
</TABLE>
 
  The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial
                                  statements.
 
                                      F-30
<PAGE>   97
 
                               ZYCON CORPORATION
 
                     CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
              FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1994, 1995 AND 1996
                                 (IN THOUSANDS)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                           1994        1995        1996
                                                                         --------    --------    --------
<S>                                                                      <C>         <C>         <C>
CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES:
  Net income...........................................................  $  5,675    $  7,477    $  2,889
  Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating
     activities:
     Depreciation and amortization.....................................     9,199       9,691      11,016
     Deferred income taxes.............................................        --       5,618          38
     Changes in operating assets and liabilities, net of effects from
      purchase of ACT:
       Increase in receivables.........................................    (4,234)     (5,723)     (5,538)
       (Increase) decrease in inventories..............................       156      (1,661)     (3,106)
       (Increase) decrease in prepaid expenses, deposits and other
        assets.........................................................       339      (2,491)      2,134
       Increase in accounts payable....................................       772       7,010       7,862
       Increase in accrued liabilities.................................       204       1,708       1,060
       Increase (decrease) in income taxes payable.....................        --       1,770        (607)
                                                                         --------    --------    --------
          Net cash provided by operating activities....................    12,111      23,399      15,748
                                                                         --------    --------    --------
CASH FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES:
  Purchase of ACT, net of cash acquired................................        --          --      (8,888)
  Purchases of plant and equipment.....................................   (13,060)    (22,365)    (52,156)
  Sale of short-term investments.......................................     2,026          --          --
                                                                         --------    --------    --------
          Net cash used for investing activities.......................   (11,034)    (22,365)    (61,044)
                                                                         --------    --------    --------
CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES:
  Bank borrowings, net.................................................     1,000      (7,000)      2,543
  Proceeds from long-term debt.........................................    11,378       1,761      46,206
  Repayment of long-term debt..........................................    (7,685)    (14,863)     (7,223)
  Proceeds from sale of common stock...................................        --      32,350          55
  Issuance of stockholder notes........................................      (575)         --          --
  Collections on stockholder notes.....................................        45         530          --
  Distribution paid to stockholders....................................    (3,185)    (10,765)         --
                                                                         --------    --------    --------
          Net cash provided by financing activities....................       978       2,013      41,581
                                                                         --------    --------    --------
INCREASE (DECREASE) IN CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS.......................     2,055       3,047      (3,715)
CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS AT BEGINNING OF YEAR.........................     6,162       8,217      11,264
                                                                         --------    --------    --------
CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS AT END OF YEAR...............................  $  8,217    $ 11,264    $  7,549
                                                                         ========    ========    ========
SUPPLEMENTAL DISCLOSURE OF CASH FLOW INFORMATION:
  Cash paid for interest...............................................  $  2,149    $  2,427    $  2,351
  Cash paid for income taxes...........................................  $     20    $     60    $  6,357
SUPPLEMENTAL DISCLOSURE OF NON-CASH FINANCING ACTIVITIES:
  Issuance of common stock in connection with ACT acquisition..........  $     --    $     --    $    600
  Assets of $8,802 acquired, net of related liabilities of $4,961
     assumed from ACT..................................................  $     --    $     --    $  3,841
  Stockholder distributions declared but not paid......................  $  1,510    $     --    $     --
</TABLE>
 
  The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial
                                  statements.
 
                                      F-31
<PAGE>   98
 
                       ZYCON CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
                   NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                               DECEMBER 31, 1996
 
1.  SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES:
 
  The Company and Consolidation
 
     Zycon Corporation (the "Company") manufactures multilayer printed circuit
boards for original equipment manufacturers and contract manufacturers of
sophisticated electronic equipment. The Company's principal customers serve
diverse market segments, including data communications, telecommunications,
advanced storage systems, workstation, servers and personal computers.
 
     The accompanying consolidated financial statements include the accounts of
the Company and its wholly owned subsidiaries. All intercompany accounts and
transactions have been eliminated in consolidation.
 
  Use of Estimates
 
     Management of the Company has made a number of estimates and assumptions
relating to the reporting of assets and liabilities and the disclosure of
contingent assets and liabilities to prepare these consolidated financial
statements in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles. Actual
results could differ from those estimates.
 
  Cash Equivalents
 
     Cash equivalents consist primarily of money market funds and highly liquid
debt instruments with original maturity dates up to 90 days.
 
  Short-Term Investments
 
     In 1994, the Company adopted Statement of Financial Accounting Standards
("SFAS") No. 115, "Accounting for Certain Investments in Debt and Equity
Securities." Short-term investments are classified as available for sale under
the provisions of SFAS No. 115 and are stated at fair value. Any unrealized
gains and losses are reported as a separate component of stockholders' equity,
but to date have not been significant.
 
  Inventories
 
     Inventories are stated at the lower of first-in, first-out cost or market.
The Company periodically reviews its inventories for potential slow-moving and
obsolete items and writes down impaired items to net realizable value.
 
  Plant and Equipment
 
     Plant and equipment are stated at cost. Depreciation is computed using the
straight-line method over the estimated useful lives of the assets, ranging from
3 to 40 years. Leasehold improvements are amortized over the shorter of the
respective lease terms, ranging from 10 to 20 years, or their estimated useful
lives.
 
  Intangible Assets
 
     Excess of cost over net assets acquired (goodwill) from the ACT acquisition
(see Note 5) is amortized using the straight-line method over ten years. In
order to comply with Statement of Financial Accounting Standards ("SFAS") No.
121, "Accounting for the Impairment of Long-Lived
 
                                      F-32
<PAGE>   99
 
                       ZYCON CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
 
Assets and for Long-Lived Assets to be Disposed of," the realizability is
evaluated periodically by management as events or circumstances indicate a
possible inability to recover its carrying amount. Such evaluation is based on
various analyses, including cash flow and profitability projections that
incorporate, as applicable, the impact on existing lines of business. The
analysis necessarily involves significant management judgment to evaluate the
ability of an acquired business to perform within projections.
 
  Revenue Recognition
 
     Sales are recognized upon shipment. Product returns and warranty costs have
been insignificant.
 
  Other Expense
 
     The Company incurred other expense of $6,019,000 during the year ended
December 31, 1996 relating to the acquisition of the Company by Hadco
Corporation (see Note 8).
 
  Income Taxes
 
     The Company accounts for income taxes using the liability method under
Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 109, Accounting for Income
Taxes. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are recognized for the future tax
consequences attributable to differences between the financial statement
carrying amounts of existing assets and liabilities and their respective tax
bases. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured using enacted tax rates
expected to apply to taxable income in the years in which those temporary
differences are expected to be recovered or settled. The effect on deferred
income tax assets and liabilities of changes in tax rates is recognized in
income in the period that includes the enactment date.
 
     The Company was an S corporation for Federal and state income tax reporting
purposes prior to the initial public offering on September 26, 1995. Federal and
state income taxes on the income of an S corporation are generally payable by
the individual stockholders rather than the corporation. Accordingly, only the
California S corporation franchise tax was provided while the Company was as S
corporation.
 
     Upon termination of the Company's S corporation status, the Company
established its net deferred tax liability and recorded an accompanying charge
of $4.5 million to income tax expense in 1995. The accompanying consolidated
statements of income for the years ended December 31, 1994 and 1995 include
provisions for income taxes on an unaudited pro forma basis, using the asset and
liability method, as if the Company had been a C corporation, fully subject to
Federal and state income taxes.
 
  Environmental Remediation Costs
 
     The Company accrues for expenses associated with environmental remediation
obligations when such expenses are probable and can be reasonably estimated.
Accruals for estimated expenses for environmental remediation obligations
generally are recognized no later than completion of the remedial feasibility
study. Such accruals are adjusted as further information becomes available or
circumstances change. Estimates of future expenditures for environmental
remediation obligations are not discounted to their present value.
 
  Concentration of Credit Risk
 
     Financial instruments potentially subjecting the Company to concentration
of credit risk consist primarily of cash equivalents and accounts receivable. By
policy, the Company limits the amounts
 
                                      F-33
<PAGE>   100
 
                       ZYCON CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
 
invested in any one type of investment. Management believes the financial risks
associated with such investments are minimal. Substantially all of the Company's
accounts receivable are derived from domestic sales to original equipment
manufacturers and contract assemblers of workstations, networking products,
computers, telecommunications equipment and instrumentation devices. A
significant percentage of the Company's receivables are concentrated with a few
customers. Historically, the Company has not incurred material credit-related
losses.
 
  Foreign Currency Translation
 
     The functional currency of the Company's Malaysian subsidiary is the United
States dollar. Accordingly, all translation gains and losses resulting from
transactions denominated in currencies other than United States dollars are
included in the consolidated statements of income. To date, the resulting gains
and losses have not been material.
 
  Reclassifications
 
     Certain 1994 and 1995 balances have been reclassified to conform with the
1996 consolidated financial statement presentation.
 
2.  BALANCE SHEET COMPONENTS:
 
  Cash Equivalents
 
     Cash equivalents include certain investments classified as
available-for-sale securities as follows as of December 31 (in thousands):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                         1995        1996
                                                                        -------     ------
    <S>                                                                 <C>         <C>
    Money market funds................................................  $    --     $3,574
    U.S. governmental treasury bills..................................    1,995      1,975
    Commercial paper..................................................   11,000      2,000
                                                                        -------     ------
                                                                        $12,995     $7,549
                                                                        =======     ======
</TABLE>
 
     These securities all have original maturity dates of 90 days or less, with
fair values approximating their cost.
 
  Inventories
 
     A summary of inventories follows as of December 31 (in thousands):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                         1995       1996
                                                                        ------     -------
    <S>                                                                 <C>        <C>
    Raw materials.....................................................  $1,392     $ 5,599
    Work in process...................................................   4,739       5,744
                                                                        ------     -------
                                                                        $6,131     $11,343
                                                                        ======     =======
</TABLE>
 
                                      F-34
<PAGE>   101
 
                       ZYCON CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
 
  Plant and Equipment
 
     A summary of plant and equipment follows as of December 31 (in thousands):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                       1995         1996
                                                                      -------     --------
    <S>                                                               <C>         <C>
    Machinery and equipment.........................................  $61,975     $ 98,699
    Leasehold improvements..........................................   23,704       25,744
    Building and building improvements..............................       --       15,458
    Office furniture and equipment..................................      520          553
    Construction in progress........................................    3,250          813
    Other...........................................................      580           --
                                                                      -------     --------
                                                                       90,029      141,267
    Less -- Accumulated depreciation and amortization...............  (37,899)     (45,970)
                                                                      -------     --------
                                                                      $52,130     $ 95,297
                                                                      =======     ========
</TABLE>
 
     Plant and equipment with a cost of approximately $32 million are located at
the Company's wholly owned subsidiary in Malaysia.
 
  Accrued Liabilities
 
     Accrued liabilities consisted of the following as of December 31 (in
thousands):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                          1995       1996
                                                                         ------     ------
    <S>                                                                  <C>        <C>
    Vacation...........................................................  $1,883     $2,120
    Payroll............................................................   1,099      1,764
    Bonuses............................................................   1,170      1,104
    Health care and workers compensation...............................     530      1,150
    Other..............................................................     339      1,341
                                                                         ------     ------
                                                                         $5,021     $7,479
                                                                         ======     ======
</TABLE>
 
  Long-Term Debt and Liabilities and Bank Borrowings
 
     Long-term debt and liabilities and bank borrowings consisted of the
following as of December 31 (in thousands):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                        1995        1996
                                                                       -------     -------
    <S>                                                                <C>         <C>
    Line of credit arrangement with a U.S. bank......................  $    --     $16,136
    Line of credit arrangement with a Malaysian bank.................       --       2,543
    Notes payable to financial lending companies and banks...........    8,025      32,857
    Long-term liabilities............................................       --       1,363
                                                                       -------     -------
                                                                         8,025      52,899
    Less -- Current maturities.......................................   (2,567)     (9,122)
                                                                       -------     -------
    Long-term debt and liabilities...................................  $ 5,458     $43,777
                                                                       =======     =======
</TABLE>
 
     The Company has available a revolving bank line of credit arrangement with
a U.S. bank aggregating the lesser of $28,000,000 or a specified percentage of
eligible accounts receivable. As of December 31, 1996, there was $16,136,000
outstanding under the line of credit agreement. The line of credit agreement
expires on July 1, 1998. Borrowings under the line of credit agreement incur
interest at the bank's prime rate (8.25% as of December 31, 1996) and are
secured by receivables, inventories
 
                                      F-35
<PAGE>   102
 
                       ZYCON CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
 
and machinery and equipment. The maximum balance outstanding during the year
under this arrangement was $20,752,000, and the average outstanding balance
during the year was $10,490,000.
 
     The Company also has a line of credit arrangement with a Malaysian bank for
aggregate borrowings of approximately $4.3 million for the purpose of acquiring
land, facilities and equipment for the Company's Malaysian subsidiary. The
arrangement is renewable annually. As of December 31, 1996, there was $2,543,000
outstanding under this arrangement and the weighted average interest rate was
10%.
 
     Notes payable to financial lending companies and banks are secured by
machinery and equipment and are generally payable in equal monthly installments,
bearing interest ranging from approximately 7.2% to 11.4% (8.3% weighted
average).
 
     Annual maturities of the notes payable are as follows (in thousands):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                    YEAR ENDING
                                   DECEMBER 31,
                                   ------------                             
        <S>                                                                  <C>
             1997..........................................................  $ 6,450
             1998..........................................................    6,788
             1999..........................................................    6,125
             2000..........................................................    5,260
             2001..........................................................    8,234
                                                                              ------
                                                                             $32,857
                                                                              ======
</TABLE>
 
     In connection with the acquisition of the Company by Hadco Corporation (see
Note 8), approximately $33.5 million of these notes payable and borrowings under
the line of credit arrangement with the U.S. bank were repaid subsequent to year
end.
 
     The Company has a commitment from a bank for a $15.5 million term loan
facility which expires in 2005 for the purpose of acquiring equipment and for
working capital to be invested in the Company's Malaysia subsidiary. Borrowings
are to be repaid over five years with interest payable at either a fixed rate
equal to the bank's cost of funds at the time of borrowing plus 3.25% or an
adjustable rate equal to the bank's prime rate plus 1.75%. As of December 31,
1996, there were no borrowings outstanding under this facility. Upon the
acquisition of the Company by Hadco (see Note 8), the commitment under this
facility was decreased to $4.4 million.
 
3.  STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY:
 
  Stockholder Distributions
 
     On September 26, 1995, the Company elected C corporation status for Federal
and state income tax reporting purposes. Simultaneously with the election of C
corporation status, the Company declared a distribution payable to existing
stockholders of the Company. This distribution represented undistributed S
corporation earnings of the Company through the completion of the Company's
initial public offering and the amount of the stockholders' S corporation tax
bases.
 
  Stock-Based Compensation Plan
 
     In 1993, the Company adopted the 1993 Long-Term Equity Incentive Plan (the
"Stock Plan"). The Company accounts for this Stock Plan under APB Opinion No.
25, Accounting for Stock Issued to Employees, under which no compensation
expense has been recognized. Had compensation expense for the Stock Plan been
determined consistent with Statement of Financial Accounting Standards
 
                                      F-36
<PAGE>   103
 
                       ZYCON CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
 
(SFAS) No. 123, Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation, the Company's net
income would have been reduced to the following pro forma amounts (in
thousands):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                          1995       1996
                                                                         ------     ------
    <S>                                                                  <C>        <C>
    As Reported........................................................  $7,477     $2,889
    Pro Forma..........................................................  $6,975     $1,579
</TABLE>
 
     The Company may grant up to 1,100,000 shares of stock to its employees and
consultants under the Stock Plan. The Company grants options with an exercise
price at least equal to the fair market price at date of grant. Options granted
under the Stock Plan vest between 20% and 60% at the end of the first year and
ratably thereafter for a period of four years.
 
     There was no activity under the Stock Plan during 1994. A summary of the
activity under the Stock Plan during 1995 and 1996 follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                 WEIGHTED
                                                                                 AVERAGE
                                                                   NUMBER OF     EXERCISE
                                                                    OPTIONS       PRICE
                                                                   ---------     --------
    <S>                                                            <C>           <C>
    Outstanding at December 31, 1994.............................        --       $   --
      Granted....................................................   707,600        10.36
                                                                    -------       ------
    Outstanding at December 31, 1995.............................   707,600        10.36
      Granted....................................................   105,200        10.50
      Exercised..................................................    (6,600)        8.36
      Cancelled..................................................   (36,900)       11.54
                                                                    -------       ------
    Outstanding at December 31, 1996.............................   769,300       $10.35
                                                                    =======       ======
</TABLE>
 
     As of December 31, 1996, 765,800 of the 769,300 options outstanding have
exercise prices between $8 and $12.00, with a weighted average exercise price of
$10.34 and a weighted average remaining contractual life of 3.7 years. 230,200
of these options are exercisable as of December 31, 1996. The remaining 3,500
options have an exercise price and a weighted average exercise price of $13.25
and a weighted average remaining contractual life of 3.88 years. 700 of these
options are exercisable as of December 31, 1996. There was no options
exercisable as of December 31, 1995.
 
     The fair value of each option grant is estimated on the date of grant using
the Black-Scholes option pricing model with the following weighted average
assumptions used for grants in 1995 and 1996; risk-free interest rate of 6
percent; expected dividend yields of 0 percent; expected lives of 7 years;
expected volatility of 35 percent. Weighted average fair values of options
granted in 1995 and 1996 were $4.30 and $3.00, respectively.
 
     In connection with the acquisition of the Company by Hadco Corporation (see
Note 8), the vesting for all outstanding options as of January 9, 1997 was
immediately accelerated pursuant to the terms of the Stock Plan and then
redeemed for cash equal to the difference between the exercise price of the
vested option and $18.00 per share.
 
4.  INCOME TAXES
 
     The components of income tax expense, as presented in the accompanying
consolidated statements of income, comprise California S corporation franchise
taxes for 1994 and through September 26, 1995, and Federal and state taxes for
the remainder of 1995 and all of 1996. The pro forma provision for income taxes
reflects the income tax expense that would have been reported if the
 
                                      F-37
<PAGE>   104
 
                       ZYCON CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
 
Company had been a C corporation in 1994 and all of 1995. The components of the
provision for income taxes and unaudited pro forma provision for income taxes
are as follows (in thousands):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                              YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31
                                                  ------------------------------------------------
                                                            ACTUAL                   PRO FORMA
                                                  --------------------------     -----------------
                                                  1994      1995       1996       1994       1995
                                                  ----     ------     ------     ------     ------
<S>                                               <C>      <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>
Current
  Federal.....................................    $--      $1,349     $4,835     $1,431     $3,547
  State.......................................     97         342        483        453        975
                                                  ----
                                                   --
                                                           ------        ---     ------     ------
          Total current.......................     97       1,691      5,318      1,884      4,522
                                                  ----
                                                   --
                                                           ------        ---     ------     ------
Deferred
  Federal.....................................     --       1,123        928        368      1,271
  State.......................................     --         116        272         81        132
  Termination of S corporation status.........     --       4,479         --         --         --
                                                  ----
                                                   --
                                                           ------        ---     ------     ------
          Total deferred......................     --       5,718      1,200        449      1,403
                                                  ----
                                                   --
                                                           ------        ---     ------     ------
Net tax provision.............................    $97      $7,409     $6,518     $2,333     $5,925
                                                  ======   ======        ===     ======     ======
</TABLE>
 
     The following table reconciles the expected Federal income tax expense to
the Company's actual income tax expense and unaudited pro forma income tax
expense (in thousands):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                             YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31
                                               ---------------------------------------------------
                                                          ACTUAL                     PRO FORMA
                                               -----------------------------     -----------------
                                                1994       1995        1996       1994       1995
                                               ------     -------     ------     ------     ------
<S>                                            <C>        <C>         <C>        <C>        <C>
Expected Federal income tax expense..........  $1,962     $ 5,061     $3,292     $1,962     $5,061
State income taxes, net of Federal tax
  benefit....................................      97         337        569        352        776
Nondeductible foreign subsidiary loss........      --          --        721         --         --
Nondeductible acquisition costs..............      --          --      2,107         --         --
Termination of S corporation status..........      --       4,479         --         --         --
Effect of S corporation earnings taxable to
  stockholders...............................  (1,962)     (2,557)        --         --         --
Other, net...................................      --          89       (171)        19         88
                                               ------     -------     -------    ------     ------
                                               $   97     $ 7,409     $6,518     $2,333     $5,925
                                               ======     =======     =======    ======     ======
</TABLE>
 
     The tax effects of temporary differences that give rise to significant
portions of the deferred income tax assets and liability are presented below as
of December 31 (in thousands):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                            1995        1996
                                                                           -------     -------
<S>                                                                        <C>         <C>
Deferred income tax assets:
  Reserves and accruals..................................................  $   749     $ 1,013
  State income taxes.....................................................      167         234
                                                                           -------     -------
          Total deferred income tax assets...............................      916       1,247
Deferred income tax liability:
  Depreciation and amortization..........................................   (6,634)     (7,003)
                                                                           -------     -------
Net deferred income tax liability........................................  $(5,718)    $(5,756)
                                                                           =======     =======
</TABLE>
 
     Deferred income tax assets are classified in other current assets in the
accompanying consolidated balance sheets.
 
                                      F-38
<PAGE>   105
 
                       ZYCON CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
 
5.  ACQUISITION OF ALTERNATIVE CIRCUIT TECHNOLOGY, INC.:
 
     On June 7, 1996, the Company completed the acquisition of the assets of
Alternate Circuit Technology, Inc. (ACT). ACT was in the business of owning,
operating and managing a quick turnaround printed circuit board manufacturing
facility in Massachusetts. The purchase price consisted of cash of $8,641,000,
50,000 shares of the Company's common stock with a total market value of
$600,000 and a covenant not to compete arrangement to two ACT shareholders
amounting to $200,000. The acquisition has been recorded using the purchase
method of accounting. The excess of the aggregate purchase price over the fair
market value of net assets acquired was $5,668,000, and this goodwill is being
amortized over ten years. The operating results of ACT have been included in the
Company's consolidated financial statements since the date of acquisition.
 
6.  CUSTOMERS:
 
     In 1994, one customer accounted for 15%, one for 11% and one for 10% of
consolidated net sales. In 1995, one customer accounted for 13% and two
companies each accounted for 10% of the Company's consolidated net sales. These
three customers comprised 35% of accounts receivable at December 31, 1995. In
1996, one customer accounted for 12% of the Company's consolidated net sales. Of
the accounts receivable balance at December 31, 1996, 9% is related to this
customer.
 
7.  COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES:
 
  Operating Leases
 
     The Company occupies its facilities under various operating lease
agreements. In addition, the Company leases certain machinery and equipment
under operating leases. Future minimum lease payments required under operating
leases in the years subsequent to December 31, 1996 will be as follows (in
thousands):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                     YEAR ENDED
                                   DECEMBER 31,
                                   ------------                        
            <S>                                                          <C>
                 1997..................................................  $ 3,984
                 1998..................................................    3,830
                 1999..................................................    3,926
                 2000..................................................    4,022
                 2001..................................................    4,091
                 2002 and thereafter...................................   26,175
                                                                         -------
                                                                         $46,028
                                                                         =======
</TABLE>
 
     Facility and equipment rent expense was approximately $4,452,000,
$4,566,000 and $4,609,000 for the years ended December 31, 1994, 1995 and 1996,
respectively. Approximately $360,000 and $135,000 of these amounts in 1994 and
1995, respectively were paid to a partnership whose partners were also
stockholders of the Company.
 
  Purchase Commitments
 
     Purchase commitments aggregated $4,126,000 as of December 31, 1996,
primarily for the acquisition of machinery and equipment.
 
                                      F-39
<PAGE>   106
 
                       ZYCON CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
 
  Stockholders' Benefit and Deferred Compensation Plan
 
     The Company has agreements with its original four stockholders providing
for payment aggregating two years salary per stockholder in the event of death
in service or disability and for payments in the event of an adjustment of the
Company's taxable income for any period the corporation was subject to S
corporation status under the Federal or state income tax laws. To date, no
payments have been required under these agreements.
 
     Subsequent to the year end and upon the acquisition of the Company by Hadco
Corporation, the Company entered into a deferred compensation plan with key
executive employees (none of whom was a director of the Company). The plan will
provide these key executive employees with certain deferred compensation under
certain circumstances.
 
  Workers' Compensation
 
     The Company self-insures its workers' compensation plan and accrues for
incurred claims development and estimated incurred but not reported claims. If
future incurred claims development substantially exceeds historical claim
patterns used to estimate the accrual, the Company could incur significant
additional obligations.
 
  Environmental Matters
 
     In March 1993, the U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) notified
Zycon of its potential liability for maintenance and remediation costs in
connection with a hazardous waste disposal facility operated by Casmalia
Resources, a California Limited Partnership, in Santa Barbara County,
California. The EPA identified Zycon as one of the 65 generators which had
disposed the greatest amounts of materials at the site. Based on the total
tonnage contributed by all generators, Zycon's share is estimated at
approximately 0.2% of the total weight.
 
     The Casmalia site was regulated by the EPA during the period when the
material was accepted. There is no allegation that Zycon violated any law in the
disposal of material at the site, rather the EPA's actions stemmed from the fact
that Casmalia Resources may not have the financial means to implement a closure
plan for the site and because of Zycon's status as a generator of hazardous
waste.
 
     In September 1996, a Consent Decree among the EPA and 48 entities
(including Zycon) acting through the Casmalia Steering Committee ("CSC") was
lodged with the United States District Court in Los Angeles, California, which
must approve the agreement. Although this approval is pending, work has started
under the Consent Decree. The Consent Decree sets forth the terms and conditions
under which the CSC will carry out work aimed at final closure of the site.
Certain closure activities will be performed by the CSC. Later work will be
performed by the CSC, if funded by other parties. Under the Consent Decree, the
settling parties will work with the EPA to pursue the non-settling parties to
ensure they participate in contributing to the closure and long-term operation
and maintenance of the facility.
 
8.  ACQUISITION BY HADCO CORPORATION:
 
     In December 1996, Hadco Corporation ("Hadco") agreed to acquire all of the
outstanding shares of the Company's common stock at a purchase price of $18.00
per share upon the terms and subject to the conditions set forth in the Tender
Offer Statement. The Tender Offer Statement was made pursuant to an Agreement
and Plan of Merger dated as of December 4, 1996 between Hadco and the Company.
The offer expired on January 9, 1997 after which substantially all of the
outstanding shares of the Company's common stock were acquired by Hadco. The
Company incurred costs aggregating $2,869,000 which represented investment
banking, financial advisory and legal fees incurred relating to
 
                                      F-40
<PAGE>   107
 
                       ZYCON CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
 
the acquisition by Hadco. These costs have been expensed in the accompanying
consolidated statement of income for the year ended December 31, 1996 as other
expense. The Company paid approximately $2,100,000 of the total costs incurred
to a financial advisory firm in which the president of such firm was also a
member of the Company's Board of Directors.
 
     Prior to entering into the Agreement and the Plan of Merger with Hadco, the
Company and certain of its principal shareholders had entered into an agreement
to sell all of the outstanding shares of the Company's common stock at $16.25
per share to an unrelated party, but the Company subsequently terminated this
agreement. In connection with this termination, the Company incurred break-up
fees and legal costs amounting to approximately $3,150,000, which was expensed
in the accompanying consolidated statement of income for the year ended December
31, 1996 as other expense.
 
                                      F-41
<PAGE>   108


                                     HADCO

             The Largest Interconnect Manufacturer in North America


        

                                Backplane Assembly

                                - Hadco provides backplane assembly services
                                  utilizing advanced automated manufacturing
                                  systems.

                                - Advanced systems include split axis assembly,
                                  "smart" feeder systems, and optical centering
                                  for high density electronic packages.
                                
                                - Hadco's backplane assembly facilities are
                                  located in California and New Hampshire.



Includes pictures of various assembled backplane products and a backplane
assembly line.


<PAGE>   109
 
                                    PART II
 
                     INFORMATION NOT REQUIRED IN PROSPECTUS
 
ITEM 14.  OTHER EXPENSES OF ISSUANCE AND DISTRIBUTION.
 
     The following statement sets forth the amounts of expenses in connection
with the offering of the Common Stock and Notes pursuant to this Registration
Statement, all of which shall be borne by the Company.
 
<TABLE>
    <S>                                                                        <C>
    SEC Registration Fee.....................................................  $   72,921
    NASD Fee.................................................................      25,064
    Nasdaq Listing Fee.......................................................      25,000
    Blue Sky Fees and Expenses...............................................      30,000
    Printing and Engraving Expenses..........................................      10,000
    Accounting Fees and Expenses.............................................     175,000
    Legal Fees and Expenses..................................................     525,000
    Transfer Agent and Registrar Fees........................................      10,000
    Miscellaneous Expenses...................................................     237,015
                                                                                 --------
              Total..........................................................  $1,200,000
                                                                                 ========
</TABLE>
 
     All of the expenses listed above, except the SEC Registration Fee and NASD
Fee, represent estimates only.
 
ITEM 15.  INDEMNIFICATION OF DIRECTORS AND OFFICERS.
 
     Reference is made to Article V, Section 2 of the By-Laws of the Registrant
and to Section 67 of the Massachusetts Business Corporation Law.
 
     Article V, Section 2 of the Company's By-Laws provides:
 
          "2. Indemnification.  Each Director, officer, employee and other agent
     of the corporation, and any person who, at the request of the corporation,
     serves as a director, officer, employee or other agent of another
     organization in which the corporation directly or indirectly owns shares or
     of which it is a creditor shall be indemnified by the corporation against
     any cost, expense (including attorney's fees), judgment, liability and/or
     amount paid in settlement reasonably incurred by or imposed upon him in
     connection with any action, suit or proceeding (including any proceeding
     before any administrative or legislative body or agency), to which he may
     be made a party or otherwise involved or with which he shall be threatened,
     by reason of his being, or related to his status as, a director, officer,
     employee or other agent of the corporation or of any other organization in
     which the corporation directly or indirectly owns shares or of which the
     corporation is a creditor, which other organization he serves or has served
     as director, officer, employee or other agent at the request of the
     corporation (whether or not he continues to be an officer, director,
     employee or other agent of the corporation or such other organization at
     the time such action, suit or proceeding is brought or threatened), unless
     such indemnification is prohibited by the Business Corporation Law of the
     Commonwealth of Massachusetts. The foregoing right of indemnification shall
     be in addition to any rights to which any such person may otherwise be
     entitled and shall inure to the benefit of the executors or administrators
     of each such person. The corporation may pay the expenses incurred by any
     such person in defending a civil or criminal action, suit or proceeding in
     advance of the final disposition of such action, suit or proceeding, upon
     receipt of an undertaking by such person to repay such payment if it is
     determined that such person is not entitled to indemnification hereunder.
     This section shall be subject to amendment or repeal only by action of the
     stockholders."
 
                                      II-1
<PAGE>   110
 
     Section 67 of the Massachusetts Corporation Law provides:
 
     "Indemnification of directors, officers, employees and other agents of a
corporation, and persons who serve at its request as directors, officers,
employees or other agents of another organization, or who serve at its request
in any capacity with respect to any employee benefit plan, may be provided by it
to whatever extent shall be specified in or authorized by (i) the articles of
organization or (ii) a by-law adopted by the stockholders or (iii) a vote
adopted by the holders of a majority of the shares of stock entitled to vote on
the election of directors. Except as the articles of organization or by-laws
otherwise require, indemnification of any persons referred to in the preceding
sentence who are not directors of the corporation may be provided by it to the
extent authorized by the directors. Such indemnification may include payment by
the corporation of expenses incurred in defending a civil or criminal action or
proceeding in advance of the final disposition of such action or proceeding,
upon receipt of an undertaking by the person indemnified to repay such payment
if he shall be adjudicated to be not entitled to indemnification under this
section which undertaking may be accepted without reference to the financial
ability of such person to make repayment. Any such indemnification may be
provided although the person to be indemnified is no longer an officer,
director, employee or agent of the corporation or of such other organization or
no longer serves with respect to any such employee benefit plan.
 
     No indemnification shall be provided for any person with respect to any
matter as to which he shall have been adjudicated in any proceeding not to have
acted in good faith in the reasonable belief that his action was in the best
interest of the corporation or to the extent that such matter relates to service
with respect to any employee benefit plan, in the best interests of the
participants or beneficiaries of such employee benefit plan.
 
     The absence of any express provision for indemnification shall not limit
any right of indemnification existing independently of this section.
 
     A corporation shall have power to purchase and maintain insurance on behalf
of any person who is or was a director, officer, employee or other agent of the
corporation, or is or was serving at the request of the corporation as a
director, officer, employee or other agent of another organization or with
respect to any employee benefit plan, against any liability incurred by him in
any such capacity, or arising out of his status as such, whether or not the
corporation would have the power to indemnify him against such liability."
 
     The Registrant's Restated Articles of Organization, as amended, provide:
 
     "The Corporation eliminates the personal liability of each director to the
Corporation or its stockholders for monetary damages for breach of fiduciary
duty as a director notwithstanding any statutory provision or other law imposing
such liability; provided, that nothing in this paragraph shall eliminate or
limit the liability of a director (i) for any breach of the director's duty of
loyalty to the Corporation or its stockholders, (ii) for acts or omissions not
in good faith or which involve intentional misconduct or knowing violation of
law, (iii) under Section sixty-one or sixty-two of Chapter 156B of the
Massachusetts General Laws, or (iv) for any transaction from which the director
derived an improper personal benefit."
 
                                      II-2
<PAGE>   111
 
ITEM 16.  EXHIBITS AND FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES.
 
     This Registration Statement includes the following exhibits:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
EXHIBIT NO.
- -----------
<C>           <S>
    1.1*      Form of Common Stock Underwriting Agreement by and among Registrant, certain
              stockholders of the Company and Robertson, Stephens & Company LLC, Merrill
              Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated and Adams, Harkness & Hill, Inc., as
              representatives of the several Underwriters.
    1.2*      Form of Note Underwriting Agreement by and among Registrant and Robertson,
              Stephens & Company LLC and Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated,
              as representatives of the several Underwriters.
    3.1       Restated Articles of Organization of Registrant.
    3.2       By-laws, as amended, of Registrant.
     4*       Form of Indenture (including Form of Note).
     5*       Opinion of Testa, Hurwitz & Thibeault, LLP as to the legality of the securities
              to be offered.
   10.1       Leases for premises located at 435-445 El Camino Real, Santa Clara, California,
              by and between Zycon Corporation and University Research Center and addenda
              thereto dated March 1, 1988; July 8, 1988; February 27, 1989; August 30, 1989;
              May 19, 1993; and August 9, 1993.
   10.2       Provisional Lease dated November 14, 1995 for the premises located at the Muara
              Tebas Land of Kuching East Malaysia by and between Sudarsono Osman and Zycon
              Corporation Sendirian Berhad.
   10.3*      Construction Agreement dated August 3, 1995 by and between Zycon Corporation
              and Hiti Engineering Sdn.Bhd.
   10.4       Facilities Agreement dated February 9, 1996 by and among the Zycon Corporation
              Sdn.Bhd., Bank Bumiputra Malaysia Berhad and BBMB Kewangan Berhad.
   10.5       Corporate Guarantee dated February 9, 1996 issued by Zycon Corporation in favor
              of Bank Bumiputra Malaysia Berhad and BBMB Kewangan Berhad.
   10.6       Lease for the three acre premises located in Santa Clara, California by and
              between Zycon Corporation and Sobrato Interests III, dated January 4, 1996.
   11         Statement re: Computation of Earnings per Share.
   12         Statement re: Computation of Ratios.
   23.1*      Consent of Testa, Hurwitz & Thibeault, LLP (included as part of Exhibit 5).
   23.2       Consent of Arthur Andersen LLP.
   23.3       Consent of KPMG Peat Marwick LLP.
   24         Power of Attorney (included on signature page).
   25         Statement of Eligibility of Trustee on Form T-1.
   27         Financial Data Schedule.
</TABLE>
 
- ---------------
 
* To be filed by amendment.
 
FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES:
 
     Report of Independent Public Accountants on Schedule
 
     Schedule II -- Valuation and Qualifying Accounts
 
ITEM 17.  UNDERTAKINGS.
 
     The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes that, for purposes of
determining any liability under the Securities Act of 1933, each filing of the
registrant's annual report pursuant to Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities
Exchange Act of 1934 (and, where applicable, each filing of an employee benefit
plan's annual report pursuant to Section 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of
1934) that is incorporated by reference in the registration statement shall be
deemed to be a new registration statement relating to the securities offered
therein, and the offering of such securities at that time shall be deemed to be
the initial bona fide offering thereof.
 
                                      II-3
<PAGE>   112
 
     Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act
of 1933 may be permitted to directors, officers and controlling persons of the
registrant pursuant to the foregoing provisions, or otherwise, the registrant
has been advised that in the opinion of the Securities and Exchange Commission
such indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Act and is,
therefore, unenforceable. In the event that a claim for indemnification against
such liabilities (other than the payment by the registrant of expenses incurred
or paid by a director, officer or controlling person of the registrant in the
successful defense of any action, suit or proceeding) is asserted by such
director, officer or controlling person in connection with the securities being
registered, the registrant will unless in the opinion of its counsel the matter
has been settled by controlling precedent, submit to a court of appropriate
jurisdiction the question whether such indemnification by it is against public
policy as expressed in the Act and will be governed by the final adjudication of
such issue.
 
     The undersigned Registrant hereby undertakes as follows:
 
     (1) For purposes of determining any liability under the Securities Act of
1933, the information omitted from the form of prospectus filed as part of this
registration statement in reliance upon Rule 430A and contained in a form of
prospectus filed by the registrant pursuant to Rule 424(b)(1) or (4) or 497(h)
under the Securities Act shall be deemed to be part of this registration
statement as of the time it was declared effective.
 
     (2) For the purpose of determining any liability under the Securities Act
of 1933, each post-effective amendment that contains a form of prospectus shall
be deemed to be a new registration statement relating to the securities offered
therein, and the offering of such securities at that time shall be deemed to be
the initial bona fide offering thereof.
 
                                      II-4
<PAGE>   113
 
                                   SIGNATURES
 
     Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, the registrant
certifies that it has reasonable grounds to believe that it meets all of the
requirements for filing on Form S-3 and has duly caused this Registration
Statement to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly
authorized, in the Town of Salem, State of New Hampshire, on February 18, 1997.
 
                                                    HADCO CORPORATION
 
                                               By /s/     ANDREW E. LIETZ
 
                                              ----------------------------------
                                                       ANDREW E. LIETZ
 
                                              President, Chief Executive Officer
                                                         and Director
 
     Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this
Registration Statement has been signed below by the following persons in the
capacities and on the date indicated.
 
     Each person whose signature appears below in so signing also makes,
constitutes and appoints Andrew E. Lietz and Timothy P. Losik, and each of them,
his true and lawful attorney-in-fact, with full power of substitution, for him
in any and all capacities, to execute and cause to be filed with the Securities
and Exchange Commission any and all amendments and post-effective amendments to
this Registration Statement, with exhibits thereto (including any subsequent
Registration Statement for the same offering which may be filed under Rule
462(b)), and other documents in connection therewith, and hereby ratifies and
confirms all that said attorney-in-fact or his substitute or substitutes may do
or cause to be done by virtue hereof.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
           SIGNATURE                                 TITLE                             DATE
- --------------------------------  --------------------------------------------  ------------------
<C>                               <S>                                           <C>
 
    /s/ HORACE H. IRVINE II       Chairman of the Board and Director            February 18, 1997
- --------------------------------
       (HORACE H. IRVINE)
 
      /s/ ANDREW E. LIETZ         President, Chief Executive Officer and        February 18, 1997
- --------------------------------  Director (Principal Executive Officer)
       (ANDREW E. LIETZ)
 
      /s/ TIMOTHY P. LOSIK        Vice President, Chief Financial Officer       February 18, 1997
- --------------------------------  and Treasurer (Principal Financial Officer
       (TIMOTHY P. LOSIK)         and Principal Accounting Officer)
     /s/ LAWRENCE COOLIDGE        Director                                      February 18, 1997
- --------------------------------
      (LAWRENCE COOLIDGE)
 
      /s/ J. STANLEY HILL         Director                                      February 18, 1997
- --------------------------------
       (J. STANLEY HILL)
 
       /s/ JOHN O. IRVINE         Director                                      February 18, 1997
- --------------------------------
        (JOHN O. IRVINE)
 
      /s/ MIKAEL SALOVAARA        Director                                      February 18, 1997
- --------------------------------
       (MIKAEL SALOVAARA)
 
       /s/ JOHN F. SMITH          Director                                      February 18, 1997
- --------------------------------
        (JOHN F. SMITH)
 
       /s/ OLIVER O. WARD         Director                                      February 18, 1997
- --------------------------------
        (OLIVER O. WARD)
</TABLE>
 
                                      II-5
<PAGE>   114
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
           SIGNATURE                                 TITLE                             DATE
- --------------------------------  --------------------------------------------  ------------------
<C>                               <S>                                           <C>
 
      /s/ PATRICK SWEENEY         Director                                      February 18, 1997
- --------------------------------
       (PATRICK SWEENEY)
 
      /s/ JOHN E. POMEROY         Director                                      February 18, 1997
- --------------------------------
       (JOHN E. POMEROY)
 
      /s/ JAMES C. TAYLOR         Director                                      February 18, 1997
- --------------------------------
       (JAMES C. TAYLOR)
</TABLE>
 
                                      II-6
<PAGE>   115
 
              REPORT OF INDEPENDENT PUBLIC ACCOUNTANTS ON SCHEDULE
 
To Hadco Corporation:
 
     We have audited, in accordance with generally accepted auditing standards,
the consolidated financial statements of Hadco Corporation included in this
registration statement and have issued our report thereon dated November 15,
1996 (except with respect to the matter discussed in Note 2, as to which the
date is January 10, 1997). Our audit was made for the purpose of forming an
opinion on the basic financial statements taken as a whole. The schedule listed
in Item 16(b) is the responsibility of the Company's management and is presented
for purposes of complying with the Securities and Exchange Commission's rules
and is not part of the basic financial statements. This schedule has been
subjected to the auditing procedures applied in the audit of the basic financial
statements and, in our opinion, fairly states, in all material respects, the
financial data required to be set forth therein, in relation to the basic
financial statements taken as a whole.
 
                                          ARTHUR ANDERSEN LLP
 
Boston, Massachusetts
November 15, 1996
 
                                       S-1
<PAGE>   116
 
                                                                     SCHEDULE II
 
                               HADCO CORPORATION
 
                       VALUATION AND QUALIFYING ACCOUNTS
                                 (IN THOUSANDS)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                              ADDITIONS
                                               BALANCE AT     CHARGED TO      DEDUCTIONS      BALANCE AT
                                               BEGINNING      COSTS AND          FROM           END OF
                                               OF PERIOD       EXPENSES      RESERVES(1)        PERIOD
                                               ----------     ----------     ------------     ----------
<S>                                            <C>            <C>            <C>              <C>
Allowance for Doubtful Accounts
  October 29, 1994...........................     $600            234            (109)          $  725
  October 28, 1995...........................     $725            277            (152)          $  850
  October 26, 1996...........................     $850            329             (79)          $1,100
</TABLE>
 
- ---------------
(1) Amounts deemed uncollectible.
 
                                       S-2
<PAGE>   117
 
                                 EXHIBIT INDEX
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
EXHIBIT NO.                                 DESCRIPTION                                PAGE NO.
- -----------   -----------------------------------------------------------------------  --------
<C>           <S>                                                                      <C>
    1.1*      Form of Common Stock Underwriting Agreement by and among Registrant,
              certain stockholders of the Company and Robertson, Stephens & Company
              LLC, Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated and Adams,
              Harkness & Hill, Inc., as representatives of the several
              Underwriters...........................................................
    1.2*      Form of Note Underwriting Agreement by and among Registrant and
              Robertson, Stephens & Company LLC and Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner &
              Smith Incorporated, as representatives of the several Underwriters.....
    3.1       Restated Articles of Organization of Registrant. ......................
    3.2       By-laws, as amended, of Registrant.....................................
   4*         Form of Indenture (including form of Note).............................
   5*         Opinion of Testa, Hurwitz & Thibeault, LLP as to the legality of the
              securities to be offered...............................................
   10.1       Leases for premises located at 435-445 El Camino Real, Santa Clara,
              California, by and between Zycon Corporation and University Research
              Center and addenda thereto dated March 1, 1988; July 8, 1988; February
              27, 1989; August 30, 1989; May 19, 1993; and August 9, 1993............
   10.2       Provisional Lease dated November 14, 1995 for the premises located at
              the Muara Tebas Land of Kuching East Malaysia by and between Sudarsono
              Osman and Zycon Corporation Sendirian Berhad. .........................
   10.3*      Construction Agreement dated August 3, 1995 by and between Zycon
              Corporation and Hiti Engineering Sdn.Bhd...............................
   10.4       Facilities Agreement dated February 9, 1996 by and among the Zycon
              Corporation Sdn.Bhd., Bank Bumiputra Malaysia Berhad and BBMB Kewangan
              Berhad.................................................................
   10.5       Corporate Guarantee dated February 9, 1996 issued by Zycon Corporation
              in favor of Bank Bumiputra Malaysia Berhad and BBMB Kewangan
              Berhad. ...............................................................
   10.6       Lease for the three acre premises located in Santa Clara, California by
              and between Zycon Corporation and Sobrato Interests III, dated January
              4, 1996. ..............................................................
   11         Statement re: Computation of Earnings per Share........................
   12         Statement re: Computation of Ratios....................................
   23.1*      Consent of Testa, Hurwitz & Thibeault, LLP (included as part of Exhibit
              5).....................................................................
   23.2       Consent of Arthur Andersen LLP.........................................
   23.3       Consent of KPMG Peat Marwick LLP.......................................
   24         Power of Attorney (included on signature page).........................
   25         Statement of Eligibility of Trustee on Form T-1........................
   27         Financial Data Schedule................................................
</TABLE>
 
- ---------------
* To be filed by amendment.

<PAGE>   1
                                                                     Exhibit 3.1

                                                          FEDERAL IDENTIFICATION

                                                              NO.: 04-2393279
                                                                   -------------


                        The Commonwealth of Massachusetts


                             MICHAEL JOSEPH CONNOLLY
                               Secretary of State
                    ONE ASHBURTON PLACE, BOSTON, MASS: 02108


                        RESTATED ARTICLES OF ORGANIZATION

                     General Laws, Chapter 156B, Section 74


     This certificate must be submitted to the Secretary of the Commonwealth
within sixty days after the date of the vote of stockholders adopting the
restated articles of organization. The fee for filing this certificate is
prescribed by General Laws, Chapter 156B, Section 114. Make check payable to the
Commonwealth of Massachusetts.



We,               Jon F. Kropper, President; and
                  James C. Hamilton, Clerk of

                                HADCO CORPORATION

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

Located at:   c/o James C. Hamilton, One Court Street, Boston, MA 02108
            --------------------------------------------------------------------

do hereby certify that the following restatement of the articles of organization

of the corporation was duly adopted at a meeting held on March 1, 1989, by vote
                                                         -------------
of 8,978,423 shares of Common out of 10,850,497 shares outstanding,
   ---------           -------       -----------
                   (Class of Stock)

          shares of           out of             shares outstanding,
- ------               -------------------------
                          (Class of Stock)

          shares of           out of             shares outstanding,
- ------               -------------------------
                          (Class of Stock)

          shares of           out of             shares outstanding,
- ------               -------------------------
                          (Class of Stock)







Note: If the space provided under any article or item on this form is
insufficient, additions shall be set forth on separate 8 1/2 x 11 sheets of
paper leaving a left hand margin of at least 1 inch for binding. Additions to
more than one article may be continued on a single sheet so long as each article
requiring each such addition is clearly indicated.

<PAGE>   2

                                                          FEDERAL IDENTIFICATION

                                                              NO.: 04-2393279
                                                                   -------------


being at least two-thirds of each class of stock outstanding and entitled to

vote and of each class or series of stock adversely affected thereby: -

     1.   The name by which the corporation shall be known is: -
          Hadco Corporation

     2.   The purposes for which the corporation is formed are as follows: -
          To carry on a general manufacturing and merchandising business and any
          business incidental thereto or in any way connected therewith,
          including, but without limiting the generality of the foregoing
          purpose, the trade or business of designing, producing, manufacturing,
          adapting, developing, forming, processing, converting, testing and
          otherwise acquiring, owning, holding consuming, disposing of and
          dealing in, and an interest in, printed circuits and all types of
          electronic and communications equipment and any and all other goods,
          articles, materials, equipment or compounds required for, or
          convenient in connection with, or incidental to any of the foregoing,
          and any other trade or business which can conveniently be carried on
          in conjunction with any of the materials aforesaid in or upon the
          premises of the Corporation, and to carry on any business permitted by
          the laws of the Commonwealth of Massachusetts to a corporation
          organized under Chapter 156B.
























Note: If the space provided under any article or item on this form is
insufficient, additions shall be set forth on separate 8 1/2 x 11 sheets of
paper leaving a left hand margin of at least 1 inch for binding. Additions to
more than one article may be continued on a single sheet so long as each article
requiring each such addition is clearly indicated.

<PAGE>   3


                                                          FEDERAL IDENTIFICATION

                                                              NO.: 04-2393279
                                                                   -------------



     *We further certify that the foregoing restated articles of organization
effect no amendments to the articles of organization of the corporation as
heretofore amended, except amendments to the following articles:
                                                                 --------------
                        3 and 4
- --------------------------------------------------------------
     (*If there are no such amendments, state "None".)


                   Briefly describe amendments in space below:

     The amendment abolishes toe previously existing class of Convertible


Preferred Stock and accordingly, amends Article 3 of the Restated Articles of

Organization to delete reference to the Convertible Preferred Stock.  Because 

the class of Convertible Preferred Stock has been eliminated and there remains

only a single class of Common Stock of Hadco Corporation, Article 4, which had

previously described the different classes of stock and the differing rights 

and privileges of such class, is deleted, in its entirety.



     IN WITNESS WHEREOF AND UNDER THE PENALTIES OF PERJURY, we hereto signed our

names this 1st day of March in the year 1989.


  /s/  Jon F. Kropper
- ------------------------------------
  Jon F. Kropper, President


  /s/  James C. Hamilton
- ------------------------------------
  James C. Hamilton, Clerk

















Note: If the space provided under any article or item on this form is
insufficient, additions shall be set forth on separate 8 1/2 x 11 sheets of
paper leaving a left hand margin of at least 1 inch for binding. Additions to
more than one article may be continued on a single sheet so long as each article
requiring each such addition is clearly indicated.

<PAGE>   1
                                                                   Exhibit 3.2

  
                                                              As Adopted 9/26/83
                                                 and Revised and Amended 6/12/87

                             * * * * * * * * * * * *

                                     BY-LAWS

                                       OF

                                HADCO CORPORATION

                             * * * * * * * * * * * *

                                    ARTICLE I
                                    ---------

                                  Stockholders
                                  ------------

     1. ANNUAL MEETING. The annual meeting shall be held within six months after
the end of the fiscal year of the corporation on a date and time fixed from time
to time by the corporation's Board of Directors. The purposes for which the
annual meeting is to be held, in addition to those prescribed by law, by the
Articles of Organization or by these By-laws, may be specified by the Directors
or the President in the event that no date for the annual meeting is so fixed
by the corporation's Board of Directors or the annual meeting has not been held
on the date so fixed by the Board of Directors, a special meeting in lieu of the
annual meeting may be held with all the force and effect of an annual meeting.

     2. SPECIAL MEETINGS. Special meetings of stockholders may be called by the
President or by the Directors. Upon written application of one or more
stockholders who hold at least 10% of the capital stock entitled to vote at a
meeting, a special meeting shall be called by the Clerk, or in case of the
death, absence, incapacity or refusal of the Clerk, by any other officer.

     3. PLACE OF MEETINGS. All meetings of stockholders shall be held at the
principal office of the Corporation unless a different place (within or without
Massachusetts, but within 




                                       





<PAGE>   2
                                      -2-


the United States) is fixed by the Directors or the President and stated in the
notice of the meeting.

     4. NOTICE OF MEETINGS. A written notice of the place, date and hour of all
meetings of stockholders stating the purpose of the meeting shall be given by
the Clerk or an Assistant Clerk or by the person calling the meeting at least
seven days or such longer period as may be required by law before the meeting to
each stockholder entitled to vote thereat and to each stockholder who under the
law, under the Articles of Organization or under these By-laws, is entitled to
such notice, by leaving such notice with him or at his residence or usual place
of business, or by mailing it, postage prepaid, and addressed to such
stockholder at his address as it appears in the records of the corporation.
Whenever notice of a meeting is required to be given a stockholder under any
provision of the Massachusetts Business Corporation Law or of the Articles of
Organization of these By-laws, a written waiver thereof, executed before or
after the meeting by such stockholder or his attorney thereunto authorized and
filed with the records of the meeting, shall be deemed equivalent to such
notice.

     5. QUORUM. The holders of a majority in interest of all stock issued,
outstanding and entitled to vote at a meeting shall constitute a quorum but a
lesser number may adjourn any meeting from time to time without further notice;
except that, if two or more classes of stock are outstanding and entitled to
vote as separate classes, then in the case of each such class, a quorum shall
consist of the holders of a majority in interest of the stock of that class
issued, outstanding and entitled to vote.

     6. VOTING AND PROXIES. Each stockholder shall have one vote for each share
of stock entitled to vote owned by him and a proportionate vote for a fractional
share, unless otherwise provided by the Articles of Organization in the case
that the corporation has two or more classes 



<PAGE>   3
                                      -3-


or series of stock. Capital stock shall not be voted if any installment of the
subscription therefor has been duly demanded in accordance with the law of the
Commonwealth of Massachusetts and is overdue and unpaid. Stockholders may vote
either in person or by written proxy dated not more than six months before the
meeting named therein. Proxies shall be filed with the clerk of the meeting, or
of any adjournment thereof, before being voted. Except as otherwise limited
therein, proxies shall entitle the persons named therein to vote at any
adjournment of such meeting but shall not be valid if executed by any one of
them unless at or prior to exercise of the proxy the corporation receives a
specific written notice to the contrary from any one of them. A proxy purporting
to be executed by or on behalf of a stockholder shall be deemed valid unless
challenged at or prior to its exercise and the burden of proving invalidity
shall rest on the challenger.

     7. ACTION AT MEETING. When a quorum is present, the holders of a majority
of the stock present or represented and voting on a matter (or if there are two
or more classes of stock entitled to vote as separate classes, then in the case
of each such class, the holders of a majority of the stock of that class present
or represented and voting on a matter), except where a larger vote is required
by law, the Articles of Organization or these By-laws, shall decide any matter
to be voted on by the stockholders. Any election of directors or officers by the
stockholders shall be determined by a plurality of the votes cast by
stockholders entitled to vote at the election. Any such elections shall be by
ballot if so requested by any stockholder entitled to vote thereon. The
corporation shall not directly or indirectly vote any share of its own stock.

     8. ACTION WITHOUT MEETING. Any action required or permitted to be taken at
any meeting of the stockholders may be taken without a meeting if all
stockholders entitled to vote on the matter consent to the action in writing
and the written consents are filed with the records 



<PAGE>   4
                                      -4-


of the meetings of stockholders. Such consent shall be treated for all purposes
as a vote at a meeting.


                                   ARTICLE II
                                   ----------

                                    Directors
                                    ---------

     1. POWERS. The business of the corporation shall be managed by a Board of
Directors who may exercise all the powers of the corporation except as otherwise
provided by law, by the Articles of Organization or by these By-laws. In the
event of vacancy in the Board of Directors, the remaining Directors, except as
otherwise provided by law, may exercise the powers of the full Board until the
vacancy is filled.

     2. ELECTION. A Board of Directors shall be elected by the stockholders at
the annual meeting. The number of directors shall be fixed by the stockholders
(except as that number may be enlarged by the Board of Directors acting pursuant
to Section 4 of this Article), but shall be not less than three, except that
whenever there shall be only two stockholders the number of directors shall be
not less than two and whenever there shall be only one stockholder or prior to
the issuance of any stock, there shall be at least one director, and there shall
be not more than twelve.

     3. VACANCIES. Any vacancy in the Board of Directors, however occurring,
including a vacancy resulting from the enlargement of the Board, may be filled
by the stockholders or, in the absence of stockholder action, by the Directors.

     4. ENLARGEMENT OF THE BOARD. The Board of Directors may be enlarged by the
stockholders at any meeting or by vote of a majority of the Directors then in
office.

     5. TENURE. Except as otherwise provided by law, by the Articles of
Organization or by these By-laws, Directors shall hold office until the next
annual meeting of stockholders and 



<PAGE>   5
                                      -5-


until their successors are chosen and qualified. Any Director may resign by
delivering his written resignation to the corporation at its principal office or
to the President, Clerk or Secretary. Such resignation shall be effective upon
receipt unless it is specified to be effective at some other time or upon the
happening of some other event.

     6. REMOVAL. A Director may be removed from office (a) with or without cause
by vote in the election of Directors, provided that the Directors of a class
elected by a particular class of stockholders may be removed only by the vote of
the holders of a majority of the shares of the particular class of stockholders
entitled to vote for the election of such Directors; or (b) for cause by vote of
a majority of the Directors then in office. A Director may be removed for cause
only after a reasonable notice and opportunity to be heard before the body
proposing to remove him.

     7. MEETINGS. Regular meetings of the Directors may be held without call or
notice at such places and, at such times as the Directors may from time to time
determine, provided that any Director who is absent when such determination is
made shall be given notice of the determination. A regular meeting of the
Directors may be held without a call or notice at the same place as the annual
meeting of stockholders.

     Special meetings of the Directors may be held at any time and place
designated in a call by the Chairman of the Board of Directors, President or two
or more Directors.

     8. TELEPHONE CONFERENCE MEETINGS. Members of the Board of Directors may
participate in a meeting of the board by means of a conference telephone or
similar communications equipment by means of which all persons participating in
the meeting can hear each other at the same time and participation by such means
shall constitute presence in person at a meeting.


<PAGE>   6
                                      -6-


     9. NOTICE OF MEETINGS. Notice of all special meetings of the Directors
shall be given to each Director by the Secretary, or Assistant Secretary, or if
there be no secretary or Assistant Secretary, by the Clerk, or Assistant Clerk,
or in case of the death, absence, incapacity or refusal or such persons, by the
officer or one of the Directors calling the meeting. Notice shall be given to
each Director in person or by telephone or by telegram sent to his business or
home address at least twenty-four hours in advance of the meeting, or by written
notice mailed to his business or home address at least forty-eight hours in
advance of the meeting. Notice of a meeting need not be given to any Director if
a written waiver of notice, executed by him before or after the meeting, is
filed with the records of the meeting, or to any Director who attends the
meeting without protesting prior thereto or at its commencement the lack of
notice to him. A notice or waiver of notice of a Directors' meeting need not
specify the purposes of the meeting.

     10. QUORUM. At any meeting of the Directors, a majority of the Directors
then in office shall constitute a quorum. Less than a quorum may adjourn any
meeting from time to time without further notice.

     11. ACTION AT MEETING. At any meeting of the Directors at which a quorum is
present, a majority of the Directors present may take any action on behalf of
the Board except to the extent that a larger number is required by law or the
Articles of organization or these By-laws.

     12. ACTION BY CONSENT. Any action required or permitted to be taken at any
meeting of the Directors may be taken without a meeting, if all the Directors
consent to the action in writing and the written consents are filed with the
records of the meetings of Directors. Such consents shall be treated for all
purposes as a vote at a meeting.

     13. COMMITTEES. The Directors may, by vote of a majority of the Directors
then in office, elect from their number an executive or other committees and may
by like vote delegate 




<PAGE>   7
                                      -7-


thereto some or all of their powers except those which by law, the Articles of
Organization or these Bylaws they are prohibited from delegating to such
committee. Except as the Directors may otherwise determine, any such committee
may make rules for the conduct of its business, but unless otherwise provided by
the Directors or in such rules, its business shall be conducted as nearly as may
be in the same manner as is provided by these By-laws for the Directors.

                                   ARTICLE III
                                   -----------

                                    Officers
                                    --------

     1. ENUMERATION. The officers of the corporation shall consist of a
President, a Treasurer, a Clerk, and such other officers, including a Chairman
of the Board of Directors, one or more Vice-Presidents, Assistant Treasurers,
Assistant Clerks, Secretary and Assistant Secretaries as the Directors may
determine.

     2. ELECTION. The President, Treasurer and Clerk shall be elected annually
by the Directors at their first meeting following the annual meeting of
stockholders. Other officers may be chosen by the Directors at such meeting or
at any other meeting.

     3. QUALIFICATION. The President may, but need not be, a Director. No
officer need be a stockholder. Any two or more offices may be held by the same
person, provided that the President and Clerk shall not be the same person. The
Clerk shall be a resident of Massachusetts unless the corporation has a resident
agent appointed for the purpose of service of process. Any officer may be
required by the Directors to give bond for the faithful performance of his
duties to the corporation in such amount and with such sureties as the Directors
may determine.

     4. TENURE. Except as otherwise provided by law, by the Articles of
Organization or by these By-laws, the President, Treasurer and Clerk shall hold
office until the first meeting of the Directors following the next annual
meeting of stockholders and until their successors are 



<PAGE>   8
                                      -8-


chosen and qualified; and all other officers shall hold office until the first
meeting of the Directors following the next annual meeting of stockholders and
until their successors are chosen and qualified, unless a shorter term is
specified in the vote choosing or appointing them. Any officer may resign by
delivering his written resignation to the corporation at its principal office or
to the President, Clerk or Secretary, and such resignation shall be effective
upon receipt unless it is specified to be effective at some other time or upon
the happening of some other event.

     5. REMOVAL. The Directors may remove any officer with or without cause by
vote of a majority of the Directors then in office; provided, that an officer
may be removed for cause only after a reasonable notice and opportunity to be
heard before the Board of Directors.

     6. PRESIDENT, CHAIRMAN OF THE BOARD AND VICE-PRESIDENT. The President
shall, unless otherwise provided by the Directors, be the chief executive
officer of the corporation and shall, subject to the direction of the Directors,
have general supervision and control of its business. Unless otherwise provided
by the Directors he shall preside, when present, at all meetings of
stockholders and, unless a Chairman of the Board has been elected and is
present, of the Directors.

     If a Chairman of the Board of Directors is elected he shall preside at all
meetings of the Board of Directors at which he is present. The Chairman shall
have such other powers as the Directors may from time to time designate.

     Any Vice-President shall have such powers as the Directors may from time to
time designate.

     7. TREASURER AND ASSISTANT TREASURER. The Treasurer shall, subject to the
direction of the Directors, have general charge of the financial affairs of the
corporation and shall cause 



<PAGE>   9
                                      -9-


accurate books of account to be kept. He shall have custody of all funds,
securities, and valuable documents of the corporation, except as the Directors
may otherwise provide.

     Any assistant treasurer shall have such powers as the Directors may from
time to time designate.

     8. CLERK AND ASSISTANT CLERKS. The Clerk shall record all proceedings of
the stockholders in a book to be kept therefor. Unless a transfer agent is
appointed, the Clerk shall keep or cause to be kept in Massachusetts, at the
principal office of the corporation or at his office, the stock and transfer
records of the corporation, in which are contained the names of all stockholders
and the record address and the amount of stock held by each.

     In case a Secretary is not elected, the Clerk shall record all proceedings
of the Directors in a book to be kept therefor.

     In the absence of the Clerk from any meeting of the stockholders, an
Assistant Clerk, if one be elected, otherwise a Temporary Clerk designated by
the person presiding at the meeting, shall perform the duties of the Clerk. Any
Assistant Clerk shall have such additional powers as the Directors may from time
to time designate.

     9. SECRETARY AND ASSISTANT SECRETARIES. If a Secretary is elected, he shall
keep a record of the meetings of the Directors and in his absence, an Assistant
Secretary, if one be elected, otherwise a Temporary Secretary designated by the
person presiding at the meeting, shall keep a record of the meetings of the
Directors.

     Any Assistant Secretary shall have such additional powers as the Directors
may from time to time designate.

     10. OTHER POWERS AND DUTIES. Each officer shall, subject to these By-laws,
have in addition to the duties and powers specifically set forth in these
By-laws, such duties and powers 



<PAGE>   10
                                      -10-


as are customarily incident to his office, and such duties and powers as the
Directors may from time to time designate.

                                   ARTICLE IV
                                   ----------

                                  Capital Stock
                                  -------------

     1. CERTIFICATES OF STOCK. Subject to the provisions of Section 2 below,
each stockholder shall be entitled to a certificate of the capital stock of the
corporation in such form as may be prescribed from time to time by the
Directors. The certificate shall be signed by the President or a Vice-President,
and by the Treasurer or an Assistant Treasurer; provided, however, such
signatures may be facsimiles if the certificate is signed by a transfer agent,
or by a registrar, other than a Director, officer or employee of the
corporation. In case any officer who has signed or whose facsimile signature has
been placed on such certificate shall have ceased to be such officer before such
certificate is issued, it may be issued by the corporation with the same effect
as if he were such officer at the time of its issue.

     Every certificate issued for shares of stock at a time when such shares are
subject to any restriction on transfer pursuant to the Articles of Organization,
these By-laws or any agreement to which the corporation is a party shall have
the restriction noted conspicuously on the certificate and shall also set forth
on the face or back of the certificate either the full text of the restriction
or a statement of the existence of such restriction and a statement that the
corporation will furnish a copy thereof to the holder of such certificate upon
written request and without charge. Every stock certificate issued by the
corporation at a time when it is authorized to issue more than one class or
series of stock shall set forth upon the face or back of the certificate either
the full text of the preferences, voting powers, qualification and special and
relative rights of the shares of each class and series, if any, authorized to be
issued, as set forth in 



<PAGE>   11
                                      -11-


the Articles of Organization, or a statement of the existence of such
preferences, powers, qualifications, and rights, and a statement that the
corporation will furnish a copy thereof to the holder of such certificate upon
written request and without charge.

     2. STOCKHOLDER ACCOUNTS. The corporation may maintain or cause to be
maintained stockholder open accounts in which may be recorded all stockholders'
ownership of stock and all changes therein. Certificates need not be issued for
shares so recorded in a stockholder open account unless requested by the
stockholder.

     3. TRANSFERS. Subject to the restrictions, if any, stated or noted on the
stock certificates, shares of stock may be transferred in the records of the
corporation by the surrender to the corporation or its transfer agent of the
certificate therefor, properly endorsed or accompanied by a written assignment
and power of attorney properly executed, with necessary transfer stamps affixed.
and with such proof of the authenticity of signature as the corporation or its
transfer agent may reasonably require. When such stock certificates are thus
properly surrendered to the corporation or its transfer agent, the corporation
or transfer agent shall cause the records of the corporation to reflect the
transfer of the shares of stock. Except as may be otherwise required by law, by
the Articles of Organization or by these By-laws, the corporation shall be
entitled to treat the record holder of stock as shown in its records as the
owner of such stock for all purposes, including the payment of dividends and
the right to vote with respect thereof, regardless of any transfer, pledgee or
other disposition of such stock, until the shares have been transferred on the
books of the corporation in accordance with the requirements of these By-laws.

     It shall be the duty of each stockholder to notify the corporation of his
post office address.


<PAGE>   12
                                      -12-


     4. RECORD DATE. The Directors may fix in advance a time which shall be not
more than sixty (60) days before the date of any meeting of stockholders or the
date for the payment of any dividend or the making of any distribution to
stockholders or the last day on which the consent or dissent of stockholders may
be effectively expressed for any purpose, as the record date for determining the
stockholders having the right to notice of and to vote at such meeting and any
adjournment therefor or the right to receive such dividend or distribution or
the right to give such consent or dissent. In such case only stockholders of
record on such record date shall have such right, notwithstanding any transfer
of stock on the books of the corporation after the record date without fixing
such record date the Directors may for any of such purposes close the transfer
books for all or any part of such period.

     If no record date is fixed and the transfer books are not closed, the
record date for determining stockholders having the right to notice of or to
vote at a meeting of stockholders shall be at the close of business on the day
next preceding the day on which notice is given and the record date for
determining stockholders for any other purpose shall be at the close of business
on the day on which the Board of Directors acts with respect thereto.

     5. REPLACEMENT OF CERTIFICATES. In case of the alleged loss, mutilation or
destruction of a certificate of stock, a duplicate certificate may be issued in
place thereof, upon such terms and conditions as the Directors may prescribe.

     6. ISSUE OF COMMON STOCK. The whole or any part of the then authorized but
unissued shares of Common Stock may be issued at any time or from time to time
by the Board of Directors without action by the stockholders.

<PAGE>   13
                                      -13-


     7. REACQUISITION OF STOCK. Shares of stock previously issued which have
been reacquired by the corporation, may be restored to the status of authorized
but unissued shares by vote of the Board of Directors, without amendment of the
Articles of Organization.

                                    ARTICLE V
                                    ---------

                        Provisions Relative to Directors,
                      Officers, Stockholders and Employees
                      ------------------------------------

     1. CERTAIN CONTRACTS AND TRANSACTIONS. In the absence of fraud or bad
faith, no contract or transaction by this corporation shall be void, voidable
or in any way affected by reason of the fact that the contract or transaction is
(a) with one or more of its officers, Directors, stockholders or employees, (b)
with a person who is in any way interested in this corporation or (c) with a
corporation, organization or other concern in which an officer, Director,
stockholder or employee of this corporation is an officer, director,
stockholder, employee or in any way interested. The provisions of this section
shall apply notwithstanding the fact that the presence of a Director or
stockholder, with whom a contract or transaction is made or entered into or who
is an officer, director, stockholder or employee of a corporation, organization
or other concern with which a contract or transaction is made or entered into or
who is in any way interested in such contract or transaction, was necessary to
constitute a quorum at the meeting of the Directors (or any authorized committee
thereof) or stockholders at which such contract or transaction was authorized
and/or that the vote of such Director or stockholder was necessary for the
adoption of such contract or transaction, provided that if said interest was
material, it shall have been known or disclosed to the Directors or stockholders
voting at said meeting on said contract or transaction. A general notice to any
person voting on said contract or transaction that an officer, Director,
stockholder or employee has a material interest in any corporation, organization
or other concern shall be sufficient disclosure as to such officer, Director,
stockholder or employee with respect to all contracts and transactions with such
corporation, organization or 



<PAGE>   14
                                      -14-


other concern shall be sufficient disclosure as to such officer, Director,
stockholder or employee with respect to all contracts and transactions with
such corporation, organization or other concern. This section shall be subject 
to amendment or repeal only by action of the stockholders.

     2. INDEMNIFICATION. Each Director, officer, employee and other agent of the
corporation, and any person who, at the request of the corporation, serves as a
director, officer, employee or other agent of another organization in which the
corporation directly or indirectly owns shares or of which it is a creditor
shall be indemnified by the corporation against any cost, expense (including
attorneys, fees), judgment, liability and/or amount paid in settlement
reasonably incurred by or imposed upon him in connection with any action, suit
or proceeding (including any proceeding before any administrative or legislative
body or agency), to which he may be made a party or otherwise involved or with
which he shall be threatened, by reason of his being, or related to his status
as a director, officer, employee or other agent of the corporation or of any
other organization in which the corporation directly or indirectly owns shares
or of which the corporation is a creditor, which other organization he serves or
has served as director, officer, employee or other agent at the request of the
corporation (whether or not he continues to be an officer, Director, employee or
other agent of the corporation or such other organization at the time such
action, suit or proceeding is brought or threatened), unless such
indemnification is prohibited by the Business Corporation Law of the
Commonwealth of Massachusetts. The foregoing right of indemnification shall be
in addition to any rights to which any such person may otherwise be entitled and
shall inure to the benefit of the executors or administrators of each such
person. The corporation may pay the expenses incurred by any such person in
defending a civil or criminal action, suit or proceeding in advance of the final
disposition of such action, suit, 



<PAGE>   15
                                      -15-


or proceeding upon receipt of an undertaking by such person to repay such
payment if it is determined that such person is not entitled to indemnification
hereunder. This section shall be subject to amendment or repeal only by action
of the stockholders.

                                   ARTICLE VI
                                   ----------

                            Miscellaneous Provisions
                            ------------------------

     1. FISCAL YEAR. Except as from time to time otherwise determined by the
Directors, the fiscal year of the corporation shall be the twelve (12) months
ending the last Saturday of October. Following any change in the fiscal year
previously adopted, a certificate of such change, signed under the penalties of
perjury, by the Clerk or an Assistant Clerk, shall be filed forthwith with the
state secretary.

     2. SEAL. The seal of this corporation shall, subject to alteration by the
Directors, bear its name, the word "Massachusetts", and the year of its
incorporation.

     3. EXECUTION OF INSTRUMENTS. All deeds, leases, transfers, contracts,
bonds, notes and other obligations authorized to be executed by an officer of
the corporation in its behalf shall be signed by the President or the Treasurer
except as the Directors may generally or in particular cases otherwise
determine.

     4. VOTING OF SECURITIES. Except as the Directors may otherwise designate,
the President or Treasurer may waive notice of, and appoint any person or
persons to act as proxy or attorney in fact for this corporation (with or
without power of substitution) at any meeting of stockholders or shareholders of
any other corporation or organization, the securities of which may be held by
this corporation.

     5. CORPORATE RECORDS. The original, or attested copies, of the Articles of
Organization, By-laws and records of all meetings of incorporators and
stockholders and the 



<PAGE>   16
                                      -16-


stock and transfer records which shall contain the names of all stockholders
and the record address and the amount of stock held by each, shall be kept in
Massachusetts at the principal office of the corporation or at an office of its
transfer agent or of the Clerk or of its resident agent. Said copies and records
need not all be kept in the same office. They shall be available at all
reasonable times to the inspection of any stockholder for any proper purpose but
not to secure a list of stockholders or other information for the purpose of
selling said list or information or copies thereof or of using the same for a
purpose other than in the interest of the applicant, as a stockholder, relative
to the affairs of the corporation.

     6. ARTICLES OF ORGANIZATION. All references in these By-laws to the
Articles of Organization shall be deemed to refer to the Articles of
Organization of the corporation as amended and in effect from time to time.

     7. AMENDMENTS. These By-laws, to the extent provided in these By-laws, may
be amended or repealed, in whole or in part, and new By-laws adopted either (a)
by the stockholders at any meeting of the stockholders by the affirmative vote
of the holders of at least a majority in interest of the capital stock presence
and entitled to vote, provided that notice of the proposed amendment or repeal
or of the proposed making of new By-laws shall have been given in the notice of
such meeting, or (b) if so authorized by the Articles of Organization, by the
Board of Directors at any meeting of the Board by the affirmative vote of a
majority of the Directors then in office, but no amendment or repeal of a By-law
shall be voted by the Board of Directors and no new By-law shall be made by the
Board of Directors which alters the provisions of these By-laws with respect to
removal of Directors, or the election of committees by Directors and the
delegation of powers thereto, nor shall the Board of Directors make, amend or
repeal any provision of the By-laws which by law, the Articles of Organization
or the By-laws requires 



<PAGE>   17
                                      -17-


action by the stockholders. Not later than the time of giving notice of the
meeting of stockholders next following the making, amending or repealing by the
Directors of any By-law, notice thereof stating the substance of such change
shall be given to all stockholders entitled to vote on amending the By-laws. Any
By-law or amendment of a By-law made by the Board of Directors may be amended or
repealed by the stockholders by affirmative vote as above provided in this
Section 7.


<PAGE>   1
                                                                    EXHIBIT 10.1


                                     LEASE


1. PARTIES: THIS LEASE, is entered into on this 1st day of March, 1988, between
University Research Center, a California General Partnership, and Zycon, a
California Corporation, hereinafter called respectively Landlord and Tenant.

2. PREMISES: Landlord hereby leases to Tenant, and Tenant hires from Landlord
those certain Premises described on the preliminary site plan proposed by Dennis
Kobza and Associates dated February 26, 1986 attached hereto, situated in the
City of Santa Clara, County of Santa Clara State of California, including a
building of:

                  Approximately 126,816 square foot on ground level industrial
         building, with parking for approximately four hundred (400)
         automobiles, described on plans prepared by Dennis Kobza and
         Associates, attached hereto as Exhibit "A." To be constructed at
         Landlord's expense. The Premises are part of the project known as
         University Research Center, consisting of two buildings totaling
         approximately 222,000 square feet to be constructed on approximately
         13.5 acres as shown on the Site Plan prepared by Dennis Kobza and
         Associates (The Project).

3. USE: Tenant shall use the Premises only for the following purposes and shall
not change the use of the Premises without the prior written consent of
Landlord: Research, Office, and Light Manufacturing purposes including but not
limited to the manufacturing of printed circuit boards.

4. TERM: The term shall be for one hundred forty-four (144) months, commencing
on the 1st day of February, 1989, and ending on the 31st day of January, 2001,
at the total rent or sum of FOURTEEN MILLION SEVEN HUNDRED NINETY ONE THOUSAND
EIGHT HUNDRED TWENTY FOUR AND 00/100 ($14,791,824.00) DOLLARS, payable, without
deduction or offset, in monthly installments of ONE HUNDRED TWO THOUSAND SEVEN
HUNDRED TWENTY ONE AND 00/100 DOLLARS:

         $102,721.00                Subject to increases for Consumer Price
                                    Index adjustments every forty-eight (48)
                                    months as provided in Article 41 herein.

due on or before the first day of each calendar month during the term hereof.
Said rental shall be paid in lawful money of the United States of America,
without offset or deduction, and shall be paid to Landlord at such place or
places as may be designated in writing from time to time by Landlord. Rent for
any period less than a calendar month shall be a pro rata portion of the monthly
installment.

Concurrently with Tenants, execution of this Lease, Tenant shall pay to Landlord
the sum of ONE HUNDRED TWO THOUSAND SEVEN HUNDRED TWENTY ONE AND 00/100
($102,721.00) DOLLARS as prepared rent for first month's rent. Tenant to receive
a credit on its second month's rental for interest earned on such pre-paid rent
in the amount of five percent (5%) per year.
<PAGE>   2
                                      -2-

5. SECURITY DEPOSIT: Concurrently with Tenant's execution of this Lease, Tenant
has deposited with Landlord the sum of ONE HUNDRED THOUSAND AND 00/100
($100,000.00) DOLLARS as a security deposit. If Tenant defaults, as defined in
Paragraph 24, with respect to any provisions of this lease, including but not
limited to the provisions relating to payment of rent or other charges, Landlord
may, to the extent reasonably necessary to remedy Tenant's default, use all or
any part of said deposit for the payment of rent or other charges in default or
the payment of any other payment of any other amount which Landlord may spend or
become obligated to spend by reason of Tenant's default or to compensate
Landlord for any other loss or damage which Landlord may suffer by reason of
Tenant's default. If any portion of said deposit is so used or applied, Tenant
shall, within ten (10) days after written demand therefore, deposit cash with
Landlord in an amount sufficient to restore said deposit to the full amount
hereinabove stated and shall pay to Landlord such other sums as shall be
necessary to reimburse Landlord for any sums paid by landlord. Said deposit
shall be returned to Tenant within fifteen (15) days after the expiration of the
term hereof less any amount deducted in accordance with this paragraph, together
with Landlord's written notice itemizing the amounts and purposes for such
retention. In the event of termination of Landlord's interest in this Lease,
Landlord shall transfer said deposit to Landlord's successor in interest. Tenant
shall receive an annual rental credit equal to five percent (5%) interest on
such security deposit applied to the first month's rent of each year of this
lease.

6. LATE CHARGES: Tenant hereby acknowledges that late payment by Tenant to
Landlord of rent and other sums due hereunder will cause landlord to incur costs
not contemplated by this Lease, the exact amount of which will be extremely
difficult to ascertain. Such costs include, but are not limited to,
administrative, processing, accounting charges, and late charges, which may be
imposed on Landlord by the terms of any contract, revolving credit, mortgage or
trust deed covering the Premises. Accordingly, if any installment of rent or any
other sum due from Tenant shall not be received by Landlord or Landlord's
designee within ten (10) days after such amount shall be due, Tenant shall pay
to Landlord a late charge equal to three (3%) percent of such overdue amount
which shall be due and payable with the payment then delinquent. The parties
hereby agree that such late charge represents a fair and reasonable estimate of
the costs Landlord will incur by reason of late payment by Tenant. Acceptance of
such late charge by Landlord shall in no event constitute a waiver of Tenant's
default with respect to such overdue amount, nor prevent Landlord from
exercising any of the other rights and remedies granted hereunder. In the event
that a late charge is payable hereunder, whether or not collected, for three (3)
consecutive installments of rent, then rent shall automatically become due and
payable quarterly in advance, rather than monthly, notwithstanding any provision
of this Lease to the contrary.

7. CONSTRUCTION AND POSSESSION: The Tenant Interior Improvements and Building
Shell shall be constructed by independent contractors to be employed by and
under the supervision of Landlord, as general contractor. The final plans for
such Interior Improvements and Building Shell shall be prepared as expeditiously
as possible and shall be subject to the reasonable approval by the parties,
which approval shall not be unreasonably withheld or delayed. Landlord shall
construct the Tenant Interior Improvements and Building Shell in
<PAGE>   3
                                      -3-


accordance with all existing applicable municipal, local, state and federal
laws, statutes, rules, regulations and ordinances.

The Building Shell and Tenant Interior Improvements are generally described in
Exhibit E. The final plans shall be consistent with Exhibit E and shall be based
upon and consistent with the plan for the Building Shell attached as Exhibit A,
and with the Tenant Floor Plans to be submitted as provided in Exhibit E.

"Cost" of the Tenant Interior Improvements is defined in Exhibit E.

Landlord shall be responsible for and shall pay the entire cost of the Building
Shell and the cost of the Tenant Interior Improvements up to the amount of THREE
MILLION EIGHT HUNDRED FOUR THOUSAND FOUR HUNDRED EIGHTY AND 00/100
($3,804,480.00) DOLLARS ("Tenant Interior Improvement Allowance"). In the event
the cost of Tenant Interior Improvements is less than THREE MILLION EIGHT
HUNDRED FOUR THOUSAND FOUR HUNDRED EIGHTY AND 00/100 ($3,804,480.00) DOLLARS,
the monthly rental under the Lease shall be reduced at the rate of FIFTEEN
DOLLARS ($15.00) per month for each ONE THOUSAND DOLLARS ($1,000.00) of the
Tenant Interior Improvement Allowance not used to a minimum of TWO MILLION FOUR
HUNDRED THOUSAND AND 00/100 ($2,400,000.00) DOLLARS. Costs, as defined in
Exhibit "E," in excess of said Tenant Interior Improvement Allowance, if any,
shall be paid for by Tenant in cash within ten (10) days after Landlord has
provided Tenant with written evidence that Landlord's progress payments to
sub-contractors has exceeded said Tenant Interior Improvement budget. All costs
for Tenant Interior Improvements shall be fully documented to and verified by
Tenant. Tenant reserves the right to require Landlord to secure three
competitive bids from sub-contractors on any item costing in excess of TWENTY
FIVE THOUSAND AND 00/100 ($25,000.00) DOLLARS.

Landlord and Tenant to execute a standard construction contract containing
provisions customarily contained in such contracts providing reasonable
protection to the interests of the parties. The final selection of the
successful sub-contractors for the interior improvements shall be subject to
Tenant's approval. Upon receipt of all competitive bids, Tenant shall retain the
right to negotiate with any sub-contractor subject to the reasonable approval of
Lessor. Tenant to have the right to record a chattel mortgage, personal property
lease, or other security interest on that portion of leasehold improvements that
it has paid for, and that have not become an integral part of the real estate,
and that are of a specific nature unique to Tenant's business, that are not
needed for the normal operation of the building or heating and cooling for
personnel within the building.

If Landlord, for any reason whatsoever, cannot deliver possession of the said
Premises to Tenant at the commencement of the said term, as hereinbefore
specified, this Lease shall not be void or voidable, nor shall Landlord be
liable to Tenant for any loss or damage resulting therefrom; but in that event
the commencement and termination dates of the Lease and all other dates affected
thereby shall be revised to conform to the date of Landlord's delivery of
possession. The term of the Lease shall not commence until the Premises are
Substantially Complete as defined herein. "Substantially Complete" shall mean
that: (i) all necessary governmental approvals, permits,
<PAGE>   4
                                      -4-


consents, and certificates have been obtained by or for Landlord for the lawful
construction by Landlord, and occupancy by Tenant, (ii) all of the Premises
interior fully meet all of the Tenant Floor Plans, (iii) all of the Premises
exterior substantially meets the applicable Tenant Floor Plans, including paved
parking areas, and (iv) said interior is in a "broom clean" finished condition.
If necessary, Landlord reserves the right to post a bond for the uncompleted
portion of the landscaping.

Notwithstanding the above, if Landlord has not commenced construction of the
Building Shell by September 1, 1988, Tenant may terminate this lease by giving
Landlord written notice. Commencement of construction shall mean that Landlord
has obtained all permits necessary to construct the Building Shell given the use
contemplated hereby, has executed Ground Lease (see Paragraph 47) and has
commenced substantial excavation. The September 1, 1988 date contemplates that
Tenant shall have provided Landlord with one-line drawings of Tenant wall layout
and Basement Details by march 15, 1988 and if it fails to do so the above date
shall be extended by one day for each day after March 31, 1988 until Tenant
delivers such drawings.

Provided further that Landlord shall complete the shell and interior
improvements by March 1, 1989 unless it has been delayed for causes beyond its
reasonable control such as, but not limited to, strikes, unavailable equipment
or materials, changes made by Tenant, or delays caused securing approval of
governmental agencies. In the event of a delayed commencement date beyond March
1st plus additional time for the unavoidable delays described above, Tenant is
to receive one day of free rent for every day beyond March 1, 1989 that the
Premises are not ready for Tenant's occupancy.

Tenant's obligations under this Lease are conditioned upon Tenant's reasonable
satisfaction before May 1, 1988, that the Building Shell and Tenant's Interior
Improvements will be approved by all applicable public authorities so as to
permit Tenant to conduct the business contemplated without having to incur
additional engineering or construction costs not customarily incurred by
companies in the printed circuit business as a result of the Premises' proximity
to residential property or from the property's proximity to the San Jose City
Limit.

8. ACCEPTANCE OF PREMISES AND COVENANTS TO SURRENDER: When Tenant enters
hereunder, Tenant shall accept the Premises as being in good and sanitary order,
condition and repair, except for latent defects except for the "punch list" to
be provided Landlord within thirty (30) days after Tenant's occupancy. The
Tenant agrees on the last day of the term hereof, or on the sooner termination
of this Lease, to surrender the Premises unto Landlord in good condition and
repair, reasonable wear and tear excepted. "Good condition" shall mean that the
interior walls of all office and warehouse areas, the floors of all office and
warehouse areas, all suspended ceilings and any carpeting will be cleaned.
Tenant shall ascertain from Landlord at least thirty (30) days before the end of
the term of this Lease whether Landlord desires to have the Premises or any part
or parts thereof restored to their condition as of the Lease commencement date
or to cause Tenant to surrender all alterations, additions, and improvements in
place to landlord. Tenant may request Landlord's decision at any time within six
(6) months before the end of the Lease term and Landlord shall respond within
thirty (30) days of Tenant's inquiry. Landlord's failure to respond within such
period shall be deemed an election that
<PAGE>   5
                                      -5-


Tenant surrender the Premises in their then current condition. If Landlord shall
so desire, then Tenant shall remove such alterations, addition, and improvements
as Landlord may require and shall repair and restore said Premises or such part
or parts thereof before the termination of this Lease at Tenant's sole cost and
expense. Tenant on or before the end of the term or sooner termination of this
Lease, shall remove all his or its personal property and trade fixtures from the
Premises, and all property not so removed shall be deemed to be abandoned by
Tenant. If the Premises are not surrendered at the end of the term or sooner
termination of this Lease, Tenant shall indemnify Landlord against loss or
liability resulting from delay by Tenant in so surrendering the Premises
including, without limitation, reasonable claims made by any succeeding tenant
founded on such delay.

Provided further that Landlord hereby warrants that all work will be performed
in a good workmanlike manner free of all defects in construction and/or
materials for a period of one year after Tenant accepts possession plus a period
of two years from acceptance for the roof membrane or any other waterproof
conditions. Landlord to further assign all subcontractor and material supplier's
warranties to Tenant.

9. USES PROHIBITED: Tenant shall not commit, or suffer to be committed, any
waste upon the said Premises, or any nuisance, or other act or thing which may
disturb the quiet enjoyment of any other tenant in the project or allow any sale
by auction upon the Premises, or allow the Premises to be used for any unlawful
purposes, or place any loads upon the floor, walls, or ceiling which endanger
the structure, or place any harmful liquids, waste materials, or hazardous
materials in the domestic drainage system of or soils surrounding the Building.
No materials, supplies, equipment, finished products or semi-finished products,
raw materials or articles of any nature or any waste materials, refuse, scrap or
debris shall be stored upon or permitted to remain on any portion of the
Premises outside the Building proper or appropriately screened area. See
Paragraph 20.

10. ALTERATIONS AND ADDITIONS: Tenant shall not make, or suffer to be made, any
alteration or addition to the said Premises, or any part thereof, without the
written consent of Landlord first had and obtained based upon Tenant's
delivering to Landlord the proposed architectural and structural plans for all
such alterations; any addition or alteration to the said Premises, except
movable furniture and trade fixtures, shall become at once a part of the realty
and belong to Landlord. Alterations and additions which are not to be deemed as
trade fixtures shall include heating, lighting, electrical systems, air
conditioning, partitioning, carpeting, or any other installation which has
become an integral part of the Premises. After having obtained Landlord's
consent, Tenant agrees that it will not proceed to make such alterations or
additions, until three (3) days from the receipt of such consent, or ten (10)
working days after request for such consent, whichever is sooner, in order that
Landlord may post appropriate notices to avoid any liability to contractors or
material suppliers for payment for Tenant's improvements. Tenant will at all
times permit such notices to be posted and to remain posted until the completion
of work. Tenant acknowledges Landlord's right to and hereby consents to
construction of additional building(s) in the Project, excepting the premises
demised by this lease, and on adjacent land owned by Landlord subject, always,
to recalculation of Tenant's Allocable share of Costs as set forth below.
Provided further that Tenant may make non-structural modifications to
<PAGE>   6
                                      -6-

the premises costing less than TWENTY FIVE THOUSAND AND 00/100 ($25,000.00)
DOLLARS per modification with a total of four (4) such modifications per year as
long as Tenant provides Landlord an "As Built" drawing within ten (10) days
following completion of the work.

11. LANDLORD'S AND TENANT'S OBLIGATIONS REGARDING COMMON AREA COSTS: Tenant
acknowledges that this lease is a net lease and the rental shall be paid to
Landlord net of all taxes (as and to the extent provided in Article 14),
utilities (as and to the extent provided in Article 15), insurance expenses (as
and to the extent provided in Article 13), maintenance, service, janitorial,
security and repair expenses (as and to the extent provided in Article 12) and
other operating expenses commonly borne by tenants of like commercial buildings.
Tenant shall pay all such expenses accruing after the lease commencement date
and during the term of this lease. Lease costs and costs of management,
financing and construction shall be Landlord's responsibility, except as
otherwise provided in this lease.

Landlord will use its best efforts to obtain separate tax assessments and
insurance billings and separate utility meters for Tenant's building leasehold
improvements therein.

Tenant will have the right to approve all vendors selected by Landlord that
provide common area maintenance.

It is contemplated that certain expenses such as gardening, outside lighting and
parking lot maintenance will be shared by Tenant and other Tenants in the
Project. Such expenses shall be prorated on a mutually acceptable basis
reflecting the services provided and in the absence of such agreement, on the
basis of the rentable square footage of the Premises compared to the rentable
square footage of the Project.

It is understood and agreed that Tenant's obligation to share in Common Area
Costs shall be adjusted to reflect the commencement and termination dates of the
Lease Term and are subject to recalculation in the event of expansion of the
Building or Project.

12. MAINTENANCE OF PREMISES: Except as provided in paragraph 11 or below, Tenant
shall, at its sole cost, keep and maintain, repair and replace, said Premises
and appurtenances and every part hereof, including but not limited to, exterior
walls, roof, glazing, sidewalks, parking areas, plumbing, electrical and HVAC
systems, and all the Tenant Interior Improvements in good and sanitary order,
condition, and repair. Tenant shall provide Landlord with a copy of a service
contract between Tenant and a licensed air-conditioning and heating contractor
which contract shall provide for bi-monthly maintenance of all air conditioning
and heating equipment at the Premises. Tenant shall pay the cost of all
air-conditioning and heating equipment repairs or replacements which are either
excluded from such service contract or any existing equipment warranties. Tenant
shall be responsible for the preventive maintenance of the membrane of the roof,
which responsibility shall be deemed properly discharged if (i) Tenant contracts
with a licensed roof contractor who is reasonably satisfactory to both Tenant
and Landlord, at Tenant's sole cost, to inspect the roof membrane at least
annually, with the first inspection due the sixth (6th) month after the
Commencement Date, and (ii) Tenant performs, at Tenant's sole cost, all
preventive maintenance recommendations made by such contractor within
<PAGE>   7
                                      -7-


a reasonable time after such recommendations are made. Such preventive
maintenance might include acts such as clearing storm gutters and drains,
removing debris from the roof membrane, trimming trees overhanging the roof
membrane, applying coating materials to seal roof penetrations, repairing
blisters, and other routine measures. Tenant shall provide to Landlord a copy of
such preventive maintenance contract and paid invoices for the recommended work.
Landlord to be responsible for repairs or replacements of foundation, exterior
walls (except painting), the structural portions of the roof, any problems
caused by subsidence, and any defects in construction, workmanship or materials
unless caused by Tenant's fault. All vinyl wall surfaces and floor tile are to
be maintained in an as good a condition as when Tenant took possession free of
holes, gouges, or defacements, reasonable wear and tear excepted. Tenant agrees
to limit attachments to vinyl wall surfaces exclusively to V-joints. The Tenant
agrees to water, maintain and replace, when necessary, any shrubbery and
landscaping. Landlord to be responsible for landscape material replacement
required for the first twelve (12) months of this lease.

13. INSURANCE: Tenant shall not use, or permit said Premises, or any part
thereof, to be used, for any purposes other than that for which the said
Premises are hereby leased; and no use shall be made or permitted to be made of
the said Premises, nor acts done, which will cause a cancellation of any
insurance policy covering said Building, or any part thereof. Tenant shall, at
its sole cost and expense, comply with any and all requirements, pertaining to
said Premises, of any insurance organization or company, necessary for the
maintenance of reasonable fire and public liability insurance, covering said
Building and appurtenances. The Landlord agrees to purchase and keep in force
fire, earthquake (if commercially available and if required by Institutional
Lenders from time to time on the majority of similar industrial buildings in the
City of Santa Clara), and extended coverage insurance covering the Premises in
amounts not to exceed the actual insurable value of the Building, including the
Premises, as determined by Landlord's insurance company's appraisers.

Tenant's obligation to pay for Earthquake coverage shall be limited to a maximum
additional cost over a normal fire and extended coverage policy of $50,000.00
per year subject to adjustment for Consumer Price Index increases utilizing
February 1988 as the base period.

In addition, Tenant agrees to insure its additions, alterations, and for those
leasehold improvements paid for by Tenant which have become an integral part of
the building or real estate for their full replacement value (without
depreciation) and to obtain worker's compensation and public liability and
property damage insurance for occurrences within the Premises of $10,000,000.00
combined single limit for bodily injury and property damage. Tenant shall name
Landlord and Santa Clara University, or any future owner of the fee interest,
and the Institutional Lender on the building as loss payees as their interests
may appear on the property insurance and as an additional insured on the
liability insurance, shall deliver a Certificate of Insurance and renewal
certificates to Landlord, fee owner, and Lender. All such policies shall provide
for thirty (30) days' prior written notice to Landlord of any cancellation or
termination.
<PAGE>   8
                                       -8-


Landlord and Tenant hereby waive any rights each may have against the other on
account of any loss or damage occasioned to the Landlord or the Tenants as the
case may be, or to the Premises or its contents, and which arise from any risk
covered by their respective insurance policies, as set forth above. The parties
shall obtain from their respective insurance companies a waiver of any right of
subrogation which said insurance company may have against the Landlord or the
Tenant, as the case may be.

14. TAXES: Tenant shall be liable for all taxes levied against personal property
and trade or business fixtures, and agrees to pay, as additional rental, all
real estate taxes and special assessment installments levied on the Premises,
upon the occupancy of the Premises and including any substitute or additional
charges which may be imposed during the Lease term including real estate tax
increases due to a sale or other transfer of the Premises, as they appear on the
City and County tax bills during the Lease term, and as they become due. It is
understood and agreed that Tenant's obligation under this paragraph will be
prorated to reflect the commencement and termination dates of this Lease.
Tenant's obligation for taxes shall not apply to taxes accruing before the
Commencement Date of this lease. In any time during the term of this Lease a
tax, excise on rents, business license tax, or any other tax, however described,
is levied or assessed against Landlord, as a substitute or addition in whole or
in part for taxes assessed or imposed on land or Buildings, Tenant shall pay and
discharge his prorata share of such tax or excise on rents or other tax before
it becomes delinquent, except that this provision is not intended to cover net
income taxes, inheritance, gift or estate tax imposed upon the Landlord. In the
event that a tax is placed, levied, or assessed against Landlord and the taxing
authority takes the position that the Tenant cannot pay and discharge his
prorata share of such tax on behalf of the Landlord, then at the sole election
of the Landlord, the Landlord may increase the rental charged hereunder by the
exact amount of such tax.

15. UTILITIES: Except as provided in paragraph 11, Tenant shall pay directly to
the providing utility all water, gas, heat, light, power, telephone and other
utilities supplied to the Premises. Tenant to pay for all sewer discharge fees
charged by the City of Santa Clara above the cost for an industrial shell as
defined by the City of Santa Clara net of any credit due from the prior use of
the property equitably prorated between Tenant's parcel and adjacent parcel
leased by Landlord.

16. WAIVER OF LIABILITY: Failure by Landlord to perform any defined services, or
any cessation thereof, when such failure is caused by accident, breakage,
repairs, strikes, lockout or other labor disturbances or labor disputes of any
character, or by any other cause, similar or dissimilar, beyond the reasonable
control of Landlord, shall not render Landlord liable in any respect for damages
to either person or property, nor be construed as an eviction of Tenant, nor
cause an abatement of rent nor relieve Tenant from fulfillment of any covenant
or agreement hereof. Should any of the equipment or machinery utilized in
supplying the services listed herein break down, or for any cause cease to
function properly, upon receipt of written notice from Tenant of any deficiency
or failure of any defined Services, Landlord shall use reasonable diligence to
repair the same promptly, but Tenant shall have no right to terminate this
Lease, and shall have no claim for rebate of rent or damages, on account of any
interruptions in service occasioned thereby or resulting therefrom. Tenant
waives the provisions of California Civil
<PAGE>   9
                                      -9-


Code Sections 1941 and 1942 concerning the Landlord's obligation of
tenantability and Tenant's right to make repairs and deduct the cost of such
repairs from the rent. Landlord shall not be liable for a loss of or injury to
property, however occurring, through or in connection with or incidental to
furnishing or its failure to furnish any of the foregoing.

17. ABANDONMENT: Tenant shall not vacate or abandon the Premises at any time
during the term; and if Tenant shall abandon, vacate or surrender said Premises,
or be dispossessed by process of law, or otherwise, any personal property
belonging to Tenant and left on the Premises shall be deemed to be abandoned, at
the option of Landlord, except such property as may be mortgaged to Landlord.

18. FREE FROM LIENS: Tenant shall keep the Premises and the Building in which
the Premises are situated, free form any liens arising out of any work
performed, materials furnished, or obligations incurred by Tenant.

Provide further that Tenant shall have the right to contest such lien provided
it posts a bond indemnifying Landlord in an equivalent amount at Tenant's sole
cost and expense.

19. COMPLIANCE WITH GOVERNMENTAL REGULATIONS: Tenant shall, at its sole cost and
expense, comply with all of the requirements of all Municipal, State and Federal
authorities now in force, or which may hereafter be in force, pertaining to the
said Premises, and shall faithfully observe in the use of the Premises all
Municipal ordinances and State and Federal statues now in force or which may
hereafter be in force provided further that Tenant reserves the right to contest
such requirement and as a condition of such contest Landlord may require a bond
be posted in a sufficient sum as Landlord reasonably determines is necessary to
protect and indemnify Landlord's interest. All costs for such bond will be at
Tenant's expense during the period of protest. The judgment of any court of
competent jurisdiction, or the admission of Tenant in any action or proceeding
against Tenant, whether Landlord be a party thereto or not, that Tenant has
violated any such ordinance or statute in the use of the Premises, shall be
conclusive of that fact as between Landlord and Tenant.

20. TOXIC WASTE AND ENVIRONMENTAL DAMAGE: Except as permitted by governmental
laws, regulations, and ordinances, Tenant shall not bring, allow, use or permit
upon the Premises, or generate or create at or emit or dispose from the Premises
any chemicals, toxic or hazardous gaseous, liquid or solid materials or waste,
including without limitation, material or substance having characteristics of
ignitability, corrosively, reactivity, or extraction procedure toxicity or
substances or materials which are listed on any of the Environmental Protection
Agency's lists of hazardous wastes or which are identified in Sections 66680
through 66685 of Title 22 of the California Administrative code as the same may
be amended from time to time. Tenant shall comply, at its sole cost, with all
laws pertaining to, and shall indemnify and hold Landlord harmless from any
claims, liabilities, costs or expenses incurred or suffered by Landlord arising
from such bringing, allowing, using, permitting, generating, crating, or
emitting or disposing of any such materials. Tenant's indemnification and hold
harmless obligations include, without limitation, (i) claims, liability, costs
or expenses resulting from or based upon administrative, judicial (civil or
criminal) or other action, legal or equitable, brought by any
<PAGE>   10
                                      -10-


private or public person under common law or under the Comprehensive
Environmental Response, Compensation and Liability Act of 1980 ("CERCLA"), the
Resource Conservation and Recovery Act of 1980 ("RCRA") or any other Federal,
State, County or Municipal law, ordinance or regulation, (ii) claims,
liabilities, costs or expenses pertaining to the cleanup or containment of
wastes, the identification of scope of any environmental contamination, the
removal of pollutants from soils, riverbeds or aquifers, the provision of an
alternative public drinking water source, or the long term monitoring of ground
water and surface waters, and (iii) all costs of defending such claims. Tenant
will provide Landlord with copies of all applications and supporting
documentation supplied to any governmental agency for the permission to use
toxic material upon the premises. Notwithstanding the above, Tenants shall not
be liable nor responsible for any toxic condition that it can prove existed
prior to its initial occupancy of the Premises.

21. INDEMNITY: As a material part of the consideration to be rendered to
Landlord, Tenant hereby waives all claims against Landlord for damages to goods,
wares and merchandise, and all other personal property in, upon or about said
Premises and for injuries to persons in or about said Premises, from any cause
arising at any time, and Tenant will hold Landlord exempt and harmless from any
damage or injury to any person, or to the goods, wares and merchandise and all
other personal property of any person, arising from the use of the Premises by
Tenant, or from the failure of Tenant to keep the Premises in good condition and
repair, as herein provided, except for Landlord's proven negligence. Further, in
the event Landlord is made party to any litigation due to the acts or omission
of Tenant, Tenant will indemnify and hold Landlord harmless from any such claim
or liability including Landlord's costs and expenses and reasonable attorney's
fees incurred in defending such claims. This paragraph shall not apply to an
injury or damage to person or property arising out of any construction defect.

22. ADVERTISEMENTS AND SIGNS: Tenant will not place or permit to be placed, in,
upon or about the said Premises any unusual or extraordinary signs, or any signs
not approved by the city or other governing authority. The Tenant will not
place, or permit to be placed, upon the Premises, any signs, advertisements or
notices without the written consent of the Landlord as to type, size, design,
lettering, coloring and location, and such consent will not be unreasonably
withheld. Any sign so placed on the Premises shall be so placed upon the
understanding and agreement that Tenant will remove same at the termination of
the tenancy herein created and repair any damage or injury to the Premises
caused thereby, and if not so removed by Tenant then Landlord may have same so
removed at Tenant's expense.

23. ATTORNEY'S FEES: In case suit should be brought for the possession of the
Premises, for the recovery of any sum due hereunder, or because of the breach of
any other covenant herein, the losing party shall pay to the prevailing party a
reasonable attorney's fee as part of its costs which shall be deemed to have
accrued on the commencement of such action.

24. TENANT'S DEFAULT: The occurrence of any of the following shall constitute a
default and breach of this Lease by Tenant: a) Any failure by Tenant to pay the
rental or to make any other payment required to be made by Tenant hereunder,
where such failure continues for ten (10) days after written notice thereof by
Landlord to Tenant; b) The abandonment or vacation


<PAGE>   11
                                      -11-


of the Premises by Tenant; c) A failure by Tenant to observe and perform any
other provision of this Lease to be observed or performed by Tenant, where such
failure continues for thirty (30) days after written notice thereof by Landlord
to Tenant; provided, however, that if the nature of such default is such that
the same cannot reasonably be cured within such thirty (30) day period Tenant
shall not be deemed to be in default if Tenant shall within such period commence
such cure and thereafter diligently prosecute the same to completion; d) The
making by Tenant of any general assignment for the benefit of creditors; the
filing by or against Tenant of a petition to have Tenant adjudged a bankrupt or
of a petition for reorganization or arrangement under any law relating to
bankruptcy (unless, in the case of a petition filed against Tenant, the same is
dismissed after the filing); the appointment of a trustee or receiver to take
possession of substantially all of Tenant's assets located at the Premises or of
Tenant's interest in this Lease, where possession is not restored to Tenant
within thirty (30) days; or the attachment, execution or other judicial seizure
of substantially all of Tenant's assets located at the Premises or of Tenant's
interest in this Lease, where such seizure is not discharged within thirty (30)
days. The notice requirements set forth herein are in lieu of and not in
addition to the notices required by California Code of Civil Procedure Section
1161.

         24.(a) REMEDIES: In the event of any such default by Tenant, then in
         addition to any other remedies available to Landlord at law or in
         equity, Landlord shall have the immediate option to terminate this
         Lease and all rights of Tenant hereunder by giving written notice of
         such intention to terminate. In the event that Landlord shall elect to
         so terminate this Lease then Landlord may recover from Tenant: a) the
         worth at the time of award of any unpaid rent which had been earned at
         the time of such termination; plus b) the worth at the time of award of
         the amount by which the unpaid rent would have been earned after
         termination until the time of award exceeds the amount of such rental
         loss Tenant proves could have been reasonably avoided; plus c) the
         worth at the time of award of the amount by which the unpaid rent for
         the balance of the term after the time of award exceeds the amount of
         such rental loss that Tenant proves could be reasonably avoided; plus
         d) any other amount necessary to compensate Landlord for all the
         detriment proximately caused by Tenant's failure to perform his
         obligations under this Lease or which in the ordinary course of things
         would be likely to result therefrom, and e) at Landlord's election,
         such other amounts in addition to or in lieu of the foregoing as may be
         permitted from time to time by applicable California law. The term
         "rent", as used herein, shall be deemed to be and to mean the minimum
         monthly installments of rent and all other sums required to be paid by
         Tenant pursuant to the terms of this Lease, all other such sums being
         deemed to be an additional rental due hereunder. As used in (a) and (b)
         above, the "worth at the time of award" is computed by allowing
         interest at the rate of the discount rate of the Federal Reserve Bank
         of San Francisco plus five (5%) percent per annum. As used in (c)
         above, the "worth at the time of award" is computed by discounting such
         amount at the discount rate of the Federal Reserve Bank of San
         Francisco at the time of award plus one (1%) percent.

         24.(b) RIGHT TO RE-ENTER: In the event of any uncured monetary default
         as defined above or a default involving a breach of Article 20 herein
         by Tenant, Landlord shall also have the right, with or without
         terminating this Lease, to re-enter the Premises and
<PAGE>   12
                                      -12-

         remove all persons and property from the Premises; such property can be
         removed and stored in a public warehouse or elsewhere at the cost of
         and for the account of Tenant.

         24.(c) ABANDONMENT: In the event of the vacation or abandonment of the
         Premises by Tenant or in the event that Landlord shall elect to
         re-enter as provided in paragraph 24.(b) above or shall take possession
         of the Premises pursuant to legal proceeding or pursuant to any notice
         provided by law, then if Landlord does not elect to terminate this
         Lease as provided in paragraph 24.(a) above, then the provisions of
         California Civil Code Section 1951.4, as amended from time to time,
         shall apply and Landlord may from time to time, without terminating
         this Lease, either recover all rental as it becomes due or relet the
         Premises or any part thereof for such term or terms and at such rental
         or rentals and upon such other terms and conditions as Landlord in its
         sole discretion may deem advisable with the right to make alterations
         and repairs to the Premises. In the event that Landlord shall elect to
         so relet, then rentals received by Landlord from such reletting shall
         be applied: first, to the payment of any indebtedness other than rent
         due hereunder from Tenant to Landlord; second, to the payment of any
         prorated cost of such reletting; third, to the payment of the cost of
         any prorated alterations and repairs to the Premises; fourth, to the
         payment of rent due and unpaid hereunder, and the residue, if any,
         shall be held by Landlord and applied in payment of future rent as the
         same may become due and payable hereunder. Should that portion of such
         rentals received from such reletting during any month, which is applied
         by the payment of rent hereunder, be less that the rent payable during
         that month by Tenant hereunder, then Tenant shall pay such deficiency
         to Landlord immediately upon demand therefore by Landlord. Such
         deficiency shall be calculated and paid monthly. Tenant shall also pay
         to Landlord, as soon as ascertained, any costs and expenses incurred by
         Landlord in such reletting or in making such alterations and repairs
         not covered by the rentals received from such reletting.

         24.(d) NO TERMINATION: No re-entry or taking possession of the Premises
         by Landlord pursuant to 24. (b) or 24. (c) of this Article 24 shall be
         construed as an election to terminate this Lease unless a written
         notice of such intention be given to Tenant or unless the termination
         thereof be decreed by a court of competent jurisdiction.
         Notwithstanding any reletting without termination by Landlord because
         of any default by Tenant, Landlord may at any time after such reletting
         elect to terminate this Lease for any such default.

25. SURRENDER OF LEASE: The voluntary or other surrender of this Lease by
Tenant, or a mutual cancellation thereof, shall not automatically effect a
merger of the Lease with Landlord's ownership of the Building and Premises.
Instead, at the option of Landlord, Tenant's surrender may terminate all or any
existing sublease or subtenancies, or may operate as an assignment to Landlord
of any or all such subleases or subtenancies, thereby creating a direct
Landlord-Tenant relationship between Landlord and any subtenants.

26. HABITUAL DEFAULT: Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in
paragraph 24, 24 (a) (b) (c) and (d), the parties hereto agree that if the
Tenant shall have defaulted in the performance of any monetary default or a
default involving a breach of Article 20 herein of this Lease for three or more
times during any twelve month period during the term
<PAGE>   13
                                      -13-


hereof, then such conduct shall, at the election of the Landlord, represent a
separate event of default which cannot be cured by the Tenant. Tenant
acknowledges that the purpose of this provision is to prevent repetitive
defaults by the Tenant under the Lease, which work a hardship upon the Landlord,
and deprive the Landlord of the timely performance by the Tenant hereunder.

27. LANDLORD'S DEFAULT: In the event of Landlord's failure to perform any of its
covenants or agreements under this Lease, Tenant shall give Landlord written
notice of such failure and shall give Landlord the reasonable opportunity to
cure such failure prior to any claim for breach or for damages resulting from
such failure.

28. NOTICES: All notices given to Tenant may be given in writing personally or
by depositing the same in the United States mail, postage prepaid, and addressed
to Tenant at the said Premises, or such other address advised by Tenant in
writing, whether or not the Tenant has departed from, abandoned or vacated the
Premises. All notices shall be deemed received three (3) days after posting.

29. ENTER BY LANDLORD: Tenant shall permit Landlord and his agents to enter into
and upon said Premises at all reasonable times subject to any security
regulations of Tenant for the purpose of inspecting the same or for the purpose
of maintaining the Premises or the Building in which said Premises are situated
or for the purposes of making repairs, alterations to the Premises, or building
on adjacent land leased by Landlord, including the erection and maintenance of
such scaffolding, canopies, fences and props as may be required without any
rebate of rent or without any liability to Tenant for any loss of occupation or
quiet enjoyment of the Premises thereby occasioned. In the event of a
substantial disruption to Tenant during such entry, Tenant will be entitled to
reasonable reduction in rent determined by the percentage of the floor area of
the building that cannot be utilized by the Tenant; and Tenant shall permit
Landlord and his agents, at any time within ninety (90) days prior to the
expiration of this Lease, to place upon said Premises any "For Sale" or "to
lease" signs and exhibit the Premises to prospective tenants at reasonable
hours.

30. DESTRUCTION OF PREMISES: If the Premises are damaged or destroyed from any
cause during the term of this lease (including option periods) Landlord will
within thirty (30) days of the destruction, notify Tenant in writing: 1) whether
or not the repairs can be made within one hundred fifty (150) days; 2) whether
the destruction is a partial destruction as defined below; 3) if the destruction
is an uninsured loss as defined below which Landlord declines to repair. Within
thirty (30) days of such notice, either party may be written notice to the other
terminate this lease if the repairs cannot be made within one hundred fifty
(150) days, or if the loss is an uninsured loss unless the Landlord elects to
repair the same or if destruction exceeds more than one-half (1/2) of the
replacement cost of the premises. If Landlord fails to timely give the notice,
Tenant shall have ninety (90) days after destruction to give notice of
termination.

In the event of a partial destruction of the Premises from any cause then,
unless the Lease is terminated as provided above, Landlord shall forthwith
repair the same, provided such repairs can be made within one hundred fifty
(150) days under the laws and regulations of State, Federal, County or Municipal
authorities, but such partial destruction shall in no way annul or void this
<PAGE>   14
                                      -14-


Lease, except that Tenant shall be entitled to a proportionate reduction of rent
while such repairs are being made, such proportionate reduction to be based upon
the extent to which the making of such repairs shall interfere with the business
carried on by Tenant in the said Premises in the reasonable judgment of
Landlord. In the event that Landlord does not elect to make such repairs, or
such repairs cannot be made under such laws and regulations, this Lease may be
terminated at the option of Tenant. For purposes of this paragraph "partial
destruction" shall mean destruction to the extent of one-half (1/2) of the
Replacement Cost of the Premises or less. In the event the Premises are more
than partially destroyed, Landlord, or Tenant, may elect to terminate this
Lease. If not so terminated, Landlord shall proceed with repairs, this Lease
continuing in full force and the rent to be proportionately reduced as
aforesaid. In respect to any partial destruction which Landlord is obligated to
repair or may elect to repair under the terms of this paragraph, the provision
of Section 1932, Subdivision 2, and of Section 1933, Subdivision 4, of the Civil
Code of the State of California are waived by Tenant. In all events a total or
partial destruction of the Premises by an uninsured casualty with damage costing
in excess of $500,000.00 to repair, such event shall terminate this Lease at the
option of Landlord. In the event of any dispute between Landlord and Tenant
relative to the provision s of this paragraph, they shall each select an
arbitrator, the two arbitrators so selected shall select a third arbitrator and
the three arbitrators so selected shall hear and determine the controversy and
their decision thereon shall be final and binding upon both the Landlord and
Tenant, who shall bear the cost of such arbitration equally between them. In all
events Landlord shall not be required to restore additions, alterations or
improvements made by Tenant after commencement of this lease or replace Tenant's
fixtures or personal property.

If the Landlord does not rebuild the Premises, then Tenants shall be entitled to
the prorated portion of insurance proceeds under the policy it carries under
Paragraph 13. The prorated portion shall be determined on a straight line basis
over the original term of the Lease.

31. ASSIGNMENT OR SUBLEASE: In the event Tenant should desire to assign this
Lease or any interest therein including, without limitation, a pledge, mortgage
or other hypothecation, except as provided in Paragraph 7, or sublet the
Premises or any part thereof, Tenant shall give Landlord written notice of such
desire at least thirty (30) days in advance of the date on which Tenant desires
to make such assignment or sublet. After Tenant has located a sub-tenant
satisfactory to Tenant, it shall provide further notice to Landlord. This
further notice shall give the name and current address of the proposed
assignee/subtenant, proposed use of the Premises, rental rate and current
financial statement, and upon request to Tenant, Landlord shall be given
additional information as reasonably required to determine whether it will
consent to the proposed assignment or sublease. Landlord shall then have a
period of five (5) working days following receipt of such notice within which to
notify Tenant in writing that Landlord elects (i) to terminate this Lease as to
the space so affected as of the date so specified by Tenant in which event
Tenant will be relieved of all further obligations hereunder as to such space,
(ii) to permit Tenant to assign or sublet such space to the named
assignee/subtenant on the terms and conditions set forth in the notice, or (iii)
refuse consent. If Landlord should fail to notify Tenant in writing of such
election within said five (5) working day period, Landlord shall be deemed to
have elected option (ii) above. Except as provided below, any rent or other
consideration realized by Tenant under any such sublease and assignment in
excess of the monthly rental
<PAGE>   15
                                      -15-


installments payable hereunder, and all expenses payable under Paragraph 11 less
reasonable subletting and assignment costs, AND COSTS PAYABLE BY TENANT TO
MODIFY THE PREMISES TO SUIT THE SUB-TENANT, SHALL BE DIVIDED AND PAID FIFTY
PERCENT (50%) to Landlord and fifty percent (50%) to Tenant. Tenant's obligation
to pay over Landlord's portion of the consideration shall constitute an
obligation for additional rent hereunder. TENANT SHALL FIRST RECEIVE ITS
SUBLETTING AND MODIFICATION COSTS WITHOUT INTEREST BEFORE DIVIDING ANY EXCESS
PROFITS WITH LANDLORD. No assignment or subletting by Tenant shall relieve
Tenant of any obligation under this Lease. Any assignment or subletting which
conflicts with the provisions hereof shall be void.

If Landlord exercises its option to terminate this Lease in part in the event
Tenant desires to sublet or assign part of the Premises, then (a) this Lease
shall end and expire, with respect to such part of the Premises, on the date
upon which the proposed sublease was to commence, and (b) from and after such
date, the rent and Tenant's allocable share of all other costs and charges shall
be adjusted, based upon the proportion that the rentable area of the Premises
remaining bears to the total rentable return of the Premises.

If Landlord does not exercise its option to terminate this Lease, Landlord's
consent to the proposed assignment or sublease shall not unreasonably withheld
provided and upon condition that:

         (a)      In Landlord's reasonable judgment the proposed assignee or
         subtenant is engaged in such a business, and the Premises, or the
         relevant part thereof, will be used in such a manner, that: (ii) is
         limited to the use expressly permitted under this Lease;

         (b)      The proposed assignee or subtenant is a company with
         sufficient financial worth and management ability to undertake the
         responsibility involved, and Landlord has been furnished with
         reasonable proof thereof;

         (c)      THIS PARAGRAPH INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK

         (d)      The proposed sublease shall be in form reasonably satisfactory
         to Landlord;

         (e)      There shall not be more than two (2) subtenants of the
         Premises at any one time;

         (f)      THIS PARAGRAPH INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK

         (g)      Tenant shall reimburse Landlord on demand for any reasonable
         costs that may be incurred by Landlord in connection with said
         assignment or sublease, including the costs of making investigations as
         to the acceptability of the proposed assignee or subtenant and
         reasonable legal costs incurred in connection with the granting of any
         requested consent; and

Any sublease or assignment executed with the consent of Landlord shall be
subject to all of the covenants, agreements, terms, provisions and conditions
contained in this Lease. Notwithstanding any such sublease or assignment and the
acceptancy of rent or additional rent by
<PAGE>   16
                                      -16-


Landlord from any subtenant or assignee, Tenant shall and will remain fully
liable for the payment of the rent and additional rent due, and to become due
hereunder, for the performance of all of the covenants, agreements, terms,
provisions and conditions contained in this Lease on the part of Tenant to be
performed and for all acts and omissions of any licensee, subtenant, assignee or
any other person claiming under or through any subtenant that shall be in
violation of any of the obligations of this Lease, and any such violation shall
be deemed to be a violation by Tenant. Tenant shall further indemnify, defend
and hold Landlord harmless from and against any and all losses, liabilities,
damages, costs and expenses (including reasonable attorney fees) resulting from
any claims that may be made against Landlord by the proposed assignee or
subtenant or by any real estate brokers or other persons claiming a commission
or similar compensation in connection with the proposed assignment or sublease.
In the event of Tenant's default, Tenant hereby assigns all rents due from any
assignment or subletting to Landlord as security for performance of its
obligations under this Lease and Landlord may collect such rents as Tenant's
Attorney-in-Fact, except that Tenant may collect such rents unless a default
occurs, as described in paragraph 24 above.

Any assignment or transfer shall be made only if and shall not be effective
until the assignee shall execute, acknowledge and deliver to Landlord an
agreement, in form and substance satisfactory to Landlord, whereby the assignee
shall assume all of the obligations of this Lease on the part of Tenant to be
performed or observed.

If Tenant is a corporation or partnership, all the above provisions shall apply
to a transfer (by one or more transfers) of a majority of the stock of the
corporation or the majority of ownership or control of the partnership, as if
such transfer were an assignment of this Lease; but said provisions shall not
apply to transactions with a corporation or partnership that controls, is
controlled by, or is under common control with Tenant, provided that, in any of
such events: (i) the successor to Tenant has a net worth, computed in accordance
with generally accepted accounting principles, at least equal to the net worth
of Tenant immediately prior to such transfer; and (ii) proof satisfactory to
Landlord of such net worth shall have been delivered to Landlord at least ten
(10) days prior to the effective date of any such transaction.

Notwithstanding the above, the sale or transfer of a majority of the Tenant's
shares shall not constitute an assignment so long as immediately after such sale
or transfer the corporation meets the new worth criteria set forth above.

Notwithstanding the above, Tenant may assign this lease without Landlord's
consent to any corporation resulting from the merger or consolidation with
Tenant or to any person or entity which acquires all or substantially all the
assets of Tenant as a going concern of the business that is being conducted on
the premises provided that the assignee meets the net worth criteria set forth
above and provided such assignee agrees in writing to abide by all of the terms
of this lease. Only the amount allocated to the lease in the agreement between
Tenant and the purchaser of the business shall be considered rent for purposes
of the 50150 sharing provided in the first paragraph of this Section 31.


<PAGE>   17
                                      -17-


The termination of this Lease due to Tenant's default shall not automatically
terminate any assignment or sublease then in existence. At the sole election of
Landlord, the assignee or subtenant shall attorn to Landlord and Landlord shall
undertake the obligations of the Tenant under the sublease or assignment;
provided the Landlord shall not be liable for prepaid rent, security deposits or
other defaults of the Tenant to the subtenant or assignee.

32. CONDEMNATION: If any part of the Premises shall be taken for any public or
quasi-public use, under any statute or by right of eminent domain or private
purchase in lieu thereof, and a part thereof remains which is susceptible of
occupation hereunder, this Lease shall as to the part so taken, terminate as of
the date title shall vest in the condemnor or purchaser and the rent payable
hereunder shall be adjusted so that the Tenant shall be required to pay for the
remainder of the term only such portion of such rent as the value of the part
remaining after such taking bears to the value of the entire Premises prior to
such taking; but in such event Landlord shall have the option to terminate this
Lease as of the date when title to the part so taken vests in the condemnor or
purchaser. Tenant to be notified in writing by Landlord of any pending or
threatened condemnation proceedings within a reasonable period of time after
Landlord's knowledge of same and whether Landlord intends to terminate the lease
so as to give Tenant a reasonable opportunity to locate new facilities. If all
of the Premises, or such part thereof be taken so that there does not remain a
portion susceptible for occupation hereunder, this Lease shall there upon
terminate. If a part of all of the Premises be taken, then Landlord and Tenant
shall share in the balance of the compensation remaining after the application
of the condemnation provisions of the Ground Lease and of the Lease Mortgage and
that is payable to Landlord. The compensation shall be divided between Landlord
and Tenant in proportion to the relative amounts spent by Landlord and Tenant
for Tenant improvements as provided in this lease. Tenant's share of the
compensation shall not exceed the depreciated value of the improvements as
provided in this lease installed and paid for by Tenant less any amounts
received or to be received by Tenant outside of the award as compensation for
Tenant's interest in those improvements. If Tenant elects to remove some or all
of the improvements pursuant to California Code of Civil Procedure Section
1263.260, then the value of such improvements removed shall be excluded from the
calculation. Landlord shall have the exclusive right to negotiate or litigate
the award with the authority exercising the power of eminent domain. Landlord
shall cooperate with Tenant in Tenant's efforts to recover compensation for
relocation costs, loss of personal property not treated as improvements
pertaining to realty and loss of goodwill. Tenant waives the provisions of
California Code of Civil Procedure Section 1265.130.

33. EFFECTS OF CONVEYANCE: The term "Landlord" as used in this Lease, means only
the Ground Lessee for the time being of the land and Building, containing the
Premises, so that, in the event of any sale of the Ground Lease, the Landlord
shall be and hereby is entirely freed and relieved of all covenants and
obligations of the Landlord hereunder, and it shall be deemed and construed,
without further agreement between the parties and the purchaser at any such
sale, if the purchaser of the Ground Lease has agreed in writing to carry out
any and all covenants and obligations of the Landlord hereunder. Landlord shall
transfer and deliver Tenant's security deposit, to the purchaser at any such
sale or the master tenant of the Building, and thereupon the Landlord shall be
discharged from any further liability in reference thereto.
<PAGE>   18
                                      -18-


34. SUBORDINATION: In the event Landlord notifies Tenant in writing, this Lease
shall be subordinate to any ground Lease, deed of trust, or other hypothecation
for security now or hereafter placed upon the real property of which the
Premises are a part and to any and all advances made on the security thereof and
to renewals, modifications, replacements and extensions thereof. Tenant agrees
to promptly execute any documents which may be required to effectuate such
subordination. Notwithstanding such subordination, Tenant's right to quiet
possession of the premises shall not be disturbed if Tenant is not in default
and so long as Tenant shall pay the rent and observe and perform all of the
provisions of this Lease. At the request of any lender, Tenant agrees to execute
and deliver any reasonable modifications of this Lease which do not adversely
affect the leasehold or Tenant's rights hereunder.

35. WAIVER: The waiver by Landlord of any breach of any term, covenant or
condition, herein contained shall not be deemed to be a waiver of such term,
covenant or condition or any subsequent breach of the same or any other term,
covenant or condition herein contained. The subsequent acceptance of rent
hereunder by Landlord shall not be deemed to be a waiver of any preceding breach
by Tenant of any term, covenant or condition of this Lease, other than the
failure of Tenant to pay the particular rental so accepted, regardless of
Landlord's knowledge of such preceding breach at the time of acceptance of such
rent.

36. HOLDING OVER: Any holding over after the termination or expiration of the
said term, shall be construed to be a hold over tenancy and Tenant shall pay
rent to Landlord at a rate equal to ONE AND ONE-HALF (1 1/2) times the monthly
rental installment due in the month preceding the termination or expiration of
the Lease and shall otherwise be on the terms and conditions herein specified,
except those provisions relating to the term and any options to extend or renew,
which terms are expressly waived during any hold over. Furthermore, no holding
over shall be deemed or construed to exercise any option to extend or renew this
Lease in lieu of full and timely exercise of any such option as required
hereunder.

37. SUCCESSORS AND ASSIGNS: The covenants and conditions herein contained shall,
subject to the provisions as to assignment, apply to and bind the heirs,
successors, executors, administrators and assigns of all the parties hereto; and
all of the parties hereto shall be jointly and severally liable hereunder.

38. ESTOPPEL CERTIFICATES: Tenant shall at any time during the term of this
Lease, upon not less than five (5) business days prior written notice from
Landlord, execute and deliver to Landlord a statement in writing certifying that
this Lease is unmodified and in full force and effect (or, if modified, stating
the nature of such modification) and the date to which the rent and other
charges are paid in advance, if any, and acknowledging that there are not, to
Tenant's knowledge, any uncured defaults on the part of Landlord hereunder or
specifying such defaults if they are claimed. Any such statement may be
conclusively relied upon by any prospective purchaser or encumbrances of the
Premises. Tenant's failure to deliver such statement within such time shall be
conclusive upon the Tenant that: (a) this Lease is in full force and effect,
without modification except as may be represented by Landlord; (b) there are not
uncured defaults in Landlord's performance.
<PAGE>   19
                                      -19-


39. OPTION TO EXTEND: Tenant shall have the option and right to extend the term
of this Lease for two (2) separate additional and successive option periods of
five (5) years each, (each such period being referred to as the "Renewal Term")
commencing with rent at "Fair Market Value," as defined in paragraph 40 below,
and subject to adjustment in accordance with paragraph 41 only under the
following conditions precedent: (i) Tenant alone is in occupation of and is
conducting the business in at least sixty six and two-thirds percent (66 2/3%)
of the Premises and Tenant, for itself and its successors and assigns, hereby
expressly acknowledges and agrees that this Option to Extend is personal to
Tenant; and (ii) and Tenant has delivered written notice by certified mail to
Landlord not less than one hundred and twenty (120) days prior and not more than
one hundred and eighty (180) days prior to the expiration of the then existing
term of the Lease of Tenant's intention to extend the term of the Lease.

40. FAIR MARKET VALUE: For purposes of this Lease the term "Fair Market Value"
shall mean the going market rental as of the date of commencement of each
Renewal Term, for equivalent space of similar age and construction, with
improvements and equipment in similar condition and for a lessee proposing to
sign five (5) year lease and having financial qualifications similar to Tenant,
it being understood that in determining "Fair Market Value" the parties shall
negotiate in good faith in order to reach agreement; and in the event the
parties are unable to reach agreement, the matter shall be referred to
arbitration by three (3) M.A.I. appraisers, experienced in the evaluation of
similar rental properties in the County of Santa Clara, State of California.
Landlord and Tenant shall each appoint one such arbitrator within thirty (30)
days of a written request for arbitration from the other, and the two
arbitrators so selected shall select a third arbitrator within fifteen (15) days
after the selection of the second arbitrator. Should either party fail to
appoint an arbitrator as provided above, the decision of the remaining
arbitrators shall be final. The arbitrators shall be instructed to disregard any
Fair Market Value directly attributable to leasehold improvements paid for
by Tenant that can be documented and supported by generally accepted accounting
methods. All specialized leasehold improvements paid for by Landlord shall be
included in Fair Market value. The determination of the three arbitrators shall
be made by the vote of two (2) or more of the three arbitrators within thirty
(30) days from the date of the appointment of the third arbitrator and shall be
final for all purposes. The cost of arbitration shall be shared equally. In no
event shall such "Fair Market value" be less than the rental paid during the
year immediately preceding the commencement of the current extension.

If, after the determination of fair rental value by appraisal, Tenant rejects
such value in a writing delivered to Landlord within five (5) days after the
date of such determination. Tenant's notice of exercise of the option shall be
deemed null and void, and the lease shall terminate effective as of the date six
(6) months after Landlord's receipt of Tenant's rejection notice. During this
six (6) month period, Tenant shall continue to pay rental at the fair rental
value determined by the arbitrators. In addition, Tenant shall bear and pay,
upon Landlord's request, all fees, costs and "out-of-pocket" expenses incurred
by Landlord in connection with the determination of fair rental value by
appraisal.

41. RENTAL ADJUSTMENTS DURING ORIGINAL TERM: The rent during the Original Term
shall be subject to adjustments beginning the FORTY-NINTH (49TH) MONTH AND
<PAGE>   20
                                      -20-


EVERY FORTY EIGHTH MONTH THEREAFTER THROUGHOUT THE BALANCE OF THE ORIGINAL TERM
BASED on the Consumer Price Index Adjustment ("Adjustment Date"). The basis for
computing the Adjustment shall be the U.S. Department of Labor, Bureau of Labor
Statistics' Consumer Price Index for All urban Consumers, All items,
1982-84=100, for the San Francisco-Oakland area, ("Index"). The Index most
recently published preceding the Lease commencement date and the commencement of
each Renewal Term shall be considered the "Beginning Index." If the Index most
recently published preceding the Adjustment Date ("Comparison Index") is greater
than the Beginning Index, the monthly rent shall be increased by multiplying the
monthly rent by a fraction, the numerator of which is the Comparison Index and
the denominator of which is the Beginning Index. Notwithstanding any subsequent
decrease in the Index, the new monthly rent shall never be less than the rent
for the month immediately preceding the Adjustment Date. On adjustment of the
monthly rent Landlord shall notify Tenant by letter stating the new monthly
rent. If the Index base year is changed so that it differs from 1982-84=100, the
Index shall be converted in accordance with the conversion factor published by
the United States Department of Labor, Bureau of Labor Statistics. If the Index
is discontinued or revised during the Renewal Term, such other government index
or computation with which it is replaced shall be used in order to obtain
substantially the same result as would be obtained if the index had not been
discontinued or revised. Provided further that for each forty-eight (48) month
adjustment period, in no event shall the rent determined in this manner be less
than on a compound annual increase of three percent (3%) per year nor more than
on a compounded annual increase of six percent (6%) per year.

Furthermore, should Tenant believe that this increase does not reflect actual
market conditions, the Tenant reserves the rights to hire three (3) M.A.I.
appraisers at its expense as described in Article 40 to determine the market
rent for similar industrial buildings in the City of Santa Clara. If the
determination of market rental value by the appraisers results in a lower
increase then that increase arrived at based on the Consumer Price Index
adjustment, including the floor and ceiling figures set forth above, the opinion
of the three appraisers shall be utilized to arrive at the adjusted rent for the
period. In no event shall the rental for the adjustment period be less than the
rental paid during the year immediately preceding the commencement of the
adjustments period.

42. OPTIONS: Except as provided in Paragraph 39, all Options provided Tenant in
this Lease are personal and granted to original Tenant and are not exercisable
by any third party should Tenant assign or sublet all or a portion of its rights
under this Lease, unless Landlord consents to permit exercise of any option by
any assignee or subtenant, in Landlord's sole discretion. In the event that
Tenant hereunder has any multiple options to extend this Lease, a later option
to extend the Lease cannot be exercised unless the prior option has been so
exercised.

Notwithstanding the above, if the assignment is a result of the transfer of
Tenant's stock as permitted by Paragraph 31, the options to extend will survive
the assignment.

43. QUIET ENJOYMENT: Upon Tenant's faithful and timely performance of all the
terms and covenants of the Lease, Tenant shall quietly have and hold the
Premises for the term and any extensions thereof.
<PAGE>   21
                                      -21-


44. BROKERS. Tenant represents it has not utilized or contracted a real estate
broker or finder with respect to this Lease, EXCEPT FOR TED LUCE REAL ESTATE,
INC. AND BISHOP HAWK, and Tenant agrees to indemnify and hold Landlord harmless
against any claim, cost, liability or cause of action asserted by any broker or
finder claiming through Tenant except for $300,000.00 in commission which
Landlord shall pay and which shall be divided equally between such Brokers. One
half of such commission will be payable upon commencement of construction and
one half upon Tenant's occupancy.

45. LANDLORD'S LIABILITY. If Tenant should recover a money judgment against
Landlord arising in connection with this Lease, the judgment shall be satisfied
only out of Landlord's interest in the Premises including the improvements and
real property and neither Landlord or any of its partners shall be liable
personally for any deficiency.

46. AUTHORITY OF PARTIES: If Tenant is a corporation, each individual executing
this Lease on behalf of said corporation represents and warrants that he is duly
authorized to execute and deliver this Lease on behalf of said corporation, in
accordance with a duly adopted resolution of the Board of Directors of said
corporation or in accordance with the by-laws of said corporation, and that this
Lease is binding upon said corporation in accordance with its terms.

47. GROUND LEASE. Landlord is the Tenant under a Ground Lease affecting the
Premises. This Lease is subordinate to the Ground Lease and is subject to all of
the terms and conditions of the Ground Lease. A true and correct copy of the
Ground Lease has been attached as Exhibit "B," and the terms of the Ground Lease
are incorporated into this Lease. Tenant shall not commit or permit to be
committed on the Premises any act or omission which shall violate any term or
condition of the Ground Lease. Tenant shall perform all actions required to be
performed by it under the terms of the Ground Lease. Tenant shall indemnify and
hold Landlord harmless from any claim, loss or damage (including any
expenditures for attorneys fees reasonably incurred by Landlord) sustained by
Landlord as the result of any act or omission by Tenant, its agents, employees,
invitees or contractors in violation of the provisions of the Ground Lease. The
provisions of this paragraph shall survive the expiration or termination of this
Lease.

48. MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS: All rights and remedies hereunder are cumulative
and not alternative to the extent permitted by law and are in addition to all
other rights and remedies in law and in equity.

If any term or provision of this Lease is held unenforceable or invalid by a
court of competent jurisdiction, the remainder of the Lease shall not be
invalidated hereby but shall be enforceable in accordance with its terms,
omitting the invalid or unenforceable term.

This Lease shall be governed by and construed in accordance with California law.

Tenant shall not permit or condone any nuisance or disturbance of any kind on
the Premises which annoys or disturbs other occupants of the Project.
<PAGE>   22
                                      -22-


All sums due hereunder, including rent and additional rent, if not paid when
due, shall bear interest at the maximum rate permitted under California law
accruing from the date due until the date paid to Landlord.

Time is of the essence hereunder.

The headings or titles to the paragraphs of this Lease are not a part of this
Lease and shall have no effect upon the construction or interpretation of any
part thereof nor shall any phrases in capital letters have any increased
emphasis. This instrument contains all of the agreements and conditions made
between the parties hereto and may not be modified orally or in any other manner
than by an agreement in writing signed by all of the parties hereto or their
respective successors in interest.

If Tenant fails to perform any obligation required under this Lease or by law or
governmental regulation, Landlord in its sole discretion may without notice
perform such obligation, in which event Tenant shall pay landlord as additional
rent all sums paid by Landlord in connection with such substitute performance
within ten (10) days following Landlord's written notice for such payment. Any
delinquent sum shall bear interest at the maximum lawful contract rate permitted
to be charged under California law.

If Landlord becomes a party to any litigation concerning this Lease, the
Premises, the Building or the Project by reason of any act or omission of Tenant
or Tenant's authorize representatives, Tenant shall be liable to Landlord for
reasonable attorneys' fees, court costs and litigation expenses incurred by
Landlord in the litigation, whether such litigation leads to actual court
action.

All monetary sums due from Tenant to landlord under this Lease shall be deemed
to be rent.

Whenever a consent of a party to this lease is required, such consent will not
be arbitrarily or unreasonably withheld or delayed.

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, Landlord and Tenant have executed these presents, the day
and year first above written.
<PAGE>   23
                                      -23-

LANDLORD:  UNIVERSITY RESEARCH CENTER        TENANT:  Zyca Corporation

A California General Partnership             a California Corporation

                                             BY:
BY: /s/ John A. Sobrato
    -----------------------------
John A. Sobrato                              ITS:     President

ITS:  General Partner

BY: /s/
    -----------------------------

ITS:  General Partner


<PAGE>   1
                                                                    EXHIBIT 10.2

                         PROVISIONAL LEASE OF STATE LAND



         Whereas, I, SUDARSONO OSMAN, the Superintendent of Lands and Surveys,
Kuching Division (hereinafter called "the said Superintendent") have agreed to
lease to ZYCON CORPORATION SENDIRIAN BERHAD, a company incorporated and
registered under the Companies Act, 1965, all that parcel of land situate in the
Muara Tebas Land District and known as Lot Number 1072 (in Block/Section Number
12) containing approximately 7.31 hectares; and

         Whereas a lease in accordance with the provision of the Land Code
cannot be given because the immediate survey of the land has not yet been
practicable;

         Now therefore, I, the said Superintendent, hereby agreed to the said
ZYCON CORPORATION SENDIRIAN BERHAD entering into possession of the said land and
holding it as tenant from the fourteenth day of November, 1995 subject to the
payment therefor of the annual rent of dollars Fourteen Thousand and Thirty-Five
only (RM14,035.00) of the payment of such revised rent as may hereafter be
determined under section 30 of the Land Code, and subject to the following terms
and conditions:

         (1) Upon the completion of a properly survey of the land the holder of
this provisional lease will be given a lease in accordance with the provisions
of the Land Code, and subject to the following express conditions and
restrictions (including any modifications of implied conditions and
restrictions):

                  (i)  This land is to be used only for industrial purposes;

                  (ii) The development or re-redevelopment of this land shall be
         in accordance with plans and sections and elevations approved by the
         superintendent of Lands and Surveys, Kuching Division;

                  (iii) The erection of a building or buildings on this land
         shall be in accordance with detailed drawings and specifications
         approved by The Council of the City of Kuching South and shall be
         completed with two (2) years from the date of registration of this
         lease;

                  (iv) No residential accommodation other than accommodation for
         a watchman with a maximum floor area of 37.2 square metres may be
         permitted on this land;

                  (v) No transfer affecting this land may be effected without
         the consent in writing of the Director of Lands and Surveys; and

                  (vi) No sublease affecting this land may be effected without
         the consent in writing of the Director of Lands and Surveys during the
         initial period of five (5) years from the date of registration of this
         lease.
<PAGE>   2
         Premium: Ringgit three hundred and ninety three thousand four hundred
twelve and cents forty only (RM393,412.40) (payable by five (5) installments as
follows:

                  (a) The first installment of RM118,023.00 to be paid on the
         registration of this lease; and

                  (b) Fourth (4) subsequent equal installments of RM83,145.80 to
         be paid annually thereafter on the 1st day of January of each
         succeeding year.)



                                                              [SKETCH]


<PAGE>   1
                                                                    Exhibit 10.4

                       DATED THIS 9TH DAY OF FEBRUARY 1996

                                     BETWEEN

                           ZYCON CORPORATION SDN. BHD.
                                   As Borrower

                         BANK BUMIPUTRA MALAYSIA BERHAD
                                   As Arranger

                         BANK BUMIPUTRA MALAYSIA BERHAD,
                            As Working Capital Lender

                         BANK BUMIPUTRA MALAYSIA BERHAD,
                              BBMB KEWANGAN BERHAD,
                                As Lending Banks

                         BANK BOMIPUTRA MALAYSIA BERHAD
                                As Funding Lender

                         BANK BUMIPUTRA MALAYSIA BERHAD
                                As Facility Agent

                                       AND

                         BANK BUMIPUTRA MALAYSIA BERHAD
                                As Security Agent

                  ---------------------------------------------
                                 RM50,400,000.00
                            FACILITIES AGREEMENT FOR
                                   1. RM5,900,000.00 Working Capital Facilities
                                   2. RM29,200,000.00 Term Loan I Facility
                                   3. USD4,000,000.00 Term Loan Facility
                                   4. USD2,000,000.00 Revolving Credit Facility
                  ---------------------------------------------

                                  Prepared by:

                                  SKRINE & CO.
                             ADVOCATES & SOLICITORS
                              4, LEECH PASAR BESAR
                               50050 KUALA LUMPUR

                         File No. PTW/ag/1518780/95(TC)
                              February 7, 1996-1i4
                           H:\PTW\CORP\1518780\FAC-AG




<PAGE>   2



THIS AGREEMENT is made the 9th day of February, 1996 BETWEEN

(1)    ZYCON CORPORATION SDN. BHD., a company incorporated in Malaysia and
       having its registered office at 11th Floor, Wisma Damansara, Jalan
       Semantan, Damansara Heights 50490 Kuala Lampur ("Borrower");

(2)    BANK BUMIPUTRA MALAYSIA BERHAD, ("Arranger");

(3)    BANK BUMIPUTRA MALAYSIA BERHAD, ("Working Capital Lender");

(4)    BANK BUMIPUTRA MALAYSIA BERHAD and, BBMB KEWANGAN BERHAD ("Lending
       Banks");

(5)    BANK BUMIPUTRA MALAYSIA BERHAD ("Funding Lender");

(6)    BANK BUMIPUTRA MALAYSIA BERHAD, as facility agent for itself and the
       Lenders (as hereinafter defined) (in such capacity, the "Facility Agent,"
       which expression shall include any of its successors in such capacity);

       and    

(7)    BANK BUMIPUTRA MALAYSIA BERHAD, as security agent for itself, the
       Facility Agent and the Lenders (in such capacity, the "Security Agent,"
       which expression shall include any of its successors in such capacity).

WHEREAS, as a result of arrangements by the Arranger made at the request of the
Borrower:

(1)    the Working Capital Lender will make available to the Borrower the
       Working Capital Facilities (as hereinafter defined) upon the security
       granted or created in its favour under, pursuant to and/or in connection
       with the Security Documents (as hereinafter defined).

(2)    the Lending Banks will make available to the Borrower the TL I Facility
       (as hereinafter defined) upon the security granted or created in favour
       of each of them under, pursuant to and/or in connection with the Security
       Documents; and

(3)    the Funding Lender will make available to Borrower the Dollar Advances
       Facility (as hereinafter defined) and the Dollar RC Facility (as
       hereinafter defined) upon the security granted or created in its favour
       under, pursuant to and/or in connection with the Security Documents.









<PAGE>   3

                                      -2-



       IT IS AGREED as follows:

1.     INTERPRETATION
       --------------

       1.1    Definition
              ----------

       In this Agreement, unless the context otherwise requires:

              "Advance Margin" means one point seven five per centum (1.75%) per
              annum or such other rate as is varied by the Funding Lender as
              specifically permitted by this Agreement;

              "Agents" means the Facility Agent and the Security Agent;

              "Assignment" means an assignment of all the Borrower's rights
              interest benefit and title in respect of the Land Letter of Offer
              and Acceptance and in and to the Land;

              "Available Dollar Advances Commitment" means, in relation to the
              Funding Lender at any particular time, the Dollar Advances
              Commitment less the Dollar Advances Outstanding at that time;

              "Available Dollar RC Commitment" means in relation to the Funding
              Lender at any particular time, the Dollar RC Commitment less the
              Dollar RC Loan at that time;

              "Available Ringgit Advances Commitment" means the Available
              Ringgit Advances Commitment (TL I);

              "Available Ringgit Advances Commitment (TL I)" means, in relation
              to a Lending Bank at any particular time, the Ringgit Advances
              Commitment (TL I) less the Ringgit Advances Outstanding (TL I) at
              that time;

              "Available Working Capital Commitment" means, in relation to the
              Working Capital Lender at any particular time, its Working Capital
              Commitment less the aggregate principal amount comprised in its
              Working Capital Outstanding Amount at that time;

              "BAFIA" means the Banking and Financial Institutions Act, 1989;

              "Base Lending Rate" means the rate of interest which is from time
              to time stipulated by BBMB as its minimum or lowest lending rate
              or where such rate is not available for any reason whatsoever,
              such other rate in substitution thereof as may from time to time
              be stipulated by BBMB to the Facility Agent;






<PAGE>   4
                                      -3-


              "BBMB" means Bank Bumiputra Malaysia Berhad, a company
              incorporated in Malaysia pursuant to the Companies Act, 1965 and
              licensed under the Banking and Financial Institutions Act, 1989 as
              a licensed bank and having its registered office at Menara
              Bumiputra, Jalan Melaka, 50100 Kuala Lumpur and includes its
              successors in title and assigns thereof;

              "BBMB Group" means all companies which are related companies or
              associate companies of BBMB;

              "Beneficiaries" means the Agents, the Working Capital Lender, the
              Lending Banks and the Funding Lender;

              "Charge" means a first fixed legal charge over the Land under the
              Sarawak Land Code (Chapter 81) in favour of the Security Agent for
              the Beneficiaries as security for the Facilities;

              "Commitment Termination Date" means:

              (a)    in relation to the TL I Facility, the date which is a
                     Ringgit Business Day following twenty four (24) months from
                     the date of first Ringgit Advance under the TL I Facility;

              (b)    in relation to the Dollar Advance Facility, the date which
                     is a Dollar Business Day following eighteen (18) months
                     from the date of first Dollar Advance;

              (c)    in relation to the Dollar RC Facility, the date which is a
                     Dollar Business Day on which the Dollar RC Facility is
                     cancelled or terminated pursuant to the terms herein;

              "Corporate Guarantee" means the corporate guarantee for the
              performance of the obligations of the Borrower to the Lenders
              under or in connection with this Agreement and each of the
              Security Documents, given by the Corporate Guarantor in favour of
              the Facility Agent and the other Beneficiaries;

              "Contractor" means HITI ENGINEERING (M) SDN. BHD. or such other
              contractors appointed by the Borrower;

              "Corporate Guarantor" means Zycon Corporation, a corporation
              incorporated and existing under the laws of the State of Delaware
              in the United States of America and having its registered office
              at 445, El Camino Real, Santa Clara, California CA 95050-4366;






<PAGE>   5

                                      -4-


              "Debenture" means the debenture to be executed by the Borrower in
              favour of the Security Agent for the benefit of the Beneficiaries
              wherein the Borrower as beneficial owner thereby:

              (1)    charges by way of first fixed legal charge over all estates
                     and interests in the Land and any other freehold or
                     leasehold property (hereinafter collectively called "the
                     Immovable Property") now or at any time during the
                     continuance of this security belonging or charged to the
                     Borrower in respect of which the Borrower shall at the
                     request of the Security Agent execute charges under the
                     Sarawak Land Code in favour of the Security Agent and such
                     other legal documents as may be required by the Security
                     Agent from time to time and all licenses now or hereafter
                     held by the Borrower to enter upon or use the Immovable
                     Property the benefit of all other agreements relating to
                     the Immovable Property to which the Borrower is or may
                     become a party or otherwise entitled and all buildings,
                     fixtures, plant and machinery owned by the Borrower and
                     from time to time on or in any freehold or leasehold
                     property an interest in which is charged hereunder and the
                     proceeds of sale thereof, all Debts (as defined in the
                     Debenture), all chattel paper, documents and instruments
                     evidencing any obligation to the Borrower, all accounts (as
                     defined in the Debenture), all its present and future
                     uncalled capital, all the undertaking and goodwill of the
                     Borrower, all stocks, shares, debentures, loan capital,
                     rights to subscribe for, convert other securities into or
                     otherwise acquire any stocks, shares, debentures and loan
                     capital of any other body corporate now or at any time
                     hereafter belonging to the Borrower, together with all
                     dividends, interest and other income and all other rights
                     of whatsoever kind deriving from or incidental to any of
                     the foregoing, all of the Equipment (as defined in the
                     Debenture) and all proceeds of sale thereof;

              (2)    assigns in favour of the Security Agent for the benefit of
                     the Beneficiaries, the benefit to the Borrower of all
                     rights and claims to which the Borrower is now or may
                     hereafter become entitled in relation to the Immovable
                     Property including in particular (but without prejudice to
                     the generality of the foregoing) all rights and claims of
                     the Borrower against all persons who now are or who at any
                     time have been or may become lessees of the whole or any
                     part or parts of the Immovable Property and all guarantors
                     and sureties for the obligations of such persons and
                     against all persons who are under any obligation to the
                     Borrower in respect of any works of design, construction,
                     repair or replacement to or on or about the Immovable
                     Property or any of the fixtures, fittings and equipment on,
                     in or about the Immovable Property so far as the same are
                     or become capable of assignment without the consent of a
                     third party or such consent shall be obtained; and





<PAGE>   6

                                      -5-


              (3)    charges by way of a first floating charge all the Inventory
                     (as defined in the Debenture) and all its property assets
                     and rights whatsoever and wheresoever both present and
                     future not otherwise charged assigned or mortgaged by way
                     of fixed charge under paragraph (1) or (2) above or
                     otherwise pursuant to the Debenture,

              save for future assets and properties of the Borrower which are
              excluded in accordance with the provisions therein;

              "Depository Agent" means the agent of BBMB in that foreign country
              where the Letter of Credit shall be issued;

              "Dollar Advance" means an advance in US Dollars made or to be made
              by the Funding Lender to the Borrower under the Dollar Advances
              Facility or, as the case may be, the outstanding principal amount
              of any such advance;

              "Dollar Advances Commitment" means the commitment of the Funding
              Lender to make Dollar Advances to the Borrower of an aggregate
              principal amount not exceeding United States Dollars Four Million
              (USD4,000,000.00) upon the terms and subject to the conditions of
              this Agreement;

              "Dollar Advances Facility" means the USD term loan facility of up
              to the aggregate principal amount of United States Dollars Four
              Million (USD4,000,000.00) granted by the Funding Lender to the
              Borrower subject to the terms and conditions herein;

              "Dollar Advance Interest Period" means the period of one (1),
              three (3) or six (6) months, as selected by the Borrower or if no
              selection is made, such period as selected by the Funding Lender
              provided that:

              (a)    the first Dollar Advance Interest Period in respect of any
                     Dollar Advance other than the first Dollar Advance shall
                     end upon the expiry of the Dollar Advance Interest Period
                     then current for the first Dollar Advance so that all
                     current Dollar Advance Interest Periods shall be
                     co-terminous;

              (b)    any Dollar Advance Interest Period relating to a Dollar
                     Advance which would otherwise extend beyond the last
                     installment date for the Dollar Advances Facility shall end
                     on the last installment date for the Dollar Advances
                     Facility;

              (c)    each subsequent Dollar Advance Interest Period shall
                     commence on the expiry of the previous one;

              (d)    any Dollar Advance Interest period which would otherwise
                     end on a non-Dollar Business Day shall end on the next
                     succeeding Dollar Business 






<PAGE>   7
                                      -6-

                     Day or if that Dollar Business Day falls in the next
                     calendar month of the year, on the preceding Dollar
                     Business Day;

              (e)    if a Dollar Advance Interest Period is extended or
                     shortened by (d) above, the following Dollar Advance
                     Interest Period shall (without prejudice to the application
                     of (d) above) end on the day on which it would have ended
                     if the preceding Dollar Advance Interest Period had not
                     been so extended or shortened; and

              (f)    If any Dollar Advance Interest Period commences on the last
                     Dollar Business Day in a calendar month or if there is no
                     corresponding date in the calendar month in which Dollar
                     Advance Interest Period is due to end, then such Dollar
                     Advance Interest Period shall end on the last Dollar
                     Business Day in the relevant later month;

              "Dollar Advances Outstandings" means, in relation, to the Funding
              Lender at any particular time, the aggregate principal amount of
              all (if any) Dollar Advances outstanding under or in connection
              with the Dollar Advances Facility at that time;

              "Dollar Business Day" means a day (other than Saturday or Sunday
              or any public holiday) on which (i) US Dollar deposits may be
              dealt in on the Singapore Inter-bank Market and (ii) commercial
              banks are open for business in Kuala Lumpur and Singapore;

              "Dollar RC Commitment" means the commitment of the Funding Lender
              to make Dollar RC Drawdowns to the Borrower of the aggregate
              principal amount not exceeding United States Dollars Two Million
              (USD2,000,000.00) upon the terms and subject to the conditions of
              this Agreement;

              "Dollar RC Drawdowns" means all drawdowns made or to be made by
              the Borrower under the Dollar RC Facility and "Dollar RC Drawdown"
              means each drawdown made or to be made by the Borrower under the
              Dollar RC Facility;

              "Dollar RC Drawdown Notice" means a notice of drawdown
              substantially in the form set out in Schedule 6 hereto;

              "Dollar RC Facility" means the USD revolving credit facility of up
              to the aggregate principal amount of United States Dollars Two
              Million (USD2,000,000.00) granted by the Funding Lender to the
              Borrower subject to the terms and conditions herein;

              "Dollar RC Loan" means at any particular time, the aggregate
              principal amount of all Dollar RC Drawdowns or amounts rolled over
              outstanding under or in connection with the Dollar RC Facility at
              that time;



<PAGE>   8

                                      -7-


              "Dollar RC Margin" means one point seven five per centum (1.75%)
              per annum or such other rate as is varied by the Funding Lender as
              specifically permitted by this Agreement;

              "Dollar RC Repayment Date" means the last Dollar Business Day of a
              Dollar RC Rollover Period;

              "Dollar RC Rollover Period" means the period of one (1), three (3)
              or six (6) months, subject to the availability of funds, as
              selected by the Borrower, for each Dollar RC Drawdown and any
              roll-over thereof but in all cases to mature on a day which is not
              later than the expiry date of the Dollar RC Facility and on a
              Dollar Business Day;

              "Dollar RC Interest Period" means the period of one (1), three (3)
              and six (6) months as selected by the Borrower or if no selection
              is made, such period as selected by the Funding Lender;

              "Effective Cost of Funds" means in relation to a Lender the cost
              to that Lender of obtaining one (1), three (3) or six (6) months
              Ringgit deposit from the Kuala Lumpur Inter-bank Market plus the
              cost of maintaining statutory reserves and complying with
              liquidity and other requirements imposed from time to time and at
              any time by Bank Negara Malaysia or any other appropriate
              authority;

              "Event of Default" means any of the events or circumstances
              described in Clause 17;

              "Facility Office" means in relation to any Beneficiary, its office
              identified in Schedule 1 (or, in the case of a Transferee, at the
              end of the Transfer Certificate to which it is a party as
              Transferee) or such other office as it may from time to time
              select and notify to the Agents and the Borrower in accordance
              with Clause 29;

              "Facilities" means the facilities comprising of the Dollar
              Advances Facility, the Dollar RC Facility, the TL I Facility and
              the Working Capital Facilities and the expression "Facility" means
              any one of these Facilities;

              "Funding Labor Outstanding Amount" means in relation to the
              Funding Lender at any particular time, the aggregate at such time
              of (i) its Dollar Advances Outstanding (ii) its Dollar RC Loan and
              (iii) all interest, fees, costs, expenses and other monies
              whatsoever which are expressed to be payable to the Funding Lender
              under this Agreement;




<PAGE>   9
                                      -8-


              "Instructing Group" means:

              (i)    before any advance, drawdown or utilisation of any of the
                     Facilities granted hereunder, the Lenders whose Lender
                     Commitment constitute in aggregate more than fifty per
                     centum (50.0%) of the Lenders Commitments;

              (ii)   thereafter, the Lenders to whom in aggregate more than
                     fifty per centum (50.0%) of the Lenders Outstanding Amounts
                     are owed;

              "Interest Payment Date" means:

              (a)    in relation to a Ringgit Advance, the last Ringgit Business
                     Day of a TL I Interest Period provided that upon
                     commencement of the installment payments under the TL I
                     Facility, each Interest Payment Date shall coincide with
                     the installment payment date then current for the TL I
                     Facility;

              (b)    in relation to a Dollar Advance, the last Dollar Business
                     day of the Dollar Advance Interest Period provided that
                     upon commencement of the installment payments under the
                     Dollar Advances Facility, each Interest Payment Date shall
                     coincide with the installment payment date then current for
                     the Dollar Advances Facility;

              (c)    in relation to a Dollar RC Drawdown the last Dollar
                     Business Day of the Dollar RC Interest Period or Dollar RC
                     Rollover Period, as the case may be;

              (d)    in relation to a drawdown under the RC Facility, the last
                     Ringgit Business Day of the Ringgit RC Interest Period or
                     the Ringgit RC Rollover Period, as the case may be;

              "Kewangan" means BBMB Kewangen Berhad, a company incorporated in
              Malaysia pursuant to the Companies Act, 1965 and having its office
              at 1st Floor, Menara Promet, Jalan Sultan Ismail, 50250 Kuala
              Lumpur and includes its successors in title and assigns thereof;

              "Land" means all that piece of land provisionally known as Lot No.
              12 at Sama Jaya Free Industrial Zone Kuching and measuring
              approximately 7.31 hectare;

              "Land Letter of Offer and Acceptance" means the letter dated 21st
              July 1995 from the Ministry of Industrial Development, Sarawek
              approving the Borrower's application for the Land, the letter
              dated 12th September 1995 from the Land and Survey Department,
              Sarawak setting out the terms and conditions of the issue of







<PAGE>   10
                                      -9-



              the provisional lease in respect of the Land and such other
              letter(s) issued by the relevant authorities in connection
              thereto;

              "Lenders" means (1) BBMB, in its capacity as the Working Capital
              Lender, (2) BBMB, in its capacity as a Lending Bank, (3) BBMB, in
              its capacity as the Funding Lender and (4) Kewangan, in its
              capacity as a Lending Bank, including their respective successors
              and "Lender" means any of them;

              "Lender Commitment" means (1) in relation to the Working Capital
              Lender, its Working Capital Commitment, (2) in relation to a
              Lending Bank, its Ringgit Advances Commitment (TL I), and (3) in
              relation to the Funding Lender, its Dollar Advances Commitment,
              and its Dollar RC Commitment and "Lenders Commitments" means the
              Lender Commitment of all the Lenders;

              "Lender Outstanding Amount" means (1) in relation to the Working
              Lender, its Working Capital Outstanding Amount, (2) in relation to
              a Lending Bank, its Lending Bank Outstanding Amount and (3) in
              relation to the Funding Lender, the Funding Lender Outstanding
              Amount and "Lenders Outstanding Amounts" means the Lender
              Outstanding Amounts of all Lenders;

              "Lending Bank Outstanding Amount" means, in relation to a Lending
              Bank at any particular time, the aggregate at such time of (i) the
              amount for the time being owing and outstanding from or by the
              Borrower to that Lending Bank under or in respect of its
              Proportion of the Ringgit Advances Facility and (ii) all interest,
              fees, costs, expenses and other monies whatsoever which are
              expressed to be payable to that Lending Bank under this Agreement
              and "Lending Bank Outstanding Amounts" means, at any particular
              time, the aggregate of the Lending Bank outstanding amounts of the
              lending Banks at such time;

              "Margin" means:

              (a)    in relation to the Dollar Advances Facility, the Advance
                     Margin;

              (b)    in relation to the TL I Facility, the TL I Margin;

              (c)    in relation to the Dollar RC Facility, the Dollar RC
                     Margin.

              "Parties" means the Borrower, the Arranger, the Facility Agent,
              the Security Agent and each of the Lenders and "Party" means one
              of such Parties;

              "Potential Event of Default" means any event or circumstance
              which, if it continued after the giving of any notice, the expiry
              of any grace period, and/or (as the case may be) the making of any
              reasonable determination by the Instructing Group would be an
              Event of Default;






<PAGE>   11

                                      -10-


              "Proportion" means, in relation to a Lending Bank, a fraction the
              numerator of which is the amount set out opposite its name in
              Column 2 of Schedule 1 and the denominator of which is
              RM29,200,000.00;

              "Ringgit Malaysia" and "RM" means the lawful currency of Malaysia;

              "Ringgit Advance" means an advance in Ringgit made or to be made
              by the Lending Banks to the Borrower under the TL I Facility or,
              as the case may be, the outstanding principal amount of that
              Ringgit Advance;

              "Ringgit Advances Commitment" means, in relation to a Lending
              Bank, the aggregate of its Ringgit Advances Commitment (TL I);

              "Ringgit Advances Commitment (TL I)" means, in relation to a
              Lending Bank and subject as provided in this Agreement, the amount
              set out opposite its name in Column 2 of Schedule 2 and "Ringgit
              Advances Commitments (TL I)" means the aggregate of the Ringgit
              Advances Commitments (TL I) of the Lending Banks;

              "Ringgit Advances Facility" means the TL I Facility;

              "Ringgit Advance Outstandings" means the Ringgit Advances
              Outstandings (TL I);

              "Ringgit Advances Outstandings (TL I)" means in relation to a
              Lending Bank at any particular time, the aggregate principal
              amount of all (if any) Ringgit Advances owing and outstanding from
              or by the Borrower to that Lending Bank under or in connection
              with the TL I Facility at that time;

              "Ringgit Business Day" means a day (other than Saturday, Sunday or
              any public holiday) on which (i) Ringgit deposits may be dealt in
              on the Kuala Lumpur inter-bank market and (ii) commercial banks
              are open for business in Kuala Lumpur and Sarawak;

              "Ringgit RC Interest Period" means the period of one (1), three
              (3) and six (6) months as selected by the Borrower or if no
              selection is made, such period as selected by the Working Capital
              Lender;

              "Ringgit RC Repayment Date" means the last Ringgit Business Day of
              a Ringgit RC Rollover Period;

              "Ringgit RC Rollover Period" means the period of one (1), three
              (3) or six (6) months, subject to the availability of funds, as
              selected by the Borrower, for each drawdown under the RC Facility
              and any roll-over thereof but in all cases to








<PAGE>   12

                                      -11-


              mature on a day which is not later than the expiry date of the
              Ringgit RC Facility and on a Ringgit Business Day;

              "Relevant Applicable Rate" means:

              (a)    the aggregate of the TL I Margin and the Base Lending Rate
                     or the Effective Cost of Funds, whichever is applicable, in
                     respect of the TL I Facility;

              (b)    the aggregate of the Advance Margin and SIBOR in respect of
                     the Dollar Advances Facility;

              (c)    the aggregate of the Dollar RC Margin and SIBOR in respect
                     of the Dollar RC Facility;

              (d)    the interest rate as set out or determined or varied as
                     specifically permitted by the terms of this Agreement in
                     respect of a facility within the Working Capital
                     Facilities.

              "Security Documents" means collectively this Agreement, the
              Debenture, the Assignment, the Charge, the Corporate Guarantee,
              the Security Agency Agreement and nay and every other document
              from time to time executed in substitution or in addition to
              secure, guarantee, indemnify or otherwise assure the performance
              of the obligations of the Borrower hereunder;

              "Shareholders Loan" means the loans granted or to be granted by
              the shareholders of the Borrower to the Borrower in such amounts
              and on such dates as set out in Schedule 8 hereof;

              "SIBOR" means the cost to the Funding Lender of obtaining one (1),
              three (3) or six (6) months US Dollars deposit from the Singapore
              Interbank Money Market as quoted on the Reuters Screen Page as at
              11:00 a.m. (Singapore time) or based on the prevailing rate as
              quoted in the said market whichever is applicable;

              "TL I Facility" means the term loan facility of up to the
              aggregate principal amount of Ringgit Malaysia Twenty Nine Million
              And Two Hundred Thousand (RM29,200,000.00) granted by the Lending
              Banks to the Borrower subject to the terms and conditions
              hereunder;

              "TL I Instalment Payment Date" means the date being a Ringgit
              Business Day on which the Borrower pays the Ringgit Advances made
              under the TL I Facility by Instalment pursuant to Clause 9.1.1;







<PAGE>   13

                                      -12-




              "TL I Interest Period" means, in respect of a Ringgit Advance made
              under the TL I Facility, a period of three (3) months commencing
              from the date of first Ringgit Advance under the TL I Facility
              provided that:

              (a)    the first TL I Interest Period in respect of any Ringgit
                     Advance other than the first Ringgit Advance shall end upon
                     the expiry of the TL I Interest Period then current for the
                     first Ringgit Advance so that all current TL I Interest
                     Periods shall be co-terminous;

              (b)    any TL I Interest Period relating to a Ringgit Advance
                     which would otherwise extend beyond the last TL I
                     Instalment Payment Date shall end on the last TL I
                     Instalment Payment Date;

              (c)    each Subsequent TL I Interest Period shall commence on the
                     expiry of the previous one;

              (d)    any TL I Interest Period which would otherwise end on a
                     non-Ringgit business day shall end on the next succeeding
                     Ringgit Business Day or if that Ringgit Business Day falls
                     in the next calendar month of the year, on the preceding
                     Ringgit Business Day;

              (e)    if a TL I Interest Period is extended or shortened by (d)
                     above, the following TL I Interest Period shall (without
                     prejudice to the application of (d) above) end on the day
                     on which it would have ended if the preceding TL I Interest
                     Period had not been so extended or shortened; and

              (f)    if any TL I Interest Period commences on the last Ringgit
                     Business Day in a calendar month or if there is no
                     corresponding date in the calendar month in which TL I
                     Interest Period is due to end, then such TL I Interest
                     Period shall end on the last Ringgit Business Day in the
                     relevant later month;

              "TL I Margin" in relation to BBMB shall mean one point seven five
              per centum (1.75%) per annum above its Base Lending Rate or such
              other rate as is varied by BBMB as specifically permitted by this
              Agreement and in relation to Kewangan shall mean one point seven
              five per centum (1.75%) per annum above the Effective Cost of
              Funds or such other rate as is varied by Kewangan, as specifically
              permitted by this Agreement;

              "Transfer Certificate" means a certificate in the form set out in
              Schedule 7 signed by a Lender and a Transferee whereby:

              (a)    such Lender seeks to procure the transfer to such
                     Transferee of all or a part of such Lender's rights and
                     obligations under the Facilities upon and subject to the
                     terms and conditions set out in Clause 22; and




<PAGE>   14

                                      -13-




              (b)    such Transferee undertakes to perform the obligations it
                     will assume as a result of delivery of such certificate to
                     the Facility Agent as is contemplated in Clause 22.4;

              "Transfer Date" in relation to any Transfer Certificate means the
              date for the making of the transfer as specified in the schedule
              to such Transfer Certificate;

              "Transferee" means a bank or financial institution licensed under
              BAFIA or the Offshore Banking Act, 1990 to which a Lender seeks to
              transfer all or part of such Lender's rights and obligations
              hereunder;

              "US Dollars" or "USD" means United States Dollars, the lawful
              currency of United States of America;

              "Working Capital Commitment" means the commitment of the Working
              Capital Lender to grant the Working Capital Facilities to the
              Borrower of up to an aggregate principal amount of Ringgit Five
              Million And Nine Hundred Thousand (RM5,900,000.00) upon the terms
              and subject to the conditions of this Agreement;

              "Working Capital Facilities" means, in relation to the Working
              Capital Lender, the Working Capital Facilities described in
              Schedule 3 granted by the Working Capital Lender to the Borrower
              under Clause 2.1.1 and made or to be made available by the Working
              Capital Lender, subject to the terms and conditions of this
              Agreement and Working Capital Facility means any one of these
              Working Capital Facilities;

              "Working Capital Outstanding Amount" means, in relation to the
              Working Capital Lender at any particular time, the aggregate at
              such time of (i) the amount for the time being owing and
              outstanding (including contingent liabilities) from or by the
              Borrower to the Working Capital Lender under or in respect of the
              Working Capital Facilities, and (ii) all interest, fees, costs,
              expenses and other monies whatsoever which are expressed to be
              payable, whether at maturity or otherwise, to the Working Capital
              Lender under this Agreement;

              "Working Capital Termination Date" means the date which is a
              Ringgit Business Day on which the Working Capital Facilities is
              canceled or terminated pursuant to Clause 2.3.2 of this Agreement;

       1.2    Any reference in this Agreement to:

       1.2.1  a "month" means (and references to "months" shall be construed
              accordingly) a period starting on one day in a calendar month and
              ending on the numerically corresponding day in the next calendar
              month or, if that day is not a Ringgit



 
<PAGE>   15
                                      -14-

              Business Day or a Dollar Business Day, as the case may be, on the
              next Ringgit Business Day or Dollar Business Day, as the case may
              be, in the said next calendar month or, if none, on the preceding
              Ringgit Business Day or Dollar Business Day, as the case may be,
              provided that if either the period starts on the last Ringgit
              Business Day or Dollar Business Day, as the case may be, in a
              calendar month or if there is no corresponding day in the next
              calendar month, the period shall end on the last Ringgit Business
              Day or Dollar Business Day, as the case may be, of the next
              relevant calendar month;

       1.2.2  a "person" shall be construed as a reference to any person, firm,
              company, corporation, government, state or agency of a state or
              any association, partnership (whether or not having separate legal
              personality) or one or more of the foregoing;

       1.2.3  a "statute" shall be construed as a reference to such statute as
              amended or re-enacted from time to time;

       1.2.4  a "Consent" shall be construed so as to include any approval
              authorization consent exemption license permission or registration
              by or from any governmental or other authority or any other
              person;

       1.2.5  "fees, costs and expenses" shall be exclusive of any service tax
              or similar tax chargeable on them, which shall accordingly be
              payable in addition.

       1.3    Section headings are for convenience only and shall not in any way
              affect the interpretation thereof.

       1.4    Save where the context otherwise requires words importing the
              singular number include the plural and vice versa.

       2.     THE FACILITIES
              --------------
 
       2.1    The Facilities
              --------------

       2.1.1  Working Capital Facilities
              --------------------------

              The Working Capital Lender agrees to grant to the Borrower Working
Capital Facilities, pursuant to which the Working Capital Lender will, upon the
terms and conditions set out in this Agreement and upon the security granted or
created in its favour under, pursuant to and/or in connection with the Security
Documents, at the request of the Borrower, allow the Borrower to utilise the
Working Capital Facilities, provided, however, that following such utilisation,
the principal amount comprised in the Working Capital Outstanding Amount shall
not exceed the Working Capital Commitment;

               




<PAGE>   16
                                     -15-

       2.1.2 Ringgit Advances Facility
             -------------------------

       (i) Each of the Lending Bank agrees to grant to the Borrower
             its respective Proportion of the TL I Facility, pursuant to which
             each favour under, pursuant to and/or in connection with the
             Security Documents and upon the terms and subject to the
             conditions of this Agreement, make Ringgit Advances under the TL I
             Facility to the Borrower provided however that the aggregate of
             such Ringgit Advances relating to each Lending Bank shall not
             exceed the Available Ringgit Advances Commitment relating to such
             Lending Bank.

       (ii) The tenor of the TL I Facility shall be for a period of
             ten (10) years (inclusive of a grace period of eighteen (18)
             months) commencing from the date of the first Ringgit Advance
             under the TL I Facility. The TL I Facility shall be subject to
             yearly review.

       2.1.3 Dollar Advances Facility
             ------------------------

       (i) The Funding Lender agrees to grant to the Borrower the
             Dollar Advances Facility, pursuant to which the Funding Lender
             will, upon the security granted or recreated in its favour under,
             pursuant to and/or in connection with the Security Documents and
             upon the terms and subject to the conditions of this Agreement,
             make Dollar Advances to the Borrower.

       (ii) The tenor of the Dollar Advances Facility shall be for a
             period of five (5) years (inclusive of a grace period of twelve
             (12) months) commencing from the date of the first Dollar Advance.

       2.1.4 Dollar RC Facility
             ------------------

             The Funding Lender agrees to grant to the Borrower the Dollar RC
             Facility,  pursuant to which the Funding Lender will, upon the
             security granted or created in its favour under, pursuant to
             and/or in connection with the Security Documents and upon the
             terms and subject to the conditions of this Agreement, make Dollar
             RC Drawdown to the Borrower.

       2.2   Purpose
             -------

       2.2.1 The Borrower shall Utilise the Working Capital Facilities
             for the purposes of financing its working capital requirements.
  
       2.2.2 The Borrower shall Utilise the proceeds of each Ringgit
             Advance made under the TL I Facility for the purpose of part
             financing the construction of the Borrower's factory.



<PAGE>   17
                                      -16-


       2.2.3  The Borrower shall utilise the proceeds of each Dollar Advance
              made under the Dollar Advances Facility for the purpose of part
              financing the acquisition of new plant, machinery and equipment to
              be installed at the Borrower's factory.

       2.2.4  The Borrower shall utilise the proceeds of each Dollar RC Drawdown
              made under the Dollar RC Facility to supplement its working
              capital.

       2.2.5  Notwithstanding the provisions herein contained, the Arranger, the
              Facility Agent, the Security Agent nor any Lender need check that
              the respective facilities are utilised for the purposes aforesaid.

       2.3    Cancellation
              ------------
 
       2.3.1  The Borrower may not cancel all or any part of any of the Lenders'
              Commitments except as expressly provided in this Agreement.

       2.3.2  The Facility Agent may, at its absolute discretion, cancel the
              Facilities or any part thereof by written notice to the Borrower
              and any amount so cancelled shall become immediately due and
              payable together with interest and any other monies due thereon
              within thirty (30) Ringgit Business Days or Dollar Business Days,
              as the case may be, provided, however, the Facility Agent shall
              only be entitled to such right:

              (a)    upon an occurrence of the Event of Default; or

              (b)    where such cancellation is made necessary as a result of
                     statutory or regulatory requirements imposed on the
                     Borrower and the Borrower elects in writing not to comply
                     or fails to comply with such statutory or regulatory
                     requirements, within thirty (30) days from the date the
                     Facility Agent notifies the Borrower in writing of the
                     same; or

              (c)    where such cancellation is made necessary as a result of
                     statutory or regulatory requirements imposed on the
                     Lenders.

       3.     CONDITIONS PRECEDENT
              --------------------

       3.1    Utilisation of Working Capital Facilities
              -----------------------------------------

       3.1.1  The Borrower may not make its request to the Working Capital
              Lender for the utilisation of the Working Capital Facilities until
              the Facility Agent has confirmed to the Borrower and the Working
              Capital Lender that the Facility Agent has received documents
              appearing to the Facility Agent to comply with the requirements of
              Schedule 2 and to be satisfactory.









<PAGE>   18

                                      -17-


       3.2    Request for Ringgit Advances
              ----------------------------

       3.2.1  The Borrower may not make its request for a Ringgit Advance until
              the Facility Agent has confirmed to the Borrower and the Lending
              Banks that the Facility Agent has received documents appearing to
              the Facility Agent to comply with the requirements of Schedule 2
              and to be satisfactory.

       3.3    Request for Dollar Advances
              ---------------------------

       3.3.1  The Borrower may not make its request for a Dollar Advance until
              the Facility Agent has confirmed to the Borrower and the Funding
              Lender that the Facility Agent has received documents appearing to
              the Facility Agent to comply with the requirements of Schedule 2
              and to be satisfactory.

       3.4    Request for Dollar RC Drawdown
              ------------------------------
 
       3.4.1  The Borrower may not make its request for a Dollar RC Drawdown
              until the Facility Agent has confirmed to the Borrower and the
              Funding Lender that the Facility Agent has received documents
              appearing to the Facility Agent to comply with the requirements of
              Schedule 2 and to be satisfactory.

       4.     WORKING CAPITAL FACILITIES
              --------------------------

       4.1    Terms and Conditions
              --------------------

              The Working Capital Facilities shall be made available by the
       Working Capital Lender upon and subject to the terms and conditions
       contained herein or otherwise made known and agreed to by the Borrower in
       writing.

       4.2    Review
              ------

              The Working Capital Lender reserves the right to review the
       Working Capital Facilities periodically. Such review may be carried out
       by the Working Capital Lender as an "in-house exercise" and the Borrower
       need not be informed of such review.

       4.3    Revolving Credit Facility ("RC Facility")
              -----------------------------------------
 
       4.3.1  Purpose of the RC Facility

              The RC Facility shall be used by the Borrower to supplement its
              working capital requirements or such other purpose as may be
              acceptable to the Working Capital Lender.







<PAGE>   19

                                      -18-


       4.3.2  Drawdown

       (a)    In the event the Borrower intends to drawdown the RC Facility or
              part thereof from the Working Capital Lender subject to the terms
              herein after determination of the Relevant Applicable Rate
              pursuant to Clause 4.3.2(b) hereof, and agreed by the Borrower,
              the Borrower shall give notice of such drawdown to the Facility
              Agent in accordance with Clause 4.3.2(b) hereof and such notice
              must reach the Facility Agent by the third Ringgit Business Day,
              at the latest, following the determination and agreement of the
              Relevant Rate for the RC Facility. The Borrower shall also deliver
              to the Facility Agent, before noon on the date of the relevant
              advance, a duly executed and stamped promissory note for the face
              amount and tenor which is equivalent to the face amount and tenor
              of the proposed advance.

       (b)    The drawdown notice substantially in the form set out in Schedule
              9 must be delivered in accordance with the provisions of Clause 29
              and must specify:

              (i)    the amount of the drawdown which shall be in multiples of
                     Ringgit Malaysia One Hundred Thousand (RM100,000.00) but
                     subject to a minimum of Ringgit Malaysia One Hundred
                     Thousand (RM100,000.00). The total drawdown under the RC
                     Facility must not exceed the approved sub-limit of Ringgit
                     Malaysia One Million (RM1,000,000.00);

              (ii)   the date on which the drawdown is required, which must in
                     any event be a Ringgit Business Day not less than three (3)
                     Ringgit Business Days following the date of the drawdown
                     notice; and

              (iii)  the Ringgit Rollover Period selected by the Borrower for
                     such drawdown referred to herein.

       (c)    Subject to Clauses 4.3.2(a) and (b) being satisfied and to the
              availability of funds, the Working Capital Lender shall on the
              date of drawdown credit the Borrower's account as specified in the
              drawdown notice.

       (d)    The Borrower shall repay the principal amount of the RC Facility
              so drawdown on demand by the Facility Agent for and on behalf of
              the Working Capital Lender for repayment thereof or on its Ringgit
              RC Repayment Date unless the Borrower shall have served a request
              in writing on the Facility Agent at least three (3) Ringgit
              Business Days before the Ringgit RC Repayment Date to roll-over
              the principal amount for the Ringgit Rollover Period and the
              Working Capital Lender has agreed to the same in writing. If the
              Working Capital Lender has agreed to allow a rollover the
              principal amount of the RC Facility so drawdown which is repayable
              on the Ringgit RC Repayment Date shall on the Ringgit RC Repayment
              Date be rolled over for the Ringgit RC Rollover Period stipulated
              in such notice.






<PAGE>   20

                                      -19-


       (e)    Any drawdown notice once received by the Facility Agent shall be
              irrevocable. In the event the Borrower fails to drawdown after the
              drawdown notice is received by the Facility Agent, the Borrower
              shall on demand indemnify the Facility Agent and the Working
              Capital Lender against all funding losses and related expenses
              suffered by them in liquidating or otherwise employing deposits
              from third parties acquired or arranged to fund the drawdown
              following receipt of the drawdown notice.

       (f)    The Borrower may prepay the whole or any part of any drawdown
              under the RC Facility Provided That:

              (a)    it has given to the Facility Agent not less than fourteen
                     (14) Ringgit Business Days' notice in respect of prepayment
                     under the Ringgit RC Facility;

              (b)    all prepayments shall not be less than RM100,000.00 or in
                     integral multiples of RM100,000.00; and

              (c)    each prepayment must be made on an Interest Payment Date;

              in default of which, the Borrower shall pay to the Facility Agent
              for the account of the Working Capital Lender a premium calculated
              at zero point five per centum (0.5%) flat on the amounts to be
              prepaid.

       (g)    Interest
              --------
 
              (i)    The Working Capital Lender shall at the request of the
                     Borrower and on selection of the Ringgit RC Interest Period
                     by the Borrower, or if no selection is made by the
                     Borrower, such period as selected by the Working Capital
                     Lender, prior to making of an advance or a rollover of an
                     advance under the RC Facility, as the case may be,
                     determine (i) whether the Ringgit RC Interest Period or the
                     Ringgit RC Rollover Period, as the case may be, is agreed
                     upon and if not, the proposed Ringgit RC Interest Period or
                     the Ringgit RC Rollover Period, as the case may be, and
                     (ii) the Relevant Applicable Rate for the intended Ringgit
                     RC Interest Period or the Ringgit RC Rollover Period, as
                     the case may be, and shall notify the Borrower of such
                     determination PROVIDED ALWAYS that the Relevant Applicable
                     Rate shall not be less than the Working Capital Lender's
                     Effective Cost of Funds plus one point seven five per
                     centum (1.75%) per annum.

              (ii)   Interest at the Relevant Applicable Rate shall accrue from
                     day to day and shall be calculated on the basis of the
                     number of days elapsed and a 365 day year. The Relevant
                     Applicable Rate so determined in accordance with 








<PAGE>   21

                                      -20-



                     the Clause 4.3.2(g)(1) above shall be the Relevant
                     Applicable Rate for the RC Facility or portion thereof so
                     drawdown or rolled over.

              (iii)  Interest on the amount of the RC Facility so drawdown or
                     rolled over, as the case may be, shall be payable on the
                     Ringgit RC Repayment Date in arrears Provided Always that
                     if the day on which interest is due is not a Ringgit
                     business Day then payment shall be made on the next
                     succeeding Ringgit Business Day. In the event the next
                     succeeding Ringgit Business Days falls on the first day of
                     the month following, then payment shall be made on the day
                     preceding the due date for payment.

       (h)    The approved sub-limits in respect of the RC Facility and the LG
              Facility (as hereinafter defined) may be varied by the Borrower
              giving not less than three (3) Ringgit Business Days' notice to
              the Working Capital Lender. The variation to the approved
              sub-limits in respect of the RC Facility and the LG Facility is
              subject to the available unutilised amount under the aggregate
              limited of RMS,900,000.00.

       4.4    Letters of Credit Facility ("LC Facility")
              ------------------------------------------

       4.4.1  Purpose

              The LC Facility shall be utilised by the Borrower to facilitate
              its imports or local purchase of goods, spare parts, new machinery
              and/or new equipment or such other purpose as may be acceptable to
              the Working Capital Lender.

       4.4.2  Tenor of Letters of Credit

              The Working Capital Lender will open sight and usance letters of
              credit and each such letter of credit shall have a maximum
              validity period of one hundred and eighty (180) days from its
              issuance date.

       4.4.3  Payment

              Full payment for each letter of credit must be effected by the
              Borrower upon presentation by the Borrower of the same and other
              relevant documents for payment.

       4.4.4  Interest

              Foreign Letters of Credit (sight)

              (i)    at the prevailing overdraft rate levied or such other rate
                     as may be levied by the Working Capital Lender's Depository
                     Agent from the date of



<PAGE>   22
                                      -21-


                     negotiation to the date of receipt of notification of
                     negotiation calculated on the basis of a 365-day year for
                     the actual number of days elapsed.

              (ii)   at one point seven five percent (1.75%) per annum above the
                     Working Capital Lender's Base Lending Rate from the date of
                     receipt of notification of negotiation to the date of
                     payment or conversion to the TR Facility (as hereinafter
                     defined) or BA Facility (as hereinafter defined) calculated
                     on the basis of a 365-day year for the actual number of
                     days elapsed.

              Local Letters of Credit (sight)

              At one point seven five percent (1.75%) per annum above the
              Working Capital Lender's Base Lending Rate from the date of
              receipt of notification of negotiation to the date of payment or
              conversion to the TR Facility or the BA Facility calculated on the
              basis of a 365-day year for the actual number of days elapsed.

              Foreign or Local Letters of Credit (usance)

              At one point seven five percent (1.75%) per annum above the
              Working Capital Lender's Base Lending Rate from the date of
              maturity to the date of payment or conversion to the TR Facility
              or the BA Facility calculated on the basis of a 365-day year for
              the actual number of days elapsed.

       4.5    Trust Receipts Facility ("the TR Facility")
              -------------------------------------------

       4.5.1  Purpose of the TR Facility

              The TR Facility shall be utilised by the Borrower to convert bills
              drawn under the LC Facility issued by the Working Capital Lender
              to facilitate its imports or local purchase of goods related to
              the Borrower's trade.

       4.5.2  Utilisation of the TR Facility

       (a)    The Borrower acknowledges that all goods covered by the relevant
              trust receipts, all documents of title relating to the goods and
              the proceeds of sale thereof, and all insurance monies arising
              from them, are held as trustees for the Working Capital Lender.

       (b)    The Borrower shall hold all relevant documents of title relating
              to the goods for the purpose of obtaining delivery and to
              warehouse the goods. The goods will be warehoused in the name of
              the Working Capital lender or as otherwise agreed by the Working
              Capital Lender and at the sole expense of the Borrower.

       (c)    The Borrower undertakes to keep the goods duly covered by
              insurance against fire and such other risks as are required by the
              working Capital Lender with such




<PAGE>   23

                                      -22-



              company or companies as acceptable to the Working Capital Lender
              and in case of loss to pay the insurance money immediately on
              receipt to the Working Capital Lender without any deduction. The
              Borrower agrees to pay to the Working Capital lender immediately
              and specifically on receipt the whole proceeds of sale and each
              part of the proceeds (whatever form they may take) without any
              deduction. The Working Capital Lender may require any money
              received on any insurance be applied in or towards making good the
              loss or damage in respect of which money is received or receivable
              or in or towards discharge of any principal sum, interest, default
              interest or any other monies payable hereunder or under any of the
              other Security Documents and the Working Capital Lender may give a
              good discharge for any such monies and nay balance remaining after
              discharging all monies payable hereunder or under the other
              Security Documents, shall be refunded to the Borrower.

       (d)    The Borrower shall return to the Working Capital Lender
              immediately on demand at any time all relevant documents of title
              relating to the goods and/or any other documents received by the
              Borrower in exchange or substitution for them and to comply
              promptly and fully with any instructions which the Working Capital
              Lender may give as to the dealing with the goods of any of them.

       (e)    The Borrower undertakes to keep the documents of title relating to
              the goods, the goods, the proceeds of any sale and all insurance
              money separate and distinct from any other documents, goods,
              proceeds of sale or insurance money relating to or arising from
              any transaction.

       (f)    A copy of the relevant insurance policy showing the Working
              Capital Lender as mortgagee is to be delivered and to be retained
              by the Working Capital Lender. However, where the goods are
              covered by a master policy, the Borrower need not submit another
              insurance policy for specific goods, nor is there a need to have
              the master policy specially endorsed to the Working Capital Lender
              as mortgagee. In such an instance, the Borrower must confirm in
              writing to the Working Capital Lender that the master policy
              covers the goods financed by the Working Capital Lender and a copy
              of such master policy is to be delivered to the Working Capital
              Lender and kept by the Working Capital Lender for its reserves.

       (g)    Any amount not paid by the Borrower to the Working Capital Lender
              under the TR Facility shall be subject to interest at the rate of
              one point seven five per centum (1.75%) per annum above the Base
              Lending Rate or such other rate as is varied by the Working
              Capital Lender pursuant to this Agreement and shall be payable
              upon maturity of the relevant bills shown by the Working Capital
              Lender and accepted by the Borrower on all goods covered by the
              relevant trust receipt.

       (h)    The tenor or each TR shall be up to one hundred and eighty (180)
              days inclusive of supplier's credit.








<PAGE>   24

                                      -23-



       4.6    Bankers Acceptances Facility ("the BA Facility")
              ------------------------------------------------
 
       4.6.1  Purpose of the BA Facility

              The BA Facility shall be utilised by the Borrower for financing
              its export as well as inland sales, imports, as well as local
              purchases or for such other purpose as may be acceptable to the
              Working Capital Lender.

       4.6.2  Utilisation of the BA Facility

       (a)    Each bankers acceptance will be discounted at inter-bank offer
              rates prevailing on the date of discount.

       (b)    The tenor of each bankers acceptance shall be up to one hundred
              and eighty (180) days inclusive of supplier's credit.

       (c)    If the Borrower fails to put the Working Capital Lender in
              sufficient funds to meets its obligations on the maturity of any
              bankers acceptance, the Working Capital Lender shall have the
              right but not the obligation to debit the Borrower's current
              account with the Working Capital Lender without prior notice the
              Borrower and if in consequent of so doing the current account is
              overdrawn, an additional interest of one per centum (1%) per annum
              above the Working Capital Lender's Base Lending Rate shall be
              charged and the Working Capital Lender shall not be liable if any
              cheque drawn under the said current account is dishonored by
              reason of insufficiency of funds.

       (d)    All bankers acceptances accepted by the Working Capital Lender are
              to be discounted with the Working Capital Lender only.

       (e)    Interest and commission are to be paid at the time of acceptance.

       (f)    The procedure for accepting and discounting bankers acceptances
              will be subject to all the conditions and guidelines laid down by
              Bank Negara Malaysia and/or other statutory bodies from time to
              time.

       (g)    The Working Capital Lender reserves the right to accept or reject
              any bankers acceptance presented.

       (h)    No new bankers acceptance will be accepted or discounted if there
              are any overdue amounts under the BA Facility and/or any of the
              other facilities.




<PAGE>   25

                                      -24-



       4.7    Export Credit Refinancing Facility ("the ECR Facility")
              -------------------------------------------------------

       4.7.1  Purpose

              The ECR (Preshipment) Facility shall be utilised by the Borrower
              as additional working capital to finance the Eligible Goods (as
              defined in the ECR Guidelines issued by Bank Negara Malaysia). The
              ECR (Postshipment) Facility shall be utilised by the Borrower for
              the purchase of usance export bills in respect of Eligible Goods.

       4.7.2  Tenor of the ECR (Preshipment) Facility

       (a)    In respect of Eligible Goods not already shipped by the Borrower
              ("ECR-Pre") the Working Capital Lender will advance sums to the
              Borrower for a maximum of one hundred and twenty (120) days under
              pre-shipment bills of exchange. Such bills of exchange shall
              expire on a day which is not a Saturday, a Sunday or a public
              holiday in Kuala Lumpur or Kuching. Each request for an advance
              shall be supported by an ECR domestic letter of credit (as defined
              by the ECR Guidelines) or an ECR domestic purchase order (as
              defined by the ECR Guidelines).

       (b)    The tenor of each advance under the ECR-Pre Facility shall be
              calculated from the date the Working Capital Lender receives the
              relevant supporting documents et out in Clause 4.7.2(a) above to
              the shipment date of the Eligible Goods from Malaysia.

       4.7.3  Tenor of Post-Shipment Advances

       (a)    In respect of Eligible Goods already shipped by the Borrower
              ("ECR-Post") the Working Capital Lender will advance sums to the
              Borrower for a maximum of one hundred and eighty (180) days by
              discounting the amounts stated in post-shipment bills of exchange.
              Such bills of exchange shall mature on a day which is not a
              Saturday, a Sunday or a public holiday in Kuala Lumpur or Kuching.

       (b)    Each request of ran advance under the ECR-Post Facility shall be
              accompanied by the export documents (as defined by the ECR
              Guidelines) in respect of the shipment of the Eligible Goods.

       (c)    All post-shipment bills of exchange shall be discounted by the
              Working Capital Lender with recourse to the Borrower. In the event
              a Borrower's customer shall fail to pay a post-shipment bill for
              whatever reason on presentation of such bill, the Borrower shall
              pay the bill amount to the Working Capital Lender on demand
              failing which the Working Capital Lender shall be entitled to
              debit the Borrower's Account for the said amount. The Borrower
              shall also indemnify the Working Capital Lender against all costs,
              expenses and charges incurred by the







<PAGE>   26

                                      -25-


              Working Capital Lender arising from the default in payment by the
              Borrower's customer.

       4.8    Letters of Guarantee Facility ("the LG Facility")
              -------------------------------------------------
 
       4.8.1  Purpose of the LG Facility

              The LG Facility shall be utilised for the issuance of guarantees
              in favor of the Government, semi-Government and private bodies in
              respect of tender, performance, advance payment, security deposit,
              supply of equipment and other business related to the Borrower's
              trade.

       4.8.2  Indemnity

       (a)    The Borrower is to issue a letter of indemnity for each guarantee
              issued under the LG Facility and in the event that the Working
              Capital Lender is called upon to make any payment under any of the
              guarantees so issued, then the Borrower shall forthwith thereafter
              and in any event not later than seven (7) Ringgit Business Days
              from the date of payment by the Working Capital Lender, repay the
              Working Capital Lender all such monies paid out by the Working
              Capital Lender, together with all interest (chargeable at one
              point zero percent (1.0%) above the Working Capital Lender's Base
              Lending Rate or such rate as the Working Capital Lender may at its
              absolute discretion impose subject to the maximum interest rate as
              allowable by Bank Negara Malaysia and any other charges and
              expenses incurred thereon.

       (b)    Without prejudice to the Working Capital Lender's right to recall
              on demand, the Working Capital Lender may at its absolute
              discretion convert the monies paid out under any guarantee into a
              term loan facility or an overdraft facility on such terms and
              conditions (including repayments) as the Working Capital Lender
              may at its absolute discretion impose.

       4.8.3  Commission

       (a)    The commission payable under the LG Facility shall be charged for
              the full liability period (inclusive of the claim period) of the
              guarantee issued.

       (b)    Should the same letter of guarantee be renewed upon expiry,
              commission shall be calculated from the date or renewal to the new
              expiry date.


       5.     UTILISATION OF WORKING CAPITAL FACILITIES
              -----------------------------------------
 
       5.1    Subject to the provisions of this Agreement, any of the Working
              Capital Facilities made available by the Working Capital Lender to
              the Borrower may be utilised 





<PAGE>   27

                                      -26-



              by the Borrower, at the request of the Borrower, made in writing
              to the Working Capital Lender if:

              5.1.1  following such utilisation by the Borrower, the aggregate
                     principal amount comprised in the Working Capital
                     Outstanding Amount shall not exceed its Working Capital
                     Commitment;

              5.1.2  all representations and warranties in Clause 18 have been
                     complied with and would be correct in all respects if
                     repeated on the proposed date of utilisation of the Working
                     Capital Facilities by reference to the circumstances then
                     existing;

              5.1.3  no Event of Default or Potential Event of Default has
                     occurred on or before the proposed date of utilisation of
                     the Working Capital Facilities or will occur as a result of
                     the utilisation of the Working Capital Facilities;

              5.1.4  such terms and conditions as may be imposed by the Working
                     Capital Lender in relation to the utilisation of the
                     Working Capital Facilities have been satisfactorily
                     complied with and/or will not be breached pursuant to such
                     utilisation;

              5.1.5  not later than 11:00 a.m. on the proposed date of
                     utilisation of that Working Capital Facilities, the Working
                     Capital Lender has received and found satisfactory such
                     additional information and/or other documents as it may
                     reasonably request.


       6.     PAYMENT OF WORKING CAPITAL FACILITIES
              -------------------------------------

       6.1    Payment by Borrower
              -------------------

       6.1.1  In consideration of the Working Capital Lender agreeing to grant
              or continue to grant the Working Capital Facilities to the
              Borrower and without prejudice to any other rights of the Working
              Capital Lender and obligations of the Borrower under this
              Agreement, the Borrower hereby covenants and undertakes with and
              to the Working Capital Lender that, subject to any specific
              agreement or arrangement for payments by the Borrower in relation
              to each or all of the working Capital Facilities now or hereafter
              subsisting between the Working Capital Lender and the Borrower,
              the Borrower will on demand, pay to the Working Capital Lender:

              (a)    all sums of money in respect of the Working Capital
                     Facilities which are then due and payable to the Working
                     Capital Lender by the Borrower and whether as principal or
                     surety or which the Borrower is then liable to pay 




<PAGE>   28
                                      -27-


                     to the Working Capital Lender anywhere or any account or
                     otherwise or in any manner whatsoever as provided in this
                     Agreement; and

              (b)    all other liabilities in respect of the Working Capital
                     Facilities which have accrued or become due and payable
                     then, including the balance for the time being owing for or
                     in respect of cheques, bills, notes, drafts or other
                     negotiable or non-negotiable instruments accepted, paid or
                     discounted for or on behalf of the Borrower or for any
                     other payments, credits or advances made to or for the use
                     or accommodation of or on behalf of the Borrower pursuant
                     to or in respect of or under any guarantee or letter of
                     credit given, established or opened by the Working Capital
                     Lender for the Borrower or in respect of any other
                     facilities whatsoever whether or not given upon or under
                     any trust receipts or other security whatsoever or
                     otherwise howsoever together with, in all cases aforesaid,
                     interest and fees at such rate as may from time to time be
                     fixed or determined by the Working Capital Lender (which
                     shall not be more than the relevant rate provided in Clause
                     7), such interest and fees to be charged and calculated on
                     a daily basis with monthly or such other periodic rests and
                     together also with commission, discount and other usual
                     bankers' charges (which shall not be more than the relevant
                     rate provided in Clause 7), such sums to be raised and paid
                     at the time and in the manner set out herein immediately
                     upon service on the Borrower of a demand for payment in
                     writing sent by the Working Capital Lender in the manner
                     provided in this Agreement.

       6.1.2  If and when a demand is made for payment of all or any monies
              agreed to be paid pursuant to this Agreement and/or the account
              current or otherwise of the Borrower with the Working Capital
              Lender shall be closed and a balance shall be owing to the Working
              Capital Lender, the balance so owing shall be an overdue sum under
              this Agreement and the Borrower will, so long as the same or any
              part thereof shall remain owing pay to the Working Capital Lender
              interest thereon in accordance with Clause 10.4.


       7.     PROVISIONS RELATION TO INTEREST, SECURITIES AND OTHERS
              ------------------------------------------------------

       7.1    Interest
              --------

       7.1.1  In respect of the Working Capital Facilities, the Borrower hereby
              expressly agrees and declares, subject to Clauses 7.2 and 7.3 and
              any specific agreement or arrangement referred to in Clause 6.1.1,
              that:

              (a)    the Working Capital Lender shall be at liberty without
                     thereby affecting its rights under this Agreement at any
                     time:





<PAGE>   29

                                      -28-



                     (i)    to vary the rate of interest and/or commission
                            payable for or in respect of any or all of its
                            Working Capital Facilities or any part thereof and
                            on serving a notice in writing on the Borrower to
                            this effect, such amended rate of interest and/or
                            commission shall be payable as from the date
                            specified in the said notice Provided that such
                            right shall only be exercisable by the Working
                            Capital Lender upon the occurrence of an Event of
                            Default or where such variation is made necessary as
                            a result of any statutory and/or regulatory
                            requirements imposed on the Borrower and/or the
                            Working Capital Lender;

                     (ii)   to vary exchange or release any security held or to
                            be held by the Working Capital Lender for or on
                            account of the Working Capital Facilities or any
                            monies and liabilities owing under this Agreement or
                            any part thereof; and

                     (iii)  to vary any credit to the Borrower and to renew
                            bills or promissory notes in any manner and to
                            compound with, give time for payment (except that
                            any such time given shall not extend beyond the
                            Working Capital Termination Date), accept
                            composition from and make any other arrangements
                            with any person or party liable to that Working
                            Capital Lender in respect of bills, rates or other
                            securities held or to be held by that Working
                            Capital Lender for its Working Capital Facilities or
                            any monies or liabilities owing under this Agreement
                            or any part thereof.

       7.1.2  When the payment of any monies under any of the Working Capital
              Facilities shall be secured to the Working Capital Lender by any
              bill of exchange, promissory note, draft, receipt or other
              instrument reserving a higher rate of interest to be paid in
              respect thereof than that provided in Clause 7.2, such higher rate
              of interest shall be payable in respect of such monies and nothing
              contained in or to be implied by this Agreement shall affect the
              right of the Working Capital Lender to enforce and recover payment
              of such higher rate of interest.

       7.2    Interest, Commission and Other Charges
              --------------------------------------
 
              The Working Capital Lender agrees with the Borrower (but without
              affecting its rights under Clauses 6.1.2 and 7.1.2) that the rate
              of interest, fees, commission and other charges payable by the
              Borrower on each sub-facility of the Working Capital Facilities
              utilised by the Borrower shall not exceed the rate specified in
              Schedule 3 in respect of each sub-facility granted to the Borrower
              under its Working Capital Facilities.





<PAGE>   30

                                      -29-



       7.3    Miscellaneous
              -------------

       7.3.1  The Working Capital Lender agrees that no Working Capital
              Facilities may be canceled prior to the Working Capital
              Termination Date otherwise than pursuant to Clauses 14 and 17.


       8.     DRAWDOWN
              --------

       8.1    Drawdown Conditions for Ringgit Advances
              ----------------------------------------

       8.1.1  Subject to the provisions of this Agreement, Ringgit Advances will
              be made by the Lending Banks to the Borrower at its request if the
              following additional conditions are fulfilled:

              (a)    not later than 11:00 a.m. on the third Ringgit Business Day
                     before the proposed date of the relevant Ringgit Advance,
                     the Facility Agent has received:

                     (i)    a notice substantially in the form set out in
                            Schedule 4 specifying (aa) the proposed ate of that
                            Ringgit Advance, which must be a Ringgit Business
                            Day falling on or before the Commitment Termination
                            Date and (bb) the amount of that Ringgit Advance,
                            which must be in multiples of RM100,000.00 subject
                            to a minimum of RM100,000.00 provided that the
                            aggregate of the Ringgit Advances made or to be made
                            under the TL I Facility shall not at any time exceed
                            the Available Ringgit Advances Commitment (TL I);

                     (ii)   a certificate of work done issued by the
                            Contractor's architect in respect of Ringgit
                            Advances to be made under the TL I Facility;

              (b)    all representations and warranties in Clause 18 (except to
                     any extent waived in accordance with Clause 23.2) have been
                     complied with and would be correct in all respects if
                     repeated on this proposed date of that Ringgit Advance by
                     reference to the circumstances then existing;

              (c)    no Event of Default or Potential Event of Default has
                     occurred on or before the proposed date of that Ringgit
                     Advance, or will occur as a result of the making of that
                     Ringgit Advance, other than that waived in accordance with
                     Clause 23.2; and

              (d)    not later than 11:00 a.m. on the proposed date of that
                     Ringgit Advance, the Facility Agent and/or the Lending
                     Banks have received and found satisfactory such additional
                     information, legal opinions and/or other 







<PAGE>   31

                                      -30-



                     documents relevant in the context of or relating to this
                     Agreement as it or they may reasonably request.

       8.1.2  The Facility Agent shall promptly notify the Lending Banks of the
              proposed date of, the amount of, each Ringgit Advance.

       8.1.3  Each Lending Bank shall participate in each Ringgit Advance made
              pursuant to Clause 8.1.1 in respect of the TL I Facility in its
              respective Proportion.

       8.2    Drawdown Condition for Dollar Advances
              --------------------------------------
 
       8.2.1  Subject to the provisions of this Agreement and to the
              availability of funds, Dollar Advances will be made by the Funding
              Lender to the Borrower at its request if the following conditions
              are fulfilled:

              (a)    not later than 11:00 a.m. on the third Dollar Business Day
                     before the proposed date of the relevant Dollar Advance,
                     the Facility Agent has received from the Borrower:

                     (i)    a notice substantially in the form set out in
                            Schedule 5 specifying (aa) the proposed date of that
                            Dollar Advance, which must be a Dollar Business Day
                            falling on or before the Commitment Termination Date
                            and (bb) the amount of that Dollar Advance, which
                            must be in multiples of USD100,000.00 subject to a
                            minimum of USD100,000.00 Provided That the aggregate
                            of the Dollar Advances made to be made under the
                            Dollar Advances Facility shall not at any time
                            exceed the Available Dollar Advances Commitment (cc)
                            the Dollar Advance Interest Period selected by the
                            Borrower for such Dollar Advance Provided that if
                            the Borrower fails to select the Dollar Advance
                            Interest Period, the Funding Lender shall be at
                            liberty to select the Dollar Advance Interest
                            Period; and

                     (ii)   original document verified by an independent
                            engineer/valuer acceptable to the Facility Agent or
                            other documents reasonably acceptable to the
                            Facility Agent confirming the purchase, value and
                            installation of machines and an independent opinion
                            from a consultant acceptable to the Facility Agent
                            confirming the date of installation of the machines
                            (if the machines have been installed) in writing, in
                            respect of Dollar Advances to be made under the
                            Dollar Advances Facility.

              (b)    all representations and warranties in Clause 18 (except to
                     any extent waived in accordance with Clause 23.2) have been
                     complied with and



<PAGE>   32

                                      -31-


                     would be correct in all respects if repeated on the
                     proposed date of that Dollar Advance by reference to the
                     circumstances then existing;

              (c)    no Event of Default or Potential Event of Default has
                     occurred on or before the proposed date of that Dollar
                     Advance, other than that waived in accordance with Clause
                     23.2; and

       8.2.2      The Facility Agent shall promptly notify the Funding
                  Lender of the proposed date of, and the amount of, each
                  Dollar Advance.

       8.2.3  (a) Subject to Clause 8.2.3(b) hereof, all payments under the
                  Dollar Advances Facility for the purchase of new fixed
                  assets shall be made direct to the parties concerned against
                  relevant original documents evidencing the delivery and
                  installation thereof.

              (b) Where the purchase price of the new fixed assets have
                  been paid by the Borrower directly to the vendors of such
                  fixed assets, the Funding Lender, upon receipt of the
                  original document by the Facility Agent and/or the Funding
                  Lender to evidence the delivery and installation of such      
                  fixed assets and/or other documentary evidence satisfactory
                  to the Facility Agent and/or the Funding Lender that the
                  purchase price has    been paid to the said vendors, will
                  reimburse the Borrower for such payments.

              (c) The Facility Agent shall have custody or possession of
                  the original documents referred to in this Clause so long as
                  this Agreement remains in subsistence PROVIDED, however. the
                  Borrower may request the Facility Agent in writing and at its
                  own cost and expenses for the release of any one of such
                  original documents and the Facility Agent, acting on the
                  instructions of the Instructing Group, will only release such
                  original documents after the interest of the Beneficiaries
                  have been endorsed thereon.

       8.3        Drawdown Conditions for Dollar RC Drawdown
                  ------------------------------------------

       8.3.1      Subject to the provisions of this Agreement and to the
                  availability of funds Dollar RC Drawdown will be made by the
                  Funding Lending to the Borrower at is request if the following
                  conditions are fulfilled:

              (a)    not later than 11:00 a.m. on the third Dollar Business Day
                     before the proposed date of the relevant Dollar RC
                     Drawdown, the Facility agent has received from the
                     Borrower:

                     (i)    a notice substantially in the form set out in
                            Schedule 6 specifying (aa) the proposed date of that
                            Dollar RC Drawdown, which must be a Dollar Business
                            Day and (bb) the amount of the Dollar RC Drawdown
                            which must be in multiples of USD100,000.00 subject







<PAGE>   33

                                      -32-



                            to a minimum of USD100,000.00. Provided that the
                            aggregate of the Dollar RC Drawdowns made or to be
                            made under the Dollar RC Facility shall not at any
                            time exceed the Available Dollar RC Commitment and
                            (cc) the Dollar RC Interest Period selected by the
                            Borrower for such Dollar RC Drawdown Provided that
                            if, the Borrower fails to select the Dollar RC
                            Interest Period, the Funding Lender shall be at
                            liberty to select the Dollar RC Interest Period for
                            that particular Dollar RC Drawdown; and

                     (ii)   not later than 12:00 noon on the proposed date of
                            the relevant Dollar RC Drawdown, a duly executed and
                            stamped Promissory Note for the amounts of each
                            Dollar RC Drawdown;

              (b)    all representations and warranties in Clause 18(except to
                     any extent waived in accordance with Clause 23.2) have been
                     complied with and would be correct in all respects if
                     repeated on the proposed date of the Dollar RC Drawdown by
                     reference to the circumstances then existing;

              (c)    no Event of Default or Potential Event of Default has
                     occurred on or before the proposed date of that Dollar RC
                     Drawdown, other than that waived in accordance with Clause
                     23.2;

              (d)    not later than 11:00 a.m. on the proposed date of that
                     Dollar RC Drawdown, the Facility Agent and/or the Funding
                     Lender have received and found satisfactory such additional
                     information, legal opinions and/or other document relevant
                     in the context of or relating to this Agreement as it may
                     reasonably request.

       8.3.2  The Facility Agent shall promptly notify that Funding Lender of
              the proposed date of, and the amount of, each Dollar RC Drawdown.


       9.     REPAYMENT AND PREPAYMENT
              ------------------------

       9.1    Repayment of Ringgit Advances
              -----------------------------
 
       9.1.1  The Borrower shall repay the Ringgit Advances made under the TL I
              Facility by the thirty four (34) quarterly installments commencing
              on the 21st month from the date of the first Ringgit Advance in
              respect of the TL I Facility. The amount of each installment will
              vary based on the aggregate of all Ringgit Advances made under the
              TL I Facility Provided that after the Commitment Termination Date,
              the amount of the remaining installments in respect of the TL I
              Facility shall be fixed by the Facility Agent.




<PAGE>   34

                                      -33-


       9.2    Repayment of Dollar Advances
              ----------------------------

       9.2.1  The Borrower shall repay the Dollar Advances made under the Dollar
              Advances Facility by sixteen (16) quarterly installments
              commencing on the 15th month from the date of the first Dollar
              Advance. The amount of each installment will vary based on the
              Dollar RC Loan provided that after the Commitment Termination
              Date, the amount of the remaining installments will be fixed by
              the Facility Agent.

       9.2.2  The Facility Agent shall promptly notify the Borrower of the
              amount of each installment payable by it under the Dollar Advances
              Facility.

       9.3    Repayment of Dollar RC Loan
              ---------------------------

       9.3.1  The Borrower shall repay the principal amount of each Dollar RC
              Drawdown on the Dollar RC Repayment Date unless the Borrower shall
              have served on the Facility Agent not less than three (3) Dollar
              Business Days, prior to the Dollar RC Repayment Date, a request to
              rollover the principal amount of the Dollar RC Drawdown for a
              period of one (1), three (3) or six (6) months and the Funding
              Lender has agreed to the same in writing. If the Funding Lender
              agrees to the request for a rollover, then the principal amount of
              the Dollar RC Drawdown which is repayable on the Dollar RC
              Repayment Date shall on the Dollar RC Repayment Date be rolled
              over for the Dollar RC Rollover Period stipulated in such notice.

       9.4    Prepayment of Ringgit Advances Facility
              ---------------------------------------

       9.4.1  The Borrower may prepay the whole or any part of any Ringgit
              Advance Provided That:

              (a)    it has given to the Facility Agent not less than thirty
                     (30) Ringgit Business Days' notice; and

              (b)    all prepayments shall not be for less than RM100,000.00 or
                     in integral multiples of RM100,000.00;

              in default of which, the Borrower shall pay to the Facility Agent
              for account of the Lending Banks a premium calculated at the rate
              of zero point five per centum (0.5%) flat on amounts to be
              prepaid.

       9.4.2  Amounts prepaid shall be applied in the inverse order of maturity
              and any amount prepaid cannot be re-borrowed by the Borrower.





<PAGE>   35

                                      -34-



         9.5      Prepayment of Dollar Advances Facility
                  --------------------------------------

         9.5.1    The Borrower may prepay the whole or any part of any Dollar
                  Advance Provided That:

                  (a)      it has given to the Facility Agent not less than
                           thirty (30) Dollar Business Days' notice in respect
                           of prepayment under the Dollar Advances Facility; and

                  (b)      all prepayments shall not be for less than
                           USD100,000.00 or in integral multiples of
                           USD100,000.00;

                  in default of which, the Borrower shall pay to the Facility
                  Agent for the account of the Funding Lender a premium
                  calculated at zero point five per centum (0.5%) flat on
                  amounts to be prepaid.

         9.5.2    Amounts prepaid shall be applied in the inverse order of
                  maturity and any amount prepaid cannot be re-borrowed by the
                  Borrower.

         9.6      Prepayment of Dollar RC Facility
                  --------------------------------

         9.6.1    The Borrower may prepay the whole or any part of any Dollar RC
                  Drawdown Provided That:

                  (a)      it has given to the Facility Agent not less than
                           fourteen (14) Dollar Business Days' notice in respect
                           of prepayment under the Dollar RC Facility;

                  (b)      all prepayments shall not be less than USD100,000.00
                           or in integral multiples of USD100,000.00; and

                  (c)      each prepayment must be made on an Interest Payment
                           Date:

                  in default of which, the Borrower shall pay to the Facility
                  Agent for the account of the Funding Lender a premium
                  calculated at zero point five per centum (0.5%) flat on the
                  amounts to be prepaid.

         9.6.2    The Borrower shall, upon demand, reimburse the Facility Agent
                  for all cost, expenses or other charges incurred by the
                  Facility Agent in the event of such prepayment.

         9.7      Miscellaneous
                  -------------

         9.7.1    Any notice of prepayment given by the Borrower under Clause
                  9.4.1 (a) or 9.5.1 (a) or 9.6.1 (a) will oblige the Borrower
                  to prepay in accordance with that notice. 



<PAGE>   36

                                      -35-


                  The Borrower may not repay or prepay all or any part of the
                  Ringgit Advances Outstandings or the Dollar Advances
                  Outstandings or the Dollar RC Loan except as expressly
                  provided in this Agreement and may not re-borrow any amount
                  repaid or prepaid.


         10.      INTEREST

         10.1     Interest Rates and Interest Period
                  ----------------------------------

         10.1.1   Interest at the Relevant Applicable Rate shall accrue from day
                  to day and shall be calculated on each Ringgit Advance on the
                  basis of a year of 365 days for the actual number of days
                  elapsed and shall exclude the day of which interest is paid.
                  Interest shall be paid on the relevant Interest Payment Date.

         10.1.2   Interest at the Relevant Applicable Rate shall accrue from day
                  to day and shall be calculated on each Dollar Advance made
                  under the Dollar Advance Facility on the basis of a year of
                  360 days for the actual number of days elapsed and shall
                  exclude the day on which the interest is paid. Interest shall
                  be paid on the relevant Interest Payment Date.

         10.1.3   Interest at the Relevant Applicable Rate shall accrue from day
                  to day and shall be calculated on each Dollar RC Drawdown made
                  under the Dollar RC Facility on the basis of a year of 360
                  days for the actual number of days elapsed and shall exclude
                  the day on which interest is paid. Interest shall be paid on
                  the relevant Interest Payment Date.

         10.2     Notification of Interest Rates
                  ------------------------------

         10.2.1   Each of the Lending Bank shall promptly notify the Facility
                  Agent of its rate of interest.

         10.2.2   The Funding Lender shall promptly notify the Facility Agent of
                  its rate of interest.

         10.2.3   The Facility Agent shall promptly notify the Borrower of each
                  rate of interest notified to the Facility Agent by the
                  relevant Lender pursuant to Clause 10.2.1 and 10.2.2.

         10.3     Payment of Interest
                  -------------------

         10.3.1   Subject as otherwise provided in this Agreement, on each
                  Interest Payment Date relating to a Ringgit Advance, the
                  Borrower shall pay to the Facility Agent for the account of
                  the Lending Banks the unpaid interest accrued during the
                  relevant TL I Interest Period, on that Ringgit Advance at the
                  Relevant Applicable Rate.






<PAGE>   37

                                      -36-


         10.3.2   Subject as otherwise provided in this Agreement, on each
                  Interest Payment Date relating to a Dollar Advance made under
                  the Dollar Advance Facility, the Borrower shall pay to the
                  Facility Agent for the account of the Funding Lender the
                  unpaid interest accrued during that Dollar Advance Interest
                  Period on that Dollar Advance at the Relevant Applicable Rate.

         10.3.3   Subject as otherwise provided in this Agreement, on each
                  Dollar RC Interest Payment Date relating to a Dollar RC
                  Drawdown made under the Dollar RC Facility, the Borrower shall
                  pay to the Facility Agent for the account of the Funding
                  Lender the unpaid interest accrued during that Dollar RC
                  Interest Period on that Dollar RC Drawdown at the Relevant
                  Applicable Rate.

         10.4     Default Interest
                  ----------------
  
         10.4.1   If the Borrower does not pay any sum payable under this
                  Agreement (including, without limitation, any sum payable
                  under this Clause) when due, it shall pay interest, in the
                  same currency as that in which that overdue sum is payable, on
                  the amount from time to time outstanding in respect of that
                  overdue sum for the period beginning on the 11th day after its
                  due date and ending on the date of its receipt by the Facility
                  Agent or the relevant Lender (both before and after judgment
                  and notwithstanding the termination of any banker and customer
                  relationship) in accordance with this Clause. For the purpose
                  of this Clause, if any payment is received by the Facility
                  Agent on the due date, but after the term required and too
                  late to be made available by the Facility Agent on that due
                  date to the Lender(s) entitled to it, that payment shall be
                  deemed to be received on the next Ringgit Business Day or the
                  Dollar Business Day, as the case may be.

         10.4.2   Interest under this Clause shall be calculated by reference to
                  successive Interest Periods, each of which (other than the
                  first, which shall begin on the 11th day after its due date)
                  shall begin on the last day of the previous one. Each such
                  Interest Period shall be of one month or such other period as
                  the Facility Agent may from time to time select and the rate
                  of interest payable on each person's share of that overdue sum
                  for all or any part of a particular Interest Period shall be
                  the rate per annum (as quoted by that person to the Facility
                  Agent) equal to the sum of the Default Rate, the Margin and
                  the cost (as certified by that person and expressed as a rate
                  per annum) to that person (including the cost occasioned by or
                  attributable to complying with reserves, liquidity, deposit or
                  other requirements imposed on that person by such relevant
                  authority or authorities) of funding its share of that overdue
                  sum, in the currency in which it is payable, for that Interest
                  Period by whatever means it determines to be appropriate.

                  In this sub-Clause 10.4.2 "Default Rate" means one per centum
                  (1.0%) per annum or such other relevant rate not exceeding the
                  maximum interest rate imposed by Bank Negara Malaysia from
                  time to time.



<PAGE>   38

                                      -37-



         10.4.3   Each Lender to whom any default interest is payable under this
                  Agreement shall promptly notify the Borrower and the Facility
                  Agent of each rate of interest determined in accordance with
                  Clause 10.4.2.

         10.5     Variation of Interest Rate/Commission
                  -------------------------------------

                  Each of the Lenders reserve the right to vary from time to
                  time and at its absolute discretion, the interest and/or
                  commission payable by the Borrower to that Lender under this
                  Agreement Provided that such right shall only be exercisable
                  by that Lender upon the occurrence of an Event of Default or
                  where such variation is made necessary as a result of any
                  statutory and/or regulatory requirements imposed on the
                  Borrower and/or the Lenders.


         11.      FEES
                  ----

         11.1     Participation Fee
                  -----------------
 
         11.1.1   Upon the execution of this Agreement, the Borrower shall pay
                  to the Facility Agent for the account of the Lenders a
                  participation fee of USD55,000.00.

         11.1.2   On receipt of the participation fee, the Facility Agent shall
                  pay to each Lender, its share of the participation fee in the
                  amount already agreed between the Facility Agent and that
                  Lender.

         11.2     Commitment Fees
                  ---------------

         11.2.1   The Borrower shall pay to the Lending Banks a commitment fee
                  at the rate of zero point two five per centum (0.25%) per
                  annum on the account of the Available Ringgit Advances
                  Commitment based on the drawdown schedule for the TL I
                  Facility and ending on the Commitment Termination Date. Such
                  drawdown schedules shall be agreed upon by the Facility Agent
                  and the Borrower on or before the execution of this Agreement
                  and shall be annexed hereto as Schedule 10. The Ringgit
                  Advances commitment fees shall be payable from the date of
                  this Agreement to the earlier of he Commitment Termination
                  Date or the date on which the Available Ringgit Advances
                  Commitment first equals zero.

         11.2.2   The Borrower shall pay to the Funding Lender a commitment fee
                  at the rate of zero point two five per centum (0.25%) per
                  annum on the account of the Available Dollar Advances
                  Commitment based on the drawdown schedule for the Dollar
                  Advances Facility and ending on the Commitment Termination
                  Date. Such drawdown schedule shall be agreed upon by the
                  Facility Agent and the Borrower on or before the execution of
                  this Agreement and shall be annexed hereto as Schedule 10. The
                  Dollar Advances commitment fee shall be payable 






<PAGE>   39

                                      -38-



                  from the date of this Agreement to the earlier of the
                  Commitment Termination Date or the date on which the Available
                  Dollar Advances Commitment first equals zero.

         11.2.3   The Borrower shall pay to the Funding Lender a commitment fee
                  at the rate of zero point two five per centum (0.25%) per
                  annum on the Available Dollar RC Commitment from day to day
                  during the period beginning on the date of this Agreement and
                  ending on the Commitment Termination Date. The Dollar RC
                  commitment fee shall be payable from the date of this
                  Agreement and on the earlier of the Commitment Termination
                  Date and the date on which the Available RC Commitment first
                  equals zero.

         12.      INDEMNITIES
                  -----------

         12.1     Miscellaneous Indemnities
                  -------------------------

                  The Borrower shall on demand indemnity the Facility Agent, the
                  Security Agent, the Arranger and the Lenders against any
                  funding or other cost, loss (including loss of Margin),
                  expense or liability sustained or incurred by it as a result
                  of:

                  (a)      any Ringgit Advance not being made by reason of
                           non-fulfillment of any of the conditions in Clause
                           3.2.1 or the Borrower purporting to revoke the notice
                           requesting a Ringgit Advance.

                  (b)      a Dollar Advance not being made by reason of
                           non-fulfillment of any of the conditions in Clause
                           3.3.1 or the Borrower purporting to revoke a notice
                           requesting a Dollar Advance.

                  (c)      a Dollar RC Drawdown not being made by reason of
                           non-fulfillment of any of the conditions in Clause
                           3.4.1 or the Borrower purporting to revoke a notice
                           requesting for a Dollar RC Drawdown.

                  (d)      the occurrence or continuance of any Event of Default
                           or Potential Event of Default.

                  (e)      the receipt of recovery by any Lender (or the
                           Facility Agent on its behalf) of all or any part of
                           its Outstandings otherwise than on the last day of an
                           Interest Period or the receipt or recovery by any
                           Lender (or the Facility Agent on its behalf) of all
                           or any part of an overdue sum otherwise than on the
                           last day of an Interest Period relating to that
                           overdue sum.

         12.2     Broken Funding Costs
                  --------------------
 
                  In the case of sub-Clause 12.1(a), (b), (c) and (e) above, the
                  amount payable shall in any event include the amount (if any)
                  by which:





<PAGE>   40

                                      -39-



                  (a)      the amount of interest which the relevant person is
                           able to obtain by placing an amount equal to its
                           share of the relevant Ringgit Advance, or overdue sum
                           payable in Ringgit on deposit in the Kuala Lumpur
                           inter-bank market or, as the case may be, the
                           relevant Dollar Advance or the relevant Dollar RC
                           Drawdown or respective overdue sum payable in Dollars
                           on deposit in the inter-bank market, for the
                           remainder of the relevant Interest Period, as soon as
                           reasonably practicable after it becomes aware that
                           the relevant Ringgit Advance or Dollar Advance or
                           Dollar RC Drawdown is not being made or (as the case
                           may be) of the relevant receipt or recovery;

                  is less than:

                  (b)      the amount of interest which, in accordance with the
                           expressed terms of this Agreement, would otherwise be
                           payable to that person on the Ringgit Advance or, as
                           the case may be, the Dollar Advance or, as the case
                           may be, the Dollar RC Drawdown for its first Interest
                           Period or on the relevant amount so received or
                           recovered for the remainder of the relevant Interest
                           Period.

         12.3     Currency Indemnity
                  ------------------

         12.3.1   Any amount received or recovered by any part to this Agreement
                  (other than the Borrower) in respect of any sum expressed to
                  be due to it from the Borrower under or in connection with
                  this Agreement or any other Security Documents in a currency
                  (such currency being referred to as the "Relevant Currency")
                  other than the currency in which such sum is expressed to be
                  due under this Agreement or any other Security Document (such
                  currency being referred to as the "Currency of Account")
                  whether as a result of, or of the enforcement of, a judgment
                  or order of court or tribunal of any jurisdiction, in the
                  dissolution of the Borrower or otherwise, shall only
                  constitute a discharge to the Borrower to the extent of the
                  amount in the Currency of Account which the recipient is able,
                  in accordance with its usual practice, to purchase with the
                  amount of the Relevant Currency so received or recovered on
                  the date of that receipt or recovery (of, if it is not
                  practicable to make that purchase on that date, on the first
                  date on which it is practicable to do so).

         12.3.2   If that amount in the Currency of Account is less than the
                  amount of the Currency of Account due to the recipient under
                  or in connection with this Agreement or any other Security
                  Document, the Borrower shall indemnify it against any loss
                  sustained by it as a result. In any event, the Borrower shall
                  indemnify the recipient against the cost of making any such
                  purchase. For the purpose of this sub-clause 12.3, it will be
                  sufficient for the recipient to demonstrate that it would have
                  suffered a loss had an actual exchange or purchase taken
                  place.



<PAGE>   41

                                      -40-



         12.4     Indemnities Separate
                  --------------------

                  Each of the indemnities in this Agreement constitute a
                  separate and independent obligation from the other obligations
                  in this Agreement, shall give rise to a separate and
                  independent cause of action, shall apply irrespective of any
                  indulgence granted by the Arranger, the Facility Agent, the
                  Security Agent and/or any Lender and shall continue in full
                  force and effect despite any judgment, order, claim or proof
                  for a liquidated amount in respect of any sum due under this
                  Agreement or any other judgment or other.



         13.      TAXES
                  -----

         13.1     Payments to be Free and Clear
                  -----------------------------

                  All sums payable by the Borrower under this Agreement shall be
                  paid (i) free of any restriction or conditions, (ii) free and
                  clear of and (except to the extent required by law) without
                  any deduction or withholding for or on account of any tax and
                  (iii) without deduction or withholding (except to the extent
                  required by law) on account of any other amount, whether by
                  way of set-off or otherwise.

         13.2     Grossing-up of Payments
                  -----------------------

         13.2.1   If the Borrower or any other person (whether or not a party
                  to, or on behalf of a party to, this Agreement) must at any
                  time deduct or withhold any tax or other amount from any sum
                  paid on payable by, or received or receivable from, the
                  Borrower under this Agreement, the Borrower shall pay such
                  additional amount as is necessary to ensure that the Facility
                  Agent, the Security Agent or the relevant Lender, as the case
                  may be, to which that sum is due receives on the due date and
                  retains (free from any liability other than tax on its own
                  overall net income) a net sum equal to what it would have
                  received and so retained had not such deduction or withholding
                  been required or made.

         13.2.2   If the Borrower or any other person (whether or not a party
                  to, or on behalf of a party to, this Agreement) must at any
                  time pay any tax or other amount on, or calculated by
                  reference to, any sum received or receivable by the Facility
                  Agent, the Security Agent or any lender, as the case may be,
                  under this Agreement (except for a payment by the Facility
                  Agent, the security Agent or a Lender of tax on its own
                  overall net income), the Borrower shall pay or procure the
                  payment of that tax or other amount before any interest or
                  penalty becomes payable or, if that tax or other amount is
                  payable and paid by the Facility Agent, the Security Agent or
                  any Lender shall reimburse it on demand for the amount paid by
                  it.

         12.2.3   Within thirty (30) Ringgit Business Days after paying any sum
                  from which it is required by law to make any deduction or
                  withholding, and within thirty (30)





<PAGE>   42

                                      -41-


                  Ringgit Business Days after the due date of payment of any tax
                  or other amount which it is required by Clause 13.2.2 to pay,
                  the Borrower shall deliver to the Facility Agent evidence
                  satisfactory to the Facility Agent, the Security Agent or the
                  relevant Lender, as the case may be, of that deduction,
                  withholding or payment and (where remittance is required) of
                  the remittance thereof to the relevant taxing or other
                  authority.



         14.      CHANGES IN CIRCUMSTANCES
                  ------------------------

         14.1     Illegality
                  ----------

         14.1.1   If at any time any Lender determines that it is or will become
                  unlawful or contrary to any directive of any agency of any
                  state for it to allow all or part of its Lender's Commitment
                  to remain outstanding, to make, fund or allow to remain
                  outstanding all or part of its Outstanding Amount and/or to
                  carry out all or any of its other obligations under this
                  Agreement, upon that Lender notifying the Facility Agent and
                  the Borrower.

                  (a)      its Lender's Commitment or the relevant part thereof,
                           shall be cancelled; and

                  (b)      the Borrower shall:

                           (i)      prepay that Lender's Outstanding Amount, or
                                    the relevant part thereof, on such date as
                                    that Lender shall certify to be necessary to
                                    comply with the relevant law or directive
                                    with all unpaid accrued interest thereon,
                                    all unpaid fees accrued to that Lender and
                                    any other sum then due to that Lender under
                                    Clause 12.1 or any other provision of this
                                    Agreement; and/or

                           (ii)     (if that Lender is a Working Capital Lender
                                    and a part of the Lender's Outstanding
                                    Amount, or a relevant part thereof, comprise
                                    its Working Capital Outstanding Amount which
                                    include any contingent liabilities of that
                                    Lender) pay to the Facility Agent for the
                                    account of that Lender an amount equal to
                                    the aggregate of the amounts of the
                                    contingent liabilities of that Lender
                                    comprised in its Working Capital Outstanding
                                    Amount (which shall be held by the Facility
                                    Agent for the account of the Working Capital
                                    Lender and applied towards the discharge of
                                    the obligations of the Borrower to the
                                    Working Capital Lender under or in
                                    connection with this Agreement and shall
                                    only be released to the Borrower as and when
                                    and to the extent that the maximum
                                    contingent liability of the Borrower to the
                                    Working Capital Lender under this Agreement
                                    is reduced) and shall pay any sum then due
                                    from the 







<PAGE>   43

                                      -42-



                                    Borrower to the Working Capital Lender in
                                    relations to its Working Capital Facilities.

         14.2     Increased Costs
                  ---------------
 
         14.2.1   If the Facility Agent or (as the case may be) any Lender
                  determines that, as a result of (a) the introduction of or any
                  change in, or in the interpretation or application of, any law
                  (which shall for this purpose include any removal or
                  modification or any exemption currently in force in favor of
                  the Borrower) or (b) compliance by the Facility Agent or that
                  Lender with any directive any agency of any state (including,
                  without limitation, a directive which affects the manner in
                  which that Lender allocates capital resources to its
                  obligations under this Agreement or any Working Capital
                  Facilities granted by it to the Borrower):

                  (i)      the cost to that Lender of maintaining all or any
                           part of its Lender's Commitment and/or of making,
                           maintaining or funding all or any part of its
                           Lender's Outstanding Amount or any overdue sum is
                           increased; and/or

                  (ii)     any sum received or receivable by the Facility Agent
                           or (as the case may be) that Lender under this
                           Agreement or the effective return to it under this
                           Agreement or any Working Capital Facilities granted
                           by it to the Borrower or the overall return on its
                           capital is reduced (except on account of tax on its
                           overall net income); and/or

                  (iii)    the Facility Agent or (as the case may be) that
                           Lender makes any payment (except on account of tax on
                           its overall net income) or forgoes any interest or
                           other return on or calculated by reference to the
                           amount of any sum received or receivable by it under
                           this Agreement;

                  the Borrower shall indemnify the Facility Agent or (as the
                  case may be) that Lender against that increased cost,
                  reduction, payment or forgone interest or other return (except
                  to the extent that if results from a deduction or withholding
                  of tax) and, accordingly, shall from time to time on demand
                  (whenever made) pay to the Facility Agent for its own account
                  or (as the case may be) for the account of that Lender the
                  amount certified by it to be necessary so to indemnify it.
                  Under this Clause 14.2.1, a Lender shall be entitled to claim
                  interest or other return directly attributable to this
                  Agreement, its Lender's Commitment, its Lender's Outstanding
                  Amount or its share of any overdue sum, but also for that
                  proportion of any cost, reduction, payment or forgone interest
                  or other return which that Lender determines to be allocable
                  to this Agreement, its Lender's Commitment, its Outstanding
                  Amount or its share of any overdue sum in relation to any law
                  or directive applicable to that Lender or affecting the
                  conduct of that Lender's business or a type of business or the
                  manner in which or the extent to which that Lender allocates
                  capital resources.








<PAGE>   44

                                      -43-




         15.      PAYMENTS
                  --------

         15.1     Ringgit Advances
                  ----------------
  
         15.1.1   On each date on which a Ringgit Advance under the TL I
                  Facility is to be made, each Lending Bank shall make its
                  Proportion of that Ringgit Advance available to the Borrower
                  in Ringgit, in immediately available and freely transferable
                  funds to the account of the Borrower with such bank in Kuala
                  Lumpur or Kuching as the Borrower shall have specified in the
                  notice requiring that Ringgit Advance. Each of the Lending
                  Bank shall promptly notify the Facility Agent upon making such
                  Ringgit Advance.

         15.1.2   On each date on which any sum is due from the Borrower to each
                  Lending Bank under this Agreement in Ringgit, it shall make
                  that sum available to that Lending Bank, by payment in
                  Ringgit, in immediately available and freely transferable
                  funds to the account of the Lending Bank with such bank in
                  Kuala Lumpur or Kuching as the Lending Bank shall have
                  designated to it for this purpose. Each Lending Bank shall
                  promptly notify the Facility Agent upon receipt of any such
                  sum from the Borrower.

         15.2     Dollar Advances
                  ---------------

         15.2.1   On each date on which a Dollar Advance is to be made, the
                  Funding Lender shall make that Dollar Advance available to the
                  Borrower, and on each date on which any sum is due to the
                  Funding Lender from the Borrower in US Dollars it shall make
                  that sum available to the Funding Lender, by payment in US
                  Dollars and in funds which are for same day settlement to the
                  Account of the Borrower with BBMB, Kuala Lumpur Branch.

         15.3     Dollar RC Drawdown
                  ------------------

         15.3.1   On each date on which a Dollar RC Drawdown is to be made, the
                  Funding Lender shall make that Dollar RC Drawdown available to
                  the Borrower, and on each date on which any sum is due to the
                  Funding Lender from the Borrower in US Dollars it shall make
                  that sum available to the Funding Lender, by payment in US
                  Dollars and in fund which are for same day settlement to the
                  account of the Borrower with BBMB, Kuala Lumpur Branch.

         15.4     Distribution to Lenders, Agents
                  -------------------------------

         15.4.1   The Facility Agent shall make available to each Lender (other
                  than the Funding Lender) before close of business in Kuala
                  Lumpur on that date its pro rata share (if any) of any sum in
                  Ringgit so received or recovered by the Facility Agent from
                  the Borrower in the same currency and funds as received by the
                  Facility Agent to such account of that Lender with such bank
                  in Kuala Lumpur as it shall have designated to the Facility
                  Agent for that purpose. If any sum is received by 




<PAGE>   45

                                      -44-


                  the Facility Agent from the Borrower later than 11:00 a.m. on
                  its due date, the Facility Agent shall make each Lender's
                  share (if any) available to it as soon as practicable
                  thereafter.

         15.4.2   The Facility Agent shall make available to the Funding Lender
                  before close of business in Singapore on that date any sum in
                  US Dollars so received by the Facility Agent from the Borrower
                  in the same currency and funds as received by the Facility
                  Agent to such account of the Funding Lender with such bank in
                  Kuala Lumpur as it shall have designated to the Facility Agent
                  for that purpose. If any sum is received by the Agent from the
                  Borrower later than 11:00 a.m. (local time in Singapore), the
                  Facility Agent shall make available to it the said sum in US
                  Dollars as soon as practicable thereafter.

         15.5     Order or Distribution
                  ---------------------
 
                  If the amount received by the Facility Agent from the Borrower
                  for the account of the Lenders on any date is less than the
                  total sum remaining and/or becoming due to the Lenders under
                  this Agreement on that date, the Facility Agent shall apply
                  that amount tin or towards payment of the following sums in
                  the following order:

                  (a)      first, any sum then due to the Facility Agent in its
                           capacity as such; and

                  (b)      secondly, in or towards payment pro rata of any sums
                           then due to the Lender (or any of them).

                  Any such applications shall override any purported
                  appropriation by any person.

         15.6     Refunding of Payments
                  ---------------------

                  The Facility Agent shall not be obliged to (but may) make
                  available to any person any sum which it is expecting to
                  receive for the account of that person until it has been able
                  to establish that it has received that sum. Howsoever, it may
                  do so if it wishes. If and to the extent that it does so but
                  it transpires that it has not then received the sum which it
                  paid out:

                  (a)      the person to whom the Facility Agent made that sum
                           available shall on request refund it to the Facility
                           Agent; and

                  (b)      that person or (at the option of the Facility Agent)
                           the person by whom that such should have been made
                           available shall on request pay to the Facility Agent
                           the amount (as certified by the Facility Agent) which
                           will indemnify the Facility agent against any funding
                           or other cost, loss expense or liability sustained or
                           incurred by it as a result of paying out that sum
                           before receiving it but without prejudice to the
                           rights of any party hereto against such defaulting
                           party.





<PAGE>   46

                                      -45-




         15.7     Non-Business Days
                  -----------------
 
         15.7.1   If any Interest Payment Date or any other repayment date,
                  (each such date hereinafter referred to as a "Relevant Date")
                  would otherwise fall on a day which is not a Ringgit Business
                  Day or, as the case may, a Dollar Business Day, it shall
                  instead fall on the next Ringgit business Day or, as the case
                  may be, Dollar Business Day in the same calendar month (if
                  there is one) or the preceding Ringgit Business Day, or as the
                  case may be, Dollar Business Day (if there is not).

         15.7.2   Any payment to be made by the Borrower on a day which is not a
                  Relevant Date and which would otherwise be due on a day which
                  is not a Ringgit Business Day or, as the case may be, a Dollar
                  Business Day shall instead be due on the next Ringgit Business
                  Day or, as the case may be, Dollar Business Day.



         16.      SECURITY
                  --------

         16.1     For the consideration aforesaid and for better securing the
                  repayment by the Borrower of the moneys due and payable or
                  hereafter due and payable under the Facilities respective
                  interest thereon and all other moneys hereby agreed to be paid
                  under this Agreement and the other Security Documents the
                  Borrower hereby agrees that the Facilities shall be secured
                  against the Security Documents.

         16.2     The Borrower hereby warrants, represents and declares that
                  there is not mortgage charge pledge or lien or any encumbrance
                  over the assets secured under the Security Documents or any
                  part thereof and:

                  (a)      The Borrower shall not have power to create any
                           subsequent assignment mortgage charge pledge lien or
                           encumbrance in respect of the assets secured under
                           the Security Documents or any part thereof without
                           the prior written consent of the Security Agent and
                           the Lenders, such consent shall not be unreasonably
                           withheld by the Security Agent and the Lenders;

                  (b)      This Agreement shall be without prejudice to any
                           security already given by the Borrower to the
                           Security Agent and the Lenders whether the same be
                           for securing repayment of the principal sums and
                           interest hereby secured or any part hereof or any
                           other moneys and whether such security is taken as
                           additional or collateral security or otherwise
                           howsoever.

         16.3     The Borrower shall at the request of the Lenders and at the
                  cost and expense of the Borrower charge or deposit with the
                  Security Agent all documents of title of any or all immovable
                  and movable properties vested in the Borrower for any tenure
                  save for future assets and properties of the Borrower which
                  are excluded in accordance with the provisions in the
                  Debenture. Such charge or deposit shall be 






<PAGE>   47

                                      -46-



                  by way of security for the repayment of the principal sum of
                  the Facilities respective interest thereon and all other
                  monies covenanted to be paid herein and in the Security
                  Documents.

         16.4     The security created by the Security Documents is and shall be
                  a continuing security for all moneys whatsoever now or
                  hereafter from time to time owing to the Facility Agent,
                  Security Agent and the Lenders by the Borrower whether alone
                  or jointly and severally with another or others and whether as
                  principal or surety notwithstanding that the Borrower may at
                  any time or times cease to be indebted to any of them for any
                  period or periods and notwithstanding any settlement of
                  account or accounts or otherwise.



         17.      EVENTS OF DEFAULT
                  -----------------

         17.1     Upon the occurrences of any of the following events:

                  17.1.1   the Borrower fails to pay any sum payable by it under
                           any of the Security Documents within ten (10) days
                           after the same has become due; or

                  17.1.2   the Borrower commits any breach of any other
                           provision of the Security Documents, and such breach
                           (if capable of remedy) is not remedied within thirty
                           (30) days of notification of such breach by the
                           Facility Agent; or

                  17.1.3   any representation or warranty made or deemed to be
                           made or repeated by the Borrower in or pursuant to
                           the Security Documents is or proves to have been
                           untrue or incorrect in any material and adverse
                           respect when made or when deemed to be repeated with
                           reference to the facts and circumstances existing at
                           such time; or

                  17.1.4   an encumbrancer takes possession over the undertaking
                           assets rights or revenues of the Borrower or a
                           distress or other process is lifted or enforced upon
                           any such assets rights or revenues and any such
                           action is not lifted or discharged within fourteen
                           (14) days or in the opinion of the Facility Agent
                           (acting on the instructions of an Instructing Group)
                           is not bona fide challenged by the Borrower in the
                           appropriate court within seven (7) days of such
                           possession or distress or enforcement; or

                  17.1.5   a petition is presented or an order is made or a
                           resolution is passed for the winding up or
                           dissolution of the Borrower or Corporate Guarantor;
                           or






<PAGE>   48

                                      -47-


                  17.1.6   any of the Security Documents is or becomes or is
                           alleged to be unlawful or unenforceable in any
                           material and adverse respect; or

                  17.1.7   any requisite Consent for the borrowing of the
                           Facilities is withdrawn or revoked or expires or is
                           modified or made subject to any condition which may
                           have a materials adverse effect on the Borrower; or

                  17.1.8   any other event or series of events or any
                           circumstances whether related or not (including but
                           without limitation any adverse change in the assets
                           or financial condition of the Borrower and/or
                           Corporate Guarantor) occurs or arises which, in the
                           opinion of the Facility Agent (acting on the
                           instructions of the Instructing Group, may/would (be
                           likely to) have a material adverse effect on the
                           Borrower or its ability or willingness to perform or
                           comply with any of its obligations under the Security
                           Documents; or

                  17.1.9   the transfer of the Land in favor of the Borrower is
                           not executed within seven (7) days from the date of
                           written request by the Security Agent or is not
                           registered for any reason whatsoever resulting in the
                           non-registration of the Charge; or

                  17.1.10  the Borrower fails and/or neglects to execute the
                           transfer of the Land as transferers; or

                  17.1.11  the Borrower breaches any term or condition of the
                           Land Letter of Offer and Acceptance; or

                  17.1.12  the Borrower fails to obtain the necessary Consent
                           for the transfer of the land to the Borrower and/or
                           the Charge; or

                  17.1.13  the Land Letter of Offer and Acceptance is revoked
                           for any reason whatsoever; or

                  17.1.14  the Corporate Guarantor ceases to be the major
                           shareholder of the Borrower; or

                  17.1.15  the Corporate Guarantor and/or the Borrower ceases or
                           threatens to cease to carry on its business; or

                  17.1.16  any other indebtedness of the Borrower in respect of
                           borrowed money is or is declared to be or is capable
                           of being rendered due and payable before its normal
                           maturity by reason of actual or potential default and
                           in the reasonable opinion of the Facility Agent
                           (acting on the instructions of the Instructing Group)
                           may/would (be likely to) have a adverse effect on the
                           Borrower or 









<PAGE>   49

                                      -48-



                           its ability or willingness to perform or comply with
                           any of its obligations under any of the Security
                           Documents; or

                  then and in any such event and at any time thereafter if such
                  event is continuing the Facility Agent may by notice to the
                  Borrower declare that the Facilities shall be cancelled and
                  the Lender's Outstanding Amounts have become immediately due
                  and repayable, whereupon the Borrower shall forthwith repay
                  the same together with all interest accrued and all other sums
                  payable under the Security Documents. A demand for repayment
                  of the Lenders Outstanding Amounts may be made by notice in
                  writing from the Facility Agent to the Borrower demanding
                  payment of the same within seven (7) Ringgit Business Days or,
                  as the case may be, seven (7) Dollar Business Days or, as the
                  case may be, seven (7) Dollar Business Days, from the date of
                  such notice.



         18.      REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES
                  ------------------------------

         18.1     Representation and Warranties
                  -----------------------------

                  The Borrower represents and warrants to the Beneficiaries as
                  at the date hereof and shall be deemed to represent at each
                  date of drawdown, as follows:

                  18.1.1   the execution of the Security Documents is a valid
                           and legally binding obligation on the Borrower
                           enforceable in accordance with the terms therein;

                  18.1.2   the execution of the Corporate Guarantee by the
                           Corporate Guarantor is valid and legally binding
                           obligation on the Corporate Guarantor enforceable in
                           accordance with the terms therein;

                  18.1.3   the execution delivery and performance of the
                           Security Documents and the use of the Facilities do
                           not and will not:

                           (a)      contravene any law regulation directive
                                    judgment or order to which the Borrower
                                    and/or the Corporate Guarantor is subject;
                                    or;

                           (b)      result in any actual or potential breach of
                                    or default under any obligation agreement
                                    instrument or Consent to which the Borrower
                                    and/or the Corporate Guarantor is a party or
                                    by which it is bound;

                  18.1.4   no litigation arbitration or administrative or
                           winding up proceeding and without limitation no
                           dispute with any statutory or governmental authority
                           is pending or to the Borrower's knowledge





<PAGE>   50

                                      -49-



                           threatened against it or any of its assets which
                           might/would be likely to have a material adverse
                           effect on the Borrower (having regard to all its
                           other obligations);

                  18.1.5   no Event of Default or Potential Event of Default has
                           occurred and is continuing;

                  18.1.6   the Borrower is not in default in the payment of any
                           due and payable taxes or in the filing registration
                           or recording of any document or under any legal or
                           statutory obligation or requirement which default
                           might/would be likely to have a material adverse
                           effect on the Borrower;

                  18.1.7   the Borrower will not nor would it, with the giving
                           of notice or lapse of time or any certificate or the
                           making of any determination or any combination
                           thereof be in breach of or in default under any
                           agreement relating to any indebtedness to which it is
                           a party or by which it is bound which might/would
                           have a material adverse effect on the Borrower
                           (having regard to all its other obligations);

                  18.1.8   all Consents necessary or appropriate for the
                           execution, delivery and performance of the Security
                           Documents and the grant of and use of the Facilities
                           have been obtained and complied with and the same are
                           in full force and effect;

                  18.1.9   all factual information supplied by the Borrower to
                           the Facility Agent in contemplation or for the
                           purpose of this Agreement, was true and accurate in
                           all material respects as at its date and not
                           misleading; and such information did not omit
                           anything, nor since the date of such information has
                           anything occurred, which renders that information
                           untrue or misleading in any material respect or
                           which, if disclosed, might/would (be likely to)
                           adversely affect the reasonable decision of a person
                           considering whether to enter into this Agreement; and
                           all projections and statements of belief and opinion
                           given by the Borrower to the Facility Agent were made
                           honestly and in good faith after due and careful
                           inquiry and remain valid;

                  18.1.10  Section 62 of BAFIA would not be contravened upon the
                           granting of the Facilities by the Lenders;

                  18.1.11  The Land Letter of Offer and Acceptance has been duly
                           accepted by the Borrower;






<PAGE>   51

                                      -50-



                  18.1.12  The Land Letter of Offer and Acceptance is still
                           valid and binding on the Borrower.


         19.      COVENANTS
                  ---------

         19.1     Particular Covenants
                  --------------------
 
                  The Borrower hereby expressly covenants with the Beneficiaries
                  that at all times during the continuance of this Agreement and
                  so long as any principal sums under the Facilities so utilised
                  and interest and any monies payable under this Agreement or
                  other Security Documents shall remain unpaid:

                  19.1.1   it will ensure that its obligations under this
                           Agreement and the other Security Documents shall at
                           all times rank ahead of all its other present and
                           future liabilities to any other third party or
                           parties (with the exception of any obligations which
                           are mandatorily preferred by law and not by
                           contract);

                  19.1.2   it will obtain, maintain in full force and effect and
                           comply with all Consents and any conditions thereof
                           necessary (or appropriate) for the execution delivery
                           and performance of this Agreement and the other
                           Security Documents and the use of the Facilities;

                  19.1.3   it will promptly inform the Facility Agent, forthwith
                           upon becoming aware of the same, of any occurrence or
                           circumstance of which it becomes aware which
                           might/would be likely to adversely affect its ability
                           to perform its obligations under the Security
                           Documents and of any Event of Default or Potential
                           Event of Default;

                  19.1.4   it will punctually pay all interests payable on its
                           relevant Interest Payment Dates and any other sums
                           owing under any of the Security Documents;

                  19.1.5   it will furnish to the Facility Agent all information
                           as the Facility Agent shall reasonably request
                           concerning the use of the Facilities and on any
                           factors partially affecting the financial condition
                           of the Borrower;

                  19.1.6   it will promptly inform and keep the Facility Agent
                           informed of any legal proceedings litigation claims
                           of a 







<PAGE>   52

                                      -51-


                           material nature involving the Borrower which would
                           have a material adverse effect on its assets or
                           financial condition or its ability to observe or
                           perform its obligations under the Security Documents;

                  19.1.7   it will observe and perform all terms and conditions
                           of the Land Letter or Offer and Acceptance and will
                           make all necessary payments pursuant to the said
                           letter;

                  19.1.8   it will execute all documents, undertake all acts
                           necessary to effect a transfer of the land in favor
                           of the Borrower and the Charge;

                  19.1.9   it will procure the delivery of the relevant issue
                           document of title to the Land when issued, the said
                           transfer and all other necessary documents to effect
                           the transfer of the Land in favor of the Borrower to
                           the Security Agent or its solicitors;

                  19.1.10  it will inform the Security Agent as regards the
                           progress in the issuance of the separate document of
                           title to the Land and inform the Security Agent in
                           respect of all matters relating to the Land;

                  19.1.11  it will ensure that there is no material change in
                           the nature of its business;

                  19.1.12  it will not make any repayments in respect of the
                           Shareholders Loan;

                  19.1.13  it will convert the Shareholders Loan to paid-up
                           capital on acquisition of the new plant and
                           machinery;

                  19.1.14  it will maintain its debt : equity ratio to at least
                           3 : 1. For the purpose of this paragraph, equity
                           shall include loans from its shareholders;

                  19.1.15  it will procure its shareholders to meet any cost
                           overrun and at the request of the Facility Agent
                           procure documentary evidence in this respect;

                  19.1.16  it will pay or procured to be paid punctually, in
                           accordance with all proper demands for payment, all
                           sums due or to become due under the construction
                           contract in respect of the factory on the Land and
                           all other costs relating thereto, 






<PAGE>   53

                                      -52-




                           duly comply with all its obligations and take all
                           reasonable steps to assume that other parties comply
                           with their respective obligations under the said
                           contract;

                  19.1.17  it will at all times comply with all applicable laws
                           or directives and any conditions of any consent
                           relating to the construction of the factory on the
                           Land and maintain in full force and effect such
                           consents and if required, apply for all consent;

                  19.1.18  it will supply a copy of the said construction
                           contract to the Security Agent;

                  19.1.19  it will allow the Security Agent and its agents and
                           employees (subject to prior appointment) access from
                           time to time to the Land and for the purpose of
                           carrying out an inspection and review thereof, cause
                           its agents or employees to give their full
                           co-operation on any such inspection and all and any
                           reasonable expenses incurred by the Security Agent in
                           connection with such inspection shall be borne by the
                           Borrower (save and except for expenses incurred in
                           respect of post sanction visits which will be borne
                           by the respective Lenders);

                  19.1.20  it will maintain in full force and effect all
                           Consents;

                  19.1.21  it will promptly inform the Security Agent on receipt
                           of any notice from the relevant land authority; and

                  19.1.22  it will at all times comply with all terms and
                           conditions of the manufacturing license issued in
                           connection with the Borrower's manufacturing
                           activities.

         19.2     Restrictive Covenants
                  ---------------------

                  The Borrower hereby covenants with the Beneficiaries that
                  during the continuance of this Agreement it will not without
                  the consent of the Facility Agent (acting on the instructions
                  of the Instructing Group) in writing first had and obtained,
                  such consent shall not be unreasonably withheld:

                  19.2.1   create or permit to subsist any encumbrance over all
                           or any of its present or future revenues or assets,
                           charged under any of the Security Documents, such
                           consent not to be unreasonably withheld by the
                           Facility Agent;






<PAGE>   54

                                      -53-


                  19.2.2   make any loans or grant any credit or give any
                           guarantee or indemnity to or for the benefit or any
                           person or otherwise voluntarily assume any liability,
                           whether actual or contingent, in respect of any
                           obligation or any other person, otherwise than in the
                           ordinary courses of its business and/or in accordance
                           with schemes approved by the Borrower for its
                           employees;

                  19.2.3   (disregarding disposals in the ordinary course of
                           business) sell, lease, transfer or otherwise dispose
                           of, by one or more transactions or series of
                           transactions (whether related or not), the whole or
                           any part of its revenues or its assets unless such
                           sale is in respect of non material items disposed of
                           on an arms length basis;

                  19.2.4   declare any dividends or any other distribution of
                           profits (whether in cash, specie or otherwise) within
                           the first three (3) years from the date of this
                           Agreement. Thereafter the Borrower without prior
                           permission shall be entitled to declare dividends
                           PROVIDED that such payment of dividends shall not
                           exceed 15% of the Borrower's retained earnings in any
                           one financial year;

                  19.2.5   vary, cancel rescind or otherwise terminate or agree
                           to any variation cancellation, rescission or accept
                           any repudiation of the said construction contract;

                  19.2.6   sell, lease, transfer or otherwise dispose of the
                           Land;

                  19.2.7   change its corporate structure either by merger,
                           amalgamation, reorganization or reconstruction;

                  19.2.8   amend its Memorandum and Articles of Association;

                  19.2.9   enter into any transaction with any person other than
                           in the ordinary course of business on ordinary
                           commercial terms and at arm's length;

                  19.2.10  made any prepayment or repayment in respect of any
                           debt (except any debts incurred by way of normal
                           trade transactions) or loan advanced to the Borrower
                           by the shareholders third parties or related
                           companies as defined under Section 6 of the Companies
                           Act, 1965 (except the Comerica Bank loan of
                           approximately United States 







<PAGE>   55

                                      -54-



                           Dollars Ten Million (USD10,000,000.00) provided that
                           in _____ month, the Borrower shall repay all monies
                           to the Lenders first before any repayment of the loan
                           or any part thereof;

                  19.2.11  save as provided by any provisions herein decrease or
                           in any way whatsoever alter the authorized or issued
                           Capital of the Borrower whether by varying the amount
                           structure or value thereof or the rights attaching
                           thereto or convert any of the its share capital into
                           stock or by consolidating, dividing, or sub-dividing
                           all or any of its shares;

                  19.2.12  make advances or guarantee to others or make
                           investments in other companies or enterprises (other
                           than normal trade credit or temporary loans to
                           customers, contractors or suppliers in the ordinary
                           course of business);

                  19.2.13  reduce its share capital;

                  19.2.14  enter or threaten to enter into any partnership,
                           profit sharing or royalty agreement or other similar
                           arrangement whereby the Borrower's income or profits
                           are, or might be shared with any other person, firm,
                           company, or enter into any management contract or
                           similar arrangement whereby the Borrower's business
                           or operations are managed by any other person, firm
                           or company save and except in the ordinary course of
                           the Borrower's business;

                  19.2.15  make or permit loans or make advances to any
                           shareholder or director of the Borrower or to any
                           related or associate company of the Borrower or to
                           any shareholder or director thereof or guarantee any
                           person, enterprise, or company (other than normal
                           trade credits or trade guarantees or temporary loans
                           to staff, customers or suppliers in the ordinary
                           course of business); 

                  19.2.16  alter the category of land use of the Land;

                  19.2.17  allow or permit any change in the Corporate
                           Guarantor's shareholding in the Borrower to less than
                           75%.

         19.3     Government Acquisition
                  ----------------------

         19.3.1   In the event that the Land or any part thereof shall at any
                  time become the subject matter of or be included in any notice
                  notification or declaration






<PAGE>   56

                                      -55-



                  concerning or relating to acquisition by government or
                  governmental authority or any inquiry or proceedings in
                  respect thereof if any government or governmental authority
                  shall condemn, nationalize, seize or otherwise expropriate all
                  or any part of the property or other assets of the Borrower
                  charged hereunder or under any of the other Security Documents
                  or shall have assumed custody or control of such property or
                  other assets the Borrower shall forthwith inform the Facility
                  Agent of the same and shall forward to the Facility Agent a
                  copy or copies of any such notice, notification or declaration
                  as soon as the same shall be delivered to or served on the
                  Borrower and shall not be more than three (3) days of
                  receiving such notification or declaration.

         19.3.2   The Facility agent shall be entitled to engage advisers and
                  agents (including solicitors and valuers) as it may think fit
                  for the purpose of appearing or attending at or advising upon
                  any inquiry or proceedings affecting concerning or relating to
                  any such acquisition, expropriation or any of the matters
                  referred to in Clause 19.3.1 hereof at the reasonable expense
                  of the Borrower.

         19.3.3   All monies received as or by way of compensation in respect of
                  any of the matters referred to in Clause 19.3.1 hereof shall
                  be applied in or towards discharge or repayment of any money
                  or liability secured by the Security Documents and the
                  Borrower shall, and hereby declares that it will hold all such
                  monies so received in trust for the Facility Agent and the
                  Borrower agrees and confirms that the Facility Agent may
                  receive and give a good discharge for all such monies.


         20.      INSURANCE
                  ---------

         20.1     The Borrower shall so long as any monies under any of the
                  Security Documents remain unpaid:

                  20.1.1   at all times prior to the completion of the
                           construction of the factory on the Land effect and
                           maintain with insurers or underwriters acceptable by
                           the Lenders in writing from time to time insurances
                           against such risks and liabilities customary for
                           businesses similar to its business as the Lenders may
                           from time to time require and in amounts and on terms
                           satisfactory to the Lenders, including but not
                           limited to Contractor's all risks insurance and
                           material supplies insurance;







<PAGE>   57

                                      -56-




                  20.1.2   at all times after the completion of the said factory
                           effect and maintain with insurers or underwriters
                           acceptable by the Lenders in writing from time to
                           time insurances against such risks and business as
                           the Lenders may from time to time require and in
                           amounts and on terms satisfactory to the Lenders,
                           including but not limited to insurances over the
                           buildings on the Land against loss and damage by
                           fire, explosion, aircraft and other serial devices
                           and articles dropped therefrom, storm, tempest,
                           flooding, burst pipes and tanks, subsidence,
                           malicious damage and such other risks as the Lenders
                           may from time to time require to the full
                           reinstatement value of the buildings on the Land
                           (which shall not be less than any amount in that
                           behalf which the Lenders may from time to time notify
                           to it) together with additional amounts estimated as
                           sufficient to cover architects' surveyors' and other
                           professional fees and the costs of demolition and
                           debris removal and will give such information to the
                           Lenders regarding such insurances as the Lenders may
                           from time to time require;

                  20.1.3   punctually pay or procure to be paid all premium and
                           deliver or procure to be delivered receipts therefor
                           to the Security Agent; and

                  20.1.4   not make, do, consent, or agree to any act or
                           omission which would or might enable cancellation of
                           any of the insurances or render any of the insurances
                           invalid, void, voidable or unenforceable.

         20.2     Each of such insurances shall:

                  20.2.1   be taken out in the joint names of the Borrower and
                           the Security Agent for and on behalf of the Lenders
                           or be noted, by indorsement on such insurances (in
                           such form as may be acceptable to the Lenders), with
                           the interest of the Beneficiaries;

                  20.2.2   contain a non-cancellation clause, a mortgage
                           interest clause and a loss payee or beneficiary
                           clause in favor of the Security Agent for and on
                           behalf of the Lenders;







<PAGE>   58

                                      -57-



                  20.2.3   acknowledge that the Borrower is the sole party
                           liable to pay the premium in respect thereof;

                  20.2.4   provide for the insurers or underwriters to pay to
                           the Security Agent at least thirty (30) days' prior
                           notice of cancellation by reason of non-payment of
                           calls, premiums or otherwise and allow the security
                           Agent or the Lenders an opportunity of paying such
                           calls or premiums which may be in default;

                  20.2.5   provide that they may not be altered or amended
                           without the prior consent in writing of the Security
                           Agent;

                  20.2.6   acknowledge that all proceeds shall, irrespective of
                           any other provisions therein contained, be paid to
                           the Security Agent without deduction, set-off or
                           counterclaim in respect of any outstanding premiums
                           or calls on it. The Security Agent (acting on the
                           instructions of the Instructing Group) may require
                           any money received on any insurance be applied in or
                           towards making good the loss or damage in respect of
                           which money is received or receivable or in or
                           towards discharge of any principal sum, interest,
                           default interest or any other monies payable
                           hereunder or under any of the other Security
                           Documents and the Security Agent may give a good
                           discharge for any such monies and any balance
                           remaining after discharging all monies payable
                           hereunder or under the other Security Documents,
                           shall be refunded to the Borrower; and

                  20.2.7   be in all other respects in form and substance
                           acceptable to the Security Agent.

                  Each of such insurances shall also contain a loss payee and
                  notice of cancellation clause, a notice of assignment signed
                  in accordance with the relevant policy rules and such other
                  terms and conditions as the Lenders may require, all such
                  provisions to be in form and substance acceptable to the
                  Lenders.






<PAGE>   59

                                      -58-



         21.      AGENCY PROVISIONS
                  -----------------

         21.1     Each of the Arrangers and the Lenders hereby appoint each of
                  the Facility Agent and the Security Agent to act as its agent
                  in connection with the Security Documents and authorizes each
                  Agent to exercise such rights, powers and discretions as are
                  specifically delegated to such Agent by the terms hereof and
                  of any other Security Document together with such other
                  rights, powers and discretions as are reasonably incidental
                  thereto.

         21.2     The Beneficiaries agree that each Agent may:

                  21.2.1   assume that:

                           (a)      any representation made by any person in
                                    connection with any Security Document is
                                    true;

                           (b)      no event which is an Event of Default or
                                    Potential Event of Default has occurred; and

                           (c)      no person is in breach of or default of its
                                    obligations under any Security Document
                                    unless it has actual knowledge or actual
                                    notice to the contrary;

                  21.2.2   assume that the Facility Office of each Lender is
                           that identified in the Schedule (or, in the case of a
                           Transferee, at the end of the Transfer Certificate to
                           which it is a party as Transferee) until it has
                           received from such Lender a notice designating some
                           other office of such Lender to replace its Facility
                           Office and act upon any such notice until the same is
                           superseded by a further such notice;

                  21.2.3   engage and pay for the advice or services of any
                           lawyers, accountants, surveyors or other experts
                           whose advice or services may to it seem necessary,
                           expedient or desirable and rely upon any advice so
                           obtained;

                  21.2.4   rely as to any matters of fact which might reasonably
                           be expected to be within the knowledge of any person
                           upon a certificate signed by or on behalf of any
                           person;









<PAGE>   60

                                      -59-





                  21.2.5   rely upon any communication or document believed by
                           it to be genuine;

                  21.2.6   refrain from exercising any right, power or
                           discretion vested in it as agent under Security
                           Document unless and until instructed by the
                           Instructing Group as to whether or not such right,
                           power or discretion is to be exercised and, if it is
                           to be exercised, as to the manner in which it should
                           be exercised; and

                  21.2.6   refrain from acting in accordance with any
                           instructions of an Instructing Group to begin any
                           legal action or proceeding arising out of or in
                           connection with any Security Document until it shall
                           have received such security as it may require
                           (whether by way of payment in advance or otherwise)
                           for all costs, claims, expenses (including legal
                           fees) and liabilities which it will or may expend or
                           incur in complying with such instructions.


         21.3     The Facility Agent shall:

                  21.3.1   promptly inform each Lender of the contents of any
                           notice or document received by it from the Borrower
                           or the Security Agent hereunder;

                  21.3.2   promptly notify each Lender of the occurrence of any
                           Event of Default or any default by the Borrower in
                           the due performance of or compliance with its
                           obligations under this Agreement of which the
                           Facility Agent has actual knowledge or actual notice;

                  21.3.3   save as otherwise provided herein, act in accordance
                           with any instructions given to it by the Instructing
                           Group, which instructions shall be binding on the
                           Arranger and the Lenders; and

                  21.3.4   if so instructed by the Instructing Group, refrain
                           from exercising any right, power or discretion vested
                           in it as agent hereunder.





<PAGE>   61

                                      -60-



         21.4     Not withstanding anything to the contrary expressed or implied
                  herein, none of the Agents or Arranger shall:

                  21.4.1   be bound to enquire as to:

                           (a)      whether or not any representation made by
                                    any person in connection herewith or with
                                    the Security Documents is true;

                           (b)      the occurrence or otherwise of any event
                                    which is or may become an Event of Default;

                           (c)      the performance by any person of its
                                    obligations under any Security Documents; or

                           (d)      any breach of or default by any person of or
                                    under its obligations under any Security
                                    Document;


                  21.4.2   be bound to account to any Lender for any sum or the
                           profit element of any sum received by it for its own
                           account;

                  21.4.3   be bound to disclose to any other person any
                           information relating to the Borrower if such
                           disclosure would or might in its opinion constitute a
                           breach of any law or regulation or be otherwise
                           actionable at the suit of any person; or

                  21.4.4   be under any obligations other than those for which
                           express provision is made herein.

         21.5     Each Lender shall from time to time on demand by an Agent,
                  indemnify such Agent, in the proportion its share of its
                  Lender's Outstanding Amounts (or, if no drawdown has been
                  made, its Lender's Commitment) bears to the amount of the
                  Lenders Outstanding Amounts (or, if no drawdown has been made,
                  the aggregate amount of the Commitments) at the time of such
                  demand (or, if the Lender's Outstanding Amounts has then been
                  repaid in full, immediately prior to the final repayment
                  thereof), against any and all costs, claims, expenses
                  (including legal fees)










<PAGE>   62

                                      -61-



                  and liabilities which such Agent may incur, otherwise than by
                  reason of its own gross negligence or willful misconduct, in
                  acting in its capacity as agent hereunder or under any
                  Security Document.

         21.6     None of the Agents or the Arranger accepts any responsibility
                  for the accuracy and/or completeness of any information
                  supplied by the Borrower in connection herewith or for the
                  legality, validity, effectiveness, adequacy or enforceability
                  of any Security Document and none of the Agents or the
                  Arranger shall be under any liability as a result of taking or
                  omitting to take any action in relation to this Agreement or
                  any other Security Documents save in the case of gross
                  negligence or willful misconduct.

         21.7     Each of the Lenders agrees that it will not assert or seek to
                  assert against any director, officer or employee of any Agent
                  or the arranger any claim it might have against any of them in
                  respect of the matters referred to in Clause 21.6.

         21.8     The Agent may resign its appointment hereunder at any time
                  without assigning any reason therefor by giving not less than
                  thirty (30) days' prior written notice to that effect to each
                  of the other parties hereto Provided that no such resignation
                  shall be effective until a successor for such Agent is
                  appointed in accordance with the succeeding provisions of this
                  Clause 21.

         21.9     Any Agent may resign its appointment hereunder at any time
                  without assigning any reason therefor by giving not less than
                  thirty (30) days' prior written notice to that effect to each
                  of the other parties hereto Provided that no such resignation
                  shall be effective until a successor for such Agent is
                  appointed in accordance with the succeeding provisions of this
                  Clause 21.

         21.10    If an Agent gives notice of its resignation pursuant to Clause
                  21.9, then any reputable and experienced bank or other
                  financial institution may be appointed as a successor to such
                  Agent by the Instructing Group (or failing such appointment
                  during the period of such notice, by the Agent itself) with
                  the consent of the Borrower which consent shall not be
                  unreasonably withheld or delayed.

         21.11    If a successor to such Agent is appointed under the provisions
                  of Clause 21.10 then (i) the retiring Agent shall be
                  discharged from any further obligation hereunder but shall
                  remain entitled to the benefit of the provisions of this
                  Clause 21 and (ii) its successor and each of the other Parties
                  hereto shall have the same rights and 







<PAGE>   63

                                      -62-


                  obligations amongst themselves as they would have had if such
                  successor had been a party hereto.

         21.12    It is understood and agreed by each Lender that it has itself
                  been, and will continue to be, solely responsible for making
                  its own independent appraisal of and investigations into the
                  financial condition creditworthiness, condition affairs,
                  status and nature of the Borrower and, accordingly, each
                  Lender warrants to the Agents and the Arranger or any of them;

                  21.12.1  to check or enquire on its behalf into the adequacy,
                           accuracy or completeness of any information provided
                           by any person in connection with any Security
                           Document or the transactions herein contemplated
                           (whether circulated to such Lender by any Agent or
                           Arranger); or

                  21.12.2  to assess or keep under review on its behalf the
                           financial condition, creditworthiness, condition,
                           affairs, status or nature of the Borrower.

         21.13    The Facility Agent may at any time without the consent of the
                  Lenders or the Instructing Group, but only if and in so far as
                  such matters are purely technical or mechanical and which will
                  not have a material commercial effect on the transaction or
                  relate to the correction of a manifest error, grant any
                  consent under this Agreement or waive on such terms and
                  subject to such conditions as it shall think fit and proper
                  any requirement of this Agreement or any breach by the
                  Borrower of any of the covenants or other provisions of this
                  Agreement and in all such circumstances the Facility Agent
                  will not be deemed to be acting unreasonably or with undue
                  delay if it seeks the instructions of the Instructing Group
                  before taking any such action. Any such consent, waiver or
                  agreement shall be binding on the Lenders.



22.      ASSIGNMENT AND TRANSFERS
         ------------------------

22.1     Benefit of Agreement
         --------------------

         This Agreement shall be binding upon and ensure to the benefit of each
         Party hereto and its successors and assigns.





<PAGE>   64
                                      -63-



22.2     Assignments and Transfers by the Borrower
         -----------------------------------------

         The Borrower shall not be entitled to assign or transfer all or any of
         its rights, benefits and obligations hereunder.

22.3     Assignments and Transfers by Lenders
         ------------------------------------

22.3.1   Any Lender may at any time assign all or any of its rights and benefits
         hereunder and under the Security Documents or transfer in accordance
         with Clause 22.4 all or any of its rights, benefits and obligations
         hereunder and under the Security Documents to a company which is its
         subsidiary or holding company or to any other financial institution
         without any consent.

22.3.2   If any Lender assigns all or any of its rights and benefits hereunder
         in accordance with Clause 22.3.1, then, unless and until the assignee
         has agreed with the Beneficiaries that it shall be under the same
         obligations towards each of them as it would have been under if it had
         been an original party hereto as a Lender, the Beneficiaries shall not
         be obliged to recognize such assignee as having the rights against each
         of them which it would have had if it had been such a party hereto.

22.4     If any Lender wishes to transfer all or any of its rights, benefits
         and/or obligations hereunder as contemplated in Clause 22.3.1, then
         such transfer may be effected by the delivery to the Facility Agent of
         a duly completed and duly executed Transfer Certificate in which event,
         on this later of the Transfer Date specified in such Transfer
         Certificate and the fifth (5th) Ringgit Business Day after (or such
         earlier Ringgit Business Day endorsed by the Facility Agent on such
         "Transfer Certificate failing on or after) the date of delivery of such
         Transfer Certificate to the Facility Agent:

         22.4.1   to the extent that in such Transfer Certificate the Lender
                  party thereto seeks to transfer its rights and obligations
                  hereunder, the Borrower and such Lender shall each be released
                  from further obligations to the other hereunder and their
                  respective rights against each other shall be cancelled (such
                  rights and obligations being referred to in this Clause 22.4
                  as "discharged rights and obligations);

         22.4.2   the Borrower and the Transferee party thereto shall each
                  assume obligations towards each other and/or acquire rights
                  against each other which differ from such discharged rights
                  and obligations only insofar as the Borrower and such
                  Transferee have assumed and/or acquired the same in place of
                  the Borrower and such Lender; and

         22.4.3   The facility Agent, the Arranger, such Transferee and the
                  other Lenders shall acquire the same rights and assume the
                  same 






<PAGE>   65

                                      -64-



                  obligations between themselves as they would have acquired and
                  assumed had such Transferee been an original party hereto as a
                  Lender with the rights and/or obligations acquired or assumed
                  by it as a result of such transfer

22.5     Any Beneficiary may at any time change its Facility Office by giving
         written notice of such change to the Agents and the Borrower.



23.      MISCELLANEOUS
         -------------

23.1     Modification and Indulgence
         ---------------------------

         The Beneficiaries may in their absolute discretion at any time and
         without in any way affecting any of their powers, rights or remedies
         conferred herein or in any of the other Security Documents or affecting
         the security thereunder:

         23.1.1   determine, vary or increase any of the approved sub-limits,
                  exceed or allow the Borrower to exceed such sub-limit and may
                  open and/or continue any account or accounts for the Borrower
                  and the Borrower hereby expressly consents to any such
                  reduction, determination, variation and/or increase as may be
                  effected or determined by the Beneficiaries;

         23.1.2   vary or depart from the terms and conditions in the Security
                  Documents governing the Facilities or any of them (however
                  substantial) but such variation or departure shall not
                  increase the Borrower's obligations under the Security
                  Documents without the Borrower's written consent;

         23.1.3   grant to the Borrower, or any surety or guarantor any time or
                  indulgence;

         23.1.4   renew any bills, notes or other negotiable securities;

         23.1.5   deal with, exchange, release or modify or abstain from
                  perfecting or enforcing any securities or guarantees or rights
                  they may now or at any time hereafter or from time to time
                  have (including any under the Security Documents) from or
                  against the Borrower or any other person; or

23.2     Waiver
         ------

         No waiver by the Beneficiaries or any of them of the Borrower's
         compliance with any of the provisions in any of the Security Documents
         or of any of the conditions precedent to utilisation or to drawdown
         shall affect the Borrower's






<PAGE>   66

                                      -65-



         obligation to subsequently comply with all provisions of such Security
         Doicuments ot to comply with all he conditions precedent for any
         subsequent utilisation or drawdown. No failure or delay on the part of
         the Beneficiaries or any of them in exercising nor any omission to
         exercise any right, power, privilege or remedy accruing to them under
         the Security Documents upon any default on the part of the Borrower
         shall impair any such right, power, privilege or remedy or be construed
         as a waiver thereof or an acquiescence in such default, affect or
         impair any of their right, power, privilege or remedy in respect of any
         other or subsequent default.



24.      Costs and Expenses
         ------------------

24.1     The Borrower shall, from time to time on demand of the Facility Agent,
         reimburse the agents and the Arranger for all reasonable costs and
         expenses (including legal fees) incurred by them in connection with the
         negotiation, preparation and execution of this Agreement and the
         completion of the transaction herein contemplated.

24.2     The Borrower shall, from time to time on demand of the Facility Agent,
         reimburse the for all costs and expenses (including legal fees)
         reasonably incurred by any of them in or in connection with the
         preservation and/or enforcement of any of the rights of the
         Beneficiaries under this Agreement and each of the Security Documents.

24.3     The Borrower shall pay all stamp, registration and other documentary
         duties to which this Agreement or any Security Document or any judgment
         given in connection herewith or therewith is or at any time may be
         subject in Malaysia an shall, from time to time within ten (10) days of
         demand by the Facility Agent, indemnify each Beneficiary against any
         liabilities, costs, claims and expenses resulting from any failure to
         pay or any delay in paying any such tax.



25.      Liens and other Securities not Affected
         ---------------------------------------

         Nothing herein contained shall prejudice or affect any lien to which
         the Beneficiaries are entitled or any other securities which the
         Beneficiaries may at any time or from time to time hold for or on
         account of the monies advanced hereunder nor shall anything herein
         contained operate so as to merge or otherwise prejudice or affect any
         bill, note or guarantee, mortgage or other security which the
         Beneficiaries may for the time being have for any money intended to be
         hereby or otherwise secured or any right or remedy of the Beneficiaries
         thereunder.






<PAGE>   67

                                      -66-



26.      Calculations and Evidence of Debt
         ---------------------------------

26.1     The Facility Agent shall maintain on its books a control account or
         accounts in which shall be recorded (i) the amount of the drawdown made
         or arising hereunder and each Lender's share therein, (ii) the amount
         of all principal, interest and other sums due or to become due from the
         borrower to any of the Lenders hereunder and each Lender's share
         therein and (iii) the amount of any sum received or recovered by the
         Facility Agent hereunder and each Lender's share therein.

26.2     In any legal action or proceeding arising out of or in connection with
         this Agreement, the entries made in the accounts maintained pursuant
         to Clause 26.1 shall be prima facie evidence of the existence and
         amounts of the obligations of the Borrower therein recorded.



27.      Disclosure
         ----------

         The Borrower hereby expressly authorizes the Agents, the Arranger and
         the Lenders to furnish all relevant information pertaining to the
         Facilities to the Central Credit Bureau of BNM whenever requested to do
         so in writing from time to time pursuant to any applicable regulation
         or directive (whether having the force of law or otherwise), to the
         BBMB Group or to any potential Transferees and they shall not be liable
         for furnishing such information.



28.      Governing Law
         -------------

         The Security Documents shall be governed by and construed in all
         respects in accordance with the laws of Malaysia and the Parties hereby
         submit to the jurisdiction of the Courts of Malaysia in all matters
         connected with the obligations and liabilities of the parties under the
         Security Documents.



29.      Notices
         -------

29.1     Each communication to be made hereunder shall be made in writing but,
         unless otherwise stated, may be made by telex, facsimile or letter.

29.2     Any communication or document to be made or delivered by one person to
         another pursuant to this Agreement shall (unless that other person has
         by fifteen (15) days' written notice to the Facility agent specified
         another address) be made 







<PAGE>   68

                                      -67-



         or delivered to that other person at the address identified herein or,
         in the case of a Transferee, at the end of the Transfer Certificate to
         which it is a party as Transferee.

29.3     Any communication or document made or delivered under Clause 29.1
         hereof shall be deemed to have been made or delivered:

         29.3.1   in the case of delivery in person, at the time of delivery;

         29.3.2   in the case of prepaid registered post, five (5) days after
                  the date of posting or where posted to an address outside
                  Malaysia, seven (7) days after the date of posting;

         29.3.3   in the case of telex on receipt by the sender of the
                  answer-back code of the recipient at the end of the
                  transmission; and

         29.3.4   in the case of telegram or facsimile, within twenty-four (24)
                  hours after the time of transmission by the sender to be
                  authenticated by the receipt by the sender of a transmission
                  controlled report appearing on its face to emanate from the
                  sender's machine showing the relevant number of pages, the
                  correct facsimile number of the recipient and the result of
                  the transmission being described as "O.K." or any equivalent
                  description indicating that the communication has been
                  properly transmitted. The original of the notice demand or
                  request so sent by facsimile shall be forwarded to the
                  receiving party by prepaid registered post.

         Provided That any communication or document to be made or delivered to
         the Facility Agent shall be effective only when received by the
         Facility Agent.



30.      Agreement to Prevail
         --------------------

         In the event of any conflict between the provisions of this Agreement
         and any of the other Security Documents, the provisions of this
         Agreement shall prevail.



31.      Severability
         ------------

         Any condition, term, stipulation, covenant or undertaking of this
         Agreement which is illegal, prohibited or unenforceable shall be
         ineffective to the extent of such illegality, voidness, prohibition or
         unenforceability without invalidating or impairing the remaining
         provisions hereof.



<PAGE>   69

                                      -68-



32.      Concurrent Actions
         ------------------

         In the event of the Borrower defaulting in payment of any sums due or
         payable hereunder whether or not a demand is required or has been made
         or in the event of the Borrower failing to observe or perform any of
         the provisions of this Agreement it shall be lawful for the Security
         Agent forthwith to institute such lawful for the Security Agent
         forthwith to institute such proceedings and take such steps as it may
         think fit to enforce or exercise of all or any of the rights and
         remedies available whether under all or some of the Security Documents
         or by statute or otherwise and the Security Agent shall be entitled to
         exercise such rights and remedies concurrently.



33.      Time of the Essence
         -------------------

         Time wherever mentioned herein, shall be of the essence of this
         Agreement.



34.      Choice of Legal Remedy
         ----------------------

         The Beneficiaries shall be entitled to recover from the Borrower all
         sums payable by the Borrower under the Facilities without first
         availing itself of its legal remedies under this Agreement or the other
         Security Documents or against any other security which the
         Beneficiaries may now or at any time hereafter or from time to time
         have from or again person.



35.      Principal & Subsidiary Instruments
         ----------------------------------

         It is hereby declared and agreed:

         35.1     this Agreement;

         35.2     the Debenture;

         35.3     the Assignment;

         35.4     the Charge;

         35.5     the Corporate Guarantee; and

         35.6     the Security Agency Agreement;







<PAGE>   70

                                      -69-



         are instruments employed in one transaction within the meaning of
         Section 4(3) of the Stamp Act, 1949 (Consolidated and Revised 1989) to
         secure one aggregate principal sum comprising:

         (i)      TL I Facility of up to RM29,200,000.00;

         (ii)     Dollar Advances Facility of up to USD4,000,000.00;

         (iii)    Dollar RC Facility of up to USD2,00,000.00;

         (iv)     Working Capital Facilities of up to RM5,900,000.00;

         and respective interest thereon and for the purpose of the said Section
         this Agreement is deemed to be the Principal Instrument and the other
         documents the Subsidiary Instruments.







<PAGE>   71
                                      -70-



      IN WITNESS WHEREOF the parties hereto have hereunto set their hands and
seal the day and year first above written.



The Common Seal of ZYCON 
CORPORATION SDN. BHD. was hereunto 
affixed in the presence of :


- ----------------------------------      -------------------------------------

Director                                *Director/Secretary





SIGNED by

for and on behalf of
BANK BUMPUTRA MALAYSIA BERHAD
as Arranger in the presence of:





SIGNED by

for and on behalf of
BANK BUMPUTRA MALAYSIA BERHAD
as Working Capital Lender
in the presence of:







<PAGE>   72

                                      -71-




SIGNED by

for and on behalf of
BANK BUMPUTRA MALAYSIA BERHAD
as Lender Bank
in the presence of:




SIGNED by

for and on behalf of
BBMB Kewangan Berhad
as Lending Bank 
in the presence of:




SIGNED by

for and on behalf of
BANK BUMIPUTRA MALAYSIA BERHAD
as Funding Lender
in the presence of:




<PAGE>   73

                                      -72-




SIGNED by

for and on behalf of
BANK BUMIPUTRA MALAYSIA BERHAD
as Facility Agent
in the presence of:





SIGNED by

for and on behalf of
BANK BUMIPUTRA MALAYSIA BERHAD
as Security Agent
in the presence of:








<PAGE>   74


<TABLE>

                                                         SCHEDULE 1
                                                         ----------

                                               LENDER AND LENDERS COMMITMENTS

<CAPTION>

                            Column 1                Column 2                Column 3                Column 4

                            Working Cap             Ringgit Malaysia        Dollar Advances         Dollar RC
under                       Commitment              Commitment              Commitment              Commitment
- -----                       ----------              ----------              ----------              ----------

<S>                         <C>                     <C>                     <C>                     <C>         
8MB BUMIPUTRA               RM5,900,000.00          RM14,600,000.00          USD4,000,000.00         USD2,000,000.00
MALAYSIA 
BERHAD
Negara Bumiputra
Alan Melaka
0100 Kuala Lumpur

Telex: PUTRA MA  28065
Facsimile: 2914967
</TABLE>




<PAGE>   75
                                      -2-


<TABLE>

                                                     SCHEDULE 1 (Cont.2)
                                                     -------------------

                                               LENDER AND LENDERS COMMITMENTS

<CAPTION>

                            Column 1                Column 2                Column 3                Column 4

                            Working Cap             Ringgit Malaysia        Dollar Advances         Dollar RC
under                       Commitment              Commitment              Commitment              Commitment
- -----                       ----------              ----------              ----------              ----------

<S>                         <C>                     <C>                     <C>                     <C>         


8MB KEWANGAN                                        RM14,600,000.00
BERHAD
First Floor
Benara Promet
Alan Sultan Ismail
8250 Kuala Lumpur

Telex:   -
Facsimile: 2451155

                            ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------

                            RM5,900,000.00          RM29,200,000.00         USD4,000,000.00         USD2,000,000.00
</TABLE>




<PAGE>   76


  

                                   SCHEDULE 2
                                   ----------

                              CONDITIONS PRECEDENT
                              --------------------
       
1.       Corporate Authorisation
         -----------------------

         In relation to the Borrower:
         ---------------------------
 
1.1      A copy of the following documents, certified as true by a director or
         the company secretary of the Borrower:

         (a)      the certificate of incorporation of the Borrower;

         (b)      the Memorandum and Articles of Associations of the Borrower;
                  and

         (c)      the latest Forms 24 and 49 relating to the Borrower filed with
                  the Registrar of Companies

1.1      A copy, certified as true by a director or the company secretary of the
         Borrower, of a board of directors' resolution approving the execution,
         delivery and performance of this Agreement and the other Security
         Documents to which it is a party and to authorise appropriate person(s)
         to execute, affix the Common Seal of the Borrower or such documents,
         give any communications and take any other action required under or in
         connection with this Agreement or such other Security Documents.

1.3      Passport number(s)/identification card number(s) and specimen
         signatures of the person(s) authorised to take action on behalf of the
         Borrower as referred to in paragraph 1.2 above.

         In relation to the Corporate Guarantor:

1.4      A certified true copy of its Articles of Incorporation and Bylaws.

1.5      A certified true copy of its board of directors' resolution authorising
         the execution of the Corporate Guarantee and the person or persons
         authorized to execute, affix the Common Seal of the Corporate Guarantor
         on the Corporate Guarantee.

2.       Authorization and Consents
         --------------------------

2.1      A certified true copy of each authorisation, consent, licence, approval
         or registration required by the Borrower for the borrowing the
         Facilities (including but without limitation, (1) all approvals of Bank
         Negara Malaysia as may be 







<PAGE>   77

                                      -2-



         required by or pursuant to the laws and directives in force or as may
         be appropriate in relation to the execution, performance and
         enforcement of this Agreement and the other Security Documents to which
         it is a party and (2) evidence of a report to Bank Negara Malaysia of
         such information relating to this Agreement, the other Security
         Documents to which it is a party and such other information as may be
         required by or pursuant to the laws and directions is force.

2.2      A certified true of each authorization, consent, licence, approval or
         registration required by the Corporate Guarantor for the issuing of the
         Corporate Guarantee (including but without limitation, all approvals of
         Bank Negara Malaysia as may be required by or pursuant to the laws and
         directives in force or as may be appropriate in relation to the
         execution, performance and enforcement of the Corporate Guarantee).

3.       Security Documents
         ------------------
 
3.1      Certified true copies of each of the Security Documents duly executed
         by each party thereto, and where appropriate, duly stamped and
         presented for registration with all appropriate authorities.

4.       Paid-up Capital of Borrower/Debt to Equity Ratio
         ------------------------------------------------

4.1      Evidence acceptable to Facility Agent that Guarantor has made loans to
         Borrower as set forth on Schedule 8.

4.2      Evidence acceptable to the Facility Agent that the debt equity ratio as
         defined in paragraph 19.1.14 of the Borrower is maintained at not more
         than 3:1.

5.       Letter of Undertaking from the Contractor
         -----------------------------------------

5.1      Irrevocable letter of undertaking from the Contractor in form and
         substance satisfactory to the Facility Agent when the Contractor
         undertakes to forward to the Facility Agent Certificate of Fitness for
         Occupation issued by the relevant authority in respect of the factory
         and/or such other building or structure constructed by the Contractor
         on the Land.

6.       Letter of Undertaking from the Corporate Guarantor
         --------------------------------------------------

6.1      Irrevocable and unconditional letter of undertaking from Corporate
         Guarantor to meet any costs over-run incurred and the construction
         period of the factory for the Borrower.






<PAGE>   78

                                      -3-



7.       Opinion
         -------

7.1      Opinion of Messrs. Skrine & Co., the Solicitors to the Lenders, in form
         and substance satisfactory to the Facility Agent.

7.2      Opinion (in a form and substance satisfactory to the Facility Agent) of
         a firm of solicitors to the Corporate Guarantor which is acceptable to
         the Lenders, as to such matters relating to the Corporate Guarantor and
         the Corporate Guarantee.

8.       Letter of Undertaking from the Borrower
         ---------------------------------------

8.1      Irrevocable Letter of Undertaking from the Borrower:

         (1)      to comply with all terms and conditions set out in the Land
                  Letter of Offer and Acceptance promptly;

         (2)      confirming that the Shareholders Loan shall be free of
                  interest;

         (3)      not to vary any repayments in respect of the Shareholders
                  Loan; and

         (4)      to convert the Shareholders Loan to paid-up capital on the
                  acquisition of the new plant and machinery.











<PAGE>   79



                                   SCHEDULE 3
                                   ----------


                           WORKING CAPITAL FACILITIES
                           --------------------------
 
1.       Revolving Credit Facility

         Interest Rate -            1.75% per annum above the Effective Cost of
                                    Funds of the Working Capital Lender.

2.       Letters of Credit Facility

         Interest Rate -            as stipulated in Clause 4.4.4 of this
                                    Agreement

         Commission -               0.15% on the amount of each letter of credit
                                    issued for each month or part thereof
                                    payable in advance but subject to a minimum
                                    charge of RM50.00 for each letter of credit
                                    issued.

3.       Trust Receipts Facility

         Interest Rate -            1.75% per annum above the Base Lending Rate
                                    of the Working Capital Lender.

         Commission -               1.0% per annum on each bankers acceptance
                                    created on the face value of the bankers
                                    acceptance from the date of creation up to
                                    the date of maturity.

5.       Export Credit Refinancing Facility 
         (Pre-shipment and Post-shipment)

         Interest Rate -            1.0% per annum above the prevailing Bank
                                    Negara Malaysia (BNM) discount rate or such
                                    other rate as may be determined by BNM from
                                    time to time.

6.       Letter of Guarantee

         Commission -               0.1% per month or part thereof on the amount
                                    guaranteed or issued but subject to a
                                    minimum charge of RM50.00, such commission
                                    to be payable immediately upon issuance of
                                    each guarantee and for every extension
                                    thereafter.





<PAGE>   80




                                   SCHEDULE 4
                                   ----------

                       FORM OF REQUEST FOR RINGGIT ADVANCE
                       -----------------------------------

To:  BANK BUMIPUTRA MALAYSIA BERHAD
    [address]



For the attention of: [name and title of relevant person]


Dear Sirs,

      Zycon Corporation Sdn. Bhd.
      RM50,400,000.00 Facility Agreement
      dated                   1996
      ----------------------------------


We refer to the above Agreement between (1) ourselves, as Borrower, (2)
yourselves as Arranger, (3) the Working Capital Lender named therein, as Working
Capital Lender, (4) the Lending Banks named therein, as Lending Banks, (5) the
Funding Lender named therein, as Funding Lender, (6) yourselves, as Facility
Agent, and (7) yourselves, as Security Agent. Terms defined in the Agreement
have the same meaning in this notice.

We give you notice that we request a Ringgit Advance to be made to us by the
Lending Banks under the Agreement as follows:

(1)  Amount                        :      [RM        ]

(2)  Date of Ringgit Advance       :      ,19    (or, if  that is not a Ringgit
                                          Business Day, the next succeeding
                                          Ringgit Business Day).


We confirm that no Event of Default or Potential Event of Default in relation to
ourselves or has occurred or will occur as a result of the making of that
Ringgit Advance, we represent and warrant that the representations and
warranties contained in Clause 18 of the Agreement have been complied with and
would be correct in all respects if repeated today by reference to the
circumstances now existing and we confirm that all the undertakings on our part
contained in Clause 19 and 20 of the Agreement have been fully performed and
observed by us.



<PAGE>   81
                                      -2-





You are requested to make the proceeds of that Ringgit Advance available to us
by credit to [details of bank accounts].



Dated       19

                                          Yours faithfully,
                                          For and on behalf of
                                          ZYCON CORPORATION SDN. BHD

                                          By:

                                          Name:

                                          Title:


















<PAGE>   82




                                   SCHEDULE 5
                                   ----------

                       FORM OF REQUEST FOR DOLLAR ADVANCE
                       ----------------------------------
 


To:  BANK BUMIPUTRA MALAYSIA BERHAD
    [address]



For the attention of: [name and title of relevant person]


Dear Sirs,

      Zycon Corporation Sdn. Bhd.
      RM50,400,000.00 Facility Agreement
      dated                   1996
      ----------------------------------


We refer to the above Agreement between (1) ourselves, as Borrower, (2)
yourselves as Arranger, (3) the Working Capital Lender named therein, as Working
Capital Lender, (4) the Lending Banks named therein, as Lending Banks, (5) the
Funding Lender named therein, as Funding Lender, (6) yourselves, as Facility
Agent, and (7) yourselves, as Security Agent. Terms defined in the Agreement
have the same meaning in this notice.

We give you notice that we request a Dollar Advance to be made to us by the
Funding Lender under the Agreement as follows:

(1)  Amount                   :      [USD       ]

(2)  Date of Dollar Advance   :      ,19    (or, if  that is not a Dollar
                                     Business Day, the next succeeding
                                     Dollar Business Day).

(3)  Period                   :      [1, 3 or 6 months]


We confirm that no Event of Default or Potential Event of Default in relation to
ourselves or any Security Party has occurred or will occur as a result of the
making of that Dollar Advance, we represent and warrant that the representations
and warranties contained in Clause 18 of the Agreement have been complied with
and would be correct in all respects if repeated today by reference to the
circumstances now existing and we confirm that all the undertakings on our part
contained in Clause 19 and 20 of the Agreement have been fully performed and
observed by us.






<PAGE>   83

                                      -2-


You are requested to make the proceeds of that Dollar Advance available to us by
credit to [details of bank accounts].


Dated       19

                                          Yours faithfully,
                                          For and on behalf of
                                          ZYCON CORPORATION SDN. BHD.

                                          By:

                                          Name:

                                          Title:
















<PAGE>   84


                                   SCHEDULE 6
                                   ----------

                     FORMS OF REQUEST FOR DOLLAR RC DRAWDOWN
                     ---------------------------------------



TO:   BANK BUMIPUTRA MALAYSIA BERHAD
      [   address    ]




      For the attention of: [name and title of relevant person]



Dear Sirs:

      Zycon Corporation Sdn. Bhd.
      RM50,400,000.00 Facility Agreement
      dated                            1996
      -------------------------------------


We refer to the above Agreement between (1) ourselves, as Borrower, (2)
yourselves as Arranger, (3) the Working Capital Lender named therein, as Working
Capital Lender, (4) the Lending Banks named therein, as Lending Banks, (5) the
Funding Lender named therein, as Funding Lender, (6) yourselves, as Facility
Agent, and (7) yourselves, as Security Agent. Terms defined in the Agreement
have the same meaning in this notice.

We give you notice that we request a Dollar RC Drawdown to be made to us by the
Funding Lender under the Agreement as follows:

(1)   Amount                   :  [  USD      ]

(2)   Date of Dollar
      RC Drawdown              :         19 (or, if
                                 that is not a Dollar Business Day, the next
                                 succeeding Dollar Business Day).

(3)   Period                   :  [1, 3 or 6 months]


We confirm that no Event or Default or Potential Event of Default in relation to
ourselves or any Security Party has occurred or will occur as a result of the
making of that Dollar RC Drawdown, we represent and warrant that the
representations and warranties contained in Clause 18 of the Agreement have been
complied with and would be correct in all respects if repeated today by
reference to the circumstances now existing and we confirm that all the
undertakings on our part contained in Clause 19 and 20 of the Agreement have
been fully performed and observed by us.






<PAGE>   85

                                      -2-




We enclose the Promissory Note for the proposed Dollar RC Drawdown. You are
requested to make the proceeds of that Dollar RC Drawdown available to us by
credit to [details of bank account].

Dated             1997.


                                    Yours faithfully,
                                    for and on behalf of
                                    ZYCON CORPORATION SDN. BHD.




                                          By:

                                          Name:

                                          Title:








<PAGE>   86


                                   SCHEDULE 7
                                   ----------               

                          FORM OF TRANSFER CERTIFICATE
                          ----------------------------


TO:   [Facility Agent]
      [Address]




                              TRANSFER CERTIFICATE
                              --------------------

 
relating to an agreement (as from time to time amended, varied, novated or
supplemented, "the Facilities Agreement") dated         19   and made between 
(1) ZYCON CORPORATION SDN. BHD. as borrower (2) BANK BUMIPUTRA MALAYSIA BERHAD
as Arranger, Facility Agent and Security Agent and (3) the Lenders listed in
Schedule 1 thereto.

1.    Terms defined in the Facilities Agreement shall, subject to any contrary
      indication, have the same meaning herein. The terms Lender, Transferee,
      Lender's Participation and Amount Transferred are defined in the Schedule
      hereto.

2.    The Lender confirms that the Lender's Participation is an accurate summary
      of its participation in the Facilitation specified in the Facilities
      Agreement and request the Transferee to accept and procure the transfer to
      the Transferee of a percentage of the Lender's Participation (equal to the
      percentage that the Amount Transferred is of the aggregate of the
      component amounts (as set out in the schedule hereto) of the Lender's
      Participation) by counter-signing and delivering this Transfer Certificate
      to the Facility Agent at its address for the service of notices specified
      in the facilities Agreement.

3.    The Transferee hereby requests the Facility Agent to accept this Transfer
      Certificate as being delivered to the Facility Agent pursuant to and for
      the purposes of Clause 22.4 of the Facilities Agreement so as to take
      effect in accordance with the terms thereof on the Transfer Date or on
      such later date as may be determined in accordance with the terms thereof.

4.    The Transferee warrants that:

      (I)   it has received a copy of the Facilities Agreement and each Security
            Document together with such other information as it has required in
            connection with this transaction and that it has not relied and will
            not hereafter rely on the Lender to check or inquire on its behalf
            into the legality, validity, effectiveness, adequacy, accuracy or
            completeness of any such information and further agrees that it has
            not relied and will not rely on the Lender to assess or keep under
            review on its 






<PAGE>   87

                                      -2-



            behalf the financial condition, creditworthiness, condition, 
            affairs, status or nature of the Borrower; and

      (ii)  it is a transferee permitted by Clause 22.3.1 of the Facilities 
            Agreement.

      The Transferee expressly acknowledges that its execution and delivery of
      the Transfer Certificate constitutes its contractual acceptance of the
      offer to become a party to the Security Agency Agreement.

5.    The Transferee hereby undertakes with the Lender and each of the other
      parties to the Facilities Agreement and the Security Agency Agreement that
      it will perform in accordance with their terms all those obligations which
      by the terms of the Facilities Agreement and the Security Agency Agreement
      will be assumed by it after delivery of this Transfer Certificate to the
      Facility Agent and satisfaction of the conditions (if any) subject to
      which this Transfer Certificate is expressed to take effect.

6.    The Lender makes no representation or warranty and assumes no
      responsibility with respect to the legality, validity, effectiveness,
      adequacy or enforceability of the Facilities Agreement or any document
      relating thereto and assumes no responsibility for the financial condition
      of the Borrower or for the performance and observance by the Borrower of
      any of its obligations under the Facilities Agreement or any documents
      relating thereto and any and all such conditions and warranties, whether
      express or implied by law or otherwise are hereby excluded.

7.    The Lender hereby gives notice that nothing herein or in the Facilities
      Agreement (or any document relating thereto) shall oblige the Lender to
      (i) accept a re-transfer from the Transferee of the whole or any part of
      its rights, benefits and/or obligations under the Facilities Agreement
      transferred pursuant hereto or (ii) support any losses directly or
      indirectly sustained or incurred by the Transferee for any reason
      whatsoever including, without limitation, the non-performance by the
      Borrower or any other party to the Facilities Agreement (or any document
      relating thereto) of its obligations under any such document. The
      transferee hereby acknowledges the absence of any such obligation as is
      referred to in (i) or (ii) above.

8.    This Transfer Certificate and the rights and obligations of the parties
      hereunder shall be governed by and construed in accordance with Malaysian
      law.



                      Schedule to the Transfer Certificate

1.    Lender:

2.    Transferee:

3.    Transfer Date:






<PAGE>   88

                                      -3-





4.    Lender's Participation:

      Lender's Available Commitment
      -----------------------------


      Lender's Outstanding Amount
      --------------------------- 


5.    Amount Transferred:


      [Transferor Lender]                       [Transferee Lender]

      By:                                       By:

      Date:                                     Date:

                                                Address:









<PAGE>   89





                                   SCHEDULE 8
                                   ----------


<TABLE>
                                SHAREHOLDERS LOAN
                                -----------------
<CAPTION>


                Date                                Amount

            <S>                                <C>
            31 August 1995                     USD 2,000,000.00

            30 September 1995                  USD 1,000,000.00

            31 October 1995                    USD 2,000,000.00

            31 December 1995                   USD 2,000,000.00

            1 January 1996                     USD 2,000,000.00

            29 February 1996                   USD 2,000,000.00
                                               ----------------

                                               USD11,000,000.00
                                               ================

</TABLE>






<PAGE>   90




                                   SCHEDULE 9
                                   ----------


                     FORM OF REQUEST FOR RINGGIT RC DRAWDOWN
                     ---------------------------------------



TO:   BANK BUMIPUTRA MALAYSIA BERHAD
      [   address  ]



For the attention: [name and title of relevant person]



Dear Sirs,

            Zycon Corporation Sdn. Bhd.
            RM50, 400,000.00 Facility Agreement
            dated                          1996
            -----------------------------------
 

We refer to the above Agreement between (1) ourselves, as Borrower, (2)
yourselves as Arranger, (3) the Working Capital Lender named therein, as Working
Capital Lender, (4) the Lending Banks named therein, as Lending Banks, (5) the
Funding Lender named therein, as Funding Lender, (6) yourselves, as Facility
Agent, and (7) yourselves, as Security Agent. Terms defined in the Agreement
have the same meaning in this notice.

We give you notice that we request a Ringgit RC Drawdown to be made to us by the
Working Capital Lender under the Agreement as follows:



(1)   Amount                     :  [USD       ]

(2)   Date of Ringgit
      RC Drawdown                :                               19 (or, if
                                    that is not a Ringgit Business Day, the 
                                    next succeeding Ringgit Business Day).

(3)   Period                     :  [1, 3 or 6 months]




We confirm that no Event of Default or Potential Event of Default in relation to
ourselves or any Security Party has occurred or will occur as a result of the
making of that Ringgit RC Drawdown, we represent and warrant that the
representations and warranties contained in Clause 18 of the Agreement have been
complied with and would be correct in all respects if repeated today by
reference to the circumstances now existing and we confirm that all the
undertakings on our part contained in Clause 19 and 20 of the Agreement have
been fully performed and observed by us.





<PAGE>   91

                                      -2-






We enclose the Promissory Note for the proposed Ringgit RC Drawdown. You are
requested to make the proceeds of that Ringgit RC Drawdown available to us by
credit to [details of bank account].

Dated            19    .



                                    Yours faithfully,
                                    for and on behalf of
                                    ZYCON CORPORATION SDN. BHD.









<PAGE>   92


                                   SCHEDULE 10
                                   -----------


                                ZYCON CORPORATION
                                -----------------


<TABLE>
                        FORECASTED 1996 DRAWDOWN SCHEDULE
                        ---------------------------------

<CAPTION>

DRAWDOWN #                    ESTIMATED DATE          ESTIMATED AMOUNT
- ----------                    --------------          ----------------


<S>   <C>                     <C>                    <C>                 
RM-TL1 (TERM LOAN FACILITY)

      1)                      APRIL 19, 1996          RM 13,400,000.00

      2)                      MAY 20, 1996            RM  5,000,000.00

      3)                      JUNE 21, 1996           RM  5,000,000.00

      4)                      JULY 23, 1996           RM  5,000,000.00

      5)                      AUG 23, 1996            RM    800,000.00
                                                         -------------

                                     TOTAL:           RM 29,200,000.00
                                                         =============

USD (TERM LOAN FACILITY)

      1)                      JUNE 15, 1996          USD $1,000,000.00

      2)                      JULY 15, 1996          USD $2,000,000.00

      3)                      AUG 15, 1996           USD $1,000,000.00
                                                         -------------

                                     TOTAL:          USD $4,000,000.00
                                                         =============

</TABLE>









<PAGE>   1
                                                                    EXHIBIT 10.5


                       DATED THIS 9TH DAY OF FEBRUARY 1996
                       ***********************************



                                ZYCON CORPORATION
                                  as Guarantor

                                       in
                                    favour of


                         BANK BUMIPUTRA MALAYSIA BERHAD
                              BBMB KEWANGAN BERHAD
                                   as Lenders

                                     - and -


                         BANK BUMIPUTRA MALAYSIA BERHAD
                                as Facility Agent


                         BANK BUMIPUTRA MALAYSIA BERHAD
                                as Security Agent



                               CORPORATE GUARANTEE

                                *****************


                                  Prepared by:


                                  SKRINE & CO.
                             ADVOCATES & SOLICITORS
                            STRAITS TRADING BUILDING
                               4 LEBOH PASAR BESAR
                               50050 KUALA LUMPUR.

                           FILE NO. TC/PTW/151878.0/95
                              February 7, 1996-liu
<PAGE>   2
         THIS GUARANTEE is issued on the 9th day of February 1996 by Zycon
Corporation, a corporation incorporated and existing under the laws of the State
of Delaware in the United States of America and having its registered office at
445 El Camino Real, Santa Clara, California CA 95050-4366 (the "Guarantor",
which expression shall include the successors, if any, of the Guarantor) in
favour of: -

(1)      BANK BUMIPUTRA MALAYSIA BERHAD and BBMB KEWANGAN BERHAD (the "Lenders",
         which expression shall include their respective successors and
         assigns); and

(2)      BANK BUMIPUTRA MALAYSIA BERHAD, as facility agent for itself and the
         other Lender (in such capacity, the "Facility Agent", which expression
         shall include any of its successors in such capacity); and

(3)      BANK BUMIPUTRA MALAYSIA BERHAD, as security agent for itself and the
         other Lender (in such capacity, the "Security Agent", which expression
         shall include any of its successors in such capacity).

         WHEREAS

(a)      By a Facilities Agreement (the "Facilities Agreement") dated the 9th of
         February 1996 made between (1) ZYCON CORPORATION SDW. BHD. (the
         "Borrower"), as Borrower, (2) BANK BUMIPUTRA MALAYSIA BERHAD, as
         Arranger, (3) BANK BUMIPUTRA MALAYSIA BERHAD, as Working Capital
         Lender, (4) BANK BUMIPUTRA MALAYSIA BERHAD and BBMB KEWANGAN BERHAD, as
         Lending Banks, (5) BANK BUMIPUTRA MALAYSIA BERHAD, as Funding Lender,
         (6) BANK BUMIPUTRA MALAYSIA BERHAD, as Facilities Agent and (7) BANK
         BUMIPUTRA MALAYSIA BERHAD, as Security Agent, inter alia (a) the
         Working Capital Lender agreed to grant to the Borrower the Working
         Capital Facilities (as defined in the Facilities Agreement) upon the
         terms and subject to the conditions of the Facilities Agreement, (b)
         the Lending Banks agreed to grant to the Borrower the Ringgit Advances
         Facility (as defined in the Facilities Agreement) upon the terms and
         subject to the conditions of the Facilities Agreement and (c) the
         Funding Lender agreed to grant to the Borrower the Dollar Advances
         Facility and the Dollar RC Facility upon the terms and subject to the
         conditions of the Facilities Agreement.

(B)      As security for the repayment by the Borrower of the monies due and
         payable or hereafter due and payable under the respective Facilities
         (as defined in the Facilities Agreement), interest thereon and all
         other monies agreed to be paid under the Facilities Agreement and the
         other Securities Documents (as defined in the Facilities Agreement),
         the Guarantor has agreed to issue this Guarantee in favour of the
         Lenders, the Facility Agent and the Security Agent.
<PAGE>   3
(C)      The Borrower may not make its request to the Working Capital Lender for
         the utilization of the Working Capital Facilities, and may not make its
         request for a Ringgit Advance (as defined in the Facilities Agreement),
         and may not make its request for a Dollar Advance (as defined in the
         Facilities Agreement) and may not make its request for a Dollar RC
         Drawdown (as defined in the Facilities Agreement), unless and until,
         inter alia, the Facility Agent has received this Guarantee duly
         executed by the Guarantor and stamped.

         NOW THEREFORE IT IS AGREED AS FOLLOW: -

1.       DEFINITIONS AND INTERPRETATION

         1.1      Terms defined in the Facilities Agreement and the Security
                  Agency Agreement

                  Except as otherwise provided in this Guarantee, all terms and
                  references which are defined or construed in the Facilities
                  Agreement and the Security Agency Agreement but are not
                  defined or construed in this Guarantee shall have the same
                  meaning and construction in this Guarantee. All references to
                  the Facilities Agreement are to the Facilities Agreement and
                  from time to time amended modified or supplemented and all
                  references to the Security Agency Agreement are to the
                  Security Agency Agreement as from time to time amended,
                  modified or supplemented.

         1.2      Terms

                  In this Guarantee, except where the context otherwise
                  requires: -

                  "Borrower" means ZYCON CORPORATION SDW. BHD., a company
                  incorporated in Malaysia and having its registered offices at
                  11th Floor, Wisma Damansara, Jalan Semantan, Damansara
                  Heights, 50490 Kuala Lumpu and includes its successor in
                  title;

                  "Dollar Advances Facility" means, in relation to the Funding
                  Lender, the USD term loan facility of up to the aggregate
                  principal amount of United States Dollars Four Million
                  (USD4,000,000.00) granted by the Funding Lender to the
                  Borrower upon the terms and subject to the conditions of the
                  Facilities Agreement;

                  "Facilities" means the facilities comprising of the Dollar
                  Advances Facility, the Dollar RC Facility, the TL AI Facility
                  and the Working Capital Facilities and the expression
                  "Facility" means any of these Facilities;
<PAGE>   4
                  "Guaranteed Indebtedness" means: -

                  (1)      all sums (whether principal, interest, fee,
                           commission or otherwise) whatsoever which are or at
                           any time may be or becomes due from or owing by the
                           Borrower to BBMB, in its capacity as a Working
                           Capital Lender whether actually or contingently,
                           under or in connection with, or which the Borrower
                           has covenanted to pay or discharge to BBMB under or
                           pursuant to, the Facilities Agreement in connection
                           with the Working Capital Lender, whether actually or
                           Contingently, under or in connection with, or which
                           the Borrower has covenanted to pay or discharge to
                           BBM under or pursuant to, the Facilities Agreement in
                           connection with the Working Capital Facilities;

                  (2)      all sums (whether principal, interest, fee,
                           commission or otherwise) whatsoever which are or at
                           any time may be or becomes due from or owing by the
                           Borrower to the Lending Banks, whether actually or
                           contingently, under or in connection with, or which
                           the Borrower has covenanted to pay or discharge to
                           the Lending Banks under or pursuant to, the
                           Facilities Agreement, in connection with the Ringgit
                           Advances Facilities;

                  (3)      all sums (whether principal, interest, fee,
                           commission or otherwise) whatsoever which are or at
                           any time may be or becomes due from or owing by the
                           Borrower to the Funding Lender, whether actually or
                           contingently, under or in connection with, or which
                           the Borrower has covenanted to pay or discharge to
                           the Funding Lender under or pursuant to, the
                           Facilities Agreement, in connection with the Dollar
                           Advances Facility;

                  (4)      all sums (whether principal, interest, fee,
                           commission or otherwise) whatsoever which are or at
                           any time may be or becomes due from or owing by the
                           Borrower to the Funding Lender whether actually or
                           contingently, under or in connection with, or which
                           the Borrower has covenanted to part or discharge to
                           the Funding Lender under or pursuant to, the
                           Facilities Agreement, in connection with the Dollar
                           RC Facility;

                  (5)      all other sums (whether principal, interest, fee,
                           commission or otherwise) whatsoever which are or at
                           any time may be or becomes due form or owing by the
                           Borrower to the Lenders, whether actually or
                           contingently, under or in connection with, or which
                           the Borrower has covenanted to pay or discharge to
                           the Lenders under
<PAGE>   5
                           or pursuant to, the Facilities Agreement and the
                           other Security Documents to which the Borrower is a
                           party; and

                  (6)      all other sums (whether principal, interest, fee,
                           commission or otherwise) whatsoever which are or at
                           any time may be or becomes due fro or owing by the
                           Borrower to the Agents, whether actually or
                           contingently, under or in connection with, or which
                           the Borrower has covenanted to pay or discharge to
                           the Agents under or pursuant to the Facilities
                           Agreement and the other Security Documents to which
                           the Borrower is a party.

         1.3      Interpretation

                  In this Guarantee unless the context otherwise requires: -

                  1.3.1    references to persons include firms, companies,
                           corporations states and administrative and
                           governmental entities, associations and partnerships
                           (whether or not having separate legal personality);

                  1.3.2    references to the masculine gender includes the
                           feminine and neuter genders and vice versa and
                           references to the singular number include the plural
                           and vice versa;

                  1.3.3    references to Schedules, Clauses, sub-clauses,
                           paragraphs and sub-paragraphs are to the Schedules
                           and to the Clauses, sub-clauses, paragraphs and
                           sub-paragraphs of this Guarantee; and

                  1.3.4    the headings of clauses and the underlined
                           introductory words to sub-clauses are inserted for
                           ease of reference only and shall be ignored in
                           construing this Guarantee.

2.       COVENANT TO PAY

         2.1      Covenant to Pay

                  In consideration of the Working Capital Lender agreeing to
                  grant to the Borrower the Working Capital Facilities on the
                  terms and subject to the conditions contained in the
                  Facilities Agreement (a copy of which the Guarantor hereby
                  acknowledges having received) or the Lending Banks agreeing to
                  grant to the Borrower the Ringgit Advances Facility on the
                  terms and subject to the Conditions contained in the
                  Facilities Agreement or the Funding Lender agreeing to grant
                  to the Borrower the Dollar Advances Facility on the terms and
                  subject to the conditions contained in the Facilities
                  Agreement or the Funding Lender agreeing to grant to the
                  Borrower the Dollar RC Facility on the terms and subject to
                  the conditions
<PAGE>   6
                  contained in the Facilities Agreement or the Beneficiaries
                  otherwise acting under or in connection with the Facilities
                  Agreement, the Guarantor hereby unconditionally and
                  irrevocably guarantees, as a continuing guarantee, the due
                  punctual payment by the Borrower of the Guaranteed
                  Indebtedness, and conditionally and irrevocably undertakes and
                  agrees that, if for any reason the Borrower does not make
                  payment of any amount of the Guaranteed Indebtedness, by the
                  time, in the currency, on the date and otherwise if the manner
                  specified in (1) the Facilities Agreement in respect of that
                  part of the Guaranteed Indebtedness owing to BBMB as a Working
                  Capital Lender (whether on the normal due date, on
                  acceleration or otherwise), (2) the Facilities Agreement in
                  the respect of that part of the Guaranteed Indebtedness owing
                  to Lending Banks (whether on the normal due date, on
                  acceleration or otherwise), or (3) the Facilities Agreement in
                  respect of that part of the Guaranteed Indebtedness owing to
                  the Funding Lender (whether on the normal due date, on
                  acceleration or otherwise), the Guarantor will pay to the
                  Facility Agent on demand for its account or for the account or
                  for the account of the relevant Beneficiary such sum in the
                  currency and in the manner provided in the Facilities
                  Agreement.

         2.2      Default of Borrower

                  In the event of the Borrower failing to observe and perform
                  any of the covenants, undertakings, stipulations or terms
                  contained in the Facilities Agreement and/or the other
                  Security Documents to which the Borrower is a party, the
                  Beneficiaries shall notwithstanding anything to the contrary
                  contained in the Facilities Agreement and/or the other
                  Security Documents be entitled to demand payment in full from
                  the Guarantor the whole of the Guaranteed Indebtedness or such
                  part thereof as may be outstanding.

         2.3      Independent Action

                  2.3.1    The Guarantor waives all rights of subrogation and
                           contribution and any rights which it may have to
                           claim prior exhaustion of remedies by the
                           Beneficiaries and agrees that demands under this
                           Guarantee may be made from time to time irrespective
                           of whether any steps or proceedings are being taken
                           or have been taken against the Borrower and/or any
                           other person or are being taken or have been taken to
                           enforce any other security, guarantee or indemnity.
                           The Beneficiaries may proceed to exercise any right
                           or remedy which the Beneficiary may have under this
                           Guarantee without regard to any actions or omissions
                           of any other party or entity and the Beneficiaries
                           may exercise any such right or remedy independently
                           of each other and in separate actions or proceedings
                           and the Guarantor hereby so agrees and waives any
                           rights it has or
<PAGE>   7
                           may have to object to any such proceedings being
                           separately brought.

                  2.3.2    The amount at any time owing by the Guarantor to the
                           Beneficiaries under this Guarantee shall be a
                           separate and independent debt from the amount owing
                           to any other party. The Beneficiaries shall have the
                           right to protect and enforce their respective rights
                           arising out of this Guarantee and it shall not be
                           necessary for any other party to be joined as an
                           additional party in any proceeding for this purpose.

3.       REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES

         3.1      Representations and Warranties

                  3.1.1    Status

                           The Guarantor is a corporation duly incorporated and
                           validly existing under the laws of the United States
                           of America and has the power and authority to own its
                           assets and to conduct the business which it conducts
                           and/or purposes to conduct.

                  3.1.2    Powers

                           The Guarantor has full power, authority and legal
                           right to enter into and perform and comply with its
                           obligations under this Guarantee.

                  3.1.3    Obligations Binding

                           The obligations of the Guarantor under this Guarantee
                           constitute the legal, valid and binding obligations
                           of the Guarantor, enforceable against the Guarantor
                           in accordance with its terms.

                  3.1.4    Authorizations and Consents

                           All actions, conditions and things required to be
                           taken, fulfilled and done (including the obtaining of
                           any necessary Consent) in order (a) to enable it to
                           lawfully enter into and perform and comply with its
                           obligations under this Guarantee, (b) to ensure that
                           those obligations are valid, legally binding and
                           enforceable, (c) to ensure that those obligations
                           rank and will at all times rank in accordance with
                           Clause 4.1.5 and (d) to make this Guarantee
                           admissible in evidence in the courts of Malaysia and
                           the United States of America have been taken,
                           fulfilled and done.
<PAGE>   8
                  3.1.5    Ranking of Obligations

                           Its payment obligators under this Guarantee rank and
                           will at all times rank at lease equally and ratably
                           in all respects with all its other unsecured
                           indebtedness except for such indebtedness as would,
                           by virtue only of the law in force in the United
                           States of America, be preferred in the event of its
                           winding-up.

                  3.1.6    Non-violation of Laws and/or Agreements

                           Neither the execution and delivery of this Guarantee
                           nor the performance or observance by the Guarantor of
                           any of its obligators or the exercise by the
                           Guarantor of any of its rights herder will: -

                           (i)      contravene, conflict with or result in any
                                    breach of any of the terms, conditions,
                                    covenants, undertakings or other provisions
                                    of, or constitute a default, event of
                                    default or an event which with the giving of
                                    notices and/or the lapse of time and/or the
                                    fulfillment of any conditions would
                                    constitute a default or an event of default
                                    under any provision of any law or
                                    regulation, order, franchise, concession,
                                    license, permit or authority or any
                                    agreement, undertaking, indenture, mortgage,
                                    deed or other instrument, or any
                                    arrangement, obligation or duty applicable
                                    to, or which is binding upon or affects the
                                    Guarantor or any of its assets or revenues,

                           (ii)     violate or exceed any limitation on the
                                    borrowing or any other powers of the
                                    Guarantor (whether imposed by any law or
                                    regulation, order agreement, instrument or
                                    otherwise) or any other limitation affecting
                                    the Guarantor, to be exceeded, or

                           (iii)    result in, or oblige the Guarantor to create
                                    any charge on the whole or any part of the
                                    assets or revenues of the Guarantor, present
                                    or future.

                  3.1.7    Litigation

                           No litigation, arbitration or administrative
                           proceedings before or of any court, tribunal or
                           regulatory authority is presently pending or, to the
                           knowledge of the Guarantor threatened against the
                           Guarantor or any of its assets or revenues which, if
                           determined adversely to

<PAGE>   9
                           the Guarantor might materially and adversely affect
                           its assets, liabilities or condition (financial or
                           otherwise) or its ability to perform its obligations
                           hereunder.

                  3.1.8    No Default

                           The Guarantor is not in breach of contravention of or
                           in default under any law or regulation, order,
                           franchise, concession, license, permit, authority,
                           agreement, undertaking, instrument, arrangement,
                           obligation or duty applicable to, or which is binding
                           upon or affect it or any of its assets or revenues,
                           (the consequences of which breach, contravention or
                           default, could materially and adversely affect the
                           Guarantor's assets, liabilities, or condition
                           (financial or otherwise) or its ability to perform
                           its obligation hereunder); no Event of Default or
                           Potential Event of Default has occurred or will occur
                           as a result of its entry into this Guarantee, and
                           neither it not any of its subsidiaries is in breach
                           of or in default of any agreement to an extent or in
                           a MANNER WHICH HAS OR COULD HAVE A MATERIAL effect on
                           it;

                  3.1.9     Winding-Up

                           N meeting has been convened for its winding-up or for
                           the appointment of a receiver, trustee, judicial
                           manager or similar officer of it, its assets or any
                           of them, no such step is intended by it and, so far
                           as it is aware, no petition, application or the like
                           is outstanding for its winding-up or for the
                           appointment of a receiver, trustee, judicial manager
                           or similar officer of it, its assets or any of them.

                  3.1.10   No Arrangements with Creditors

                           The Guarantor has not entered into any arrangement or
                           composition with its creditors.

                  3.1.11   No Immunity

                           Neither it not its assets is entitled to immunity
                           from suit, execution, attachment or other legal
                           process, and its entry into this Guarantee
                           constitutes, and the exercise of its rights and
                           performance of and compliance with its obligations
                           under this Guarantee will constitute, private and
                           commercial acts done and performed for private and
                           commercial purpose.
<PAGE>   10
                  3.1.12   No Misstatement

                           No information, exhibit or report furnished by it to
                           the Beneficiaries in connection with this Guarantee
                           contained any misstatement of fact as at the date of
                           such exhibit or report or as at the date when such
                           information was given which was material in the
                           context of this Guarantee or omitted to state a fact
                           as at such date which in any such case would be
                           materially adverse to the interests of the
                           Beneficiaries under this Guarantee.

         3.2      Continuation of Representation and Warranties

                  Each of the representations and warranties set forth in Clause
                  4.1 above will be correct and complied with in all material
                  respects so long as any sum remains to be lent to or remains
                  payable by the Borrower under the Facilities Agreement as if
                  repeated then by reference to the then existing circumstances.

4.       INDEPENDENT LIABILITY

         As separate, independent and alternative stipulations, the Guarantor
         unconditionally and irrevocably agrees: -

         4.1      that any sum which, although expressed to be payable by the
                  Borrower under the Facilities Agreement, is for any reason
                  (whether or not now existing and whether or not now known or
                  becoming known to any party to this Guarantee) not recoverable
                  from the Guarantor on the basis of guarantee shall
                  nevertheless be recoverable by it as if it were the sole
                  principal debtor and shall be paid by it to the Facility Agent
                  on demand; and

         4.2      as a primary obligation to indemnify each Beneficiary against
                  any loss suffered by it as a result of any sum expressed to be
                  payable by the Borrower under the Facilities Agreement not
                  being paid by the time, on the date and otherwise in the
                  manner specified in the Facilities Agreement or any payment
                  obligation of the Borrower under the facilities Agreement
                  being or becoming void, voidable or unenforceable for any
                  reasons (whether or not now existing and whether or not now
                  known or becoming known to the guarantor r any Beneficiary),
                  the amount of that loss being the amount expressed to be
                  payable by the Borrower in respect of the relevant sum.

5.       INTEREST TO BE CAPITALIZED

         The Guarantor hereby agrees that the capitalized rate of interest fixed
         by each Beneficiary form time to time in respect of the Facilities
         shall apply and have
<PAGE>   11
         effect and be calculated on the amounts due to such Beneficiary
         hereunder until that Beneficiary shall have received one hundred Sen in
         every Ringgit outstanding, or as the case may be, one hundred cents in
         every Dollar outstanding under the Facilities. For the avoidance of
         doubt, it is hereby expressly provided that the capitalized rates of
         interest shall be payable before and after judgment and notwithstanding
         the termination of the banker and customer relationship between the
         Lenders and the Borrower by reason of the termination of the Facilities
         by recall or demand or by reason of the incapacity, winding-up, or
         liquidation of any party or by frustration, force majeur, operation of
         law, order or direction of any competent authority or otherwise
         howsoever.

6.       PRINCIPAL DEBTOR

         As between the Guarantor and the Beneficiaries, the Guarantor shall be
         liable under this Guarantee as if it were the sole principal debtor and
         not merely a surety. Accordingly, it shall not be discharged, nor its
         liability be affected nor shall this Guarantee be discharged or
         diminished by reason of: -

         6.1      any increase, decrease, extension, renewal or restructure of
                  the Facilities or any variation, cancellation, supplement,
                  substitution, or modifications of whatsoever nature being made
                  to any provision of the Facilities Agreement and/or the other
                  Security Documents, with or without the knowledge or consent
                  of the Guarantor; or

         6.2      any irregularity, unenforceability, illegality, invalidity or
                  defect in the Security Documents or in relation to any
                  obligation of the Borrower thereunder to the intent to that
                  the Guarantor's obligations under this Guarantee shall remain
                  in full force and effect as if there were no such
                  irregularity, unenforceability, illegality, invalidity or
                  defect; or

         6.3      any variations, exchange, renewal, release or discharge of any
                  security or the refusal or neglect by any Beneficiary to
                  complete or enforce any security or instrument and whether
                  satisfied by payment or not; or

         6.4      any refusal by any Lender at any time or times with or without
                  notice to the Guarantor or the Borrower to advance the monies
                  or give further credit or accommodation to the Borrower
                  notwithstanding that the limit or amount of the Facilities
                  shall not have been reached; or

         6.5      any other person or persons who is or was intended to
                  guarantee, indemnify, provide security or in any other manner
                  assume or undertake to be responsible for the obligation or
                  liability in respect of the Facilities or any part thereof or
                  other indebtedness of the Borrower shall fail to do so or
                  shall be discharged or released from doing so; or
<PAGE>   12
         6.6      any present or future bill note guarantee indemnity mortgage
                  charge pledge lien debenture or other security or right or
                  remedy held by or available to any Beneficiary being or
                  becoming wholly or in part voidable or unenforceable on any
                  ground whatsoever or by any Beneficiary from time to time
                  dealing with exchanging varying releasing or failing to
                  perfect or enforce any of the same; or

         6.7      any time indulgence concession waiver or consent at any time
                  given to the Borrower or any other persons, whether by any
                  Beneficiary or any other persons; or

         6.8      the renewing determining varying or increasing any bill
                  promissory note or other negotiable instrument accommodation
                  facilities or transaction in any manner whatsoever or
                  concurring in accepting or varying any compromise arrangement
                  or settlement or omitting to claim or enforce payment form the
                  Borrower or any other person; or

         6.9      any act or omission which would not have discharged or
                  affected the liability of the Guarantor had it been the
                  principal debtor instead of the guarantor or by anything done
                  or omitted which but for this provision might operate to
                  exonerate the Guarantor; or

         6.10     the winding-up, insolvency, bankruptcy, amalgamation,
                  reconstruction or reorganization of the Borrower or any other
                  persons (or the commencement of any of the foregoing).

7.       INDEMNITY

         As a separate and independent obligation the Guarantor hereby agrees as
         primary obligor to indemnify each Beneficiary on demand from and
         against any claims, losses, funding or other costs, expenses or
         otherwise incurred by that Beneficiary as a result of the terms of the
         Facilities being or becoming void, voidable or unenforceable in any
         manner or by reason of or consequent to any breach of warranties and/or
         undertakings herein contained or any default on the part of the
         Borrower in performing and observing the obligations to be performed
         and observed by the Borrower or for any other reasons whatsoever,
         whether or not known to that Beneficiary; the among of such claims,
         losses, costs, expenses or otherwise being the amount which that
         Beneficiary would have otherwise been entitled to recover from the
         Borrower under the Security Documents.

8.       CONTINUING SECURITY

         The Guarantee is a continuing security and shall secure the ultimate
         balance from time to time owing to each Beneficiary by the Borrower
         under the Security Documents notwithstanding the liquidation winding-up
         or other incapacity or any
<PAGE>   13
         change in the constitution of the Borrower or other incapacity or any
         change in the constitution of the Borrower or the liquidation
         winding-up or other incapacity of the Guarantor or any other person or
         any settlement of account or other matter whatsoever. This Guarantee
         shall remain in full force and effect until all monies owing under the
         Security Documents have been paid or satisfied in full and is in
         addition to and not in substitution for any other rights or remedies
         which the Beneficiaries may have under the Security Documents and may
         be enforced without first having recourse to any such rights or
         remedies and without taking any steps or proceedings against the
         Borrower or any other persons.

9.       LIABILITY OF GUARANTOR

         9.1      Discharge Only By Performance

                  The obligations of the Guarantor shall not be discharged
                  except by performance and then only to the extent of such
                  performance. Such obligations shall not be subject to any
                  prior notice to or demand to the Guarantor with regard to any
                  default of the Borrower and shall not be impaired by any
                  extension of time forbearance or concession given to the
                  Borrower or any other person or any assertion of or failure to
                  assert any right or remedy against the Borrower or any other
                  persons or in respect to the Security Documents and/or any
                  modification or amplification of the provision thereof
                  contemplated by the terms thereof or any failure of the
                  Borrower to comply with any requirements of any law
                  regulations or order in Malaysia or of any political
                  sub-division or agency thereof.

         9.2      Arrangements With Borrower

                  The Guarantor shall not be discharged or release from this
                  Guarantee by any arrangement entered into or any composition
                  accepted by any Beneficiary modifying its rights and remedies
                  whether with or without the assent of the Guarantor by any
                  alteration in the obligations terms stipulations covenants and
                  undertakings contained in the Security Documents or by any
                  forbearance whether as to pay time performance or otherwise.

         9.3      Reconstruction

                  The liabilities and or obligations of the Guarantor created by
                  the is Guarantee shall continue to be valid and binding for
                  all purposes whatsoever notwithstanding any change by
                  amalgamation reconstruction or otherwise which may be made in
                  the constitution of the Beneficiaries of the Borrower and it
                  is hereby expressly declared that no change of any sort
                  whatsoever in relation to or affecting the Guarantor shall in
                  any way affect the
<PAGE>   14
                  liabilities and or obligations created hereunder in relation
                  to any transaction whatsoever whether past present or future.

         9.4      Liquidation

                  In the event of the liquidation of the Borrower, each
                  Beneficiary (notwithstanding the payment by the Guarantor to
                  the Beneficiaries or any one of them of any part of the amount
                  hereby guaranteed) may rank as creditor and prove for such
                  amount remaining outstanding against the Borrower or agree to
                  accept any composition in respect of the same and such
                  Beneficiary may receive and retain the whole of the dividends
                  composition or other payments thereon. The Guarantor shall not
                  in such event prove against the Borrower or in any way compete
                  with the Beneficiaries so as to diminish any dividend or other
                  advantage that would or might come to the Beneficiaries until
                  the whole of each of the Beneficiary's claims against the
                  Borrower have been satisfied. Further for the purpose of
                  enabling any Beneficiary to maximize its recoveries in any
                  actual or potential winding-up, any amount received or
                  recovered by any Beneficiary (otherwise than as a result of a
                  payment by the Borrower to the Facility Agent) in respect of
                  any sum payable by the Borrower under the Facilities
                  Agreement, may be placed by the recipient in an interest
                  bearing suspense account. That amount may be kept there (with
                  any interest earned being credited to that account) unless and
                  until the recipient has irrevocably received or recovered its
                  share of all sums payable to it under the Facilities
                  Agreement.

         9.5      Subordination

                  So long as any sum remains to be lent to or remains payable by
                  the Borrower under the Facilities Agreement: -

                  9.5.1    any right of the Guarantor, by reason of the
                           performance of any of its obligations under this
                           Guarantee, to be indemnified by the Borrower or to
                           take the benefit of or enforce any security,
                           guarantee or indemnity shall be exercised and
                           enforced only in such manner and on such terms as the
                           Facility Agent (acting on the instructions from the
                           Instruction Group) may require; and

                  9.5.2    any amount received or recovered by the Guarantor (a)
                           as a result of any exercise of any such right or (b)
                           in the winding-up of the Borrower shall be held in
                           trust for the Beneficiaries and immediately paid to
                           the Facility Agent.
<PAGE>   15
10.      RECOVERY OF MONIES BY GUARANTOR

         Until all monies and liabilities payable under the Facilities shall
         have been fully paid and discharged the Guarantor shall not: -

         (a)      in respect of any monies which may have been paid by the
                  Guarantor to any Beneficiary, seek to enforce repayment or
                  payment or to exercise any other rights or remedies of
                  whatsoever kind which may accrue howsoever to the Guarantor in
                  respect of the amount so paid;

         (b)      prove in competition with any Beneficiary for any monies owing
                  by the Borrower to the Guarantor on any account whatsoever
                  and/or in respect of any monies due or owing from the Borrower
                  to such Beneficiary but will give to that Beneficiary the full
                  benefit of any proof which the Guarantor may be able to make
                  in the liquidation of the Borrower or in any arrangement or
                  composition with its creditors;

         (c)      take any steps to enforce any rights or remedies against the
                  Borrower or receive or claim or have the benefit of any
                  payment or distribution, from or an account of the Borrower or
                  exercise any right of set-off or counterclaim against the
                  Borrower;

         (d)      have any claim on or participate in the benefit of any claims
                  or security which may hereafter be provided by the Borrower;
                  and

         (e)      negotiate assign charge or otherwise dispose of any monies
                  obligations or liabilities now or hereafter due or owing to
                  the Guarantor from the Borrower or any co-guarantor or any
                  promissory note bill of exchange guarantee indemnity mortgage
                  charge or other security. Provided always that, on making a
                  claim against the Guarantor pursuant hereto, the Facility
                  Agent (actin on instruction form the Instruction Group) may
                  instruct the Guarantor to take any steps in connection with
                  any of the matters referred to in the e foregoing
                  sub-paragraphs and any monies or other benefit thereby
                  obtained by the Guarantor will thereafter be held by the
                  Guarantor in trust for the Beneficiaries and immediately paid
                  to the Facility Agent.

12.      OTHER SECURITIES HELD BY THE BENEFICIARIES

         This Guarantee shall be in addition to and shall not be in any way
         prejudiced or affected by any collateral or other security now or
         hereafter held by the Beneficiaries for all or any part of the monies
         hereby guaranteed nor shall such collateral or other security or lien
         to which the Beneficiaries may be otherwise entitled to or the
         liability of any person or persons or corporation not parties hereto
         for all or any part of the monies hereby secured be in any way
         prejudiced or affected by this present Guarantee.
<PAGE>   16
13.      PAYMENTS

         13.1     Payments Without Set-Off, Counterclaim etc.

                  All payments to be made by the Guarantor to the Beneficiaries
                  hereunder shall be made in full and without any set-off,
                  counterclaim or merger or combination of accounts whatsoever.

         13.2     Payments Without Deductions for Taxes

                  13.2.1   All payments to be made by the Guarantor under this
                           Guarantee shall be paid (1) free of any restrictions
                           or conditions, (2) free and clear or and (except to
                           the extent required by law) without any deduction or
                           withholding (except to the extent required by law) on
                           account of any other amount, whether by way of
                           set-off or otherwise.

                  13.2.2   If the guarantor or any other person (whether or not
                           a party to, or on behalf of a party to, this
                           Guarantee) must at any time deduct or withhold any
                           tax or other amount from any sum paid or payable by,
                           or received or receivable from, the Guarantor under
                           this Guarantee, the Guarantor shall pay such
                           additional amount as is necessary to ensure that the
                           Beneficiary to which that sum is due receives on the
                           due date and retains (free from any liability other
                           than tax on its own overall net income) a net sum
                           equal to what it would have received and so retained
                           had no such deduction or withholding been required or
                           made.

                  13.2.3   if the Borrower or any other person (whether or not a
                           party to, or on behalf of a party to, this Guarantee)
                           must at any time pay any tax or other amount, on or
                           calculated b reference to, any sum received or
                           receivable by, any Beneficiary under this Guarantee
                           (except for a payment by that Beneficiary of tax on
                           its own overall net income), the Guarantor shall pay
                           or procure the payment of that tax or other amount
                           before any interest or penalty becomes payable or, if
                           that tax or other amount is payable and paid by that
                           Beneficiary, shall reimburse it on demand for the
                           amount paid by it.

                  13.2.4   Within thirty (30) days after paying any sum from
                           which it is required by law to make any deduction or
                           withholding, and within thirty (30) days after the
                           due date of payment of any tax or other amount which
                           it is required by Clause 14.3 above to pay, the
                           Guarantor shall deliver to the Facility Agent
                           evidence satisfactory to the relevant Beneficiary of
                           that deduction, withholding or
<PAGE>   17
                           payment and (where remittance is required) of the
                           remittance thereof to the relevant taxing or other
                           authority.

                  13.2.5   As soon as the Guarantor is aware that any such
                           deduction, withholding or payment is required (or of
                           any change in any such requirement), it shall notify
                           the Facility Agent.

         13.3     Currency of Payment

                  13.3.1   Any payment or payments made by the Guarantor to or
                           for the account of any Beneficiary in a currency (the
                           currency in which the relevant payment is made being
                           hereinafter referred to a the "Relevant Currency")
                           other than the currency in which such payment or
                           payments are expressed to be payable by the Guarantor
                           to it under this Guarantee (the currency in which the
                           relevant payment is expressed to be payable under
                           this Guarantee being hereinafter referred to as "the
                           Currency of Account") (whether as a result or, or of
                           the enforcement of, a judgment or order of a court of
                           any jurisdiction, in the winding-up of the Guarantor
                           to the extent of the Currency of Account which the
                           recipient is able, in accordance with its usual
                           practice, to purchase with the amount so received or
                           recovered in the Relevant Currency on the date of
                           that receipt or recovery (or, it if is not
                           practicable to make that purchase on that date, on
                           the first date on which it is practicable to do so).
                           If the amount of the Currency of Account is less than
                           the amount expressed to be due to the recipient under
                           this Guarantee, the Guarantor shall indemnify it
                           against any loss sustained by it as a result thereof.
                           In any event, the Guarantor shall indemnify the
                           recipient against the cost of making any such
                           purchase. For the purpose of this Clause, it will be
                           sufficient for the recipient to demonstrate that it
                           would have suffered a loss had an actual exchange or
                           purchase been made.

                  13.3.2   These indemnities constitute a separate and
                           independent obligation from the other obligations in
                           this Guarantee, shall give rise to a separate and
                           independent cause of action shall apply irrespective
                           or any indulgence granted by any Beneficiary and
                           shall continue in full force and effect despite any
                           judgment, order, claim or proof for a liquidated
                           amount in respect of any sum due under this Guarantee
                           or any other judgment or order.

         13.4     Payments in Freely Transferable Funds

                  13.4.1   On each date on which any sum in Ringgit is due from
                           the Guarantor under this Guarantee, the Guarantor
                           shall make that sum
<PAGE>   18
                           available to the Facility Agent so as to be received
                           by the Facility Agent in Ringgit and in immediately
                           available and freely transferable funds before 11
                           a.m. (local time in Kuala Lumpur) to such account of
                           the Facility Agent with such bank in Kuala Lumpur as
                           the Facility Agent shall have designated to it for
                           that purpose.

                  13.4.2   On each date on which any sum in US Dollars is due
                           from the Guarantor under this Guarantee, the
                           Guarantor shall make that sum available to the
                           Facility Agent so as to be received by the Facility
                           Agent in US Dollars by 11 a.m. (local time in
                           Singapore) and in funds which are for same day
                           settlement in the [Singapore Clearing House Interback
                           Payments System] (or, if such funds cease to exist
                           or, in the Facility Agent's opinion, cease to be
                           customary for the settlement in Singapore of
                           international banking transactions in US Dollars,
                           such other US Dollars funds as the Facility Agent may
                           from time to time determine to be customary for that
                           purpose) to such account of the Facility Agent with
                           such bank in Singapore as the Facility Agent may from
                           time to time designate for that purpose.

14.      APPROPRIATION OF PAYMENTS

         14.1     All sums from time to time recovered or received by the
                  Facility Agent under or in connection with this Guarantee or
                  pursuant to the Enforcement of this Guarantee (hereinafter
                  referred to as "the Sums Recovered") shall be applied by the
                  Facility Agent in the following manner and order: -

                  14.1.1   first, in or towards payment to the Agents of any fee
                           and any costs, charges and expenses sustained or
                           incurred by the Agents, and any other sums then due
                           and payable to the Agents in their respective
                           capacities as such, under or in connection with the
                           Facilities Agreement;

                  14.1.2   secondly, in or towards payment to each of the
                           Lenders, of its respective Secured Proportion (as
                           defined in the Security Agency Agreement), at such
                           time, of the balance of the Sums Recovered; and

                  14.1.3   thirdly, in payment of any surplus to the Guarantor.

15.      GUARANTEE ENFORCE

         Each of the Beneficiary may enforce this Guarantee against the
         Guarantor at any time in the manner as stipulated in Clause 1 hereof.
<PAGE>   19
16.      GUARANTEE NOT REVOCABLE

         This Guarantee shall not be determinable by the Guarantor except on the
         terms of making full provision up to the limit of the Facilities
         together with interest thereon and any other outstanding liabilities or
         obligations (whether actual or contingent) on the part of the Borrower
         and shall in all respects and for all purposes be binding and operative
         until discharged by performance thereof.

17.      WAIVER OF ALL RIGHTS AS SURETT

         In order to give full effect to this Guarantee the Guarantor hereby
         waives all rights and privileges which the Guarantor might otherwise as
         a surety be entitled to claim.

18.      REINSTATEMENT OF GUARANTEE

         Any settlement or discharge between any of the Beneficiaries and the
         Guarantor shall be conditional upon no security or payment to such
         Beneficiary by the Borrower or any other person being avoided or
         reduced by virtue of any provision or enactment relating to bankruptcy,
         insolvency or dissolution for the time being in force or by virtue of
         any obligation to give effect to any preference or priority and such
         Beneficiary shall be entitled to recover the value amount of any such
         security or payment from the Guarantor subsequently as if such
         settlement or discharge had not occurred.

19.      STATEMENT

         A certificate by any Beneficiary as to any sum payable by the Guarantor
         to it under this Guarantee, and any other certificate, determination,
         notification or the like of any Beneficiary provided for in this
         Guarantee, shall be conclusive save for manifest error.

20.      MISCELLANEOUS

         20.1     Severablity

                  In the event that any one or more provisions of this Guarantee
                  be determined to be illegal or unenforceable by any court of
                  law, such provision shall be ineffective to the extent of such
                  illegality or unenforceability, without invalidating the
                  remaining provisions hereof. The Guarantor agrees, upon
                  request by the Facility Agent (acting on instructions fro the
                  Instructing Group), to replace any provision of this
<PAGE>   20
                  Guarantee which is so determined to be illegal or
                  unenforceable by a valid provision which has as nearly as
                  possible the same effect. The illegality, invalidity or
                  unenforceability of any provision of this Guarantee under the
                  law of any jurisdiction shall not affect its legality,
                  validity or enforceability under the law of any other
                  jurisdiction nor the illegality, validity or enforceability of
                  any of the provision.

         20.2     Law

                  This Guarantee is governed by, and shall be construed in
                  accordance with, the laws of Malaysia

                  (i)      The Guarantor irrevocably: -

                           (aa)     submits to the non-exclusive jurisdiction of
                                    the courts of Malaysia and United States;

                           (bb)     waives any objections on the ground of venue
                                    or forum non-convenience or any similar
                                    grounds;

                           (cc)     consents to service of process by mail or in
                                    other manner permitted by the relevant law.

                  (ii)     The Guarantor shall at all times maintain an agent
                           for service of process in Malaysia. Such agent shall
                           be: -

                  Name:

                  Address:

                           and the Guarantor undertakes not to revoke the
                           authority of the above agent and if, for any reasons,
                           which agent or any successor agent no longer serves
                           as agent of the Guarantor to receive service of
                           process, the Guarantor shall promptly appoint another
                           such agent and advise the Lender thereof.

         20.3     Notices

                  20.3.1   Each communication to be made hereunder shall be made
                           in writing but, unless otherwise stated, may be made
                           by telex, facsimile or letter.

                  20.3.2   Any communication or document to be made or delivered
                           by one person to another pursuant to this Guarantee
                           shall (unless that other person has by fifteen (15)
                           days' written notice to be the Facility
<PAGE>   21
                           Agent specified another address) be made or delivered
                           to that other person at the address identified
                           herein, or, in the case of a Transferee, at the end
                           of the Transfer Certificate to which it is a party as
                           Transferee.

                  20.3.3   Any communication or document made or delivered under
                           Clause 20.3.1 hereof shall be deemed to have been
                           made or delivered: -

                           (i)      in the case of delivery in person, at the
                                    time of delivery;

                           (ii)     in the case of prepaid registered post, five
                                    (5) days after the date of posting or where
                                    posted to an address outside Malaysia, seven
                                    (7) days after the date of posting;

                           (iii)    in the case of telex on receipt by the
                                    sender of the answer-back code of the
                                    recipient at the end of the transmission;
                                    and

                           (iv)     in the case of telegram or facsimile, within
                                    twenty-four (24) hours after the time of
                                    transmission by the sender to be
                                    authenticated by the receipt by the send of
                                    a transmission controlled report appearing
                                    on its fact to emanate from the sender's
                                    machine showing the relevant number of
                                    pages, the correct facsimile number of the
                                    recipient and the result of the transmission
                                    being described as "O.K." or any equivalent
                                    description indicating that the
                                    communication has been property transmitted.
                                    The original of the notice, demand or
                                    request so sent by facsimile shall be
                                    forwarded to the receiving party by prepaid
                                    registered post.


                           Provided that any communication or document to be
                           made or delivered to the Facility Agent shall be
                           effective only when received by the Facility Agent.

                  20.4     Waiver, Rights Cumulative

                           No failure on the part of any Beneficiary to
                           exercise, and no delay on its part in exercising, any
                           right or remedy under this Guarantee will operate as
                           a waiver thereof, nor will any single or partial
                           exercise of any right or remedy preclude any other or
                           further exercise thereof or the exercise of any other
                           right or remedy. The rights and remedies provided in
                           this Guarantee are cumulative and
<PAGE>   22
                           not exclusive of any rights or remedies (whether
                           provided by law or otherwise).

                  20.5     Legal Costs

                           The Guarantor shall pay on demand all costs and
                           expenses (including legal fees) incurred by any of
                           the Beneficiaries in protecting or enforcing any
                           rights under this Guaranty.

                  20.6     Successors in Title

                           This Guarantee shall ensure to the benefit of each or
                           the Beneficiaries and their respective successors and
                           assigns, and the obligations of the Guarantor under
                           this Guarantee shall be binding on it and its
                           successors notwithstanding any change in the
                           constitution or status of it or any of its
                           successors.

                  20.7     No Assignment by Guarantor

                           The Guarantor may not assign its rights or transfer
                           its obligations under this Guarantee.

                  20.8     Agent for Service

                           The Guarantor irrevocably appoints
                           _____________________ to receive, for it and on its
                           behalf service of process in any Proceedings in
                           _______________________________-. Such service shall
                           be deemed completed on delivery to the process agent
                           (whether or not it is forwarded to and received by
                           the Guarantor). If for any reason the process agent
                           ceases to be able to act as such or no longer has an
                           address in _____________________________, the
                           Guarantor irrevocably agrees to appoint a substitute
                           process agent acceptable to the Facility Agent, and
                           to deliver to the Facility Agent a copy of the new
                           agent's acceptance of that appointment, within 30
                           days. Nothing shall affect the right to service
                           process in any other manner permitted by law.

                  20.9     Independent Legal Advice

                           The Guarantor hereby declares that it has sought
                           independent legal advice before executing this
                           Guarantee and that the contents of this Guarantee has
                           been explained to the Guarantor and the Guarantor has
                           perfectly understood the same before the signing it
                           voluntary with full knowledge of the Guarantor's
                           obligations.
<PAGE>   23
                  20.10    Principal & Subsidiary Instruments

                           It is hereby declared and agreed that: -

                           (a)      the Facilities Agreement;

                           (b)      the Debenture;

                           (c)      the Assignment;

                           (d)      the Charge;

                           (e)      this Corporate Guarantee; and

                           (f)      the Security Agency Agreement;

                                    are instruments employed in one transaction
                                    within the meaning of Section 4(3) of the
                                    Stamp Act, 1949 (Consolidated and Revised
                                    1989) to secure an aggregate principal sum
                                    comprising: -

                           (i)      TL I Facility of up to RM29,200,000.00;

                           (ii)     Dollar Advances Facility of up to
                                    USD4,000,000.00;

                           (iii)    Dollar RC Facility or up to USD2,000,000.00;

                           (iv)     Working Capital Facilities of up to
                                    RN5,900,000.00

                                    and respective interest thereon and for the
                                    purpose of the said Section the Facilities
                                    Agreement is deemed to be the Principal
                                    Instrument and the other documents the
                                    Subsidiary Instruments.
<PAGE>   24
         IN WITNESS WHEREOF the parties have hereunto set their respective hands
the day and year first abovewritten.


SIGNED by                                   )
                                            )
for and on behalf of                        )
ZYCON CORPORATION                           )
in the presence of: -                       )


SIGNED by                                   )
                                            )
for and on behalf of                        )
BANK BUMIPUTRA MALAYSIA                     )
BERHAD                                      )
as Lender in the                            )
Presence of:                                )


SIGNED by                                   )
                                            )
for and on behalf of                        )

BBMB KEWANGAN BERHAD as                     )
as Lender in the presence of: -             )



SIGNED by                                   )
                                            )
for and on behalf of                        )
BANK BUMIPUTRA MALAYSIA                     )
BERHAD as Facility Agent                    )
in the presence of: -                       )


SIGNED by                                   )
                                            )
for and on behalf of                        )
BANK BUMIPUTRA MALAYSIA                     )
BERHAD as Security Agent                    )
in the presence of: -                       )

<PAGE>   1
                                                                    EXHIBIT 10.6

                                  LEASE BETWEEN
             SOBRATO INTERESTS III, a California Limited Partnership
                                       AND
                    ZYCON CORPORATION, a Delaware Corporation
<PAGE>   2
                                TABLE OF CONTENTS


Section                                                                   Page #


1.  PARTIES:............................................................      1

2.  PREMISES:...........................................................      1

3.  USE:................................................................      1

4.  TERM:...............................................................      1

5.  THIS PARAGRAPH INTENTIONALLY DELETED................................      2

6.  LATE CHARGES:.......................................................      2

7.  CONSTRUCTION AND POSSESSION:........................................      2

8.  ACCEPTANCE OF PREMISES AND COVENANTS TO SURRENDER...................      4

9.  USES PROHIBITED:....................................................      5

10. ALTERNATIONS AND ADDITIONS..........................................      5

11. LANDLORD'S AND TENANT'S OBLIGATIONS REGARDING COMMON AREA COSTS:....      5

12. MAINTENANCE OF PREMISES:............................................      6

13. INSURANCE:..........................................................      6

14. TAXES...............................................................      7

15. UTILITIES:..........................................................      8

16. WAIVER OF LIABILITY.................................................      8

17. ABANDONMENT:........................................................      8

18. FREE FROM LIENS:....................................................      8

19. COMPLIANCE WITH GOVERNMENTAL REGULATIONS:...........................      9

20. TOXIC WASTE AND ENVIRONMENTAL DAMAGES...............................      9

   A. TENANT'S RESPONSIBILITY...........................................      9

                                      -i-
<PAGE>   3
Section                                                         Page No.

   B. TENANT'S INDEMNITY REGARDING HAZARDOUS MATERIALS....          9

   C. LANDLORD'S REPRESENTATIONS AND INDEMNITY............         10

   D. ACTUAL RELEASE BY TENANT............................         10

   E. ENVIRONMENTAL MONITORING............................         11

21. INDEMNITY:............................................         11

22. ADVERTISEMENTS AND SIGNS:.............................         12

23. ATTORNEY'S FEES:......................................         12

24. TENANT'S DEFAULT:.....................................         12

   24(a). REMEDIES:.......................................         13

   24.(b) RIGHT TO RE-ENTER:..............................         13

   24.(c) ABANDONMENT:....................................         13

   24.(d) NO TERMINATION:.................................         14

25. SURRENDER OF LEASE:...................................         14

26. HABITUAL DEFAULT......................................         14

27. LANDLORD'S DEFAULT:...................................         14

28. NOTICES:..............................................         14

29. ENTRY BY LANDLORD:....................................         15

30. DESTRUCTION OF PREMISES...............................         15

31. ASSIGNMENT OR SUBLEASE:...............................         16

32. CONDEMNATION:.........................................         19

33. EFFECTS OF CONVEYANCE:................................         19

34. SUBORDINATION:........................................         20

35. WAIVER:...............................................         20

36. HOLDING OVER:.........................................         20

37. SUCCESSORS AND ASSIGNS:...............................         20
<PAGE>   4
Section                                                         Page No.


38. ESTOPPEL CERTIFICATES:................................         20

39. OPTIONS TO EXTEND:....................................         21

40. THIS PARAGRAPH INTENTIONALLY DELETED..................         21

41. THIS PARAGRAPH INTENTIONALLY DELETED..................         21

42. OPTIONS:..............................................         21

43. QUIET ENJOYMENT:......................................         21

44. BROKERS:..............................................         22

45. LANDLORD'S LIABILITY:.................................         22

46. AUTHORITY OF PARTIES:.................................         22

47. THIS PARAGRAPH INTENTIONAL DELETED....................         22

48. MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS:.............................         22

49. THIS PARAGRAPH INTENTIONAL DELETED....................         22
<PAGE>   5
         1. PARTIES: THIS LEASE, is entered into on this 4th day of January,
1996, between Sobrato Interests III, a California Limited Partnership, and
Zycon, a Delaware Corporation, hereinafter called respectively Landlord and
Tenant.

         2. PREMISES: Landlord hereby leases to Tenant, and Tenant hires from
Landlord those certain Premises described on the site plan proposed by
Architectural Technologies dated 12/4/95, attached hereto, situated in the City
of Santa Clara, County of Santa Clara, State of California, including
improvements of:

                  Approximately a 59,000 square foot two story industrial
                  building, with parking for approximately two hundred eight
                  (208) automobiles, described on plans prepared by
                  Architectural Technologies dated 12/4/95, attached hereto as
                  Exhibit "A" to be constructed at Landlord's expense. The
                  Premises are to be constructed on approximately 3 acres as
                  shown on the Site Plan prepared by Architectural Technologies
                  dated 12/4/95 (the "Premises").

         3. USE: Tenant shall use the Premises only for the following purposes
and shall not change the use of the Premises without the prior written consent
of Landlord: Research, Office, and Light Manufacturing purposes including but
not limited to the assembly and manufacture of printed circuit boards, provided
that such assembly and manufacture shall be permitted by the 1994 Uniform
Building Code F-1 Occupancy.

         4. TERM: The Term shall be for one hundred fifty (150) months,
commencing on the 1st day of October, 1996 and ending on the 31st day of March,
2009, at the total rent or sum of NINE MILLION SEVEN HUNDRED THIRTY ONE THOUSAND
ONE HUNDRED SEVENTY FIVE AND 00/100 ($9,731,175.00) DOLLARS, payable, without
deduction or offset, in monthly installments as follows:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                           $'s/Month                        $'s/Year
                           ---------                        --------
<S>                                                         <C>
         10/1/96 - 9/30/97        $ 56,050 x 12 =           $672,600
         10/1/97 - 9/30/98        $ 57,451 x 12 =           $689,415
         10/1/98 - 9/30/99        $ 58,888 x 12 =           $706,650
         10/1/99 - 9/30/00        $ 60,360 x 12 =           $724,317
         10/1/00 - 9/30/01        $ 61,869 x 12 =           $742,425
         10/1/01 - 9/30/02        $ 63,415 x 12 =           $760,985
         10/1/02 - 9/30/03        $ 65,001 x 12 =           $780,010
         10/1/03 - 9/30/04        $ 66,626 x 12 =           $799,510
         10/1/04 - 9/30/05        $ 68,291 x 12 =           $819,498
         10/1/05 - 9/30/06        $ 69,999 x 12 =           $839,985
         10/1/06 - 9/30/07        $ 71,749 x 12 =           $860,985
         10/1/07 - 9/30/08        $ 73,542 x 12 =           $882,509
         10/1/08 - 3/31/09        $ 75,381 x 06 =           $452,286
</TABLE>
<PAGE>   6
                                      -2-


due on or before the first day of each calendar month during the term hereof.
Said rental shall be paid in lawful money of the United States of America,
without offset or deduction, and shall be paid to Landlord at such place or
places as may be designated in writing from time to time by Landlord. Rent for
any period less than a calendar month shall be a pro rata portion of the monthly
installment.

         Concurrently with Tenant's execution of this Lease, Tenant shall pay to
Landlord the sum of FIFTY SIX THOUSAND FIFTY AND 00/100 ($56,050.00) DOLLARS as
prepaid rent for the first month's rent.

         5. THIS PARAGRAPH INTENTIONALLY DELETED.

         6. LATE CHARGES: Tenant hereby acknowledges that late payment by Tenant
to Landlord or rent and other sums due hereunder will cause Landlord to incur
costs not contemplated by this Lease, the exact amount of which will be
extremely difficult to ascertain. Such costs include, but are not limited to,
administrative, processing, accounting charges, and late charges, which may be
imposed on Landlord by the terms of any contract, revolving credit, mortgage or
trust deed covering the Premises. Accordingly, if any installment of rent or any
other sum due from Tenant shall not be received by Landlord or Landlord's
designee within ten (10) days after such amount shall be due, Tenant shall pay
to Landlord a late charge equal to three percent (3%) of such overdue amount
which shall be due and payable with the payment then delinquent. The parties
hereby agree that such late charge represents a fair and reasonable estimate of
the costs Landlord will incur by reason of late payment by Tenant. Acceptance of
such late charge by Landlord shall in no event constitute a waiver of Tenant's
default with respect to such overdue amount, nor prevent Landlord from
exercising any of the other rights and remedies granted hereunder. In the event
that a late charge is payable hereunder, whether or not collected, for three (3)
consecutive installments of rent, then rent shall automatically become due and
payable quarterly in advance, rather than monthly, notwithstanding any provision
of this Lease to the contrary.

         7. CONSTRUCTION AND POSSESSION: The Tenant Interior Improvements and
Building Shell shall be constructed by independent contractors to be employed by
and under the supervision of Sobrato Construction Corporation, as general
contractor. The final plans for such Interior Improvements shall be prepared as
expeditiously as possible and shall be subject to the reasonable approval by the
parties, which approval shall not be unreasonably withheld or delayed. Landlord
shall construct the Tenant Interior Improvements and Building Shell in
accordance with all existing applicable municipal, local, state and federal
laws, statutes, rules, regulations and ordinances.

         The Building Shell and Tenant Interior Improvements are generally
described in Exhibit E. The final plans shall be consistent with Exhibit E and
shall be based upon and consistent with the plan for the Building Shell attached
as Exhibit A, and with the Tenant Floor Plans to be submitted as provided in
Exhibit E.

         Landlord shall be responsible for and shall pay the entire cost of the
Building Shell. Costs for all Tenant Interior Improvements shall be paid for by
Tenant in cash within ten (10)


<PAGE>   7
                                      -3-


days after Landlord has provided Tenant with written evidence of Landlord's
progress payments to sub-contractors. Landlord to retain 10% from progress
payment to sub-contractors until completion of punch list corrective work. All
costs for Tenant Interior Improvements shall be fully documented to and verified
by Tenant. Tenant reserves the right to require Landlord to secure three
competitive bids from sub-contractors on any item costing in excess of TWENTY
FIVE THOUSAND AND 00/100 ($25,000.00) DOLLARS.

         Landlord and Tenant to execute a standard construction contract
containing provisions customarily contained in such contracts providing
reasonable protection to the interests of the parties. The final selection of
the successful sub-contractors for the interior improvements shall be subject to
Tenant's approval. Upon receipt of all competitive bids, Tenant shall retain the
right to negotiate with any subcontractor subject to the reasonable approval of
Lessor. Tenant to have the right to record a chattel mortgage, personal property
lease, or other security interest on the lease hold improvements that it has
paid for and that have become an integral part of the real estate; Tenant's
rights hereunder will revert to the Landlord upon Tenant's surrender at the end
of the term or sooner termination of this Lease.

         If Landlord, for any reason whatsoever, cannot deliver possession of
the said Premises to Tenant at the commencement of the said term, as
hereinbefore specified, this Lease shall not be void or voidable, nor shall
Landlord be liable to Tenant for any loss or damage resulting therefrom; but in
that event the commencement date and the rent and rent schedule set forth in
Article 4 shall be revised to conform to the date of the Landlord's delivery of
possession but the termination date for the initial term of the Lease shall
continue to be March 31, 2009. If Tenant does not meet the plan delivery dates
described below, or should Tenant substantially change such plans afterward,
rental shall still commence on October 1, 1996 provided Landlord completes the
Building Shell to a watertight condition by July 1, 1996 even if Tenant
Improvements are not complete. The term of the Lease shall not commence until
the Premises are Substantially Complete as defined herein. "Substantially
Complete" shall mean that : (i) all necessary governmental approvals, permits,
consents, and certificates have been obtained by or for Landlord for the lawful
construction by Landlord, and occupancy by Tenant, (ii) all of the Premises'
interior fully meet all of the Tenant Floor Plans A, (iii) all of the Premises'
exterior substantially meets the applicable Tenant Floor Plans, including paved
parking areas, and (iv) said interior is in a "broom clean" finished condition.
If necessary, Landlord reserves the right to post a bond for the uncompleted
portion of the landscaping. In the event items (i), (ii), (iii) and (iv) above
are completed prior to October 1, 1996, Tenant agrees to accept such earlier
completion date and agrees to pay a per diem rental in the amount of $1,868.00
for each day prior to October 1, 1996 that the premises are completed.

         Notwithstanding the above, if Landlord has not acquired title to the
land and commenced construction of the Building Shell by June 1, 1996, Tenant
may terminate this Lease as its sole remedy by giving Landlord written notice.
Commencement of construction shall mean that Landlord has obtained all permits
necessary to construct the Building Shell given the use contemplated hereby, and
has commenced substantial excavation. The October 1, 1996 building delivery date
contemplates that Tenant shall have provided Landlord with one-line drawings of
Tenant wall layout and specifies all required electrical and mechanical
equipment by March 1,
<PAGE>   8
                                      -4-


1996, and complete working drawings by April 1, 1996 and if Tenant fails to do
so, the building delivery date shall be extended by one day for each day after
the above dates until Tenant delivers such drawings.

         Provided further that Landlord shall complete the Building Shell to a
watertight condition by July 1, 1996 and Tenant Interior Improvements by October
1, 1996 unless it has been delayed for causes beyond its reasonable control such
as, but not limited to, strikes, unavailable equipment or materials, changes
made by Tenant, or delays caused securing approval of governmental agencies. In
the event of a delayed Lease Commencement Date beyond December 1, 1996 plus
additional time for the unavoidable delays described above, Tenant is to receive
one day of free rent for every day beyond December 1, 1996 that the Premises are
not ready for Tenant's occupancy.

         8. ACCEPTANCE OF PREMISES AND COVENANTS TO SURRENDER. When Tenant
enters hereunder, Tenant shall accept the Premises as being in good and sanitary
order, condition and repair, except for latent defects and except for the "punch
list" to be provided Landlord within thirty (30) days after Tenant's occupancy.
The Tenant agrees on the last day of the tern hereof, or on the sooner
termination of this Lease, to surrender the Premises unto Landlord in good
condition and repair, reasonable wear and tear consistent with first class
office and light manufacturing uses excepted. "Good condition" shall mean that
the interior walls of all office and warehouse areas, the floors of all office
and warehouse areas, all suspended ceilings and any carpeting will be cleaned.
Tenant shall ascertain from Landlord at least thirty (30) days before the end of
the term of this Lease whether Landlord desires to have the Premises or any part
or parts thereof restored to their condition as of the Lease Commencement Date,
reasonable wear and tear consistent with first class office and light
manufacturing uses excepted, or to cause Tenant to surrender all alterations,
additions, and improvements in place to Landlord. Tenant may request Landlord's
decision at any time within six (6) months before the end of the Lease term and
Landlord shall respond within thirty (30) days of Tenant's inquiry. Landlord's
failure to respond within such period shall be deemed an election that Tenant
surrender the Premises in their then current condition. If Landlord so elects as
provided above, then Tenant shall remove such alterations, additions, and
improvements as Landlord may require and shall repair and restore said Premises
or such part or parts thereof to the condition before such removal, reasonable
wear and tear excepted, before the termination of this Lease at Tenant's sole
cost and expense. Tenant on or before the end of the Term or sooner termination
of this Lease, shall remove all his or its personal property and trade fixtures
from the Premises, and all property not so removed shall be deemed to be
abandoned by Tenant. Upon removal of its personal property and trade fixtures
from the Premises by Tenant, then Tenant shall be fully responsible to repair
any damage to the Premises caused by such removal and to return the Premises
upon which such personal property and trade fixtures were located to the
condition as existed prior to the installation, reasonable wear and tear
excepted. If the Premises are not surrendered at the end of the Term or sooner
termination of this Lease, Tenant shall indemnify Landlord against loss or
liability resulting from delay by Tenant in so surrendering the Premises
including, without limitation, any reasonable claims made by any succeeding
tenant founded on such delay. As used in this Lease, the words "trade fixtures"
shall include equipment.
<PAGE>   9
                                      -5-


         Provided further that Landlord hereby warrants that all work will be
performed in a good workmanlike manner free of all defects in construction
and/or materials for a period of one year after Tenant accepts possession plus a
period of two years from acceptance for the roof membrane or any other
waterproof conditions. Landlord to further assign all sub-contractor and
material supplier's warranties to Tenant.

         9. USES PROHIBITED: Tenant shall not commit, or suffer to be committed,
any waste upon the said Premises, or any nuisance, or other act or thing which
may disturb the quiet enjoyment of any other tenant in the project or allow any
sale by auction upon the Premises, or allow the Premises to be used for any
unlawful purpose, or place any loads upon the floor, walls, or ceiling which
endanger the structure, or place any harmful liquids, waste materials, or
hazardous materials in the domestic drainage system of or soils surrounding the
Building. No materials, supplies, equipment, finished products or semi-finished
products, raw materials or articles of any nature or any waste materials,
refuse, scrap or debris shall be stored upon or permitted to remain on any
portion of the Premises outside of the Building proper or appropriately screened
area unless completely enclosed in appropriate container that meets City
approvals. See Article 20.

         10. ALTERNATIONS AND ADDITIONS. Tenant shall not make, or suffer to be
made, any alteration or addition to the said Premises, or any part thereof,
without the written consent of Landlord first had and obtained based upon
Tenant's delivering to Landlord the proposed architectural and structural plans
for all such alterations; any addition or alteration to the said Premises,
except movable furniture and trade fixtures, shall become at once a part of the
realty and belong to Landlord. Alterations and additions which are not to be
deemed as trade fixtures shall include heating, lighting, electrical systems,
air conditioning, partitioning, carpeting, or any other installation which has
become an integral part of the Premises. After having obtained Landlord's
consent, Tenant agrees that it will not proceed to make such alterations or
additions, until three (3) days from the receipt of such consent, or ten (10)
working days after request for such consent, whichever is sooner, in order that
Landlord may post appropriate notices to avoid any liability to contractors or
material suppliers for payment for Tenant's improvements. Tenant will at all
times permit such notices to be posted and to remain posted until the completion
of work. Provided further that Tenant may make non-structural modifications to
the premises costing less than FIFTY THOUSAND AND 00/100 ($50,000.00) per
modification with a total of four (4) such modifications per year as long as
Tenant provides Landlord an "As Built" drawing within ten (10) days following
completion of the work.

         11. LANDLORD'S AND TENANT'S OBLIGATIONS REGARDING COMMON AREA COSTS:
Tenant acknowledges that this Lease is a net lease and the rental shall be paid
to Landlord net of all taxes (as and to the extent provided in Article 14),
utilities (as and to the extent provided in Article 15), insurance expenses (as
and to the extent provided in Article 13), maintenance, service, janitorial,
security and repair expenses (as and to the extent provided in Article 12) and
other operating expenses commonly borne by tenants of like commercial buildings.
Tenant shall pay all such expenses accruing after the Lease Commencement Date
and during the term of this Lease. Lease costs and costs of management,
financing and construction shall be Landlord's responsibility, except as
otherwise provided in this Lease.
<PAGE>   10
                                      -6-


         Landlord will use its best effort to obtain separate tax assessments
and insurance billings and separate utility meters for Tenant's building and
leasehold improvements therein.

         Tenant will have the right to approve all vendors selected by Landlord
that provide common area maintenance.

         12. MAINTENANCE OF PREMISES: Except as provided in Article 11 or below,
Tenant shall, at its sole cost, keep and maintain, repair and replace, said
Premises and appurtenances and every part hereof, including but not limited to,
exterior walls, roof glazing, sidewalks, parking areas, plumbing, electrical and
HVAC systems, and all the Tenant Interior Improvements in good and sanitary
order, condition and repair. Tenant shall provide Landlord with a copy of a
service contract between Tenant and a licensed air-conditioning and heating
contractor which contract shall provide for bi-monthly maintenance of all air
conditioning and heating equipment at the Premises. Tenant shall pay the cost of
all air-conditioning and heating equipment repairs or replacements which are
either excluded from such service contract or any existing equipment warranties.
Tenant shall be responsible for the preventive maintenance of the membrane of
the roof, which responsibility shall be deemed properly discharged if (i) Tenant
contracts with a licensed roof contractor who is reasonably satisfactory to both
Tenant and Landlord, at Tenant's sole cost, to inspect the roof membrane at
least annually, with the first inspection due the sixth (6th) month after the
Commencement Date, and (ii) Tenant performs, at Tenant's sole cost, all
preventive maintenance recommendations made by such contractor within a
reasonable time after such recommendations are made. Such preventive maintenance
might include acts such as clearing storm gutters and drains, removing debris
from the roof membrane, trimming trees overhanging the roof membrane, applying
coating materials to seal roof penetrations, repairing blisters, and other
routine measures. Tenant shall provide to Landlord a copy of such preventive
maintenance contract and paid invoices for the recommended work. Landlord to be
responsible for repairs or replacements of foundation, exterior walls (except
painting), the structural portions of the roof, any problems caused by
subsidence, and any defects in construction, workmanship or materials unless
caused by Tenant's fault. All vinyl wall surfaces and floor tile are to be
maintained in an as-good a condition as when Tenant took possession free of
holes, gouges, or defacements, reasonable wear and tear excepted. Tenant agrees
to limit attachments to vinyl wall surfaces exclusively to V-joints. Tenant
agrees to water, maintain and replace, when necessary, any shrubbery and
landscaping. Landlord to be responsible for landscape material replacement
required for the first twelve (12) months of this Lease.

         13. INSURANCE: Tenant shall not use, or permit said Premises, or any
part thereof, to be used, for any purpose other than that for which the said
Premises are hereby leased; and no use shall be made or permitted to be made of
the said Premises, nor acts done, which will cause a cancellation of any
insurance policy covering said Building, or any part thereof. Tenant shall, at
its sole cost and expense, comply with any and all requirements, pertaining to
said Premises, of any insurance organization or company, necessary for the
maintenance of reasonable fire and public liability insurance, covering said
Building and appurtenances. The Landlord agrees to purchase and keep in force
fire, earthquake (if commercially available and if required by Institutional
Lenders from time to time on the majority of similar industrial buildings in the
City of Santa Clara), and extended coverage insurance covering the Premises in
amounts not to
<PAGE>   11
                                      -7-


exceed the actual insurable value of the Building, including the Premises, as
determined by Landlord's insurance company's appraisers.

         Tenant's obligation to pay for Earthquake coverage shall be limited to
a maximum additional cost over a normal fire and extended coverage policy of
$35,000.00 per year subject to adjustment for Consumer Price Index increases
utilizing October 1, 1996 as the base period or if no consumer price index is
published for such period, then the nearest published information shall be
utilized as the base.

         In addition, Tenant agrees to insure its additions, alterations, and
those leasehold improvements paid for by Tenant which have become an integral
part of the Building or real estate for their full replacement value (without
depreciation) and to obtain worker's compensation and public liability and
property damage insurance for occurrences within the Premises of $10,000,000.00
combined single limit for bodily injury and property damage. Tenant shall name
Landlord, Sobrato Development Companies, and any future owner of the fee
interest, and the Institutional Lender on the building as loss payees as their
interests may appear on the property insurance and as an additional insured on
the liability insurance; shall deliver a Certificate of Insurance, additional
insured endorsement and renewal certificates to Landlord, fee owner, and Lender.
All such policies shall provide for thirty (30) days' prior written notice to
Landlord of any cancellation or termination.

         Landlord and Tenant hereby waive any rights each may have against the
other on account of any loss or damage occasioned to the Landlord or the Tenant
as the case may be, or to the Premises or its contents, and which arise from any
risk covered by their respective insurance policies, as set forth above. The
parties shall obtain from their respective insurance companies a waiver of any
right of subrogation which said insurance company may have against the Landlord
or the Tenant, as the case may be.

         14. TAXES. Tenant shall be liable for all taxes levied against personal
property and trade or business fixtures, and agrees to pay, as additional
rental, all real estate taxes and special assessment installments levied on the
Premises, upon the occupancy of the Premises and including any substitute or
additional charges which may be imposed during the Lease term including real
estate tax increases due to a sale or other transfer of the Premises, as they
appear on the City and County tax bills during the Lease term, and as they
become due. It is understood and agreed that Tenant's obligation under this
Article will be pro rated to reflect the commencement and termination dates of
this Lease. Tenant's obligation for taxes shall not apply to taxes accruing
before the Lease Commencement Date of this Lease. In any time during the term of
this Lease a tax, excise on rents, business license tax, or any other tax,
however described, is levied or assessed against Landlord, as a substitute or
addition in whole or in part for taxes assessed or imposed on land or Buildings,
Tenant shall pay and discharge his pro rata share of such tax or excise on rents
or other tax before it becomes delinquent, except that this provision is not
intended to cover net income taxes, inheritance, gift or estate tax imposed upon
the Landlord. In the event that a tax is placed, levied, or assessed against
Landlord and the taxing authority takes the position that the Tenant cannot pay
and discharge his pro rata share of
<PAGE>   12
                                      -8-



such tax on behalf of the Landlord, then at the sole election of the Landlord,
the Landlord may increase the rental charged hereunder by the exact amount of
such tax.

         15. UTILITIES: Except as provided in Article 11, Tenant shall pay
directly to the providing utility all water, gas, heat, light, power, telephone,
and other utilities supplied to the Premises. Tenant to pay for all sewer
discharge fees charged by the City of Santa Clara.

         16. WAIVER OF LIABILITY: Failure by Landlord to perform any defined
services, or any cessation thereof, when such failure is caused by accident,
breakage repairs, strikes, lockout or other labor disturbances or labor disputes
of any character, or by any other cause, similar or dissimilar, beyond the
reasonable control of Landlord, shall not render Landlord liable in any respect
for damages to other person or property, nor be construed as an eviction of
Tenant, nor cause an abatement of rent nor relieve Tenant from fulfillment of
any covenant or agreement hereof. Should any of the equipment or machinery
utilized in supplying the services listed herein break down, or for any cause
cease to function properly, upon receipt of written notice from Tenant of any
deficiency or failure of any defined Services, Landlord shall use reasonable
diligence to repair same promptly, but Tenant shall have no right to terminate
this Lease, and shall have no claim for rebate of rent or damages, on account of
any interruptions in service occasioned thereby or resulting therefrom. Tenant
waives the provisions of California Civil Code Sections 1941 and 1942 concerning
the Landlord's obligation of tenantability and Tenant's right to make repairs
and deduct the cost of such repairs from the rent. Landlord shall not be liable
for a loss of or injury to property, however occurring, through or in connection
with or incidental to furnishing or its failure to furnish any of the foregoing.

         17. ABANDONMENT: Tenant shall not vacate or abandon the Premises at
any time during the Term; and if Tenant shall abandon, vacate or surrender said
Premises, or be dispossessed by process of law, or otherwise, any personal
property belonging to Tenant and left on Premises shall be deemed to be
abandoned, at the option of the Landlord, except such property as may be
mortgaged to Landlord.

         18. FREE FROM LIENS: Tenant shall keep the Premises and the Building
in which the Premises are situated, free from any liens arising out of any work
performed, materials furnished, or obligations incurred by Tenant.

Provided further that Tenant shall have the right to contest such lien provided
it posts a bond indemnifying Landlord in an equivalent amount at Tenant's sole
cost and expense.

         19. COMPLIANCE WITH GOVERNMENTAL Regulations: Tenant shall, at its
sole cost and expense, comply with all of the requirements of all Municipal,
State and Federal authorities now in force, or which may hereafter be in force,
pertaining to the said Premises, and shall faithfully observe in the use of the
Premises all Municipal ordinances and State and Federal statutes now in force or
which may hereafter be in force provided further that Tenant reserves the right
to contest such requirement and as a condition of such contest Landlord may
require a bond be posted in a sufficient sum as Landlord reasonable determines
is necessary to protect and indemnify Landlord's interest. All costs for such
bond will be at Tenant's expense during the

<PAGE>   13
                                      -9-


period of protest. The judgment of any court of competent jurisdiction, or the
admission of Tenant in any action or proceeding against Tenant, whether Landlord
be a party thereto or not, that Tenant has violated any such ordinance or
statute in the use of the Premises, shall be conclusive of that fact as between
Landlord and Tenant.

         20. TOXIC WASTE AND ENVIRONMENTAL DAMAGES:

         A. TENANT'S RESPONSIBILITY: Except as may be permitted by the 1994
Uniform Building Code F-1 Occupancy, without the prior written consent of
Landlord, Tenant shall not bring, use, or permit upon the Premises, or generate,
create, release, emit, or dispose (nor permit any of the same) from the Premises
any chemicals, toxic or hazardous gaseous, liquid or solid materials or waste,
including without limitation, material or substance having characteristics of
ignitability, corrosivity, reactivity, or toxicity or substances or materials
which are listed on any of the Environmental Protection Agency's lists of
hazardous wastes or which are identified in Division 22 Title 26 of the
California Code of Regulations as the same may be amended from time to time
("Hazardous Materials"). In order to obtain consent, Tenant shall deliver to
Landlord its written proposal describing the toxic material to be brought onto
the Premises, measures to be taken for storage and disposal thereof, safety
measures to be employed to prevent pollution of the air, ground, surface and
ground water. Landlord's approval may be withheld in its reasonable judgment. In
the event Landlord consents to Tenant's use of Hazardous Materials on the
Premises, Landlord may impose reasonable conditions relating to the use of such
hazardous materials and the surrender of the Premises including requiring Tenant
to comply with all applicable closure requirements which may be imposed by
applicable authorities.

         B. TENANT'S INDEMNITY REGARDING HAZARDOUS MATERIALS: Tenant shall
comply, at its sole cost, with all laws pertaining to, and shall indemnify and
hold Landlord harmless from any claims, liabilities, costs or expenses incurred
or suffered by Landlord arising from such bringing, using, permitting,
generating, emitting or disposing of Hazardous Materials by (i) Tenant, or by
(ii) a third party through the surface soils of the Premises during the Lease
Term. Tenant's indemnification and hold harmless obligations include, without
limitation, (i) claims, liability, costs or expenses resulting from or based
upon administrative, judicial (civil or criminal) or other action, legal or
equitable, brought by any private or public person under common law or under the
Comprehensive Environmental Response, Compensation and Liability Act of 1980
("CERCLA"), the Resource Conservation and Recovery Act of 1980 ("RCRA") or any
other Federal, State, County or Municipal law, ordinance or regulation, (ii)
claims, liabilities, costs or expenses pertaining to the identification,
monitoring, cleanup, containment, or removal of Hazardous Materials from soils,
riverbeds or aquifers including the provision of an alternative public drinking
water source, and (iii) all costs of defending such claims after request for
defense by Landlord. This Indemnity under this Paragraph B does not apply to
claims covered under Paragraph C.

         C. LANDLORD'S REPRESENTATIONS AND INDEMNITY: Landlord represents to
Tenant that no Hazardous Materials (as defined in Paragraph A) exists at the
Premises or any portion thereof. Landlord will provide Tenant, for Tenant's
approval, with a copy of all Phase I, Phase II or other environmental reports
within five days of Landlord's receipt of such reports. If any

<PAGE>   14
                                      -10-


report obtained by Landlord prior to commencement of construction discloses the
presence of Hazardous Material on the Premises, Tenant may, without further
liability, cancel its obligations under this Lease within 10 days of receipt of
such report. Landlord acknowledges and agrees that Tenant has no responsibility
for the conditions existing as of the date of the execution of this Lease in,
on, under or about the Premises or for any Hazardous Materials which Tenant can
prove were introduced to, on, in, under or about the Premises by Landlord or its
affiliated companies during construction. Landlord shall indemnify and hold
Tenant and its officers, directors, agents and employees ("Tenant Indemnities")
harmless from any claims, liabilities, costs or expenses incurred or suffered by
Tenant Indemnitees arising from the presence of Hazardous Materials on the
Premises as of the execution of this Lease or Hazardous Materials which were
used, generated, permitted, admitted, disposed of or brought onto the Premises
by Landlord during the Landlord's or Landlord's affiliated companies'
construction of the Building as required by this Lease. Landlord's
indemnification and hold harmless obligations include, without limitation, all
of the items referred to in subparagraphs (i) and (ii) of Paragraph B and all
costs of defending such claims after request for defense by Tenant. Landlord
agrees that the foregoing obligations are material conditions of this Lease, and
that such obligations shall survive any termination, cancellation or expiration
of this Lease.

         D. ACTUAL RELEASE BY TENANT: Tenant agrees to notify Landlord of any
lawsuits which relate to, or orders which relate to the remedying of, the actual
release of Hazardous Materials on or into the soils or groundwater at or under
the Premises. Tenant shall also provide to Landlord all notices required by
Section 25359.7(b) of the Health and Safety Code and all other notices required
by law to be given to Landlord in connection with Hazardous Materials. Without
limiting the foregoing, Tenant shall also deliver to Landlord, within twenty
(20) days after receipt thereof, any written notices from any governmental
agency alleging a material violation of, or material failure to comply with, any
federal, state or local laws, regulations, ordinances or orders, the violation
of which or failure to comply with, poses a foreseeable and material risk or
contamination of the groundwater or injury to humans (other than injury solely
to Tenant, its agents and employees within the Building).

         In the event of any release on or into the Premises or into the soil or
groundwater under the Premises of any Hazardous Materials used, treated, stored
or disposed of by Tenant, Tenant agrees to comply, at its sole cost and expense,
with all laws, regulations, ordinances and orders of any federal, state or local
agency relating to the monitoring or remediation of such Hazardous Materials. In
the event of any such release of Hazardous Materials, Tenant agrees to meet and
confer with Landlord and its Lender to attempt to eliminate and mitigate any
financial exposure to such Lender and resultant exposure to Landlord under
California Code of Civil Procedure section 736(b) as a result of such release
and promptly to take reasonable monitoring, cleanup and remedial steps given,
inter alia, the historical uses to which the Property has and continues to be
used, the risks to public health posed by the release, the then available
technology and the costs of remediation, cleanup and monitoring, consistent with
acceptable customary practices for the type and severity of such contamination
and all applicable laws. Nothing in the preceding sentence shall eliminate,
modify or reduce the obligation of Tenant under Article 20.B of this Lease to
indemnify and hold Landlord harmless from any claims liabilities, costs or
expenses
<PAGE>   15
                                      -11-


incurred or suffered by Landlord as provided in Article 20.B of this Lease.
Tenant shall provide Landlord prompt written notices of Tenant's monitoring
cleanup and remedial steps.

         In the absence of an order of any federal, state or local governmental
or quasi-governmental agency relating to the cleanup, remediation or other
response action required by applicable law, any dispute arising between Landlord
and Tenant concerning Tenant's obligation to Landlord under this Article 20.D
concerning the Level, method, and manner of cleanup, remediation or response
action required in connection with such a release of Hazardous Materials shall
be resolved by mediation and/or arbitration pursuant to the provisions of
Article 45 of this Lease.

         E. ENVIRONMENTAL MONITORING: Tenant shall permit Landlord and the
Lender and its agents and representatives reasonable rights to enter the
Premises during Tenant's normal business hours, and upon reasonable notice, to
observe the Premises, take and remove soil or groundwater samples and conduct
tests on the Premises, provided (1) that such inspection and testing and
sampling do not interfere with Tenant's use of the Premises as otherwise
permitted under the Lease; and (2) that the Lender, its agents and
representatives execute an appropriate Confidentiality Agreement reasonably
satisfactory to Lender and Tenant agreeing to hold confidential all
information relating to Tenant's products, processes and business operations
learned from such inspection; provided, however, that such confidentiality
shall not apply to any release of Hazardous Materials or contamination of the
Property, Improvements, soil or groundwater or any disclosure required by law.

         21. INDEMNITY: As a material part of the consideration to be rendered
to Landlord, Tenant hereby waives all claims against Landlord for damages to
goods, wares and merchandise, and all other personal property in, upon or about
said premises and for injuries to persons in or about said Premises, from any
cause arising at any time, and Tenant will hold Landlord exempt and harmless
form any damage or injury to any person, or to the goods, wares and merchandise
and all other personal property of any person, arising from the use of the
Premises by Tenant, or from the failure of Tenant to keep the Premises in good
condition and repair, as herein provided, except for Landlord's proven
negligence. Further, in the event Landlord is made party to any litigation due
to the acts or omission of Tenant, Tenant will indemnify and hold Landlord
harmless from any such claim or liability including Landlord's costs and
expenses and reasonable attorney's fees incurred in defending such claims. This
Article shall not apply to an injury or damage to person or property arising out
of any construction defect.

         22. ADVERTISEMENTS AND SIGNS: Tenant will not place or permit to be
placed, in, upon or about the said Premises any unusual or extraordinary signs,
or any signs not approved by the City or other governing authority. The Tenant
will not place, or permit to be placed, upon the Premises, any signs,
advertisements or notices without the written consent of the Landlord as to
type, size, design, lettering, coloring and location, and such consent will not
be unreasonably withheld. Any sign so placed on the Premises shall be so placed
upon the understanding and agreement that Tenant will remove same at the
termination of the tenancy herein created and repair any damage or injury to the
Premises caused thereby, and if not so removed by Tenant then Landlord may have
same so removed at Tenant's expense.
<PAGE>   16
                                      -12-


         23. ATTORNEY'S FEES: In case suit should be brought for the possession
of the Premises, for the recovery of any sum due hereunder, or because of the
breach of any other covenant herein, the losing party shall pay to the
prevailing party a reasonable attorney's fee as part of its costs which shall be
deemed to have accrued on the commencement of such action.

         24. TENANT'S DEFAULT:: The occurrence of any of the following shall
constitute a default and breach of this Lease by Tenant: (a) Any failure by
Tenant to pay the rental or to make any other payment required to be made by
Tenant hereunder, where such failure continues for ten (10) days after written
notice thereof by Landlord to Tenant; (b) The abandonment or vacation of the
Premises by Tenant; (c) A failure by Tenant to observe and perform any other
provision of this Lease to be observed or performed by Tenant, where such
failure continues for thirty (30) days after written notice thereof by Landlord
to Tenant; provided, however, that if the nature of such default is such that
the same cannot reasonably be cured within such thirty (30) day period Tenant
shall not be deemed to be in default if Tenant shall within such period commence
such cure and thereafter diligently prosecute the same to completion; (d) The
making by Tenant of any general assignment for the benefit of creditors; the
filing by or against Tenant of a petition to have Tenant adjudged a bankrupt or
of a petition for reorganization or arrangement under any law relating to
bankruptcy (unless, in the case of petition filed against Tenant, the same is
dismissed after the filing); the appointment of a trustee or receiver to take
possession of substantially all of Tenant's assets located at the Premises or of
Tenant's interest in this Lease, where possession is not restored to Tenant
within thirty (30) days; or the attachment, execution or other judicial seizure
of substantially all of Tenant's assets located at the Premises or of Tenant's
interest in this Lease, where such seizure is not discharged within thirty (30)
days. The notice requirements set forth herein are in lieu of and not in
addition to the notices required by California Code of Civil Procedure Section
1161.

         24(a). REMEDIES: In the event of any such default by Tenant, then in
addition to any other remedies available to Landlord at law or in equity,
Landlord shall have the immediate option to terminate this Lease and all rights
of Tenant hereunder by giving written notice of such intention to terminate. In
the event that Landlord shall elect to so terminate this Lease then Landlord may
recover from Tenant: (a) the worth at the time of award of any unpaid rent which
had been earned at the time of such termination; plus (b) the worth at the time
of award of the amount by which the unpaid rent would have been earned after
termination until the time of award exceeds the amount of such rental loss
Tenant proves could have been reasonably avoided; plus (c) the worth at the time
of award of the amount by which the unpaid rent for the balance of the term
after the time of award exceeds the amount of such rental loss that Tenant
proves could be reasonably avoided; plus (d) any other amount necessary to
compensate Landlord for all the detriment proximately caused by Tenant's failure
to perform his obligations under this Lease or which in the ordinary course of
things would be likely to result therefrom, and (e) at Landlord's election, such
other amounts in addition to or in lieu of the foregoing as may be permitted
from time to time by applicable California law. The term "rent," as used herein,
shall be deemed to be and to mean the minimum monthly installments of rent and
all other sums required to be paid by Tenant pursuant to the terms of this
Lease, all other such sums being deemed to be additional rental due hereunder.
As used in (a) and (b) above, the "worth at the time of award" is computed


<PAGE>   17
                                      -13-


by allowing interest at the rate of the discount rate of the Federal Reserve
Bank of San Francisco plus five (5%) percent per annum. As used in (c) above,
the "worth at the time of award" is computed by discounting such amount at the
discount rate of the Federal Reserve Bank of San Francisco at the time of award
plus one (1%) percent.

         24.(b) RIGHT TO RE-ENTER:In the event of any uncured monetary default
as defined above or a default invoking a breach of Article 20 herein by Tenant,
Landlord shall also have the right, with or without terminating this Lease, to
reenter the Premises and remove all persons and property from the Premises; such
property may be removed and stored in a public warehouse or elsewhere at the
cost of and for the account of Tenant.

         24.(c) ABANDONMENT: In the event of the vacation or abandonment of the
Premises by Tenant or in the event that Landlord shall elect to re-enter as
provided in Article 24.(b) above or shall take possession of the Premises
pursuant to legal proceeding or pursuant to any notice provided by law, then if
Landlord does not elect to terminate this Lease as provided in Article 24.(a)
above, then the provisions of California Civil Code Section 1951.4, as amended
form time to time, shall apply and Landlord may from time to time, without
terminating this Lease, either recover all rental as it becomes due or relet the
Premises or any part thereof for such term or terms and at such rental or
rentals and upon such other terms and conditions as Landlord in its sole
discretion may deem advisable with the right to make alterations and repairs to
the Premises. In the event that Landlord shall elect to so relet, then rentals
received by Landlord from such reletting shall be applied: first, to the payment
of any indebtedness other than rent due hereunder from Tenant to Landlord;
second, to the payment of any prorated cost of such reletting; third, to the
payment of the cost of any prorated alterations and repairs to the Premises;
fourth, to the payment of rent due and unpaid hereunder, and the residue, if
any, shall be held by Landlord and applied in payment of future rent as the same
may become due and payable hereunder. Should that portion of such rentals
received from such reletting during any month, which is applied by the payment
of rent hereunder, be less than the rent payable during that month by Tenant
hereunder, then Tenant shall pay such deficiency to Landlord immediately upon
demand therefore by Landlord. Such deficiency shall be calculated and paid
monthly. Tenant shall also by to Landlord, as soon as ascertained, any costs and
expenses incurred by Landlord in such reletting or in making such alterations
and repairs not covered by the rentals received from such reletting.

         24.(d) NO TERMINATION: No re-entry or taking possession of the Premises
by Landlord pursuant to 24.(b) or 24.(c) of this Article 24 shall be construed
as an election to terminate this Lease unless a written notice of such intention
to be given to Tenant or unless the termination thereof be decreed by a court of
competent jurisdiction. Notwithstanding any reletting without termination by
Landlord because of any default by Tenant, Landlord may at any time after such
reletting elect to terminate this Lease for any such default.

         25. SURRENDER OF LEASE: The voluntary or other surrender of this Lease
by Tenant, or a mutual cancellation thereof, shall not automatically effect a
merger of the Lease with Landlord's ownership of the Building and Premises.
Instead, at the option of Landlord, Tenant's surrender may terminate all or any
existing sublease or subtenancies, or may operate as an


<PAGE>   18
                                      -14-


assignment to Landlord of any or all such subleases or subtenancies, thereby
creating a direct Landlord-Tenant relationship between Landlord and any
subtenants.

         26. HABITUAL DEFAULT Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained
in Article 24, 24(a), (b), (c) and (d), the parties hereto agree that if the
Tenant shall have defaulted in the performance of any monetary default or a
default involving a breach of Article 20 herein of this Lease for three or more
times during any twelve month period during the term hereof, then such conduct
shall, at the election of the Landlord, represent a separate event of default
which cannot be cured by the Tenant. Tenant acknowledges that the purpose of
this provision is to prevent repetitive defaults by the Tenant under the Lease,
which work a hardship upon the Landlord, and deprive the Landlord of the timely
performance by the Tenant hereunder.

         27. LANDLORD'S DEFAULT: In the event of Landlord's failure to perform
any of its covenants or agreements under this Lease, Tenant shall give Landlord
written notice of such failure and shall give Landlord the reasonable
opportunity to cure such failure prior to any claim for breach or for damages
resulting from such failure.

         28. NOTICES: All notices given to Tenant may be given in writing
personally or by depositing the same in the United States mail, postage prepaid,
and addressed:

    Tenant at:                         Landlord at:
    Zycon Corporation                  Sobrato Interests III
    445 El Camino Real                 10600 North De Anza Boulevard, Suite 200
    Santa Clara, California  95050     Cupertino, California  95014

or such other address advised by Tenant or Landlord in writing, whether or not
Tenant has departed from, abandoned or vacated the Premises. All notices shall
be deemed received three (3) days after posting.

         29. ENTRY BY LANDLORD: Tenant shall permit Landlord and his agents to
enter into and upon said Premises at all reasonable times subject to any
security regulations of Tenant for the purpose of inspecting the same or for the
purpose of maintaining the Premises or the Building in which said Premises are
situated, or for the purpose of making repairs, alterations to the Premises, or
building on adjacent land leased by Landlord, including the erection and
maintenance of such scaffolding, canopies, fences and props as may be required
without any rebate of rent or without any liability to Tenant for any loss of
occupation or quiet enjoyment of the Premises thereby occasioned. In the event
of a substantial disruption to Tenant during such entry, Tenant will be entitled
to reasonable reduction in rent determined by the percentage of the floor area
of the building that can not be utilized by the Tenant; and Tenant shall permit
Landlord and his agents, at any time within ninety (90) days prior to the
expiration of this Lease, to place upon said Premises any "For Sale" or "For
Lease" signs and exhibit the Premises to prospective tenants at reasonable
hours.

         30.DESTRUCTION OF PREMISES: If the Premises are damaged or destroyed
from any cause during the term of this Lease (including option periods) Landlord
will within thirty (30)


<PAGE>   19
                                      -15-


days of the destruction, notify Tenant in writing: (1) whether or not the
repairs can be made within one hundred fifty (150) days; (2) whether the
destruction is a partial destruction as defined below; (3) if the destruction is
an uninsured loss as defined below which Landlord declines to repair. Within
thirty (30) days of such notice, either party may by written notice to the other
terminate this Lease if the repairs cannot be made within one hundred fifty
(150) days, or if the loss is an uninsured loss unless the Landlord elects to
repair the same or if destruction exceeds more than one-half (1/2) of the
replacement cost of the premises. If Landlord fails to timely give the notice,
Tenant shall have ninety (90) days after destruction to give notice of
termination.

         In the event of a partial destruction of the Premises from any cause
then, unless the Lease is terminated as provided above, Landlord shall forthwith
repair the same, provided such repairs can be made within one hundred fifty
(150) days under the laws and regulations of State, Federal, County or Municipal
authorities, but such partial destruction shall in no way annul or void this
Lease, except that Tenant shall be entitled to a proportionate reduction of rent
while such repairs are being made, such proportionate reduction to be based upon
the extent to which the making of such repairs shall interfere with the business
carried on by Tenant in the said Premises in the reasonable judgment of
Landlord. In the event that Landlord does not elect to make such repairs, or
such repairs cannot be made under such laws and regulations, this Lease may be
terminated at the option of Tenant. For purposes of this Article "partial
destruction" shall mean destruction to the extent of one-half (1/2) of the
Replacement Cost of the Premises or less. In the event the Premises are more
than partially destroyed, Landlord, or Tenant, may elect to terminate this
Lease. If not so terminated, Landlord shall proceed with repairs, this Lease
continuing in full force and the rent to be proportionately reduced as
aforesaid. In respect to any partial destruction which Landlord is obligated to
repair or may elect to repair under the terms of this Article, the provision of
Section 1932, Subdivision 2, and of Section 1933, Subdivision 4, of the Civil
Code of the State of California are waived by Tenant. In all events a total or
partial destruction of the Premises by an uninsured casualty with damage costing
in excess of $500,000.00 to repair, such event shall terminate this Lease at the
option of Landlord. In the event of any dispute between Landlord and Tenant
relative to the provisions of this Article, they shall each select an
arbitrator, the two arbitrators so selected shall select a third arbitrator and
the three arbitrators so selected shall hear and determine the controversy and
their decision thereon shall be final and binding upon both Landlord and Tenant,
who shall bear the cost of such arbitration equally between them. In all events
Landlord shall not be required to restore additions, alterations or improvements
made by Tenant after commencement of this Lease or replace Tenant's fixtures or
personal property. This exception shall not apply to the Tenant Interior
Improvements covered by Article 7 provided sufficient insurance proceeds are
available to Landlord to restore such improvements or modifications.

         If the Landlord does not rebuild the Premises, then Tenant shall be
entitled to the prorated portion of insurance proceeds under the policy it
carries under Article 13. The prorated portion shall be determined on a straight
line basis over the original term of the Lease.

         31.ASSIGNMENT OR SUBLEASE: In the event Tenant should desire to assign
this Lease or any interest therein including, without limitation, a pledge,
mortgage or other hypothecation, except as provided in Article 7, or sublet the
Premises or any part thereof, Tenant shall give


<PAGE>   20
                                      -16-


Landlord written notice of such desire at least thirty (30) days in advance of
the date on which Tenant desires to make such assignment or sublet. After Tenant
has located a subtenant satisfactory to Tenant, it shall provide further notice
to Landlord. This further notice shall give the name and current address of the
proposed assignee/subtenant, proposed use of the Premises, rental rate and
current financial statement; and upon request to Tenant, Landlord shall be given
additional information as reasonably required to determine whether it will
consent to the proposed assignment or sublease. Landlord shall then have a
period of five (5) working days following receipt of such notice within which to
notify Tenant in writing that Landlord elects (i) to terminate this Lease as to
the space so affected as of the date so specified by Tenant in which event
Tenant will be relieved of all further obligations hereunder as to such space,
(ii) to permit Tenant to assign or sublet such space to the named
assignee/subtenant on the terms and conditions set forth in the notice, or (iii)
refuse consent. If Landlord should fail to notify Tenant in writing of such
election within said five (5) working day period, Landlord shall be deemed to
have elected option (ii) above. Except as provided below, any rent or other
consideration realized by Tenant under any such sublease and assignment in
excess of the monthly rental installments payable hereunder, and all expenses
payable under Article 11 less reasonable subletting and assignment costs, and
costs payable by Tenant to modify the premises to suit the sub-tenant, shall be
divided and paid fifty percent (50%) to Landlord and fifty percent (50%) to
Tenant. Tenant's obligation to pay over Landlord's portion of the consideration
shall constitute an obligation for additional rent hereunder. Tenant shall first
receive its subletting and modification costs without interest before dividing
any excess profits with Landlord. No assignment or subletting by Tenant shall
relieve Tenant of any obligation under this Lease. Any assignment or subletting
which conflicts with the provisions hereof shall be void.

         If Landlord exercises its option to terminate this Lease in part in the
event Tenant desires to sublet or assign part of the Premises, then (a) this
Lease shall end and expire, with respect to such part of the Premises, on the
date upon which the proposed sublease was to commence, and (b) from and after
such date, the rent and Tenant's allocable share of all other costs and charges
shall be adjusted, based upon the proportion that the rentable area of the
Premises remaining bears to the total rentable area of the Premises.

         If Landlord does not exercise its option to terminate this Lease,
Landlord's consent to the proposed assignment or sublease shall not be
unreasonably withheld provided and upon condition that:

                  (a) In Landlord's reasonable judgment, the proposed assignee
         or subtenant is engaged in such a business, and the Premises, or the
         relevant part thereof, will be used in such a manner, that:
         (ii) is limited to the use expressly permitted under this Lease;

                  (b) The proposed assignee or subtenant is a company with
         sufficient financial worth and management ability to undertake the
         responsibility involved and Landlord has been furnished with reasonable
         proof thereof;

                  (c)      THIS PARAGRAPH INTENTIONALLY DELETED
<PAGE>   21
                                      -17-


                  (d) The proposed sublease shall be in form reasonably
         satisfactory to Landlord;

                  (e) There shall not be more than two (2) subtenants of the
         Premises at any one time;

                  (f)      THIS PARAGRAPH INTENTIONALLY DELETED

                  (g) Tenant shall reimburse Landlord on demand for any
         reasonable costs that may be incurred by Landlord in connection with
         said assignment or sublease, including the costs of making
         investigations as to the acceptability of the proposed assignee or
         subtenant and reasonable legal costs incurred in connection with the
         granting of any requested consent;

                  (h) Landlord will not withhold consent to an assignment or a
         sublease of the Premises if Landlord does or is required to consent to
         an assignment or sublease of 445 El Camino Real, Santa Clara, 435 El
         Camino Real, Santa Clara, or 1270 Cambell Avenue, San Jose.

         Any sublease or assignment executed with the consent of Landlord shall
be subject to all of the covenants, agreements, terms, provisions and conditions
contained in this Lease. Notwithstanding any such sublease or assignment and the
acceptance of rent or additional rent by Landlord from any subtenant or
assignee, Tenant shall and will remain fully liable for the payment of the rent
and additional rent due, and to become due hereunder, for the performance of all
of the covenants, agreements, terms, provisions and conditions contained in this
Lease on the part of Tenant to be performed and for all acts and omissions of
any licensee, subtenant, assignee or any other person claiming under or through
any subtenant that shall be in violation of any of the obligations of this
Lease, and any such violation shall be deemed to be a violation by Tenant.
Tenant shall further indemnify, defend and hold Landlord harmless from and
against any and all losses, liabilities, damages, costs and expenses (including
reasonable attorney fees) resulting from any claims that may be made against
Landlord by the proposed assignee or subtenant or by any real estate brokers or
other persons claiming a commission or similar compensation in connection with
the proposed assignment or sublease. In the event of Tenant's default, Tenant
hereby assigns all rents due from any assignment or subletting to Landlord as
security for performance of its obligations under this Lease and Landlord may
collect such rents as Tenant's Attorney-in-Fact, except that Tenant may collect
such rents unless a default occurs, as described in Article 24 above.

         Any assignment or transfer shall be made only if and shall not be
effective until the assignee shall execute, acknowledge and deliver to landlord
an agreement, in form and substance satisfactory to Landlord, whereby the
assignee shall assume all of the obligations of this Lease on the part of Tenant
to be performed or observed.

         If Tenant is a corporation or partnership, all the above provisions
shall apply to a transfer (by one or more transfers) of a majority of the stock
of the corporation or the majority of


<PAGE>   22
                                      -18-


ownership or control of the partnership, as if such transfer were an assignment
of this Lease; but said provisions shall not apply to transactions with a
corporation or partnership that controls, is controlled by, or is under common
control with Tenant, provided that, in any such events: (i) the successor to
Tenant has a net worth, computed in accordance with generally accepted
accounting principles, at least equal to the net worth of Tenant immediately
prior to such transfer; and (ii) proof satisfactory to Landlord of such newt
worth shall have been delivered to Landlord at least ten (10) days prior to the
effective date of any such transaction.

         Notwithstanding the above, the sale or transfer of a majority of the
Tenant's shares shall not constitute as assignment so long as immediately after
such sale or transfer the corporation meets the net worth criteria set forth
above. Without limiting the above, the issuance of new shares by Zycon in any
private or public offering and the sale of any stock of existing shareholder in
connection therewith, shall not constitute as assignment of the lease, provided
the net worth of Tenant immediately following such sale is no less than the net
worth of Tenant immediately prior to such stock sale.

         Notwithstanding the above, Tenant may assign this Lease without
Landlord's consent to any corporation resulting from the merger or consolidation
with Tenant or to any person or entity which acquires all or substantially all
the assets of Tenant as a going concern of the business that is being conducted
on the Premises provided that the assignee meets the net worth criteria set
forth above and provided such assignee agrees in writing to abide by all of the
terms of this Lease. Only the amount allocated to the Lease in the agreement
between Tenant and the purchaser of the business shall be considered rent for
purposes of the 50/50 sharing provided in the first paragraph of this Article
31.

         The termination of this Lease due to Tenant's default shall not
automatically terminate any assignment or sublease then in existence. At the
sole election of Landlord, the assignee or subtenant shall attorn to Landlord
and Landlord shall undertake the obligations of the Tenant under the sublease or
assignment; provided the Landlord shall not be liable for prepaid rent, security
deposits or other defaults of the Tenant to the subtenant or assignee.

         32. CONDEMNATION: If any part of the Premises shall be taken for any
public or quasi-public use, under any statute or by right of eminent domain or
private purchase in lieu thereof, and a part thereof remains which is
susceptible of occupation hereunder, this Lease shall as to the part so taken,
terminate as of the date title shall vest in the condemn or purchase, and the
rent payable hereunder shall be adjusted so that the Tenant shall be required to
pay for the remainder of the term only such portion of such rent as the value of
the part remaining after such taking bears to the value of the entire Premises
prior to such taking; but in such event Landlord shall have the option to
terminate this Lease as of the date when title to the part so taken vests in the
condemnor or purchaser. Tenant to be notified in writing by Landlord of any
pending or threatened condemnation proceedings within a reasonable period of
time after Landlord's knowledge of same and whether Landlord intends to
terminate the lease so as to give Tenant a reasonable opportunity to locate new
facilities. If all of the Premises be taken, then Landlord and Tenant shall
share in the balance of the compensation remaining after the application of the
condemnation provisions of any existing Mortgage covering the Premises. The
compensation


<PAGE>   23
                                      -19-


shall be divided between Landlord and Tenant in proportion to the relative
amounts spent by Landlord for the Building; shell and the appraised value of the
land at the time of condemnation and Tenant for the Building shell Tenant
Improvements as provided in this Lease. Tenant's share of the compensation shall
not exceed the depreciated value of the improvements as provided in this Lease
installed and paid for by Tenant less any amounts received or to be received by
Tenant outside of the award as compensation for Tenant's interest in those
improvements. If Tenant elects to remove some or all of the improvements
pursuant to California Code of Civil Procedure Section 1263.260, then the value
of such improvements removed shall be excluded form the calculation. Landlord
shall have the exclusive right to negotiate or litigate the award with the
authority exercising the power of eminent domain. Landlord shall cooperate with
Tenant in Tenant's efforts to recover compensation for relocation costs, loss of
personal property not treated as improvements pertaining to realty and loss of
goodwill. Tenant waives the provisions of California Code of Civil Procedure
Section 1265.130.

         33. EFFECTS OF CONVEYANCE: The term "Landlord" as used in this Lease,
means only the Owner for the time being of the land and Building, containing the
Premises, so that, in the event of any sale, the Landlord shall be and hereby is
entirely freed and relieved of all covenants and obligations for the Landlord
hereunder, and it shall be deemed and construed, without further agreement
between the parties and the purchaser at any such sale, if the purchaser has
agreed in writing to carry out any and all covenants and obligations of the
Landlord hereunder, and thereupon the Landlord shall be discharged from any
further liability in reference thereto.

         34. SUBORDINATION: In the event Landlord notifies Tenant in writing,
this Lease shall be subordinate to any deed of trust, or other hypothecation for
security now or hereafter placed upon the real property of which the Premises
are a part and to any and all advances made on the security thereof and to
renewals, modifications, replacements and extensions thereof. Tenant agrees to
promptly execute any documents which may be required to effectuate such
subordination. Notwithstanding such subordination, Tenant's right to quire
possession of the Premises shall not be disturbed if Tenant is not in default
and so long as Tenant shall pay the rent and observe and perform all of the
provisions of this Lease. At the request of any lender, Tenant agrees to execute
and deliver any reasonable modifications of this Lease which do not adversely
affect the leaseholder or Tenant's right hereunder.

         35. WAIVER: The waiver by Landlord of any breach of any term, covenant
or condition, herein contained shall not be deemed to be a waiver of such term,
covenant or condition or any subsequent breach of the same or any other term,
covenant or condition herein contained. The subsequent acceptance of rent
hereunder by Landlord shall not be deemed to be a waiver of any preceding breach
by Tenant of any term, covenant or condition of this Lease, other than the
failure of Tenant to pay the particular rental so accepted, regardless of
Landlord's knowledge of such preceding breach at time of acceptance of such
rent.

         36. HOLDING OVER: Any holding over after the termination or expiration
of the said term, shall be construed to be a hold over tenancy and Tenant shall
pay rent to Landlord at a rate equal to one and one-half (1 1/2) times the
monthly rental installment due in the month preceding the termination or
expiration of the Lease and shall otherwise be on the terms and conditions


<PAGE>   24
                                      -20-


herein specified, except those provisions relating to the term and any options
to extend or renew, which terms are expressly waived during any hold over.
Furthermore, no holding over shall be deemed or construed to exercise any option
to extend or renew this Lease in lieu of full and timely exercises of any such
option as required hereunder.

         37.SUCCESSORS AND ASSIGNS: The covenants and conditions herein
contained shall, subject to the provisions as to assignment, apply to and bind
the heirs, successors, executors, administrators and assigns of all the parties
hereto; and all of the parties hereto shall be jointly and severally liable
hereunder.

         38. ESTOPPEL CERTIFICATES: Tenant shall at any time during the term of
this Lease, upon not less than five (5) business days prior written notice from
Landlord, execute and deliver to Landlord a statement in writing certifying that
this Lease is unmodified and in full force and effect (or, if modified, stating
the nature of such modification) and the date to which the rent and other
charges are paid in advance, if any, and acknowledging that there are not, to
Tenant's knowledge, any uncured defaults on the part of Landlord hereunder or
specifying such defaults if they are claimed. Any such statement may be
conclusively relied upon by any prospective purchaser or encumbrance of the
Premises. Tenant's failure to deliver such statement within such time shall be
conclusive upon the Tenant that: (a) this Lease is in full force and effect,
without modification except as may be represented by Landlord; (b) there are not
uncured defaults in Landlord's performance.

         39. OPTIONS TO EXTEND: Tenant shall have the option and right to extend
the term of this Lease for two (2) separate additional and successive option
periods of five (5) years each, (each such period being referred to as the
"Renewal Term"). The rental during each such renewal term shall be determined by
increasing the annual rental by 2.5% of the annual rental then being paid in the
year immediately preceding the renewal term and continuing to be adjusted by
increasing 2.5% each and every year throughout the renewal term. Tenant's
options are subject to the following conditions precedent: (i) Tenant alone is
in occupation of and is conducting g the business in at least sixty six and
two-thirds percent (66 2/3%) of the Premises and Tenant, for itself and its
successors and assigns, hereby expressly acknowledges and agrees that this
Option to Extend is personal to Tenant; and (ii) Tenant has delivered written
notice by certified mail to Landlord not less than one hundred and twenty (120)
days prior and not more than one hundred and eighty (180) day prior to the
expiration of the then existing term of the Lease of Tenant's intention to
extend the term of the Lease.

         40. THIS PARAGRAPH INTENTIONALLY DELETED.

         41. THIS PARAGRAPH INTENTIONALLY DELETED.

         42. OPTIONS: Except as provided in Article 39, all Options provided
Tenant in this Lease are personal and granted to original Tenant and are not
exercisable by any third party should Tenant assign or sublet all or a portion
of its rights under this Lease, unless Landlord consents to permit exercise of
any option by any assignee or subtenant, in Landlord's sole

<PAGE>   25
                                      -21-


discretion. In the event that Tenant hereunder has any multiple options to
extend this Lease, a later option to extend the Lease cannot be exercised unless
the prior option has been so exercised.

         Notwithstanding the above, if the assignment is a result of the
transfer of Tenant's stock as permitted by Article 31, the options to extend
will survive the assignment.

         43. QUIET ENJOYMENT: Upon Tenant's faithful and timely performance of
all the terms and covenants of the Lease, Tenant shall quietly have and hold the
Premises for the term and any extensions thereof.

         44. BROKERS: Tenant represents it has not utilized or contacted a real
estate broker or finder with respect to this Lease, and Tenant agrees to
indemnify and hold Landlord harmless against any claim, cost, liability or cause
of action asserted by any broker or finder claiming through Tenant.

         45. LANDLORD'S LIABILITY: If Tenant should recover a money judgment
against Landlord arising in connection with this Lease, the judgment shall be
satisfied only out of Landlord's interest in the Premises or any other Premises
lease by Landlord to Tenant and owned by Landlord including the improvements and
real property and neither Landlord or any of its partners shall be liable
personally for an deficiency.

         46. AUTHORITY OF PARTIES: If Tenant is a corporation, each individual
executing this Lease on behalf of said corporation represents and warrants that
he is duly authorized to execute and deliver this Lease on behalf of said
corporation, in accordance with a duly adopted resolution of the Board of
Directors of said corporation or in accordance with the by-laws of said
corporation, and that this Lease is binding upon said corporation in accordance
with its terms.


         47. THIS PARAGRAPH INTENTIONALLY DELETED

         48. MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS: All rights and remedies hereunder are
cumulative and not alternative to the extent permitted by law and are in
addition to all other rights and remedies in law and in equity.

         49. THIS PARAGRAPH INTENTIONALLY DELETED

         If any term or provision of this Lease is held unenforceable or invalid
by a court of competent jurisdiction, the remainder of the Lease shall not be
invalidated thereby but shall be enforceable in accordance with its terms,
omitting the invalid or unenforceable term.

         This Lease shall be governed by and construed in accordance with
California law. All sums due hereunder, including rent and additional rent, if
not paid when due, shall bear interest at the maximum rate permitted under
California law accruing from the date due until the date paid to Landlord.

         Time is of the essence hereunder.
<PAGE>   26
                                      -22-


         The headings or titles to the paragraphs of this Lease are not a part
of this Lease and shall have no effect upon the construction or interpretation
of any part thereof nor shall any phrases in capital letters have nay increased
emphasis. This instrument contains all of the agreements and conditions made
between the parties hereto and may not be modified orally or in any other manner
than by an agreement in writing signed by all of the parties hereto or their
respective successors in interest.

         If Tenant fails to perform any obligation required under this Lease or
by law or governmental regulation, Landlord in its sole discretion may without
notice perform such obligation, in which event Tenant shall pay Landlord as
additional rent all sums paid by Landlord in connection with such substitute
performance within ten (10) days following Landlord's written notice for such
payment. Any delinquent sum shall bear interest at the maximum lawful contract
rate permitted to be charged under California law.

         If Landlord becomes a party to any litigation concerning this Lease,
the Premises, the Building or the Project by reason of any act or omission of
Tenant or Tenant's authorized representatives, Tenant shall be liable to
Landlord for reasonable attorneys' fees, court costs and litigation expenses
incurred by Landlord in the litigation, whether such litigation leads to actual
court action.

         All monetary sums due from Tenant to Landlord under this Lease shall be
deemed to be rent.

         Whenever a consent of a party to this Lease is required, such consent
will not be arbitrarily or unreasonably withheld or delayed.

         IN WITNESS WHEREOF, Landlord and Tenant have executed these presents,
the day and year first above written.

LANDLORD:                                            TENANT:

SOBRATO INTERESTS III                                ZYCON CORPORATION,
a California Limited Partnership                     a Delaware Corporation





By:  /s/ John M. Sobrato                             By: /s/ Ronald H. Donati
     ----------------------------------                  ---------------------
     John M. Sobrato, Trustee under THE              Ronald H. Donati
     JOHN MICHAEL SOBRATO 1985                       Its:  President
     SEPARATE PROPERTY TRUST
     Its:  General Partner

<PAGE>   27

                               EXHIBIT "C" and "D"


                                    NOT USED

<PAGE>   28
                                   EXHIBIT "E"

                            GUIDELINE SPECIFICATIONS
                           PROJECT: ZYCON CORPORATION
                            BUILDING SHELL DEFINITION



BUILDING SHELL DEFINITION

         The Building Shell includes the following items:

                  1.       Site Work

                           a. Asphalt concrete paving, wheel stops, and
stripping.

                           b. Concrete sidewalks, concrete curbs extending
through base rock, gutter, driveway, approaches, and plaster walls.

                           c. Landscaping, landscape lighting, including
photocells and automatic irrigation system.

                           d. Underground utilities - one 3" water, gas, fire
line, domestic sanitary line, site storm drainage system and, empty primary and
secondary electrical line, all of which shall be stubbed into building.

                  2.       Building Structure

         Includes all elements necessary to provide for a completely waterproof
Building Shell including but not limited to:

                           a. Concrete foundation and 5" slab-on-grade including
all reinforcing steel and wire mesh for 3,000 lb. loading including loading dock
if applicable.

                           b. Structural steel columns and beams.

                           c. Wood panelized glulam roof structure with #420 WMD
or equal fiberglass built-up roofing including roof drainage plumbing tied into
site storm system.

                           d. Glass, glazing and perimeter roll up or hollow
metal doors including normal passage hardware.

                           e. Concrete tilt-up or plaster on metal stud framed
exterior walls.

                           f. Exterior painting.
<PAGE>   29
                                      -2-


                           g. 6" sewer gut line run from front to back wall of
building.

                           h. A park standard flag pole and monument sign
without lettering.

                           i. Concrete depressed loading with two docks
including manual dock levers, 10' x 12' high lift doors and forklift ramp.

                           j. Concrete refuse pads adequately screened.

                           k. 2' x 8' roof access including ships ladder.

                           l. 3" over 10" paving at loading areas and dedicated
truck lanes.

                           m. The cost of providing home office and on site
supervision and administration of the shell construction.

TENANT INTERIOR IMPROVEMENT DEFINITION

         The Tenant Interior Improvements to be specified by Tenant subject to
the reasonable approval of Landlord shall include the following.

                  1. Insulation: Thermal or sound insulation, except
requirements of Title 24 to be included in shell cost.

                  2. Partitions: Textured gypboard or demountable vinyl covered
partitions over metal stud framing at 24" on center, with 2-1/2" rubber base as
required per Tenant Floor Plan.

                  3. Stairs, handrails, and shafts including sound insulation
(if multi-story).

                  4. Elevators: Elevators and shafts (if multi-story).

                  5. Doors and hardware: Full height, solid core, laminate doors
with anodized aluminum frame and lever handle latch set hardware as required per
Tenant Floor Plan.

                  6. Ceiling: Suspended T-bar ceiling with 2' x 4' 5/8" thick
fire rated acoustical tile or textured sheetrock over metal stud framing as
required per Tenant Floor Plan.

                  7. Lighting: 2' x 4' recessed fluorescent lighting fixtures as
required per Tenant Floor Plan.

                  8. Electrical: Primary and secondary wire, main switchgear,
power and lighting panels, electrical outlets, telephone outlets, light switches
and other required electrical distribution per Tenant Floor Plan.
<PAGE>   30

                                      -3-

                  9. Floor Covering: Cut pile or textured loop glued down carpet
or VAT as required per Tenant Floor Plan.

                  10. Window Covering: Horizontal aluminum one-inch salt blinds
as required per Tenant Floor Plan.

                  11. Life Safety Systems: Semi-recessed ceiling-mounted fire
sprinklers and gridwork as required per Tenant Floor Plan, including required
fire hoses, cabinets and fire extinguishers.

                  12. HVAC: Roof or pad mounted built-up or package units
including high and low pressure ducting and shafts, VAV boxes, supply and return
diffusers, and mechanical screening if required.

                  13. Plumbing: Restrooms and janitor closets including ceramic
tile, fixtures, mirrors, partitions and accessories, drinking fountains, sinks,
floor drains, coffee bars and other plumbing work as required per Tenant Floor
Plan.

                  14. Millwork: Millwork or cabinetry as required per Tenant
Floor Plan.

                  15. Interior Glazing: Glass or glazing as required per Tenant
Floor Plan.

                  16. The cost of Governmental permit fees including but not
limited to sewer discharge fees, construction taxes, electrical connection fees,
City plan check and permit fees; architectural and engineering fees to provide
working drawings for Tenant's supplied preliminary plans.

                  17. The cost of all consultant fees required to obtain all the
necessary governmental approvals for tenants use of toxic materials within the
building.

                  18. THIS PARAGRAPH DELETED INTENTIONALLY.

                  19. The cost of the tenant improvements including fit-up of
special areas shall include six percent (6.0%) fee to Sobrato Construction
Corporation to cover all of the following: field superintendent, temporary
on-site facilities; home office administration, supervision, and coordination;
financing fees, construction interests; construction period insurance; on-site
security and clean-up services during construction, and contractor's profit.

         Landlord and Tenant must each approve the Tenant Floor Plan for Tenant
Interior Improvements to the building. Landlord will prepare the Tenant Floor
Plan based on final improvement drawings and information supplied by Tenant.
Tenant will have ten (10) business days from receipt to approve or disapprove
any plans, and failure to timely disapprove shall mean approval. Said approval
shall not be unreasonably withheld. Tenant, at Tenant's expense,
<PAGE>   31


                                      -4-

to supply Landlord with preliminary improvement information including one-line
drawings of Tenant's wall layout, preliminary electrical and air conditioning
loads by March 1, 1996.

         Complete working drawings for all interior improvements including
electrical, air conditioning, and piping, to be provided Landlord prior to April
1, 1996. Any substantial changes to the final Tenant interior working drawings
provided after March 1, 1996 which Landlord can prove causes the Lease
Commencement Date to be delayed, shall cause the Lease Commencement Date to
occur one (1) day in advance of substantial completion as defined in the Lease
for each day of delay. Provided further that a total of five (5) days in delay
shall be granted Tenant for miscellaneous changes prior to the Landlord
enforcing the terms of this Article.

         Tenant will be permitted to install its fixtures and assembly equipment
during Landlord's construction of interior improvements at no rental cost,
provided it does not interfere with Landlord's construction schedule, and
employs Union labor unless Landlord and Tenant have secured agreements from
sub-contractors permitting equipment suppliers and Zycon mechanics to install
equipment.


<PAGE>   1
 
                                                                      EXHIBIT 11
 
                               HADCO CORPORATION
 
                STATEMENT RE: COMPUTATION OF PER SHARE EARNINGS
                     (IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PER SHARE DATA)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                  THREE MONTHS
                                           FOR THE YEARS ENDED OCTOBER,          ENDED JANUARY
                                          -------------------------------     --------------------
                                           1994        1995        1996        1996         1997
                                          -------     -------     -------     -------     --------
                                                                                  (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                       <C>         <C>         <C>         <C>         <C>
Primary:
  Net Income (Loss).....................  $ 9,943     $21,374     $32,014     $ 7,191     $(69,161)
                                          =======     =======     =======     =======      =======
  Average shares outstanding............    9,861       9,805      10,245      10,020       10,413
  Add: Average common stock equivalents
     outstanding........................    1,536       1,553       1,140       1,392           --
  Less: Shares assumed repurchased under
     the treasury stock method..........     (677)       (552)       (301)       (308)          --
                                          -------     -------     -------     -------      -------
          Total.........................   10,720      10,806      11,084      11,104       10,413
                                          -------     -------     -------     -------      -------
  Per share amount......................  $   .93     $  1.98     $  2.89     $   .65     $  (6.64)
                                          =======     =======     =======     =======      =======
</TABLE>

<PAGE>   1
                                                                      EXHIBIT 12


                               HADCO CORPORATION
             COMPUTATION OF THE RATIO OF EARNINGS TO FIXED CHARGES

<TABLE>
The following table sets forth the ratio of earnings to fixed charges of Hadco
Corporation for the period October 31, 1992 to January 25, 1997, including pro
forma financial data. The ratio of earnings to fixed charges is computed by
dividing net fixed charges (interest expense on all debt plus the interest
portion of rent expense) into earnings before income taxes and fixed charges.

<CAPTION>
                                                 Fiscal Year Ended,                                    Three Months Ended,
                       ---------------------------------------------------------------------   ------------------------------------
                       Oct. 31,   Oct. 30,   Oct. 29,   Oct. 28,   Oct. 26,      Oct. 26,      Jan. 27,   Jan. 25,      Jan. 25,
                         1992       1993       1994       1995       1996          1996          1996      1997           1997
                       --------   --------   --------   --------   --------   --------------   --------   --------   --------------
                                                                               (Pro Forma)                             (Pro Forma)
<S>                    <C>        <C>         <C>        <C>        <C>           <C>           <C>       <C>            <C>
Earnings before 
  income taxes          12,165     12,941     $16,434    $35,038    $52,481       $49,979       $11,794   $(62,496)      $14,518

Interest expense, 
  including interest 
  portion of rental 
  expense                2,045      1,402         891        537        338        16,197            95        933         4,669
Amortization of Debt 
  Issuance Costs                                                                      125            --          5            31
                        ------     ------     -------    -------    -------       -------       -------   --------       -------
Earnings before fixed 
  charges               14,210     14,343      17,325     35,575     52,819        66,301        11,899    (61,558)       19,218
                        ------     ------     -------    -------    -------       -------       -------   --------       -------
Fixed Charges:
  Interest expense, 
    including interest 
    portion of rental 
    expense              2,045      1,402         891        537        338        16,197            95        933         4,669
  Amortization of Debt 
    Issuance Costs          --         --          --         --         --           125            --          5            31
                        ------     ------     -------    -------    -------       -------       -------   --------       -------
Fixed charges            2,045      1,402         891        537        338        16,322            95        938         4,700
                        ------     ------     -------    -------    -------       -------       -------   --------       -------
Ratio of earnings to 
  fixed charges            6.9x      10.2x       19.4x      66.2x     156.3x          4.1x        125.1x        --           4.1x
</TABLE>

<PAGE>   1
 
                                                                    EXHIBIT 23.2
 
                   CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT PUBLIC ACCOUNTANTS
 
     As independent public accountants, we hereby consent to the use of our
reports (and to all references to our Firm) included in or made a part of this
registration statement.
 
                                          ARTHUR ANDERSEN LLP
 
Boston, Massachusetts
February 18, 1997

<PAGE>   1
 
                                                                    EXHIBIT 23.3
 
The Board of Directors
Hadco Corporation
 
We consent to the use of our report included herein and to the reference to our
firm under the heading "Experts" in the prospectus.
 
                                          KPMG Peat Marwick LLP
 
San Jose, California
February 17, 1997

<PAGE>   1
                                                                      EXHIBIT 25


                       SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
                             WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549


                                    FORM T-1
                                    ---------

                       STATEMENT OF ELIGIBILITY UNDER THE
                        TRUST INDENTURE ACT OF 1939 OF A
                    CORPORATION DESIGNATED TO ACT AS TRUSTEE

                Check if an Application to Determine Eligibility
                  of a Trustee Pursuant to Section 305(b)(2) __


                       STATE STREET BANK AND TRUST COMPANY
               (Exact name of trustee as specified in its charter)

              Massachusetts                                      04-1867445
    (Jurisdiction of incorporation or                         (I.R.S. Employer
organization if not a U.S. national bank)                   Identification No.)

                225 Franklin Street, Boston, Massachusetts         02110
               (Address of principal executive offices)          (Zip Code)

       John R. Towers, Esq. Senior Vice President and Corporate Secretary
                225 Franklin Street, Boston, Massachusetts 02110
                                  (617)654-3253
            (Name, address and telephone number of agent for service)

                              ---------------------


                                HADCO CORPORATION
               (Exact name of obligor as specified in its charter)

         MASSACHUSETTS                                          (04-2393279)
(State or other jurisdiction of                               (I.R.S. Employer
incorporation or organization)                              Identification No.)

                                12A MANOR PARKWAY
                           SALEM, NEW HAMPSHIRE 03079



                              --------------------

                         CONVERTIBLE SUBORDINATED NOTES
                         (Title of indenture securities)
<PAGE>   2
                                     GENERAL

ITEM 1.  GENERAL INFORMATION.

         FURNISH THE FOLLOWING INFORMATION AS TO THE TRUSTEE:

         (A)  NAME AND ADDRESS OF EACH EXAMINING OR SUPERVISORY AUTHORITY TO
              WHICH IT IS SUBJECT.

                  Department of Banking and Insurance of The Commonwealth of
                  Massachusetts, 100 Cambridge Street, Boston, Massachusetts.

                  Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System, Washington,
                  D.C., Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation, Washington, D.C.

         (B)  WHETHER IT IS AUTHORIZED TO EXERCISE CORPORATE TRUST POWERS.

                  Trustee is authorized to exercise corporate trust powers.

ITEM 2.  AFFILIATIONS WITH OBLIGOR.

         IF THE OBLIGOR IS AN AFFILIATE OF THE TRUSTEE, DESCRIBE EACH SUCH
AFFILIATION.

                  The obligor is not an affiliate of the trustee or of its
                  parent, State Street Boston Corporation.

                  (See note on page 2.)

ITEM 3. THROUGH ITEM 15.   NOT APPLICABLE.

ITEM 16. LIST OF EXHIBITS.

         LIST BELOW ALL EXHIBITS FILED AS PART OF THIS STATEMENT OF ELIGIBILITY.

         1. A COPY OF THE ARTICLES OF ASSOCIATION OF THE TRUSTEE AS NOW IN
         EFFECT.

                  A copy of the Articles of Association of the trustee, as now
         in effect, is on file with the Securities and Exchange Commission as
         Exhibit 1 to Amendment No. 1 to the Statement of Eligibility and
         Qualification of Trustee (Form T-1) filed with the Registration
         Statement of Morse Shoe, Inc. (File No. 22-17940) and is incorporated
         herein by reference thereto.

         2. A COPY OF THE CERTIFICATE OF AUTHORITY OF THE TRUSTEE TO COMMENCE
         BUSINESS, IF NOT CONTAINED IN THE ARTICLES OF ASSOCIATION.

                  A copy of a Statement from the Commissioner of Banks of
         Massachusetts that no certificate of authority for the trustee to
         commence business was necessary or issued is on file with the
         Securities and Exchange Commission as Exhibit 2 to Amendment No. 1 to
         the Statement of Eligibility and Qualification of Trustee (Form T-1)
         filed with the Registration Statement of Morse Shoe, Inc. (File No.
         22-17940) and is incorporated herein by reference thereto.

         3. A COPY OF THE AUTHORIZATION OF THE TRUSTEE TO EXERCISE CORPORATE
         TRUST POWERS, IF SUCH AUTHORIZATION IS NOT CONTAINED IN THE DOCUMENTS
         SPECIFIED IN PARAGRAPH (1) OR (2), ABOVE.

                  A copy of the authorization of the trustee to exercise
         corporate trust powers is on file with the Securities and Exchange
         Commission as Exhibit 3 to Amendment No. 1 to the Statement of
         Eligibility and Qualification of Trustee (Form T-1) filed with the
         Registration Statement of Morse Shoe, Inc. (File No. 22-17940) and is
         incorporated herein by reference thereto.

         4. A COPY OF THE EXISTING BY-LAWS OF THE TRUSTEE, OR INSTRUMENTS
         CORRESPONDING THERETO.

                  A copy of the by-laws of the trustee, as now in effect, is on
                  file with the Securities and Exchange Commission as Exhibit 4
                  to the Statement of Eligibility and Qualification of Trustee
                  (Form T-1) filed with the Registration Statement of Eastern
                  Edison Company (File No. 33-37823) and is incorporated herein
                  by reference thereto.


                                        1
<PAGE>   3
         5. A COPY OF EACH INDENTURE REFERRED TO IN ITEM 4. IF THE OBLIGOR IS IN
         DEFAULT.

                  Not applicable.

         6. THE CONSENTS OF UNITED STATES INSTITUTIONAL TRUSTEES REQUIRED BY
         SECTION 321(B) OF THE ACT.

                  The consent of the trustee required by Section 321(b) of the
                  Act is annexed hereto as Exhibit 6 and made a part hereof.

         7. A COPY OF THE LATEST REPORT OF CONDITION OF THE TRUSTEE PUBLISHED
         PURSUANT TO LAW OR THE REQUIREMENTS OF ITS SUPERVISING OR EXAMINING
         AUTHORITY.

                  A copy of the latest report of condition of the trustee
         published pursuant to law or the requirements of its supervising or
         examining authority is annexed hereto as Exhibit 7 and made a part
         hereof.


                                      NOTES

         In answering any item of this Statement of Eligibility which relates to
matters peculiarly within the knowledge of the obligor or any underwriter for
the obligor, the trustee has relied upon information furnished to it by the
obligor and the underwriters, and the trustee disclaims responsibility for the
accuracy or completeness of such information.

         The answer furnished to Item 2. of this statement will be amended, if
necessary, to reflect any facts which differ from those stated and which would
have been required to be stated if known at the date hereof.



                                    SIGNATURE

         Pursuant to the requirements of the Trust Indenture Act of 1939, as
amended, the trustee, State Street Bank and Trust Company, a corporation
organized and existing under the laws of The Commonwealth of Massachusetts, has
duly caused this statement of eligibility to be signed on its behalf by the
undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, all in the City of Boston and The
Commonwealth of Massachusetts, on the 12TH DAY OF FEBRUARY 1997.

                               STATE STREET BANK AND TRUST COMPANY


                               By:  /s/ GERALD R. WHEELER
                                    ---------------------
                                    GERALD R. WHEELER
                                    VICE PRESIDENT


                                        2
<PAGE>   4
                                    EXHIBIT 6


                             CONSENT OF THE TRUSTEE

         Pursuant to the requirements of Section 321(b) of the Trust Indenture
Act of 1939, as amended, in connection with the proposed issuance by HADCO
CORPORATION. of its CONVERTIBLE SUBORDINATED NOTES, we hereby consent that
reports of examination by Federal, State, Territorial or District authorities
may be furnished by such authorities to the Securities and Exchange Commission
upon request therefor.

                                STATE STREET BANK AND TRUST COMPANY


                                By:  /s/ GERALD R. WHEELER
                                     ---------------------
                                     GERALD R. WHEELER
                                     VICE PRESIDENT

DATED: FEBRUARY 12, 1997


                                        3
<PAGE>   5
                                    EXHIBIT 7

Consolidated Report of Condition of State Street Bank and Trust Company of
Boston, Massachusetts and foreign and domestic subsidiaries, a state banking
institution organized and operating under the banking laws of this commonwealth
and a member of the Federal Reserve System, at the close of business September
30, 1996, published in accordance with a call made by the Federal Reserve Bank
of this District pursuant to the provisions of the Federal Reserve Act and in
accordance with a call made by the Commissioner of Banks under General Laws,
Chapter 172, Section 22(a).


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                    Thousands of
ASSETS                                                                 Dollars
<S>                                                                   <C>
Cash and balances due from depository institutions:
         Noninterest-bearing balances and currency and coin .....     1,385,597
         Interest-bearing balances ..............................     6,205,892
Securities ......................................................     8,693,549
Federal funds sold and securities purchased
         under agreements to resell in domestic offices
         of the bank and its Edge subsidiary ....................     5,707,012
Loans and lease financing receivables:
         Loans and leases, net of unearned income ..  4,352,939
         Allowance for loan and lease losses .......     71,421
         Loans and leases, net of unearned income and allowances      4,281,518
Assets held in trading accounts .................................       702,030
Premises and fixed assets .......................................       364,550
Other real estate owned .........................................         1,100
Investments in unconsolidated subsidiaries ......................        65,775
Customers' liability to this bank on acceptances outstanding ....        36,351
Intangible assets ...............................................        71,688
Other assets ....................................................       835,647
                                                                     ----------

Total assets ....................................................    28,350,709
                                                                     ==========

LIABILITIES

Deposits:
         In domestic offices ....................................     8,283,786
                  Noninterest-bearing ..............  6,040,773
                  Interest-bearing .................  2,243,013
         In foreign offices and Edge subsidiary .................     9,309,212
                  Noninterest-bearing ..............     53,213
                  Interest-bearing .................  9,255,999
Federal funds purchased and securities sold under
         agreements to repurchase in domestic offices of
         the bank and of its Edge subsidiary ....................     7,014,421
Demand notes issued to the U.S. Treasury and Trading Liabilities        698,705
Other borrowed money ............................................       690,865
Bank's liability on acceptances executed and outstanding ........        37,357
Other liabilities ...............................................       695,718
                                                                     ----------

Total liabilities ...............................................    26,730,064
                                                                     ----------

EQUITY CAPITAL
Common stock ....................................................        29,931
Surplus .........................................................       277,023
Undivided profits ...............................................     1,311,920
Cumulative foreign currency translation adjustments .............         1,771
                                                                     ----------

Total equity capital ............................................     1,620,645
                                                                     ----------

Total liabilities and equity capital ............................    28,350,709
                                                                     ==========
</TABLE>

                                        4
<PAGE>   6
I, Rex S. Schuette, Senior Vice President and Comptroller of the above named
bank do hereby declare that this Report of Condition has been prepared in
conformance with the instructions issued by the Board of Governors of the
Federal Reserve System and is true to the best of my knowledge and belief.

                                          Rex S. Schuette


We, the undersigned directors, attest to the correctness of this Report of
Condition and declare that it has been examined by us and to the best of our
knowledge and belief has been prepared in conformance with the instructions
issued by the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System and is true and
correct.

                                          David A. Spina
                                          Marshall N. Carter
                                          Charles F. Kaye


                                        5
<PAGE>   7
         5. A COPY OF EACH INDENTURE REFERRED TO IN ITEM 4. IF THE OBLIGOR IS IN
         DEFAULT.

                  Not applicable.

         6. THE CONSENTS OF UNITED STATES INSTITUTIONAL TRUSTEES REQUIRED BY
         SECTION 321(b) OF THE ACT.

                  The consent of the trustee required by Section 321(b) of the
                  Act is annexed hereto as Exhibit 6 and made a part hereof.

         7. A COPY OF THE LATEST REPORT OF CONDITION OF THE TRUSTEE PUBLISHED
         PURSUANT TO LAW OR THE REQUIREMENTS OF ITS SUPERVISING OR EXAMINING
         AUTHORITY.

                  A copy of the latest report of condition of the trustee
         published pursuant to law or the requirements of its supervising or
         examining authority is annexed hereto as Exhibit 7 and made a part
         hereof.

                                      NOTES

         In answering any item of this Statement of Eligibility which relates to
matters peculiarly within the knowledge of the obligor or any underwriter of the
obligor, the trustee has relied upon the information furnished to it by the
obligor and the underwriters, and the trustee disclaims responsibility for the
accuracy or completeness of such information.

         The answer to Item 2. of this statement will be amended, if necessary,
to reflect any facts which differ from those stated and which would have been
required to be stated if known at the date hereof.


                                    SIGNATURE

         Pursuant to the requirements of the Trust Indenture Act of 1939, as
amended, the trustee, State Street Bank and Trust Company, a corporation duly
organized and existing under the laws of The Commonwealth of Massachusetts, has
duly caused this statement of eligibility to be signed on its behalf by the
undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, all in the City of Boston and The
Commonwealth of Massachusetts, on the February 12, 1997.

                                  STATE STREET BANK AND TRUST COMPANY


                                  By: /s/ GERALD R. WHEELER
                                      -------------------------------
                                      GERALD R. WHEELER
                                      VICE PRESIDENT


                                        2
<PAGE>   8
                                    EXHIBIT 6


                             CONSENT OF THE TRUSTEE

         Pursuant to the requirements of Section 321(b) of the Trust Indenture
Act of 1939, as amended, in connection with the proposed issuance by HADCO
CORPORATION. of its CONVERTIBLE SUBORDINATED NOTES, we hereby consent that
reports of examination by Federal, State, Territorial or District authorities
may be furnished by such authorities to the Securities and Exchange Commission
upon request therefor.

                                  STATE STREET BANK AND TRUST COMPANY


                                  By: /s/ GERALD R. WHEELER
                                      -------------------------------
                                      GERALD R. WHEELER
                                      VICE PRESIDENT

DATED:  FEBRUARY 12, 1997

                                        3

<TABLE> <S> <C>

<ARTICLE> 5
<MULTIPLIER> 1,000
<CURRENCY> U.S. DOLLARS
       
<S>                             <C>
<PERIOD-TYPE>                   3-MOS
<FISCAL-YEAR-END>                          OCT-25-1997
<PERIOD-START>                             OCT-27-1996
<PERIOD-END>                               JAN-25-1997
<EXCHANGE-RATE>                                      1
<CASH>                                           8,825
<SECURITIES>                                     3,264
<RECEIVABLES>                                   74,446
<ALLOWANCES>                                     1,830
<INVENTORY>                                     34,107
<CURRENT-ASSETS>                               131,902
<PP&E>                                         388,294
<DEPRECIATION>                                 184,655
<TOTAL-ASSETS>                                 448,554
<CURRENT-LIABILITIES>                          109,830
<BONDS>                                        228,168
                                0
                                          0
<COMMON>                                           523
<OTHER-SE>                                      70,534
<TOTAL-LIABILITY-AND-EQUITY>                    71,057
<SALES>                                        111,536
<TOTAL-REVENUES>                               111,536
<CGS>                                           86,681
<TOTAL-COSTS>                                  173,979
<OTHER-EXPENSES>                                     0
<LOSS-PROVISION>                                     0
<INTEREST-EXPENSE>                                (53)
<INCOME-PRETAX>                               (62,496)
<INCOME-TAX>                                     6,665
<INCOME-CONTINUING>                           (69,161)
<DISCONTINUED>                                       0
<EXTRAORDINARY>                                      0
<CHANGES>                                            0
<NET-INCOME>                                  (69,161)
<EPS-PRIMARY>                                   (6.64)
<EPS-DILUTED>                                        0
        

</TABLE>


© 2022 IncJournal is not affiliated with or endorsed by the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission